Motors

Page 1

Product catalog Industrial hydraulics Part 2: Motors


1

Product catalog Industrial hydraulics Part 2: Motors

Product catalogs Industrial hydraulics of Bosch Rexroth at a glance: Part 1:

Pumps

RE 00112-01

Part 2

Motors

RE 00112-02

Part 3:

Cylinders

RE 00112-03

Part 4:

On/o valves

RE 00112-04

Part 5:

Proportional servo valves

RE 00112-05

Part 6:

Electronics

RE 00112-06

Part 7:

Systems

RE 00112-07

Part 8:

Power units, Manifolds and plates, Accumulators

RE 00112-08

Part 9:

Filters

RE 00112-09

Part 10:

ATEX units for potentially explosive atmospheres

RE 00112-10

For the latest product information from Bosch Rexroth, please visit our website: www.boschrexroth.com/ics

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


2

Publisher

Bosch Rexroth AG Zum EisengieĂ&#x;er 1 97816 Lohr, Germany Phone +49(0)9352/18-0 Fax +49(0)9352/18-40 info@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com

Catalog No.

Document no.: RE 00112-02 Material no.: R999000303 Edition: 2013-08 Replaces: RE 00112-01_2008-11

Reprints and translation, in whole or in part, only with the publisher´s prior consent. Subject to revision.

Should you have queries with regard to the products in this catalog, please contact the Rexroth sales partner in your vicinity. www.boschrexroth.com/contact

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


3 Contents | Motors

Contents 5

1

69

2

External gear motors

337

3

Radial piston motors

379

4

General

Axial piston motors

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


4

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


5 Contents | General | Motors

General Designation

Data sheet

Page

Installation, commissioning and maintenance Installation, commissioning, maintenance of hydraulic systems

07900

7

Installation, commissioning and servicing of hydraulic pumps and motors

07080

13

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons

90220

15

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

90221

31

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids (HFDR/HFDU)

90222

45

Rating of hydraulic fluids for Rexroth hydraulic components (pumps and motors)

90235

61

1

Hydraulic fluids

2

3

4

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


6

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


7

Installation, commissioning and maintenance of hydraulic systems

1.

General

1.1 Long service life and functional reliability of hydraulic systems and their components depend on correct handling. Ensure trouble-free operation by observing the following points: – The specific installation and operating instructions for the relevant components – Special instructions in individual cases – Technical data in the data sheet. In addition, we would like to draw your attention to the following regulations: – German standard “Hydraulic systems“ DIN 24346 – ISO standard ISO 4413 2.

Installation

2.1 Preparatory work for the installation – Sauberkeit der Anlage gewährleisten! • For the surroundings: Keep power units, line connections and components clean or clean them (e.g. pickling after, for example, processes have been carried out that involve heat, i.e. welding, hot bending, etc.)!

RE 07900/10.06 Replaces: 08.06

1/6

• For hydraulics fluids: Take care of contamination and humidity; contamination from the environment must not enter the tanks! Fill oil tanks only through filters, preferably system filters or portable filter stations with fine filters. Internal protective coatings, if any, must be resistant to the hydraulic fluid used! • For parts taken from stock: The storage of parts that were not filled or treated with anti-corrosion fluid can lead to the formation of resin. Solve the resin using a grease solvent and renew the lubricating film. – Check to see that all of the parts required for the installation are available! – Take note of any transport damage! 2.2 Carrying out the montage – Use lifting lugs and transport facilities! – Do not apply force to prevent transverse forces and tension on pipes and components. The valve mounting surfaces must be perfectly even. The fixing screws must be tightened evenly at the specified torque. Take care that pipes are adequately fixed! – When selecting pipes, hoses and fittings/flanges, observe the correct pressure stage (wall thickness, material). Use only seamless precision steel pipes.


8 2/6

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

Installation, commissioning and maintenance of hydraulic systems

– Do not use hemp or putty as sealing materials! This may cause contamination and thus malfunction. – To prevent external leakage, observe the installation instructions of the pipe fittings’ manufacturer. We recommend the use of fittings with elastic seals.

As the hydraulic fluids often do not comply with the required cleanliness, the fluids must be filled through a filter. The absolute filter rating of the filling filter should be at least that of the filters installed in the system. 3.2 Trial run

– Make sure that hoses are properly laid! Rubbing and abutting of the lines must be prevented.

– For safety reasons, only personnel of the machine manufacturer and, if required, maintenance and operating personnel should be present.

– Provide the correct hydraulic fluids • Mineral oils: HLP hydraulic oils according to DIN 51524 part 2 are generally suitable for standard systems and components.

– All pressure relief valves, pressure reducing valves, pressure controllers of pumps must be unloaded. An exemption to this are TÜV-set valves.

• Fast bio-degradable hydraulic fluids: VDMA 24568.

– Switch the system on briefly and check whether the direction of rotation of the drive motor matches the prescribed direction of rotation of the pump.

– Open isolator valves completely!

For these fluids, the system and components must be matched.

– Check the position of the directional valves and, if necessary, move the spool to the required position.

• Hardly inflammable hydraulic fluids: VDMA 24317. For these fluids, the system and components must be matched. (Before filling in the special media, check, whether the system is compatible with the intended fluid.)

– Set the control spool to by-pass. – Open suction valves of the pump. If required for design reasons, fill pump housing with hydraulic fluids to prevent bearings and parts of the rotary group from running dry.

The following points must be observed in accordance with the relevant requirements:

– If a pilot oil pump is provided, commission it1).

– Viscosity of the hydraulic fluid

– Start up the pump, swivel it from its zero position and listen for any noises.

– Operating temperature range

– Swivel the pump slightly out (ca. 5°)1).

– Type of seals used on the components fitted 3.

RE 07900/10.06

– Bleed the system Carefully loosen fittings or bleed screws at high points in the system. When the escaping fluid is free from bubbles, then the filling process is completed. Re-tighten fittings.

Commissioning When the installation has been carried out correctly, proceed with commissioning and functional testing.

3.1 Preparations for trial run

– Flush the system; if possible, short-circuit actuators. Flush the system until the filters remain clean; check the filters! With servo-systems, the servo-valves must be removed and replaced by flushing plates or direction valves of the same size. Short-circuit the actuators. During flushing, the hydraulic fluid in the complete hydraulic system should reach temperatures that are at least as high as later during operation. Change the filter elements as required. Flushing continues until the required minimum cleanliness is reached. This can only be achieved by continuous monitoring using a particle counter.

– Tank cleaned? – Lines cleaned and properly installed? – Fittings, flanges tightened? – Lines and components correctly connected in line with installation drawings and circuit diagram? Is the accumulator filled with nitrogen? Fill in nitrogen until the pre-charge pressure p0 as specified in the cicuit di agram is reached. (On the fluid side the system must be pressureless!). It is recommended that the gas precharge pressure is marked on the accumulator itself (e.g. self-adhesive label) and in the hydraulic circuit so that a comparative check is possible, if required.

– Check the system functions under no-load conditions, if possible, by hand; cold-test the electrohydraulic control.

Caution! Use only nitrogen as pre-charge gas! Accumulators must comply with the safety regulations valid at the place of installation.

– When the operating temperature has been reached, test the system under load; slowly increase the pressure.

– Are the drive motor and pump properly installed and aligned?

– Monitor control and instrumentation equipment!

– Is the drive motor correctly connected? – Are filters with the prescribed filter rating used?

– Check the housing temperature of hydraulic pumps and hydraulic motors.

– Are filters fitted in the correct direction of flow?

– Listen for noises!

– Has the specified hydraulic fluid filled up to the upper marking?

– Check the hydraulic fluid level; if required, top up! 1)

As far as possible with the control elements fitted; otherwise, start up at full displacement. In conjunction with combustion engines, start up at idle speed.


9 RE 07900/10.06

Installation, commissioning and maintenance of hydraulic systems

Hydraulics Bosch Rexroth AG

3/6

– Check the setting of pressure relief valves by loading or braking the system.

The most common faults are:

– Inspect the system for leaks.

– The hydraulic fluid is not filtered before being filled in.

– Switch off the drive.

– The installation is not checked before commissioning (subsequent conversion with loss of fluid!).

– The fluid tank is not inspected.

– Retighten all fittings, even if there is no evidence of leakage.

– System components are not bled.

Caution! Only tighten fittings when the system is depressurised!

– Pressure relief valves are set only slightly higher than the operating pressure (closing pressure differential is not observed).

– Is the pipe fixing adequate, even under changing pressure loads?

1

– Pressure controllers of hydraulic pumps are set higher or to the same pressure as the pressure relief valve.

– Are the fixing points at the correct positions?

– The flushing time of servo systems is not adhered to.

– Are the hoses laid so that they do not chamfer, even under pressure load?

– Abnormal pump noise is ignored (cavitation, leaking suction lines, too much air in the hydraulic fluid).

– Check the fluid level. – Test the system for all functions. Compare measured values with the permissible or specified data (pressure, velocity. Adjust further control components).

– Transversal loads on cylinder piston rods are not observed (installation error!).

– Jerky movements indicate, amongst other things, the presence of air in the system. By briefly swivelling the pump in one or both directions with the actuator being loaded or braked, it is possible to eliminate certain air pockets. The system is completely bled when all functions are performed jerk-free and smoothly and the sur face of the hydraulic fluid level is free from foam. Experience has shown that foaming should have ceased one hour after start-up at the latest.

– Limit switches are set too low.

– Hydraulic cylinders are not bled (damage to seals!) – The switching hysteresis of pressure switches is not taken into account when settings are made.

2

– Hydraulic pump and hydraulic motor housings are not filled with hydraulic fluid prior to commissioning. – Settings are not documented. – Adjustment spindles are not secured or sealed. – Unnecessary personnel present during commissioning of the system.

– Check the temperature. – Switch off the drive. – Remove filter elements (off-line and full-flow filters) and inspect them for residues. Clean filter elements or replace them, if required. Paper or glass fibre elements cannot be cleaned. – If further contamination is found, additional flushing is required to prevent premature failure of the system components. – All the adjustments made are to be recorded in an acceptance report. 3.3 Commissioning of fast running systems Such system can often not be commissioning using the normal measuring instruments (such as pressure gauges, thermometers, electrical multimeters, etc.) and standard tools. Optimization is also not possible. These systems include, for example, forging presses, plastics injection moulding machines, special machine tools, rolling tools, crane controls, machines with electrohydraulic closed-loop control systems. Commissioning and optimization of these systems often require more comprehensive measuring equipment to allow several measurements to be taken at a time (e.g. several pressures, electrical signals, travel, velocities, flows, etc.). 3.4 The most common faults occurring during commissioning Apart from servicing, commissioning is very decisive for the service life and functional reliability of a hydraulic system. For this reason, faults during commissioning must be avoided as far as possible.

4.

Maintenance According to DIN 31 051 the term “maintenance” includes the following fields of activity: – Inspection Measures to recognise and assess the actual situation, i.e. recognise how and why the so-called wear reserve continues to decrease.

3

– Maintenance Measures to preserve the nominal conditions, i.e. to take precautions in order that the reduction in the wear reserve during the useful life is kept as low as possible. – Repair Measures to restore the nominal condition, i.e. compensate for reduction in performance and restore the wear reserve. Maintenance measures must be planned and taken in accordance with the operating time, the consequences of a failure and the required availability. 4.1 Inspection The individual points to be inspected should be summarised for a specific system in so-called inspection lists in order that the inspections can be carried out adequately by employees with different qualification levels. Important points of inspection are: – Checking the hydraulic fluid level in the tank. – Checking the heat exchanger (air, water) for effectiveness.

4


10 4/6

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

Installation, commissioning and maintenance of hydraulic systems

RE 07900/10.06

– Checking the system for external leakage (visual inspection).

• daily during the first week and replace them as required.

– Checking the hydraulic fluid temperature during operation.

• After one week, the filters should be cleaned as required.

– Checking pressures

• Maintenance of suction filters:

– Amount of leakage – Checking the cleanliness of the hydraulic fluid Caution! Visual inspections can only give an approximation (clouding of the hydraulic fluid, darker appearance than at the time of filling, sediments in the fluid tank).

Suction filters require particularly thorough servicing. After the running-in period, they must be inspected at least once a week and cleaned, if necessary. – Service the system fluid • Maintenance intervals depend on the following operating factors:

If conventional particle counting is impossible, the following three methods can be used for establishing the fluid cleanliness:

- Hydraulic fluid condition (e.g. water in oil, strongly aged oil)

• Particle counts using electronic counting and sorting equipment.

We recommend that the fluid be changed in dependence upon an oil analysis. With systems whose oil is not analysed at regular intervals the fluid should be replaced every 2000 to 4000 operating hours at the latest.

• Microscopic examination. • Gravimetric establishment of solids by means of finest filtration of a certain fluid volume (e.g. 100 ml) and weighing of the filter paper before and after the filtration process. This allows the establishment of the amount of solid particles in mg/l. – Check the contamination of filters. A visual inspection of deep filters, which are widely used today, is no longer possible. – Analyse the chemical properties of the hydraulic fluid. – Check the temperature at points where bearings are located. – Check the generation of noise. – Test performance and velocity. – Inspect pipes and hoses. Caution! Damaged pipes and hoses must be immediately replaced. – Inspect accumulator stations. 4.2 Maintenance In practice, inspection, maintenance and repair work is not as strictly separated as the definitions may suggest. Servicing is often done in conjunction with inspections. For safety reason, pipe fittings, connections and components must not be loosened or removed as long as the system is pressurised.

- Operating temperature and oil fill

• Drain the system fluid at operating temperature and change it. • Severely aged or contaminated system fluid cannot be improved by adding new fluid! • Only fill in oil via filters that have at least the same separation capacity as the filters installed in the system, or use a system filter. • Take samples of the system fluid to have the type, size and amount of particles analysed in the lab. Record the results. – Check the accumulator for its pre-charge pressure; for this, the accumulator must be depressurised on the fluid side. Caution! Work on systems that include accumulators may only be carried out after the fluid pressure was unloaded. Welding or soldering work or any mechanical work on accumulators is not permitted. Improper repairs can lead to severe accidents. Repairs on hydraulic accumulator may therefore only be carried out by Rexroth Service service personnel.

Important service work is:

– The operating temperature must be measured. An increase in the operating temperature indicates increasing friction and leakage.

– Create a maintenance book

– Leakage in the pipework

We recommend that a maintenance book is created to lay down the parts to be inspected. – Check the hydraulic fluid level • continuously during commissioning • shortly after commissioning • later, at weekly intervals – Inspect filters • during commissioning every two to three hours and, if necessary, replace them.

Leakage, especially with underfloor piping, represents, apart from loss of fluid, a risk for equipment and concrete floors. For safety reasons, sealing work on the pipes may only be carried out when the system is depressurised. Leakage at points that are sealed with soft seals (O-rings, form seal rings, etc.) cannot be eliminated by tightening as these sealing elements are either destroyed or hardened. Sealing can only be achieved by replacing the sealing elements.


11 RE 07900/10.06

Installation, commissioning and maintenance of hydraulic systems

– Check main and pilot pressure • Check interval: One week • Document pressure corrections in the maintenance book. • Frequent pressure adjustments indicate, among other things, wear of the pressure relief valve. 4.3 Repair Locate and eliminate malfunction and damage. – Fault localisation A precondition for system repairs is successful, i.e. systematic fault search. This requires in any case detailed knowledge of the structure and the operating principle of the individual components as well as of the entire system. The required documentation should be available and easily accessible. The most important measuring instruments (thermometer, electrical multimeter, industrial stethoscope, stop watch, rpm counter, etc.) should also be available in the vicinity of the system, especially in the case of large systems.

Hydraulics Bosch Rexroth AG

5/6

Generally, defective components should not be repaired on site, since for the proper repair, the required tooling and the required cleanliness are usually not given on site. On site, only complete components should be changed whenever possible, in order • to keep the time for which the opened system is exposed to ambient influences to a minimum,

1

• to keep the fluid loss as low as possible, • to ensure the shortest possible downtime through the use of overhauled and tested components. After failed components are located, it is essential to check whether the entire system or parts of the system have been contaminated by broken parts or larger amounts of abraded metal. 4.4 Repair and major overhaul of hydraulic components Generally, it can be said that only the component manufacturer can carry out major overhauls in the most efficiently and reliably (same quality standard, trained personnel, test facilities, warranty, etc.). 2

– Fault correction When carrying out any work, observe strictest cleanliness. Before loosening fittings, clean the surrounding area.

3

4

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Zum Eisengießer 1 97816 Lohr am Main, Germany Telefon +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-0 Telefax +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-23 58 documentation@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.de

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging.


12 6/6

Bosch Rexroth AG

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Zum EisengieĂ&#x;er 1 97816 Lohr am Main, Germany Telefon +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-0 Telefax +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-23 58 documentation@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.de

Hydraulics

Installation, commissioning and maintenance of hydraulic systems

RE 07900/10.06

Š This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging.


13

Installation, commissioning and servicing of hydraulic pumps and motors

RE 07080/07.05 Replaces: 02.03

1/2

(vane pumps, internal gear pumps, radial piston motors, internal gear pumps)

1.

General

1.1

To ensure proper operation of pumps and motors, please observe the following information:

– Suction vacuum pressure or feed pressure must be within the limits specified by the manufacturer; filters and valves possibly installed must be taken into account.

– Technical data in the data sheet

– Take care that the suction lines are leak-free.

– General notes on commissioning of hydraulic systems

– The flow velocity in suction lines should not exceed 0.5 m/s.

– The following notes on installation and operation 2.

Installation

2.1

Flushing

2.2

– On pumps taken from stock, resin may have formed. This must be removed by means of solvents. Then, the lubricat- 2.3.2 Leakage drain lines ing film must be renewed. In the case of hardly inflamma– Use sufficiently large nominal widths in order to keep the ble fluids, no special measures have to be taken. backpressure in the housing within the permissible limits. Installation – When installing the lines, make sure that the housing – Observe drawings and/or instructions is completely filled with fluid, while taking care that a – Ensure stress-free installation siphoning effect is avoided. – In the case of prime movers, ensure that foundations are level

2.3

– Cut the pipe ends at an angle of less than 45° and install them at a distance of at least 2.5 x the pipe diameter from the tank floor in order to prevent the aspiration of deposits from the tank floor.

Lines and connections

2.3.1 Suction lines – Design and assemble lines according to the manufacturer’s instructions.

– Pressureless return flow to the tank – Sufficient cooling and settling of the hydraulic fluid is achieved by directing the fluid to the tank wall. – Ensure a sufficient distance to temperature switches.


14 2/2

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

2.3.3 Installation instructions

Installation, commissioning and servicing

3.3

3.4

– Set all valves, especially on the suction and supply side, to the free-flow position. – Switch the motor briefly on and off several times in order to facilitate bleeding. Only operate the pump under full load when it runs properly and smoothly.

– We recommend seamless precision steel pipes to DIN 2391 and pipe connections that can be loosened. Filters

– During initial start-up, bleed the pressure line to allow complete filling of the pump. Exceptions to this are pump with automatic bleed valve.

– Whenever possible, use return line or pressure filters. – Use suction filters only in conjunction with underpressure switches/clogging indicators. – Depending on the pump type, the required filter rating is 25 μm to 40 μm. Recommendation: 10- μm filters prolong the service life under high load conditions. 2.5

– When the system starts up, the fluid level in the tank must not fall below the minimum suction level. 3.5

– Carefully increase the pressure to the required values, but do not set to unnecessarily high values.

2.5.1 Mineral oils – When HL oils without wear-reducing additives are used, vane pumps (V3, V4, PV7, PVV, PVQ) may only be operated at reduced pressure. 3.6 – Oils containing polar additives (slide way oils) must not be used for pumps with plain bearings, as the additives precipitate at 70 °C and thus impair cooling and lubrica4. tion of the bearings. 4.1 2.5.2 HFC fluid (water glycol)

4.2

Commissioning Electrical open and closed-loop control elements

4.3

Direction of rotation of drive/output shafts – Observe the arrow of direction of rotation – Testing of a unit filled with hydraulic fluid: Switching the unit briefly on and off prevents damage in the case of the wrong direction of rotation.

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Zum Eisengießer 1 97816 Lohr am Main, Germany Phone +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-0 Fax +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-23 58 documentation@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.de

– Check the fluid temperature under normal operating conditions. Routine maintenance Frequency

Mounting

Filters – Observe clogging indicators and check suction filters for operability according to the operating instructions.

– Observe voltages and current intensity 3.2

Temperature

– Check the correct orientation of the pumps, motors, cylinders, further energy converters and lines at normal operating pressure and operating temperature.

When using hydraulic media, which are not listed in the technical data, please consult us. 3.1

– If required, secure settings against unwanted adjustment.

– Loads and operating conditions determine regular maintenance intervals.

– Internal gear pumps of types PGF and PGH are suitable for operation with HFC fluids.

3.

Pressure limitation / pressure control – Always select the lowest settings for commissioning.

Hydraulic media

Please note the information in the data sheets!

Start-up – Observe specific component instructions.

– The ends of the suction, return and leakage drain lines must therefore be installed with a distance of at least 200 mm from each other.

2.4

Filling – Pump types V3, V4, PV7, PVV, PVQ are self-priming, the housings need not to be filled. Internal gear pumps must be filled prior to commissioning! For all other pumps, verify, whether the housing must be filled.

– All lines have to be submerged at least 2.5 x the pipe diameter below the lowest permissible fluid level, but at least 100 mm in order to prevent foaming. – Install the leakage drain line higher than the suction line and take precautions that the returning oil cannot be directly re-aspired.

RE 07080/07.05

4.4

Servicing – We recommend regular servicing of the complete system by Bosch Rexroth!

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging.


15

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons

RE 90220/05.12 Replaces: 05.10

1/16

Application notes and requirements for Rexroth hydraulic components

Hydraulic fluids

Title

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-containing hydraulic fluids

Standard

DIN 51524

ISO 15380

ISO 12922

ISO 12922

Data sheets

RE 90220

RE 90221

RE 90222

RE 90223 (in preparation)

Classification

HL HLP HLPD HVLP HLPD and more

HEPG HEES partially saturated HEES saturated HEPR HETG

HFDR HFDU (ester base) HFDU (glycol base) and more

HFC HFB HFAE HFAS


16 2/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

Contents 1 Basic information .................................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.1 General instructions ...................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.2 Scope ...........................................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.3 Safety instructions .....................................................................................................................................................................................3 2 Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels ....................................................................................................................................4 3 Selection of the hydraulic fluid ..........................................................................................................................................................................5 3.1 Selection criteria for the hydraulic fluid .................................................................................................................................................5 3.1.1 Viscosity .................................................................................................................................................................................................5 3.1.2 Viscosity-temperature behavior........................................................................................................................................................5 3.1.3 Wear protection capability ................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.4 Material compatibility..........................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.5 Aging resistance .................................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.6 Air separation ability (ASA)...............................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.7 Demulsifying ability and water solubility .........................................................................................................................................6 3.1.8 Filterability .............................................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.9 Corrosion protection ..........................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.10 Additivation .........................................................................................................................................................................................7 3.2 Classification and fields of application ................................................................................................................................................7 4 Hydraulic fluids in operation ..............................................................................................................................................................................9 4.1 General .........................................................................................................................................................................................................9 4.2 Storage and handling ...............................................................................................................................................................................9 4.3 Filling of new systems...............................................................................................................................................................................9 4.4 Hydraulic fluid changeover ......................................................................................................................................................................9 4.5 Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids .........................................................................................................................9 4.6 Re-additivation............................................................................................................................................................................................9 4.7 Foaming behavior .......................................................................................................................................................................................9 4.8 Corrosion ...................................................................................................................................................................................................10 4.9 Air ................................................................................................................................................................................................................10 4.10 Water ........................................................................................................................................................................................................10 4.11 Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration .......................................................................................................................................10 5 Disposal and environmental protection ........................................................................................................................................................11 6 Other hydraulic fluids based on mineral oil and related hydrocarbons .................................................................................................12 7 Glossary ...............................................................................................................................................................................................................15


17 RE 90220/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

3/16

1 Basic information 1.1 General instructions The hydraulic fluid is the common element in any hydraulic component and must be selected very carefully. Quality and cleanliness of the hydraulic fluid are decisive factors for the operational reliability, efficiency and service life of a system. Hydraulic fluids must conform, be selected and used in accordance with the generally acknowledged rules of technology and safety provisions. Reference is made to the countryspecific standards and directives (in Germany the directive of the Employer's Liability Insurance Association BGR 137). This data sheet includes recommendations and regulations concerning the selection, operation and disposal of hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons in the application of Rexroth hydraulic components. The individual selection of hydraulic fluid or the choice of classification are the responsibility of the operator. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure that appropriate measures are taken for safety and health protection and to ensure compliance with statutory regulations. The recommendations of the lubricant manufacturer and the specifications given in the safety data sheet are to be observed when using hydraulic fluid.

Notes: In the market overview RE 90220-01, hydraulic fluid based on mineral oil are described which, according to the information of the lubricant manufacturer, feature the respective parameters of the current requirements standard DIN 51524 and other parameters which are of relevance for suitability in connection 1 with Rexroth components. These specifications are not checked or monitored by Bosch Rexroth. The list in the market overview does not therefore represent a recommendation on the part of Rexroth or approval of the respective hydraulic fluid for use with Rexroth components and does not release the operator from his responsibility regarding selection of the hydraulic fluid. Bosch Rexroth will accept no liability for its components for any damage resulting from failure to comply with the notes below.

1.3 Safety instructions Hydraulic fluids can constitute a risk for persons and the environment. These risks are described in the hydraulic fluid safety data sheets. The operator is to ensure that a current safety data sheet for the hydraulic fluid used is available and that the measures stipulated therein are complied with.

2

This data sheet does not absolve the operator from verifying the conformity and suitability of the respective hydraulic fluid for his system. He is to ensure that the selected fluid meets the minimum requirements of the relevant fluid standard during the whole of the period of use. Other regulations and legal provisions may also apply. The operator is responsible for their observance, e.g. EU directive 2004/35/EG and their national implementations. In Germany the Water Resources Act (WHG) is also to be observed.

3

We recommend that you maintain constant, close contact with lubricant manufacturers to support you in the selection, maintenance, care and analyses. When disposing of used hydraulic fluids, apply the same care as during use.

1.2 Scope This data sheet must be observed when using hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons in Bosch Rexroth hydraulic components. Please note that the specifications of this data sheet may be restricted further by the specifications given in the product data sheets for the individual components. The use of the individual hydraulic fluids in accordance with the intended purpose can be found in the safety data sheets or other product description documents of the lubricant manufacturers. In addition, each use is to be individually considered. Rexroth hydraulic components may only be operated with hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons according to DIN 51524 if specified in the respective component data sheet or if Rexroth approval for use is furnished.

4


18 4/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

2 Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels Solid particle contamination is the major reason for faults occurring in hydraulic systems. It may lead to a number of effects in the hydraulic system. Firstly, single large solid particles may lead directly to a system malfunction, and secondly small particles cause continuous elevated wear. For hydraulic fluids, the cleanliness level is given as a threedigit numerical code in accordance with ISO 4406. This numerical code denotes the number of particles present in a hydraulic fluid for a defined quantity. Moreover, foreign solid matter is not to exceed a mass of 50 mg/kg (gravimetric examination according to ISO 4405). In general, compliance with a minimum cleanliness level of 20/18/15 in accordance with ISO 4406 or better is to be maintained in operation. Special servo valves demand improved cleanliness levels of at least 18/16/13. A reduction in cleanliness level by one level means half of the quantity of particles and thus greater cleanliness. Lower numbers in cleanliness levels should always be striven for and extend the service life of hydraulic components. The component with the highest cleanliness requirements determines the required cleanliness of the overall system. Please also observe the specifications in table 1: "Cleanliness levels according to ISO 4406" and in the respective data sheets of the various hydraulic components.

Hydraulic fluids frequently fail to meet these cleanliness requirements on delivery. Careful filtering is therefore required during operation and in particular, during filling in order to ensure the required cleanliness levels. Your lubricant manufacturer can tell you the cleanliness level of hydraulic fluids as delivered. To maintain the required cleanliness level over the operating period, you must use a reservoir breather filter. If the environment is humid, take appropriate measures, such as a breather filter with air drying or permanent off-line water separation. Note: the specifications of the lubricant manufacturer relating to cleanliness levels are based on the time at which the container concerned is filled and not on the conditions during transport and storage. Further information about contamination with solid matter and cleanliness levels can be found in brochure RE 08016.

Table 1: Cleanliness levels according to ISO 4406 Particles per 100 ml More than

Up to and including

Scale number

8,000,000

16,000,000

24

4,000,000

8,000,000

23

2,000,000

4,000,000

22

1,000,000

2,000,000

21

500,000

1,000,000

20

250,000

500,000

19

130,000

250,000

18

64000

130,000

17

32000

64000

16

16000

32000

15

8000

16000

14

4000

8000

13

2000

4000

12

1000

2000

11

500

1000

10

250

500

9

130

250

8

64

130

7

32

64

6

20 / 18 / 15 > 4 Îźm > 6 Îźm > 14 Îźm


19 RE 90220/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

5/16

3 Selection of the hydraulic fluid The use of hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils for Rexroth hydraulic components is based on compliance with the minimum requirements of DIN 51524.

3.1 Selection criteria for the hydraulic fluid The specified limit values for all components employed in the hydraulic system, for example viscosity and cleanliness level, must be observed with the hydraulic fluid used, taking into account the specified operating conditions. Hydraulic fluid suitability depends, amongst others, on the following factors:

If the viscosity of a hydraulic fluid used is above the permitted operating viscosity, this will result in increased hydraulic-mechanical losses. In return, there will be lower internal leakage losses. If the pressure level is lower, lubrication gaps may not be filled up, which can lead to increased wear. For hydraulic pumps, the permitted suction pressure may not be reached, which may lead to cavitation damage. If the viscosity of a hydraulic fluid is below the permitted operating viscosity, increased leakage, wear, susceptibility to contamination and a shorter component life cycle will result. 3.1.2 Viscosity-temperature behavior

3.1.1 Viscosity Viscosity is a basic property of hydraulic fluids. The permissible viscosity range of complete systems needs to be determined taking account of the permissible viscosity of all components and it is to be observed for each individual component. The viscosity at operating temperature determines the response characteristics of closed control loops, stability and damping of systems, the efficiency factor and the degree of wear. We recommend that the optimum operating viscosity range of each component be kept within the permissible temperature range. This usually requires either cooling or heating, or both. The permissible viscosity range and the necessary cleanliness level can be found in the product data sheet for the component concerned.

For hydraulic fluids, the viscosity temperature behavior (V-T behavior) is of particular importance. Viscosity is characterized in that it drops when the temperature increases and rises when the temperature drops; see Fig. 1 "Viscosity temperature chart for HL, HLP, HLPD (VI 100)". The interrelation between viscosity and temperature is described by the viscosity index (VI). The viscosity temperature diagram in Fig. 1 is extrapolated in the < 40 °C range. This idealized diagram is for reference purposes only. Measured values can be obtained from your lubricant manufacturer and are to be preferred for design purposes.

Fig. 1: Viscosity-temperature chart for HL, HLP, HLPD (VI 100, double logarithmic representation) 40°

20°

20°

1

40°

60°

80°

2

3

100°

1600 1000

0 15 VG 00 1 VG 68 VG 6 4 VG 32 VG 22

VG

15

10

200

VG

VG

600 400

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

100 60 4

40

20

10

5 40°

25°

10°

10°

30°

Temperature t [°C]

50°

70°

90°

115°


20 6/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

3.1.3 Wear protection capability

3.1.6 Air separation ability (ASA)

Wear protection capability describes the property of hydraulic fluids to prevent or minimize wear within the components. The wear protection capability is described in DIN 51524-2,-3 via test procedures "FZG gear test rig" (ISO 14635-1) and "Mechanical test in the vane pump" (ISO 20763). From ISO VG 32 DIN 51524-2,-3 prescribes a rating of at least 10 (FZG test). At present, the FZG test cannot be applied to viscosity classes < ISO VG 32.

The air separation ability (ASA) describes the property of a hydraulic fluid to separate undissolved air. Hydraulic fluids contain approx. 7 to 13 percent by volume of dissolved air (with atmospheric pressure and 50 °C). Hydraulic fluids always contain dissolved air. During operation, dissolved air may be transformed into undissolved air, leading to cavitation damages. Fluid classification, fluid product, reservoir size and design must be coordinated to take into account the dwell time and ASA value of the hydraulic fluid. The air separation capacity depends on the viscosity, temperature, basic fluid and aging. It cannot be improved by additives.

3.1.4 Material compatibility The hydraulic fluid must not negatively affect the materials used in the components. Compatibility with coatings, seals, hoses, metals and plastics is to be observed in particular. The fluid classifications specified in the respective component data sheets are tested by the manufacturer with regard to material compatibility. Parts and components not supplied by us are to be checked by the user. Table 2: Known material incompatibilities Classification

Incompatible with:

HLxx classifications

with EPDM seals

Zinc- and ash/free hydraulic fluids

with bronze-filled PTFE seals

3.1.5 Aging resistance The way a hydraulic fluid ages depends on the thermal, chemical and mechanical stress to which it is subjected. Aging resistance can be greatly influenced by the chemical composition of the hydraulic fluids. High fluid temperatures (e.g. over 80 °C) result in a approximate halving of the fluid service life for every 10 °C temperature increase and should therefore by avoided. The halving of the fluid service life results from the application of the Arrhenius equation (see Glossary). Table 3: Reference values for temperature-dependent aging of the hydraulic fluid Reservoir temperature

Fluid life cycle

80 °C

100 %

90 °C

50 %

100 °C

25 %

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons are tested with 20% water additive during testing of aging resistance according to ISO 4263-1. The calculated fluid service life is derived from the results of tests in which the long-term characteristics are simulated in a short period of time by applying more arduous conditions (condensed testing). This calculated fluid service life is not to be equated to the fluid service life in real-life applications. Table 3 is a practical indicator for hydraulic fluids with water content < 0.1%, cf. chapter 4.10. "Water".

According to DIN 51524 for instance, an ASA value d 10 minutes is required for viscosity class ISO VG 46, 6 minutes are typical, lower values are preferable. 3.1.7 Demulsifying ability and water solubility The capacity of a hydraulic fluid to separate water at a defined temperature is known as the demulsifying ability. ISO 6614 defines the demulsifying properties of hydraulic fluids. For larger systems with permanent monitoring, a demulsifying fluid with good water separation capability (WSC) is recommended. The water can be drained from the bottom of the reservoir. In smaller systems (e.g. in mobile machines), whose fluid is less closely monitored and where water contamination into the hydraulic fluid, for instance through air condensation, cannot be ruled out completely, an HLPD fluid is recommended. The demulsifying ability up to ISO-VG 100 is given at 54 °C, and at 82 °C for fluids with higher viscosity. Water emulsifying HLPD hydraulic fluids have no, or a very poor, demulsifying ability. 3.1.8 Filterability Filterability describes the ability of a hydraulic fluid to pass through a filter, removing solid contaminants. The hydraulic fluids used require a good filterability, not just when new, but also during the whole of their service life. Depending on the basic fluid used and the additives (VI enhancers) there are great differences here. The filterability is a basic prerequisite for cleanliness, servicing and filtration of hydraulic fluids. Filterability is tested with the new hydraulic fluid and after the addition of 0.2 % water. The underlying standard (ISO 13357-1/-2) stipulates that filterability must have no negative effects on the filters or the hydraulic fluid, see chapter 4 "Hydraulic fluids in operation". 3.1.9 Corrosion protection Hydraulic fluids should not just prevent corrosion formation on steel components, they must also be compatible with non-ferrous metals and alloys. Corrosion protection tests on different metals and metal alloys are described in DIN 51524. Hydraulic fluids that are not compatible with the materials listed above must not be used, even if they are compliant with ISO 51524. Rexroth components are usually tested with HLP hydraulic fluids or corrosion protection oils based on mineral oils before they are delivered.


21 RE 90220/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

7/16

3.1.10 Additivation The properties described above can be modified with the help of suitable additives. A general distinction is made for fluids between heavy metal-free and heavy metal-containing (generally zinc) additive systems. Both additive systems are most often incompatible with each other. The mixing of these fluids must be avoided even if the mixing ratio is very low. See chapter 4, "Hydraulic fluids in operation�.

1

Increasing additivation generally leads to deteriorated air separation ability (ASA) and water separation capability (WSC) of the hydraulic fluid. According to the present state of knowledge, all hydraulic fluids described in this document, independently of the actual additivation, can be filtered using all filter materials with all known filtration ratings t 1 Îźm without filtering out effective additives at the same time. Bosch Rexroth does not prescribe any specific additive system.

3.2 Classification and fields of application

2

Table 4: Classification and fields of application Typical field of application

Classification

Features

HL fluids according to DIN 51524-1 VI = 100

Hydraulic fluids predominantly only with additives for oxidation and corrosion protection, but no specific additives for wear protection in case of mixed friction

HL fluids can be used in hydraulic systems that do not pose any requirements as to wear protection.

Hydraulic fluid with corrosion, oxidation and verified wear protection additives

HLP fluids are suitable for most fields of application and components provided the temperature and viscosity provisions are observed.

Notes HL fluids may be used only for components whose product data sheet specifically allows HL fluids. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. Hydraulic fluids that only comply with the requirements of classes HL and HR in accordance with ISO 11158 without proving that DIN 51524-1 is also met may be used only with written approval of Bosch Rexroth AG. Observe restrictions as to pressure, rotation speed etc.

HLP fluids according to DIN 51524-2 VI = 100

3

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. For the viscosity classes VG10, VG15 and VG22, DIN 51524 defines no requirements as to wear protection (DIN 51354 part 2 and DIN 51389 part 2). Beyond the requirements of DIN 51524 part 2, we require the same base oil type, identical refining procedure, identical additivation and identical additivation level across all viscosity classes.

4

Continued on page 8


22 8/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

Table 4: Classification and fields of application (continued from page 7) Classification

Features

Typical field of application

Notes

HVLP fluids according to DIN 51524-3 VI > 140

HLP hydraulic fluid with additional improved viscosity temperature behavior

HVLP fluids are used in systems operated over a wide temperature range.

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. The same notes and restrictions as defined for HLP fluids apply accordingly. The effect on Rexroth components (e.g. compatibility with material seals, wear resistance capacity) may differ when using related hydrocarbons instead of mineral oils, cf. Table 6, line 8. When using HVLP fluids, the viscosity may change on account of the shear of the long-chain VI enhancers. The viscosity index, high at the start, decreases during operation. This needs to be taken into account when selecting the hydraulic fluid. The only value at present that can be used to assess viscosity changes in operation is the result of the test in accordance with DIN 51350 part 6. Please note that there are practical applications that create a much higher shear load on such fluids than can be achieved by this test. Up to VI < 160, we recommend a maximum permitted viscosity drop of 15 %, viscosity at 100 °C. The viscosity limits given by Bosch Rexroth for its components are to be observed for all operating conditions, even after the hydraulic fluids have sheared. HVLP fluids should be used only if required by the temperature ranges of the application.

HLPD fluids according to DIN 51524-2, HVLPD fluids in accordance with DIN 51524-3

HLP and HVLP hydraulic fluid with additional detergent and or dispersant additives

HLPD and HVLPD fluids are used in systems where deposits as well as solid or liquid contamination need to be kept temporarily suspended

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. Some of these fluids are able to absorb significant quantities of water (> 0.1 %). This may have negative implications for the wear protection and the aging properties of the fluid. The wetting ability of these fluids varies largely depending on the product. Therefore it is not correct to say that they are generally all very well able to prevent stick-slip. In individual cases where higher water contamination is to be expected (such as in steelworks or under humid conditions), the use of HLPD/HVLPD fluids cannot be recommended as the emulsified water does not settle in the reservoir but is evaporated in heavily loaded positions. For such cases, we recommend using HLP hydraulic fluids with particularly good demulsifying ability. The water collected at the reservoir bottom is to be drained regularly. If HLPD/HVLPD fluids are used, contamination does not settle. It rather remains suspended and needs to be filtered out or removed by appropriate draining systems. For this reason, the filter area must be increased. HLPD/HVLPD fluids may contain additives that in the long run are incompatible with plastics, elastomers and non-ferrous metals. Furthermore, these additives may lead to the premature clogging of hydraulic filters. Therefore, test the filterability and the selection of the filter material in consultation with the filter manufacturer.


23 RE 90220/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

9/16

4 Hydraulic fluids in operation 4.1 General The properties of hydraulic fluids can change continually during storage and operation. Please note that the fluid standard DIN 51524 merely describes minimum requirements for hydraulic fluids in new condition at the time of filling into the bins. The operator of a hydraulic system must ensure that the hydraulic fluid remains in a utilizable condition throughout its entire period of use. Deviations from the characteristic values are to be clarified with the lubricant manufacturer, the test labs or Bosch Rexroth. Please note the following aspects in operation.

4.2 Storage and handling Hydraulic fluids must be stored correctly in accordance with the instructions of the lubricant manufacturer. Avoid exposing the containers to lengthy periods of direct heat. Containers are to be stored in such a way that the risk of any foreign liquid or solid matter (e.g. water, foreign fluids or dust) ingression into the inside of the container can be ruled out. After taking hydraulic fluids from the containers, these are immediately to be properly resealed. Recommendation: – Store containers in a dry, roofed place

For information on changing over hydraulic fluids with different classifications please refer to VDMA 24314, VDMA 24569 and ISO 15380 appendix A. Bosch Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from inadequate hydraulic fluid changeovers!

4.5 Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids If hydraulic fluids from different manufacturers or different types from the same manufacturer are mixed, gelling, silting and deposits may occur. These, in turn, may cause foaming, impaired air separation ability, malfunctions and damage to the hydraulic system. If the fluid contains more than 2 % of another fluid then it is considered to be a mixture. Exceptions apply for water, see chapter 4.10 "Water". Mixing with other hydraulic fluids is not generally permitted. This also includes hydraulic fluids with the same classification and from the market overview RE 90220-01. If individual lubricant manufacturers advertise miscibility and/or compatibility, this is entirely the responsibility of the lubricant manufacturer.

Note: With connectible accessory units and mobile filtering systems, there is a considerable risk of non-permitted mixing of the hydraulic fluids!

4.3 Filling of new systems

Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from mixing hydraulic fluids!

Usually, the cleanliness levels of the hydraulic fluids as delivered do not meet the requirements of our components. Hydraulic fluids must be filtered using an appropriate filter system to minimize solid particle contamination and water in the system. As early as possible during test operation, new systems should be filled with the selected hydraulic fluid so as to reduce the risk of accidentally mixing the fluids (see chapter 4.5 "Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids"). Changing the hydraulic medium at a later point represents significant additional costs (see following chapter).

2

Bosch Rexroth customarily tests all components with mineral oil HLP before they are delivered.

– Clean reservoir systems and machine reservoirs regularly

– Store barrels on their sides

1

4.6 Re-additivation

3

Additives added at a later point in time such as colors, wear reducers, VI enhancers or anti-foam additives, may negatively affect the performance properties of the hydraulic fluid and the compatibility with our components and therefore are not permissible. Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from re-additivation!

4.7 Foaming behavior 4.4 Hydraulic fluid changeover Changeovers, in particular between hydraulic fluids with heavy metal-free and heavy metal-containing (generally zinc) additives, frequently lead to malfunctions, see chapter 3.1.10 "Additivation". In the case of changeovers of the fluid in hydraulic systems, it is important to ensure compatibility of the new hydraulic fluid with the remainder of the previous hydraulic fluid. We recommend obtaining a written performance guarantee from the manufacturer or supplier of the new hydraulic fluid. The quantity of old fluid remaining should be minimized. Mixing hydraulic fluids should be avoided, see following chapter.

Foam is created by rising air bubbles at the surface of hydraulic fluids in the reservoir. Foam that develops should collapse as quickly as possible. 4 Common hydraulic fluids in accordance with DIN 51524 are sufficiently inhibited against foam formation in new condition. On account of aging and adsorption onto surfaces, the defoamer concentration may decrease over time, leading to a stable foam. Defoamers may be re-dosed only after consultation with the lubricant manufacturer and with his written approval. Defoamers may affect the air separation ability.


24 10/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

4.8 Corrosion

4.11 Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration

The hydraulic fluid is to guarantee sufficient corrosion protection of components under all operating conditions, even in the event of impermissible water contamination.

Air, water, operating temperature influences and solid matter contamination will change the performance characteristics of hydraulic fluids and cause them to age.

During storage and operation, hydraulic fluid based on mineral oils with anti-corrosion additives protect components against water and "acidic" oil degradation products.

To preserve the usage properties and ensure a long service life for hydraulic fluid and components, the monitoring of the fluid condition and a filtration adapted to the application requirements (draining and degassing if required) are indispensable.

4.9 Air

The effort is higher in the case of unfavorable usage conditions, increased stress for the hydraulic system or high expectations as to availability and service life, see chapter 2 "Solid particle contamination and cleanliness level".

Under atmospheric conditions, the hydraulic fluid contains dissolved air. In the negative pressure range, for instance in the suction pipe of the pump or downstream of control edges, this dissolved air may transform into undissolved air. The undissolved air content represents a risk of cavitation and of the diesel effect. This results in material erosion of components and increased hydraulic fluid aging. With the correct measures, such as suction pipe and reservoir design, and an appropriate hydraulic fluid, air intake and separation can be positively influenced. See also chapter 3.1.7 "Air separation ability (ASA)”.

4.10 Water Water contamination in hydraulic fluids can result from direct ingress or indirectly through condensation of water from the air due to temperature variations. Water in the hydraulic fluid may result in wear or direct failure of hydraulic components. Furthermore, a high water content in the hydraulic fluid negatively affects aging and filterability and increases susceptibility to cavitation. Undissolved water can be drained from the bottom of the reservoir. Dissolved water can be removed only by using appropriate measures. If the hydraulic system is used in humid conditions, preventive measures need to be taken, such as an air dehumidifier at the reservoir vent. During operation, the water content in all hydraulic fluids, determined according to the "Karl Fischer method" (see chapter 6 "Glossary") for all hydraulic fluids must constantly be kept below 0.1% (1000 ppm). To ensure a long service life of both hydraulic fluids and components, Bosch Rexroth recommends that values below 0.05% (500 ppm) are permanently maintained. To ensure a long service life for the hydraulic fluids and the components, we recommend that values below 0.05 % (500 ppm) are permanently maintained. Detergent and or dispersant hydraulic fluids (HLPD / HVLPD) are able to absorb (and keep suspended) more water. Prior to using these hydraulic fluids, please contact the lubricant manufacturer.

When commissioning a system, please note that the required minimum cleanliness level can frequently be attained only by flushing the system. Due to severe start-up contamination, it may be possible that a fluid and/or filter replacement becomes necessary after a short operating period (< 50 operating hours). The hydraulic fluid must be replaced in regular intervals and tested by the lubricant manufacturer or recognized, accredited test labs. We recommend a reference analysis after commissioning. The minimum data to be tested for analyses are: – Viscosity at 40 °C and 100 °C – Neutralization number NN (acid number AN) – Water content (Karl-Fischer method) – Particle measurement with evaluation according to ISO 4406 or mass of solid foreign substances with evaluation to EN 12662 – Element analysis (RFA (EDX) / ICP, specify test method) – Comparison with new product or available trend analyses – Assessment / evaluation for further use – Also recommended: IR spectrum Compared to the pure unused hydraulic fluid, the changed neutralization number NN (acid number AN) indicates how many aging products are contained in the hydraulic fluid. This value must be kept as low as possible. As soon as the trend analysis notes a significant increase in the acid number, the lubricant manufacturer should be contacted. In case of warranty, liability or guarantee claims to Bosch Rexroth, service verification and/or the results of fluid analyses are to be provided.


25 RE 90220/05.12

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

Bosch Rexroth AG

11/16

5 Disposal and environmental protection Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oil and related hydrocarbons are hazardous for the environment. They are subject to a special disposal obligation. The respective lubricant manufacturers provide specifications on environmentally acceptable handling and storage. Please ensure that spilt or splashed fluids are absorbed with appropriate adsorbents or by a technique that prevents it contaminating water courses, the ground or sewerage systems.

1

It is also not permitted to mix fluids when disposing of hydraulic fluids. Regulations governing the handing of used oils stipulate that used oils are not to mixed with other products, e.g. substances containing halogen. Non-compliance will increase disposal costs. Comply with the national legal provisions concerning the disposal of the corresponding hydraulic fluid. Comply with the local safety data sheet of the lubricant manufacturer for the country concerned. 2

3

4


26 12/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

6 Other hydraulic fluids based on mineral oil and related hydrocarbons Table 6: Other hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons Serial number 1

Hydraulic fluids

Features / Typical field of application / Notes

Hydraulic fluids with classification HL, HM, HV according to ISO 11158

– Can be used without confirmation provided they are listed in the respective product data sheet and are compliant with DIN 51524. Conformity with DIN 51524 must be verified in the technical data sheet of the fluid concerned. For classification see Table 4: "Hydraulic fluid classification”. – Fluids only classified in accordance with ISO 11158 may be used only with prior written approval of Bosch Rexroth AG.

2

Hydraulic fluids with classification HH, HR, HS, HG according to ISO 11158

– May not be used.

3

Hydraulic fluids with classification HL, HLP, HLPD, HVLP, HVLPD to DIN 51502

– DIN 51502 merely describes how fluids are classified / designated on a national level. – It contains no information on minimum requirements for hydraulic fluids. – Hydraulic fluids standardized according to DIN 51502 can be used without confirmation provided they are listed in the respective product data sheet and are compliant with DIN 51524. Conformity with DIN 51524 must be verified in the technical data sheet of the fluid concerned. For classification see Table 4: "Hydraulic fluid classification”.

4

Hydraulic fluids with classification HH, HL, HM, HR, HV, HS, HG according to ISO 6743-4

– ISO 6743-4 merely describes how fluids are classified / designated on an international level. It contains no information on minimum requirements for hydraulic fluids. – Hydraulic fluids standardized according to ISO 6743 -4 can be used without confirmation provided they are listed in the respective product data sheet and are compliant with DIN 51524. Conformity with DIN 51524 must be verified in the technical data sheet of the fluid concerned. For classification see table 4: "Classification and fields of application".

5

Lubricants and regulator – Turbine oils can be used after confirmation and with limited performance data. fluids for turbines to – They usually offer lower wear protection than mineral oil HLP. Classification of DIN 51515-1 and -2 turbine oils to DIN 51515-1 comparable to HL, turbine oils to DIN 51515-2 comparable to HLP.

6

Lube oils C, CL, CLP in accordance with DIN 51517

– Particular attention must be paid to material compatibility! – Lube oils in acc. with DIN 51517 can be used after confirmation and with limited performance data. They are mostly higher-viscosity fluids with low wear protection. Classification: CL similar to HL fluids and CLP similar to HLP fluids. – Particular attention must be paid to material compatibility, specifically with non-ferrous metals! 7

– There are medical white oils and synthetic hydrocarbons (PAO). Fluids to be used in pharmaceutical – Can only be used after consultation and approval for use in the specific application, and foodstuff industries, even if they are compliant with DIN 51524. in acc. with FDA / USDA / NSF H1 – May be used only with FKM seals. – Other fluids used in pharmaceutical and foodstuff industries may be used only after confirmation. – Attention is to be paid to material compatibility in accordance with the applicable food law. Caution! Fluids used in pharmaceutical and foodstuff industries should not be confused with environmentally acceptable fluids!

Continued on page 13


27 RE 90220/05.12

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

Bosch Rexroth AG

13/16

Table 6: Other hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons (continued from page 12) Serial number 8

Hydraulic fluids

Features / Typical field of application / Notes

Hydraulic fluids of classes HVLP and HVLPD based on related hydrocarbons

– Can only be used after consultation and approval for use in the specific application, even if they are compliant with DIN 51524.

1

– Lower pour point than HLP – Other wetting (polarity)

9

Automatic Transmission Fluids (ATF)

– ATF are operating fluids for automatic gearboxes in vehicles and machines. In special cases, ATFs are also used for certain synchronous gearboxes and hydraulic systems comprising gearboxes. – To be used only after confirmation! – Some of these fluids have poor air separation abilities and modified wear properties. – Check material compatibility and filterability!

10

Multi-purpose oil (MFO) – Industry

– Multi-purpose oils (industry) combine at least two requirements for a fluid, for instance metal machining and hydraulics.

2

– To be used only after confirmation! – Please pay particular attention to air separation ability, modified wear properties and the reduced material life cycle. – Check material compatibility and filterability! 11

Multi-purpose oils (MFO) – Mobil UTTO, STOU

– Multi-purpose oils combine requirements for wet brakes, gearboxes, motor oil (STOU only) and hydraulics. – Fluids of the types: – UTTO (= universal tractor transmission oil) and – STOU (= Super Tractor super tractor universal oil) – To be used only after confirmation! – Please pay particular attention to shear stability, air separation ability and modified wear properties.

3

– Check material compatibility and filterability! 12

Single-grade engine oils 10W, 20W, 30W

– To be used only after confirmation!

13

Multi-grade engine oils 0Wx-30Wx

– To be used only after confirmation!

– Please pay particular attention to the air separation ability and filtering ability.

– Please pay particular attention to air separation ability, changes in wear protection capability, viscosity changes during operation, material compatibility, dispersant and detergent properties and filterability. Caution! Multi-grade engine oils have been adapted to specific requirements in combustion engines and are suitable for use in hydraulic systems only to a limited extent.

14

15

4

Hydraulic fluids for military applications to MIL 13919 or H 540, MIL 46170 or H 544, MIL 5606 or H 515, MIL 83282 or H 537, MIL 87257

– To be used only after confirmation!

Motor vehicle transmission oils

– Motor vehicle transmission oil can be used after confirmation and with limited performance data.

– Please pay particular attention to air separation ability, changes in wear protection capability, viscosity changes during operation, material compatibility, water separation capability and filterability. Caution! Hydraulic fluids for military applications do not meet the current requirements for high-quality hydraulic fluids and are suitable for use only to a limited degree.

– Pay particular attention to wear protection, material compatibility, specifically with non-ferrous metals, as well as viscosity! Continued on page 14


28 14/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

Table 6: Other hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons (continued from page 13) Serial number 16

Hydraulic fluids

Features / Typical field of application / Notes

Diesel, test diesel in acc. with DIN 4113

– Diesel / test diesel has poorer wear protection capabilities and a very low viscosity (< 3 mm2/s). – May be used only with FKM seals – Please note their low flash point! – To be used only after confirmation and with limited performance data!

17

Hydraulic fluids for roller – Hydraulic fluids for roller processes have lower wear protection capabilities than processes mineral oil HLP and a lower viscosity – Please note their low flash point! – Hydraulic fluids for roller processes with limited performance data can be used only after confirmation.

18

Fluids for power steering, hydro-pneumatic suspension, active chassis etc.

– Can only be used after consultation and approval for use in the specific application, even if they are compliant with DIN 51524. – Please note the low viscosity! – In most cases they have poor water separation capability – Check the material compatibility!


29 RE 90220/05.12

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

Bosch Rexroth AG

15/16

7 Glossary Additivation Additives are chemical substances added to the basic fluids to achieve or improve specific properties. Aging Hydraulic fluids age due to oxidation (see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance"). Liquid and solid contamination acts as a catalyzer for aging, meaning that it needs to be minimized as far as possible by careful filtration. API classification Classification of basic fluids by the American Petroleum Institute (API) – the largest association representing the US oil and gas industry. Arrhenius equation The quantitative relation between reaction rate and temperature is described by an exponential function, the Arrhenius equation. This function is usually visualized within the typical temperature range of the hydraulic system. For a practical example, see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance”. Related hydrocarbons Related hydrocarbons are hydrocarbon compounds that are not classified as API class 1, 2 or 5. Basic fluids In general, a hydraulic fluid is made up of a basic fluid, or base oil, and chemical substances, the so-called additives. The proportion of basic fluid is generally greater than 90%. Demulsifying Ability of a fluid to separate water contamination quickly; achieved with careful selection of base oil and additives. Detergent Ability of certain additives to emulsify part of the water contamination in the oil or to hold it in suspension until it has evaporated with increasing temperature. Larger water quantities, in contrast (above approx. 2 %), are separated immediately. Dispersant Ability of certain additives to keep insoluble liquid and solid contamination in suspension in the fluid. Diesel effect If hydraulic fluid that contains air bubbles is compressed quickly, the bubbles are heated to such a degree that a selfignition of the air-gas mix may occur. The resultant temperature increase may lead to seal damage and increased aging of the hydraulic fluid. Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils are made from petroleum (crude oil). ICP (atomic emission spectroscopy) The ICP procedure can be used to determine various wear metals, contamination types and additives. Practically all elements in the periodic system can be detected with this method. Karl Fischer method Method to determine the water content in fluids. Indirect coulometric determination procedure in accordance with DIN EN ISO 12937 in connection with DIN 51777-2. Only the combination of both standards will assure adequately accurate measured values.

Cavitation Cavitation is the creation of cavities in fluids due to pressure reduction below the saturated vapour pressure and subsequent implosion when the pressure increases. When the cavities implode, extremely high acceleration, temperatures and pressure may occur temporarily, which may damage the component surfaces.

1

Neutralization number (NN) The neutralization number (NN) or acid number (AN) specifies the amount of caustic potash required to neutralize the acid contained in one gram of fluid. Pour point The lowest temperature at which the fluid still just flows when cooled down under set conditions. The pour point is specified in the lubricant manufacturers' technical data sheets as a reference value for achieving this flow limit. RFA (wavelength dispersive x-ray fluorescence analysis) Is a procedure to determine nearly all elements in liquid and solid samples with nearly any composition. This analysis method is suitable for examining additives and contamination, delivering fast results.

2

Shearing/shear loss Shearing of molecule chains during operation can change the viscosity of hydraulic fluids with long chain VI enhancers. The initially high viscosity index drops. This needs to be taken into account when selecting the hydraulic fluid. The only value at present that can be used to assess viscosity changes in operation is the result of the test in accordance with DIN 51350 part -6. Please note that there are practical applications that create a much higher shear load on such hydraulic fluids than can be achieved by this test. Stick-slip effect (sliding) Interaction between a resilient mass system involving friction (such as cylinder + oil column + load) and the pressure increase at very low sliding speeds. The static friction of the system is a decisive value here. The lower it is, the lower the speed that can still be maintained without sticking. Depending on the tribologic system, the stick-slip effect may lead to vibrations generated and sometimes also to significant noise emission. In many cases, the effect can be attenuated by replacing the lubricant. Viscosity Viscosity is the measure of the internal friction of a fluid to flow. It is defined as the property of a substance to flow under tension. Viscosity is the most important characteristic for describing the load-bearing capacity of a hydraulic fluid. Kinematic viscosity is the ratio of the dynamic viscosity and the density of the fluid; the unit is mm²/s. Hydraulic fluids are classified by their kinematic viscosity into ISO viscosity classes. The reference temperature for this is 40 °C. Viscosity index (VI) Refers to the viscosity temperature behavior of a fluid. The lower the change of viscosity in relation the temperature, the higher the VI.

3

4


30 16/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Zum EisengieĂ&#x;er 1 97816 Lohr am Main, Germany Phone +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-0 Fax +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-23 58 documentation@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.de

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils

RE 90220/05.12

Š This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. No statements concerning the suitability of a hydraulic fluid for a specific purpose can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


31

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12 1/14 Replaces: 05.10

Application notes and requirements for Rexroth hydraulic components

Hydraulic fluids

Title

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-containing hydraulic fluids

Standard

DIN 51524

ISO 15380

ISO 12922

ISO 12922

Data sheets

RE 90220

RE 90221

RE 90222

RE 90223 (in preparation)

Classification

HL HLP HLPD HVLP HLPD and more

HEPG HEES partially saturated HEES saturated HEPR HETG

HFDR HFDU (ester base) HFDU (glycol base) and more

HFC HFB HFAE HFAS


32 2/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

Contents 1 Basic information .................................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.1 General instructions ...................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.2 Environmental compatibility .....................................................................................................................................................................3 1.3 Scope ...........................................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.4 Safety instructions .....................................................................................................................................................................................3 2 Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels .....................................................................................................................................4 3 Selection of the hydraulic fluid ..........................................................................................................................................................................5 3.1 Selection criteria for the hydraulic fluid .................................................................................................................................................5 3.1.1 Viscosity .................................................................................................................................................................................................5 3.1.2 Viscosity-temperature behavior........................................................................................................................................................5 3.1.3 Wear protection capability ................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.4 Material compatibility..........................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.5 Aging resistance .................................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.6 Biological degradation .......................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.7 Air separation ability (ASA) ...............................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.8 Demulsifying ability and water solubility ........................................................................................................................................7 3.1.9 Filterability .............................................................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.10 Corrosion protection ........................................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.11 Additivation .........................................................................................................................................................................................7 3.2 Classification and fields of application ................................................................................................................................................8 4 Hydraulic fluids in operation ............................................................................................................................................................................10 4.1 General .......................................................................................................................................................................................................10 4.2 Storage and handling .............................................................................................................................................................................10 4.3 Filling of new systems.............................................................................................................................................................................10 4.4 Hydraulic fluid changeover ....................................................................................................................................................................10 4.5 Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids .......................................................................................................................10 4.6 Re-additivation..........................................................................................................................................................................................10 4.7 Foaming behavior .....................................................................................................................................................................................10 4.8 Corrosion ...................................................................................................................................................................................................11 4.9 Air ................................................................................................................................................................................................................11 4.10 Water ........................................................................................................................................................................................................11 4.11 Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration .......................................................................................................................................11 5 Disposal and environmental protection ........................................................................................................................................................12 6 Glossary ...............................................................................................................................................................................................................13


33 RE 90221/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

3/14

1 Basic information 1.1 General instructions The hydraulic fluid is the common element in any hydraulic component and must be selected very carefully. Quality and cleanliness of the hydraulic fluid are decisive factors for the operational reliability, efficiency and service life of a system. Hydraulic fluids must conform, be selected and used in accordance with the generally acknowledged rules of technology and safety provisions. Reference is made to the countryspecific standards and directives (in Germany the directive of the Employer's Liability Insurance Association BGR 137). This data sheet includes recommendations and regulations concerning the selection, operation and disposal of environmentally compatible hydraulic fluids in the application of Rexroth hydraulic components. The individual selection of hydraulic fluid or the choice of classification are the responsibility of the operator. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure that appropriate measures are taken for safety and health protection and to ensure compliance with statutory regulations. The recommendations of the lubricant manufacturer and the specifications given in the safety data sheet are to be observed when using hydraulic fluid. This data sheet does not absolve the operator from verifying the conformity and suitability of the respective hydraulic fluid for his system. He is to ensure that the selected fluid meets the minimum requirements of the relevant fluid standard during the whole of the period of use. Other regulations and legal provisions may also apply. The operator is responsible for their observance, e.g. EU directive 2004/35/EG, 2005/360/EG and their national implementation. In Germany the Water Resources Act (WHG) is also to be observed. We recommend that you maintain constant, close contact with lubricant manufacturers to support you in the selection, maintenance, care and analyses. When disposing of used hydraulic fluids, apply the same care as during use. Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids have been used successfully for many years. In some countries, the use of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids is already prescribed in ecologically sensitive areas (e.g. forestry, locks, weirs). Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids may only be used in the pharmaceutical and food industry subject to required certification to FDA/USDA/NSF H1.

1.2 Environmental compatibility There is no unambiguous legal definition for environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids as different testing procedures can be applied for biological degradation and toxicity. According to ISO 15380 the definition of "environmentally acceptable" is as follows: Humans, animals, plants, air and soil must not be endangered. With regard to hydraulic fluids in an unused condition in the bin this mainly means: – biological degradation at least 60 % (according to ISO 14593 or ISO 9439) – acute fish toxicity at least 100 mg/l (according to ISO 7346-2)

– acute daphnia toxicity at least 100 mg/l (according to ISO 5341) – acute bacteria toxicity at least 100 mg/l (according to ISO 8192) The same amount of care should be taken when handling 1 environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids as for mineral oils, leakage from the hydraulic system should be avoided. Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids are designed so that in the event of accidents and leakage,less permanent environmental damage is caused than by mineral oils, see also chapter 5 "Disposal and environmental protection". In comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP , the biological degradation of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids may change fluid aging, see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance", 3.1.6. "Biological degradation" and 4 "Hydraulic fluids in operation".

1.3 Scope This data sheet must be applied when using environmentally 2 acceptable hydraulic fluids with Rexroth hydraulic components. The specifications of this data sheet may be further restricted by the specification given in the data sheets for the individual components. The use of the individual environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids in accordance with the intended purpose can be found in the safety data sheets or other product description documents of the lubricant manufacturers. In addition, each use is to be individually considered. Rexroth hydraulic components may only be operated with environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids according to ISO 15380 if specified in the respective component data sheet or if a Rexroth approval for use is furnished. The manufacturers of hydraulic systems must adjust their systems and operating instructions to the environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids.

3

Notes: In the market overview RE 90221-01, environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids based on mineral oil are described which, according to the information of the lubricant manufacturer, feature the respective parameters of the current requirements standard ISO 15380 and other parameters which are of relevance for suitability in connection with Rexroth components. These specifications are not checked or monitored by Bosch Rexroth. The list in the market overview does not therefore represent a recommendation on the part of Rexroth or approval 4 of the respective hydraulic fluid for use with Rexroth components and does not release the operator from his responsibility regarding selection of the hydraulic fluid. Bosch Rexroth will accept no liability for its components for any damage resulting from failure to comply with the notes below.

1.4 Safety instructions Hydraulic fluids can constitute a risk for persons and the environment. These risks are described in the hydraulic fluid safety data sheets. The operator is to ensure that a current safety data sheet for the hydraulic fluid used is available and that the measures stipulated therein are complied with.


34 4/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

2 Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels Solid particle contamination is the major reason for faults occurring in hydraulic systems. It may lead to a number of effects in the hydraulic system. Firstly, single large solid particles may lead directly to a system malfunction, and secondly small particles cause continuous elevated wear. For mineral oils, the cleanliness level of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids is given as a three-digit numerical code in accordance with ISO 4406. This numerical code denotes the number of particles present in a hydraulic fluid for a defined quantity. Moreover, foreign solid matter is not to exceed a mass of 50 mg/kg (gravimetric examination according to ISO 4405).

the operating period, you must use a reservoir breather filter. If the environment is humid, take appropriate measures, such as a breather filter with air drying or permanent off-line water separation. Note: the specifications of the lubricant manufacturer relating to cleanliness levels are based on the time at which the container concerned is filled and not on the conditions during transport and storage. Further information about contamination with solid matter and cleanliness levels can be found in brochure RE 08016.

In general, compliance with a minimum cleanliness level of 20/18/15 in accordance with ISO 4406 or better is to be maintained in operation. Special servo valves demand improved cleanliness levels of at least 18/16/13. A reduction in cleanliness level by one level means half of the quantity of particles and thus greater cleanliness. Lower numbers in cleanliness levels should always be striven for and extend the service life of hydraulic components. The component with the highest cleanliness requirements determines the required cleanliness of the overall system. Please also observe the specifications in table 1: "Cleanliness levels according to ISO 4406" and in the respective data sheets of the various hydraulic components. Hydraulic fluids frequently fail to meet these cleanliness requirements on delivery. Careful filtering is therefore required during operation and in particular, during filling in order to ensure the required cleanliness levels. Your lubricant manufacturer can tell you the cleanliness level of hydraulic fluids as delivered. To maintain the required cleanliness level over

Table 1: Cleanliness levels according to ISO 4406 Particles per 100 ml More than

Up to and including

Scale number

8,000,000

16,000,000

24

4,000,000

8,000,000

23

2,000,000

4,000,000

22

1,000,000

2,000,000

21

500,000

1,000,000

20

250,000

500,000

19

130,000

250,000

18

64000

130,000

17

32000

64000

16

16000

32000

15

8000

16000

14

4000

8000

13

2000

4000

12

1000

2000

11

500

1000

10

250

500

9

130

250

8

64

130

7

32

64

6

20 / 18 / 15 > 4 μm > 6 μm > 14 μm


35 RE 90221/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

5/14

3 Selection of the hydraulic fluid Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids for Bosch Rexroth hydraulic components are assessed on the basis of their fulfillment of the minimum requirements of ISO 15380.

If the viscosity of a hydraulic fluid is below the permitted operating viscosity, increased leakage, wear, susceptibility to contamination and a shorter life cycle will result.

3.1 Selection criteria for the hydraulic fluid

Please ensure that the permissible temperature and viscosity limits are observed for the respective components. This usually requires either cooling or heating, or both.

The specified limit values for all components employed in the hydraulic system, for example viscosity and cleanliness level, must be observed with the hydraulic fluid used, taking into account the specified operating conditions. Hydraulic fluid suitability depends, amongst others, on the following factors: 3.1.1 Viscosity Viscosity is a basic property of hydraulic fluids. The permissible viscosity range of complete systems needs to be determined taking account of the permissible viscosity of all components and it is to be observed for each individual component. The viscosity at operating temperature determines the response characteristics of closed control loops, stability and damping of systems, the efficiency factor and the degree of wear. We recommend that the optimum operating viscosity range of each component be kept within the permissible temperature range. This usually requires either cooling or heating, or both. The permissible viscosity range and the necessary cleanliness level can be found in the product data sheet for the component concerned. If the viscosity of a hydraulic fluid used is above the permitted operating viscosity, this will result in increased hydraulic-mechanical losses. In return, there will be lower internal leakage losses. If the pressure level is lower, lubrication gaps may not be filled up, which can lead to increased wear. For hydraulic pumps, the permitted suction pressure may not be reached, which may lead to cavitation damage.

1

3.1.2 Viscosity-temperature behavior For hydraulic fluids, the viscosity temperature behavior (V-T behavior) is of particular importance. Viscosity is characterized in that it drops when the temperature increases and rises when the temperature drops. The interrelation between viscosity and temperature is described by the viscosity index (VI). If exposed to the cold for several days, viscosity may rise significantly (HETG and HEES). After heating, the characteristic values as specified on the data sheet are restored. Please ask your lubricant manufacturer for the " Flow capacity after 7 days at low temperature" (ASTM D 2532) of fluid classifications 2 HETG and partially saturated HEES. All known environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids have better viscosity temperature behavior than mineral oil HLP and generally feature greater shear stability than HVLP mineral oils. This should be taken into consideration when selecting hydraulic fluid for the required temperature range. A lower viscosity level can frequently be used to save any drive power during a cold start and avoid viscosity being too low at higher temperatures. The required viscosity and temperature limits in the product data sheets are to be observed in all operating conditions. Depending on the basic fluid types/classes, VI indices can be achieved of 140–220, see Fig. 1: "Examples: V-T diagrams in comparison to HLP (reference values)" and Table 4: "Classification and fields of application of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids".

3

Fig. 1: Examples V-T diagrams in comparison to HLP (reference values, double-logarithmic representation) 40q 1600 1000 600 400

20q

0q

20q

40q

60q

80q 100q

Temperature

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

200 100 60 40 20 10

5 40q 25q 10q 0q 10q 30q 50q Temperature t [°C]

Typical viscosity data [mm2/s]

70q

90q

115q

–20 °C

40 °C

100 °C

HEES partially saturated

1250

46

9

HEES saturated

2500

46

8

HEPG

2500

46

10

HEPR

1400

46

10

For comparison HLP (see RE 90220)

4500

46

7

HEPG HEPR HEES partially saturated HEES saturated HLP

Detailed V-T diagrams may be obtained from your lubricant manufacturer for their specific products.

4


36 6/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

3.1.3 Wear protection capability

3.1.5 Aging resistance

Wear protection capability describes the property of hydraulic fluids to prevent or minimize wear within the components. The wear protection capability is described in ISO 15380 via test procedures"FZG gear test rig" (ISO 14635-1) and "Mechanical test in the vane pump" (ISO 20763). From ISO VG 32, ISO 15380 prescribes a rating of at least 10 (FZG test). At present, the FZG test cannot be applied to viscosity classes < ISO VG 32. The wear protection capability of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids in relation to the two test procedures is comparable to that of mineral oil HLP/HVLP.

The way an environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids ages depends on the thermal, chemical and mechanical stress to which it is subjected. The influence of water, air, temperature and contamination may be significantly greater than for mineral oils HLP/HVLP. Aging resistance can be greatly influenced by the chemical composition of the hydraulic fluids .

3.1.4 Material compatibility The hydraulic fluid must not negatively affect the materials used in the components. Compatibility with coatings, seals, hoses, metals and plastics is to be observed in particular. The fluid classifications specified in the respective component data sheets are tested by the manufacturer with regard to material compatibility. Parts and components not supplied by us are to be checked by the user. Table 2: Known material incompatibilities Classification Incompatible with: HE... general

One-component color coatings, lead, galvanized zinc coatings, some non-ferrous metals, seals made of NBR. In some cases, the latter show major increases in volume when impermissibly aged hydraulic fluids come into contact with the material. NBR is only permitted by prior consent, please observe the customary seal and tube replacement intervals. Do not use any hydrolysis/susceptible polyurethane qualities. Note Please check seals and coatings of control cabinets, outer coatings of hydraulic components and accessories (connectors, cables, control cabinets) for resistance to vapors issuing from hydraulic fluids.

HETG/HEES

Zinc, some non-ferrous alloys with zinc

HEPG

Steel/aluminum tribocontacts, paper filters, polymethylmethacrylate (PMMA), NBR Note Check plastics for resistance

The material incompatibilities mentioned here do not automatically result in function problems. However the elements of the materials are found in the hydraulic fluids after use. The biological degradation of hydraulic fluids is negatively influenced.

High fluid temperatures (e.g. over 80 °C) result in a approximate halving of the fluid service life for every 10 °C temperature increase and should therefore by avoided. The halving of the fluid service life results from the application of the Arrhenius equation (see Glossary). Table 3: Reference values for temperature-dependent aging of the hydraulic fluid Reservoir temperature

Fluid life cycle

80 °C

100 %

90 °C

50 %

100 °C

25 %

A modified aging test (without adding water) is prescribed for fluid classifications HETG and HEES. Hydraulic fluids with HEPG and HEPR classification are subjected to the identical test procedure as mineral oils (with 20 % water added). The calculated fluid service life is derived from the results of tests in which the long-term characteristics are simulated in a short period of time by applying more arduous conditions (condensed testing). This calculated fluid service life is not to be equated to the fluid service life in real-life applications. Table 3 is a practical indicator for hydraulic fluids with water content < 0.1%, cf. chapter 4.10. "Water". 3.1.6 Biological degradation Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids are ones which degrade biologically much faster than mineral oils. Biological degradation is a biochemical transformation effected by micro-organisms resulting in mineralization. For environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids that make reference to ISO 15380, biological degradation according to ISO 14593 or ISO 9439 must be verified. 60% minimum degradation is defined as limit value. Proof of biological degradation is furnished for the new, unmixed, ready-formulated hydraulic fluids. Aged or mixed hydraulic fluids are less able to degrade biologically. Biological degradation outside the defined test procedure is subject to a variety of natural influences. The key factors are temperature, humidity, contamination, fluid concentration, type and quantity of micro-organisms. Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids require no extended maintenance in comparison to mineral oils, please observe chapter 4 "Hydraulic fluids in operation".


37 RE 90221/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

7/14

3.1.7 Air separation ability (ASA)

3.1.10 Corrosion protection

The air separation ability (ASA) describes the property of a hydraulic fluid to separate undissolved air. Hydraulic fluids always contain dissolved air. During operation, dissolved air may be transformed into undissolved air, leading to cavitation damages. Fluid classification, fluid product, reservoir size and design must be coordinated to take into account the dwell time and ASA value of the hydraulic fluid. The air separation capacity depends on the viscosity, temperature, basic fluid and aging. It cannot be improved by additives.

Hydraulic fluids should not just prevent corrosion formation on steel components, they must also be compatible with non-ferrous metals and alloys. Corrosion protection tests on different metals and metal alloys are described in ISO 15380. 1 Hydraulic fluids that are not compatible with the materials listed above must not be used, even if they are compliant with ISO 15380.

According to ISO 15380, for instance, an ASA value d 10 minutes is required for viscosity class ISO VG 46, 6 minutes are typical, lower values are preferable. 3.1.8 Demulsifying ability and water solubility The capacity of a hydraulic fluid to separate water at a defined temperature is known as the demulsifying ability. ISO 6614 defines the demulsifying properties of hydraulic fluids. Fluids classified HETG, HEES and HEPR separate from water. HETG and HEES hydraulic fluids have a different water separation ability to mineral oil HLP/HVLP. At 20 °C, in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP, a multiple ( > factor 3) of water can separate in the hydraulic fluid. Water solubility is also more temperature-dependent than for mineral oils. With regard to water solubility, HEPR hydraulic fluids behave like HVLP hydraulic fluids (see RE 90220). In the majority of cases, HEPG-classified fluids HEPG dissolve water completely , see chapter "4.10 Water".

Rexroth components are usually tested with HLP hydraulic fluids or corrosion protection oils based on mineral oils before they are delivered. 3.1.11 Additivation The properties described above can be modified with the help of suitable additives. Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids should never contain heavy metals. According to the present state of knowledge, all hydraulic fluids, regardless of additivation, can be filtered with all customary filter materials in all known filtration ratings (t 0.8 Îźm), without filtering out effective additives at the same time.

2

Bosch Rexroth does not prescribe any specific additive system.

3.1.9 Filterability Filterability describes the ability of a hydraulic fluid to pass through a filter, removing solid contaminants. The hydraulic fluids used require a good filterability, not just when new, but also during the whole of their service life. Depending on the different basic fluids (glycols, saturated and partially saturated ester oils, hydrocrack oils, polyalpha olefins, triglycerides) and additives (VI enhancers), there are great differences here.

3

The filterability is a basic prerequisite for cleanliness, servicing and filtration of hydraulic fluids. Rexroth therefore requires the same degree of filterability of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids as for mineral oils HLP/HVLP to DIN 51524. As ISO 15380 does not comment on the filterability of hydraulic fluids, filterability comparable to that of mineral oils HLP/HVLP must be requested of lubricant manufacturers. Filterability is tested with the new hydraulic fluid and after the addition of 0.2 % water. The underlying standard (ISO 133571/-2) stipulates that filterability must have no negative effects on the filters or the hydraulic fluid, see chapter 4 "Hydraulic fluids in operation".

4


38 8/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

3.2 Classification and fields of application Table 4: Classification and fields of application Classification

Features

HEPG according to ISO 15380

Basic fluid, glycols

Density at 15 °C: typically > 0.97 kg/dm³

Typical field of application

Notes

Systems on exposed water courses (locks, weirs, dredgers)

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner.

VI: typical > 170

– Very good viscosity/temperature characteristics, shear stability – Resistant to aging – Incompatible with mineral oil (exceptions must be confirmed by the lubricant manufacturer) – Can be water-soluble – Can be mixed with water – Very good wear protection properties – A higher implementation temperature with the same viscosity in comparison to mineral oil is to be expected – Due to the higher density in comparison to HLP, lower suction pressures are to be anticipated for pumps. Reduce the maximum speed as required and optimize suction conditions. – Classified as insignificantly water-endangering (water hazard class WGK 1) – Prior to commissioning, contact the lubricant manufacturer, as the components are tested with mineral oil HLP/corrosion protection oil.

Basic fluid: Ester Suitable for most based on renewfields of application able raw materials, and components. synthetic esters, mixtures of various Density at esters, mixtures with 15 °C: typically polyalphaolefines 0.90–0.93 kg/dm³ (< 30%) VI: typical > 160 HEES partially saturated according to ISO 15380

Iodine count < 90

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. – Preferred use of FKM seals. Please enquire for shaft seal rings and implementation temperatures under –15 °C. – In operation, a higher temperature in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP is to be expected given identical design and viscosity – Limit lower (depending on viscosity class) and upper implementation temperatures (maximum 80 °C due to aging) – Good viscosity/temperature characteristics, shear stability. – Good corrosion protection, if correspondingly additivized – Mostly classed as insignificantly water-endangering (water hazard class WGK 1), in some cases as not water-endangering – High dirt dissolving capacity on fluid changeovers – In unfavorable operating conditions (high water content, high temperature), HEES on ester basis have a tendency to hydrolysis. The acidic organic decomposition products can chemically attack materials and components.

Continued on page 9


39 RE 90221/05.12

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

Bosch Rexroth AG

9/14

Table 4: Classification and fields of application (continued from page 8) Classification

Features

Basic fluid: Ester based on renewable raw materials, synthetic esters, mixtures of various Density at esters, mixtures with 15 °C: typically polyalphaolefines 0.90–0.93 kg/dm³ (< 30%) VI: typical 140–160 HEES saturated according to ISO 15380

Iodine count <15

Typical field of application Suitable for most fields of application and components. Saturated HEES should be preferred over partially saturated HEES and HETG for components and systems exposed to high stress levels.

Notes For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner.

1

– Preferred use of FKM seals. Please enquire for shaft seal rings and implementation temperatures under –15 °C. – In operation, a higher temperature in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP is to be expected given identical design and viscosity – Good viscosity/temperature characteristics, shear stability – Good corrosion protection, if correspondingly additivized – Mostly classed as insignificantly water-endangering (water hazard class WGK 1), in the case of low viscosity classes (up to ISO VG 32) also classed as not water-endangering

2

– High dirt dissolving capacity on fluid changeovers HEPR according to ISO 15380 Density at 15 °C: typically 0.87 kg/ dm³

Basic fluid: synthetically manufactured hydrocarbons (polyalpha olefins PAO) partly mixed with esters ( < 30 %)

VI : typical 140–160

Suitable for most fields of application and components. HEPR should be preferred over partially saturated HEES and HETG for components and systems exposed to high stress levels.

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. – Behaves similarly to HVLP- hydraulic fluids, individual products comply with ISO 15380 HEPR and DIN 51524-3 HVLP – Preferred use of FKM seals. Please enquire for shaft seal rings and implementation temperatures under –15 °C. – Good viscosity-temperature behavior – Classified as insignificantly water-endangering (water hazard class WGK 1)

3

Note: Note shear stability (see chapter 4.11 "Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration" and chapter 6 "Glossary") HETG according to ISO 15380 Density at 15 °C: typically 0.90-0.93 kg/dm³ VI: typical > 200 Iodine count > 90

Basic fluid: vegetable oils and triglycerides

Not recommended for Rexroth components!

Practical requirements are frequently not fulfilled by hydraulic fluids in this classification. Use only permissible after consultation. – Viscosity is not stable over time – Very fast fluid aging, very hydrolysis-susceptible (please observe neutralization number) – Tendency to gumming, gelling and setting. – Limit the lower (depending on viscosity class) and upper implementation temperatures (see chapter 3.1.5) – Only limited material compatibility – Filterability problems at water ingress – High dirt dissolving capacity on fluid changeovers – Mostly classed as not water-endangering

4


40 10/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

4 Hydraulic fluids in operation 4.1 General The properties of hydraulic fluids can change continually during storage and operation. Please note that the fluid standard ISO 15380 merely describes minimum requirements for hydraulic fluids in new condition at the time of filling into the bins. The operator of a hydraulic system must ensure that the hydraulic fluid remains in a utilizable condition throughout its entire period of use. Deviations from the characteristic values are to be clarified with the lubricant manufacturer, the test labs or Bosch Rexroth. Bosch Rexroth will accept no liability for damage to its components within the framework of the applicable liability legislation insofar as the latter is due to non-observance of the following instructions. Please note the following aspects in operation.

4.2 Storage and handling Hydraulic fluids must be stored correctly in accordance with the instructions of the lubricant manufacturer. Avoid exposing the containers to lengthy periods of direct heat. Containers are to be stored in such a way that the risk of any foreign liquid or solid matter (e.g. water, foreign fluids or dust) ingression into the inside of the container can be ruled out. After taking hydraulic fluids from the containers, these are immediately to be properly resealed. Recommendation: – Store containers in a dry, roofed place – Store barrels on their sides – Clean reservoir systems and machine reservoirs regularly

4.3 Filling of new systems Usually, the cleanliness levels of the hydraulic fluids as delivered do not meet the requirements of our components. Hydraulic fluids must be filtered using an appropriate filter system to minimize solid particle contamination and water in the system. As early as possible during test operation, new systems should be filled with the selected hydraulic fluid so as to reduce the risk of accidentally mixing fluids (see chapter 4.5 "Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids"). Changing the hydraulic medium at a later point represents significant additional costs (see following chapter).

4.4 Hydraulic fluid changeover In particular with the changeover from mineral oils to environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids, but also from one environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids to another, there may be interference (e.g. incompatibility in the form of gelling, silting, stable foam or reduced filterability or filter blockage). In the case of changeovers of the fluid in hydraulic systems, it is important to ensure compatibility of the new hydraulic fluid with the remains of the previous hydraulic fluid. Bosch Rexroth recommends obtaining verification of compatibility from the

manufacturer or supplier of the new hydraulic fluid. The quantity of old fluid remaining should be minimized. Mixing hydraulic fluids should be avoided, see following chapter. For information on changing over hydraulic fluids with different classifications, please refer to VDMA 24314, VDMA 24569 and ISO 15380 appendix A. Bosch Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from inadequate hydraulic fluid changeovers!

4.5 Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids If hydraulic fluids from different manufacturers or different types from the same manufacturer are mixed, gelling, silting and deposits may occur. These, in turn, may cause foaming, impaired air separation ability, malfunctions and damage to the hydraulic system. If the fluid contains more than 2 % of another fluid then it is considered to be a mixture. Exceptions apply for water, see chapter 4.10 "Water". Mixing with other hydraulic fluids is not generally permitted. This also includes hydraulic fluids with the same classification and from the market overview RE 90221-01. If individual lubricant manufacturers advertise miscibility and/or compatibility, this is entirely the responsibility of the lubricant manufacturer. Bosch Rexroth customarily tests all components with mineral oil HLP before they are delivered. Note: With connectible accessory units and mobile filtering systems, there is a considerable risk of non-permitted mixing of the hydraulic fluids! Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from mixing hydraulic fluids!

4.6 Re-additivation Additives added at a later point in time such as colors, wear reducers, VI enhancers or anti-foam additives, may negatively affect the performance properties of the hydraulic fluid and the compatibility with our components and therefore are not permissible. Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from re-additivation!

4.7 Foaming behavior Foam is created by rising air bubbles at the surface of hydraulic fluids in the reservoir. Foam that develops should collapse as quickly as possible. Common hydraulic fluids in accordance with ISO 15380 are sufficiently inhibited against foam formation in new condition. On account of aging and adsorption onto surfaces, the defoamer concentration may decrease over time, leading to a stable foam. Defoamers may be re-dosed only after consultation with the lubricant manufacturer and with his written approval. Defoamers may affect the air separation ability.


41 RE 90221/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

11/14

4.8 Corrosion

4.11 Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration

The hydraulic fluid is to guarantee sufficient corrosion protection of components under all operating conditions, even in the event of impermissible water contamination.

Air, water, operating temperature influences and solid matter contamination will change the performance characteristics of hydraulic fluids and cause them to age.

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids are tested for corrosion protection in the same way as mineral oil HLP/ HVLP. When used in practice other corrosion mechanisms are revealed in detail and in individual cases, for the most part in contact with non-ferrous and white alloys.

4.9 Air Under atmospheric conditions the hydraulic fluid contains dissolved air. In the negative pressure range, for instance in the suction pipe of the pump or downstream of control edges, this dissolved air may transform into undissolved air. The undissolved air content represents a risk of cavitation and of the diesel effect. This results in material erosion of components and increased hydraulic fluid aging. With the correct measures, such as suction pipe and reservoir design, and an appropriate hydraulic fluid, air intake and separation can be positively influenced. See also chapter 3.1.7 "Air separation ability (ASA)”.

To preserve the usage properties and ensure a long service life 1 for hydraulic fluid and components, the monitoring of the fluid condition and a filtration adapted to the application requirements (draining and degassing if required) are indispensable. The effort is higher in the case of unfavorable usage conditions, increased stress for the hydraulic system or high expectations as to availability and service life, see chapter 2 "Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels". When commissioning a system, please note that the required minimum cleanliness level can frequently be attained only by flushing the system. Due to severe start-up contamination, it may be possible that a fluid and/or filter replacement becomes necessary after a short operating period (< 50 operating hours).

2

The hydraulic fluid must be replaced at regular intervals and tested by the lubricant manufacturer or recognized accredited test labs. We recommend a reference analysis after commissioning. The minimum data to be tested for analyses are:

4.10 Water

– Viscosity at 40 °C and 100 °C

Water contamination in hydraulic fluids can result from direct ingress or indirectly through condensation of water from the air due to temperature variations.

– Neutralization number NN (acid number AN)

HEPG dissolves water completely. This means that any water that has ingressed into the system cannot be drained off in the sump of the reservoir. In the case of hydraulic fluids classed HETG, HEES and HEPR undissolved water can be drained off from the reservoir sump, the remaining water content is however too high to ensure that the maximum permissible water limit values are observed in the long term. Water in the hydraulic fluid can result in wear or direct failure of hydraulic components. Furthermore, a high water content in the hydraulic fluid negatively affects aging and filterability and increases susceptibility to cavitation. During operation, the water content in all hydraulic fluids, determined according to the "Karl Fischer method" (see chapter 6 "Glossary") for all environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids must constantly be kept below 0.1% (1000 ppm). To ensure a long service life of both hydraulic fluids and components, Bosch Rexroth recommends that values below 0.05% (500 ppm) are permanently maintained. Due to the higher water solubility (except for HEPR) in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP it is urgently advised that precautions be taken when using environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids, such as a dehumidifier on the reservoir ventilation. Water content has an affect particularly in the case of HETG and partially saturated HEES in that it accelerates aging (hydrolysis) of the hydraulic fluid and biological degradation, see chapter 4.11 "Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration".

– Water content (Karl-Fischer method) – Particle measurement with evaluation according to ISO 4406 or mass of solid foreign substances with evaluation to EN 12662 – Element analysis (RFA (EDX) / ICP, specify test method)

3

– Comparison with new product or available trend analyses – Assessment / evaluation for further use – Also recommended: IR spectrum" Differences in the maintenance and upkeep of environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids with the corresponding suitability characteristics (as required in market overview RE 90221-01) in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP are not necessary. Attention is however drawn to the note in chapter 1.3. After changing over hydraulic fluids it is recommended that the filters be replaced again after 50 operating hours as fluid aging products may have detached themselves ("self-cleaning effect"). Compared to the pure unused hydraulic fluid the changed neutralization number NN (acid number AN) indicates how many aging products are contained in the hydraulic fluid. This difference must be kept as low as possible. As soon as the trend analysis notes a significant increase in the values, the lubricant manufacturer should be contacted. A higher viscosity than that of new materials indicates that the hydraulic fluid has aged. Evaluation by the test lab or lubricant manufacturers is however authoritative, whose recommendation should be urgently observed.

4


42 12/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

On systems where the possibility of water contamination cannot be completely ruled out (also condensation), it should be ensured via the hydraulic system circuit that fluid aging products are not accumulating in individual areas of the hydraulic system, but are being removed from the system in a controlled manner via the filtration system. This should be ensured via suitable hydraulic circuits (e.g. flushing circuit) or system manufacturer's operating instructions/specifications. In case of warranty, liability or guarantee claims to Bosch Rexroth, service verification and/or the results of fluid analyses are to be provided.

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

5 Disposal and environmental protection All environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids, are like mineral oil-based hydraulic fluids, subject to special disposal obligations. The respective lubricant manufacturers provide specifications on environmentally acceptable handling and storage. Please ensure that spilt or splashed fluids are absorbed with appropriate adsorbents or by a technique that prevents it contaminating water courses, the ground or sewerage systems. It is also not permitted to mix fluids when disposing of hydraulic fluids. Regulations governing the handing of used oils stipulate that used oils are not to mixed with other products, e.g. substances containing halogen. Non-compliance will increase disposal costs. Comply with the national legal provisions concerning the disposal of the corresponding hydraulic fluid. Comply with the local safety data sheet of the lubricant manufacturer for the country concerned.


43 RE 90221/05.12

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

Bosch Rexroth AG

13/14

6 Glossary Additivation Additives are chemical substances added to the basic fluids to achieve or improve specific properties. Aging Hydraulic fluids age due to oxidation (see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance"). Liquid and solid contamination acts as a catalyzer for aging, meaning that it needs to be minimized as far as possible by careful filtration. Please refer to Hydrolysis. Arrhenius equation The quantitative relation between reaction rate and temperature is described by an exponential function, the Arrhenius equation. This function is usually visualized within the typical temperature range of the hydraulic system. For a practical example, see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance�. Basic fluids In general, a hydraulic fluid is made up of a basic fluid, or base oil, and chemical substances, the so-called additives. The proportion of basic fluid is generally greater than 90%. Diesel effect If hydraulic fluid that contains air bubbles is compressed quickly, the bubbles are heated to such a degree that a selfignition of the air-gas mix may occur. The resultant temperature increase may lead to seal damage and increased aging of the hydraulic fluid. Saturated esters Esters differ by the number of C atoms (chain length) and position of the bonds between the C atoms. Saturated esters do not have double/multiple bonds between C atoms and are therefore more resistant to aging than partially saturated esters. Partially saturated esters In contrast to saturated esters, partially saturated esters have double/multiple bonds between C atoms. Rexroth defines partially saturated esters as unsaturated bonds and mixtures of esters with unsaturated and saturated bonds. Esters with unsaturated bonds are produced on the basis of renewable raw materials. Depending on their number and position, these unsaturated bonds between the C atoms are instable. These bonds can detach themselves and form new bonds, thus changing the properties of those liquids (an aging mechanism). One of the underlying requirements for inclusion in the market overview RE 90221-01 is an aging stability characteristic. Attention is however drawn to the note in chapter 1.3. Hydrolysis Hydrolysis is the splitting of a chemical bond through the reaction with water under the influence of temperature. ICP (atomic emission spectroscopy) The ICP procedure can be used to determine various wear metals, contamination types and additives. Practically all elements in the periodic system can be detected with this method..

Iodine count The iodine count is a yardstick for the quantity of single and multiple unsaturated bonds between C atoms in the basic fluid. A low iodine count indicates that the hydraulic fluid contains few unsaturated bonds and is thus considerably more resistant 1 to aging than a hydraulic fluid with a high iodine count. A statement about the position at which these multiple bonds are located and about how "stable" they are against influencing factors cannot be derived simply by stating the iodine count. Karl Fischer method Method to determine the water content in fluids. Indirect coulometric determination procedure in accordance with DIN EN ISO 12937 in connection with DIN 51777-2. Only the combination of both standards will assure adequately accurate measured values. For hydraulic fluids based on glycol, DIN EN ISO 12937 is to be applied in conjunction with DIN 51777-1. Cavitation Cavitation is the creation of cavities in fluids due to pressure reduction below the saturated vapour pressure and subsequent implosion when the pressure increases. When the cavities implode, extremely high acceleration, temperatures and pressure may occur temporarily, which may damage the component surfaces.

2

Neutralization number (NN) The neutralization number (NN) or acid number (AN) specifies the amount of caustic potash required to neutralize the acid contained in one gram of fluid. Pour point The lowest temperature at which the fluid still just flows when cooled down under set conditions. The pour point is specified in the lubricant manufacturers' technical data sheets as a reference value for achieving this flow limit. RFA (wavelength dispersive x-ray fluorescence analysis) Is a procedure to determine nearly all elements in liquid and solid samples with nearly any composition. This analysis method is suitable for examining additives and contamination, delivering fast results.

3

Shearing/shear loss Shearing of molecule chains during operation can change the viscosity of hydraulic fluids with long chain VI enhancers. The initially high viscosity index drops. This needs to be taken into account when selecting the hydraulic fluid. The only value at present that can be used to assess viscosity changes in operation is the result of the test in accordance with DIN 51350 part -6. Please note that there are practical applications that create a much higher shear load on such hydraulic fluids than can be achieved by this test. Stick-slip Interaction between a resilient mass system involving friction (such as cylinder + oil column + load) and the pressure increase at very low sliding speeds. The static friction of the system is a decisive value here. The lower it is, the lower the speed that can still be maintained without sticking. Depending on the tribologic system, the stick-slip effect may lead to vibrations generated and sometimes also to significant noise emission. In many cases, the effect can be attenuated by replacing the lubricant.

4


44 14/14

Bosch Rexroth AG

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

RE 90221/05.12

Viscosity Viscosity is the measure of the internal friction of a fluid to flow. It is defined as the property of a substance to flow under tension. Viscosity is the most important characteristic for describing the load-bearing capacity of a hydraulic fluid. Kinematic viscosity is the ratio of the dynamic viscosity and the density of the fluid; the unit is mm²/s. Hydraulic fluids are classified by their kinematic viscosity into ISO viscosity classes. The reference temperature for this is 40 °C. Viscosity index (VI) Refers to the viscosity temperature behavior of a fluid. The lower the change of viscosity in relation the temperature, the higher the VI.

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Zum Eisengießer 1 97816 Lohr am Main, Germany Phone +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-0 Fax +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-23 58 documentation@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.de

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. No statements concerning the suitability of a hydraulic fluid for a specific purpose can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


45

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids (HFDR/HFDU)

RE 90222/05.12 1/16

Application notes and requirements for Rexroth hydraulic components

Hydraulic fluids

Title

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-containing hydraulic fluids

Standard

DIN 51524

ISO 15380

ISO 12922

ISO 12922

Data sheets

RE 90220

RE 90221

RE 90222

RE 90223 (in preparation)

Classification

HL HLP HLPD HVLP HLPD and more

HEPG HEES partially saturated HEES saturated HEPR HETG

HFDR HFDU (ester base) HFDU (glycol base) and more

HFC HFB HFAE HFAS


46 2/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

Contents 1 Basic information .................................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.1 General instructions ...................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.2 Fire resistance ............................................................................................................................................................................................3 1.3 Scope ...........................................................................................................................................................................................................4 1.4 Safety instructions .....................................................................................................................................................................................4 2 Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels .....................................................................................................................................5 3 Selection of the hydraulic fluid ..........................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1 Selection criteria for the hydraulic fluid .................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.1 Viscosity .................................................................................................................................................................................................6 3.1.2 Viscosity-temperature behavior........................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.3 Wear protection capability ................................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.4 Material compatibility..........................................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.5 Aging resistance .................................................................................................................................................................................7 3.1.6 Environmentally acceptable ..............................................................................................................................................................8 3.1.7 Air separation ability (ASA) ...............................................................................................................................................................8 3.1.8 Demulsifying ability and water solubility ........................................................................................................................................8 3.1.9 Filterability .............................................................................................................................................................................................8 3.1.10 Corrosion protection ........................................................................................................................................................................8 3.1.11 Additivation .........................................................................................................................................................................................8 3.2 Classification and fields of application ................................................................................................................................................9 4 Hydraulic fluids in operation ...........................................................................................................................................................................11 4.1 General .......................................................................................................................................................................................................11 4.2 Storage and handling .............................................................................................................................................................................11 4.3 Filling of new systems.............................................................................................................................................................................11 4.4 Hydraulic fluid changeover ....................................................................................................................................................................11 4.5 Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids .......................................................................................................................11 4.6 Re-additivation..........................................................................................................................................................................................11 4.7 Foaming behavior .....................................................................................................................................................................................11 4.8 Corrosion ...................................................................................................................................................................................................12 4.9 Air ................................................................................................................................................................................................................12 4.10 Water ........................................................................................................................................................................................................12 4.11 Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration .......................................................................................................................................12 5 Disposal and environmental protection ........................................................................................................................................................13 6 Glossary ...............................................................................................................................................................................................................14


47 RE 90222/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

3/16

1 Basic information 1.1 General instructions

1.2 Fire resistance

The hydraulic fluid is the common element in any hydraulic component and must be selected very carefully. Quality and cleanliness of the hydraulic fluid are decisive factors for the operational reliability, efficiency and service life of a system.

There is no clear legal definition of fire-resistant hydraulic fluids. There are great differences regarding fire resistance. The selection is the sole responsibility of the system operator with respect to requirements (application, construction and design 1 of the system, hottest source in the system, necessary fire protection).

Hydraulic fluids must conform, be selected and used in accordance with the generally acknowledged rules of technology and safety provisions. Reference is made to the countryspecific standards and directives (in Germany the directive of the Employer's Liability Insurance Association BGR 137). This data sheet includes recommendations and regulations concerning the selection, operation and disposal of fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids in the application of Rexroth hydraulic components. The individual selection of hydraulic fluid or the choice of classification are the responsibility of the operator. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure that appropriate measures are taken for safety and health protection and to ensure compliance with statutory regulations. The recommendations of the lubricant manufacturer and the specifications given in the safety data sheet are to be observed when using hydraulic fluid. This data sheet does not absolve the operator from verifying the conformity and suitability of the respective hydraulic fluid for his system. He is to ensure that the selected fluid meets the minimum requirements of the relevant hydraulic fluid standard during the whole of the period of use. The currently valid standard for fire-resistant hydraulic fluids is the ISO 12922. In addition, other, more detailed documents, guidelines, specifications and legislation may also be valid. The operator is responsible for ensuring that such regulations are observed, for example: – 7th Luxembourg Report: Luxembourg, April 1994, Doc. No. 4746/10/91 EN "Requirements and tests applicable to fire-resistant hydraulic fluids for hydrostatic and hydrokinetic power transmission and control" – VDMA 24314 (1981-11): "Changing hydraulic fluids – guidelines" – VDMA 24317 (2005-11): "Fire-resistant hydraulic fluids – minimum technical requirements" – FM Approval Standard 6930 (2009-04): "Flammability Classification of Industrial Fluids" (only available in English) – DIN Technical Report CEN/TR 14489 (2006-01): "Selection guidelines for protecting safety, health and the environment" We recommend that you maintain constant, close contact with lubricant manufacturers to support you in the selection, maintenance, care and analyses. When disposing of used hydraulic fluids, apply the same care as during use.

Different test procedures are applied for evaluating fire resistance. Fire resistance test procedure according to ISO 12922: – Ignition properties of spray according to ISO 15029-1 (Spray flame persistence – hollow-cone nozzle method) – Ignition properties of spray according to ISO 15029-2 (Stabilized flame heat release) – Wick flame persistence of fluids according to ISO 14935 (average flame persistence) – Determination of the flammability characteristics of fluids in contact with hot surfaces, ignition process according to ISO 20823 (ignition temperature, flame spread)

2

In general, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids are distinguished between water-containing fire-resistant and water-free fire-resistant hydraulic fluids. Water-containing fire-resistant hydraulic fluids are described in RE 90223. Water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluid means hydraulic fluids with a water-proportion of 0.1% by volume ("Karl Fischer method", see chapter 6 "Glossary"), measured at the time of filling in the transport container. In Europe water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids are not approved for use in underground coal mining. The classification 3 HFDU is no longer included in the VDMA 24317: 2005. Note In contrast to water-containing fluids, all water-free, fireresistant hydraulic fluids have a flash point and a fire point. Specific parameters for flash point and fire point can be found in the technical and/or safety data sheet for the hydraulic fluid concerned. Just as much care should be taken when working with fireresistant hydraulic fluids are with other hydraulic fluids, e.g. mineral oils. A leak from the hydraulic system must be avoided. The best and most cost-effective protection against fire and explosion is to prevent leakage with meticulous service, maintenance and care of the hydraulic system. 4


48 4/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

1.3 Scope

1.4 Safety instructions

This data sheet must be applied when using water-free, fireresistant hydraulic fluids with Rexroth hydraulic components. The specifications of this data sheet may be further restricted by the specifications given in data sheets for the individual components concerned.

Hydraulic fluids can constitute a risk for persons and the environment. These risks are described in the hydraulic fluid safety data sheets. The operator is to ensure that a current safety data sheet for the hydraulic fluid used is available and that the measures stipulated therein are complied with.

The use of the individual water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids in accordance with the intended purpose can be found in the safety data sheets or other product description documents of the lubricant manufacturers. In addition, each use is to be individually considered. Rexroth hydraulic components may only be operated with water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids according to ISO 12922 if specified in the respective component data sheet or if a Rexroth approval for use is furnished. The manufacturers of hydraulic systems must adjust their systems and operating instructions to the water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids. Bosch Rexroth will accept no liability for its components for any damage resulting from failure to comply with the notes below.


49 RE 90222/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

5/16

2 Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels Solid particle contamination is the major reason for faults occurring in hydraulic systems. It may lead to a number of effects in the hydraulic system. Firstly, single large solid particles may lead directly to a system malfunction, and secondly small particles cause continuous elevated wear. For mineral oils, the cleanliness level of water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids is given as a three-digit numerical code in accordance with ISO 4406. This numerical code denotes the number of particles present in a hydraulic fluid for a defined quantity. Moreover, foreign solid matter is not to exceed a mass of 50 mg/kg (gravimetric examination according to ISO 4405). In general, compliance with a minimum cleanliness level of 20/18/15 in accordance with ISO 4406 or better is to be maintained in operation. Special servo valves demand improved cleanliness levels of at least 18/16/13. A reduction in cleanliness level by one level means half of the quantity of particles and thus greater cleanliness. Lower numbers in cleanliness levels should always be striven for and extend the service life of hydraulic components. The component with the highest cleanliness requirements determines the required cleanliness of the overall system. Please also observe the specifications in table 1: "Cleanliness levels according to ISO 4406" and in the respective data sheets of the various hydraulic components.

Hydraulic fluids frequently fail to meet these cleanliness requirements on delivery. Careful filtering is therefore required during operation and in particular, during filling in order to ensure the required cleanliness levels. Your lubricant manufacturer can tell you the cleanliness level of hydraulic fluids as delivered. To maintain the required cleanliness level over the operating period, you must use a reservoir breather filter. If the environment is humid, take appropriate measures, such as a breather filter with air drying or permanent off-line water separation.

1

Note: the specifications of the lubricant manufacturer relating to cleanliness levels are based on the time at which the container concerned is filled and not on the conditions during transport and storage. Further information about contamination with solid matter and cleanliness levels can be found in brochure RE 08016.

2

Table 1: Cleanliness levels according to ISO 4406 Particles per 100 ml More than

Up to and including

Scale number

8,000,000

16,000,000

24

4,000,000

8,000,000

23

2,000,000

4,000,000

22

1,000,000

2,000,000

21

500,000

1,000,000

20

250,000

500,000

19

130,000

250,000

18

64000

130,000

17

32000

64000

16

16000

32000

15

8000

16000

14

4000

8000

13

2000

4000

12

1000

2000

11

500

1000

10

250

500

9

130

250

8

64

130

7

32

64

6

20 / 18 / 15 > 4 μm > 6 μm > 14 μm

3

4


50 6/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

3 Selection of the hydraulic fluid Water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids for Bosch Rexroth hydraulic components are assessed on the basis of their fulfillment of the minimum requirements of ISO 12922.

3.1 Selection criteria for the hydraulic fluid The specified limit values for all components employed in the hydraulic system, for example viscosity and cleanliness level, must be observed with the hydraulic fluid used, taking into account the specified operating conditions.

We recommend that the optimum operating viscosity range of each component be kept within the permissible temperature range. This usually requires either cooling or heating, or both. The permissible viscosity range and the necessary cleanliness level can be found in the product data sheet for the component concerned. If the viscosity of a hydraulic fluid used is above the permitted operating viscosity, this will result in increased hydraulic-mechanical losses. In return, there will be lower internal leakage losses. If the pressure level is lower, lubrication gaps may not be filled up, which can lead to increased wear. For hydraulic pumps, the permitted suction pressure may not be reached, which may lead to cavitation damage.

Hydraulic fluid suitability depends, amongst others, on the following factors: 3.1.1 Viscosity Viscosity is a basic property of hydraulic fluids. The permissible viscosity range of complete systems needs to be determined taking account of the permissible viscosity of all components and it is to be observed for each individual component. The viscosity at operating temperature determines the response characteristics of closed control loops, stability and damping of systems, the efficiency factor and the degree of wear.

If the viscosity of a hydraulic fluid is below the permitted operating viscosity, increased leakage, wear, susceptibility to contamination and a shorter component life cycle will result. Please ensure that the permissible temperature and viscosity limits are observed for the respective components. This usually requires either cooling or heating, or both.

Fig. 1: Examples V-T diagrams for water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids in comparison to HLP and HFC (reference values, double-logarithmic representation)

40q 1600 1000 600 400

20q

0q

20q

40q

60q

80q 100q

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

200 100 60 40 20 HFC

10

HFDU HLP46

5 40q 25q 10q 0q 10q

30q

50q

70q

90q

115q

HFDR

Temperature t [째C]

Typical viscosity data [mm2/s] at temperature

0 째C

40 째C

100 째C

HFDR

2500

43

5,3

HFDU (ester base)

330

46

9,2

HFDU (glycol base)

350

46

8,7

For comparison HLP (see RE 90220)

610

46

7

For comparison HFC (see RE 90223)

280

46

Detailed V-T diagrams may be obtained from your lubricant manufacturer for their specific products. Descriptions of the individual classifications can be found in chapter 3.2 and in Table 4.


51 RE 90222/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

3.1.2 Viscosity-temperature behavior For hydraulic fluids, the viscosity temperature behavior (V-T behavior) is of particular importance. Viscosity is characterized in that it drops when the temperature increases and rises when the temperature drops. The interrelation between viscosity and temperature is described by the viscosity index (VI). For cold testing over a period of several days, the viscosity of ester-based HFDU can increase greatly. After heating, the characteristic values as specified on the data sheet are restored. Please ask your lubricant manufacturer for the "Flow capacity after seven days at low temperature" (ASTM D 2532) for the fluid classification ester-based HFDU .

Table 2: Known material incompatibilities Classification Incompatible with: HFD in general

HFDR

Individual component color coating, lead, galvanic zinc-plating, in part non-ferrous metals with zinc, tin and aluminum in a tribological system. Sealing elements made of NBR. In some cases, the latter show major increases in volume when impermissibly aged hydraulic fluids come into contact with the material. Do not use any hydrolysis/susceptible polyurethane qualities.

HFDU based on ester

Single-component color coatings, lead, galvanized zinc coatings, in part non-ferrous metals with zinc, tin, seals made of NBR. In some cases, the latter show major increases in volume when impermissibly aged hydraulic fluids come into contact with the material. Do not use any hydrolysis/susceptible polyurethane qualities.

HFDU based on glycol

Single-component color coatings, steel/aluminum tribocontacts, paper filters, polymethylmethacrylate (PMMA). The compatibility of NBR is to be examined for individual case.

3.1.3 Wear protection capability Wear protection capability describes the property of hydraulic fluids to prevent or minimize wear within the components. The wear protection capability is described in ISO 12922 via test procedures"FZG gear test rig" (ISO 14635-1) and "Mechanical test in the vane pump" (ISO 20763). The wear protection capability of water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids in relation to the two test procedures is comparable to that of mineral oil HLP/HVLP. 3.1.4 Material compatibility The hydraulic fluid must not negatively affect the materials used in the components. Compatibility with coatings, seals, hoses, metals and plastics is to be observed in particular. The fluid classifications specified in the respective component data sheets are tested by the manufacturer with regard to material compatibility. Parts and components not supplied by us are to be checked by the user.

Seals, plastics and coatings of control cabinets, outer coatings of hydraulic components and accessory components (connectors, wiring harnesses, control cabinets) are to be tested for stability.

1

Note: hydraulic fluid vapors can also lead to incompatibility!

HFDU fluid based on ester and glycol have better viscosity/ temperature characteristics than mineral oil HLP (see Fig. 1). This should be taken into consideration when selecting hydraulic fluid for the required temperature range. The viscosity and temperature limits required in the product data sheets are to be observed in all operating conditions. Note For ambient temperatures below 0 °C, fire-resistant, watercontaining hydraulic fluids of classification HFC are to be preferred because they observe the component-related viscosity ranges and because the have better pour points (see RE 90223).

7/16

The material incompatibilities mentioned here do not automatically result in function problems. However the elements of the materials are found in the hydraulic fluids after use. The material incompatibilities described here may lead to accelerated aging of the hydraulic fluid and to reduced fire resistance.

2

3

3.1.5 Aging resistance The way a water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluid ages depends on the thermal, chemical and mechanical stress to which it is subjected. The influence of water, air, temperature and contamination may be significantly greater than for mineral oils HLP/HVLP. Aging resistance can be greatly influenced by the chemical composition of the hydraulic fluids. High fluid temperatures (e.g. over 80 °C) result in a approximate halving of the fluid service life for every 10 °C temperature 4 increase and should therefore by avoided. The halving of the fluid service life results from the application of the Arrhenius equation (see Glossary). Table 3: Reference values for temperature-dependent aging of the hydraulic fluid Reservoir temperature

Fluid life cycle

80 °C

100 %

90 °C

50 %

100 °C

25 %


52 8/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

A modified aging test (ISO 4263-3 or ASTM D943 – without the addition of water) is specified for fluid classification HFDU. Fluid classification HFDR is described with a special procedure with respect to oxidation stability (EN 14832) and oxidation service life (ISO 4263-3). The calculated fluid service life is derived from the results of tests in which the long-term characteristics are simulated in a short period of time by applying more arduous conditions (condensed testing). This calculated fluid service life is not to be equated to the fluid service life in real-life applications. Table 3 is a practical indicator for hydraulic fluids with water content < 0.1%, cf. chapter 4.10. "Water". 3.1.6 Environmentally acceptable HFDU fluids based on ester and glycol are hydraulic fluids which may also be classified as environmentally acceptable. The main criteria for fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids are the leak-free, technically problem-free use and the necessary fire resistance. Environmentally acceptable is merely a supplementary criterion. Notes on environmentally compatible hydraulic fluids can be found in RE 90221. 3.1.7 Air separation ability (ASA) The air separation ability (ASA) describes the property of a hydraulic fluid to separate undissolved air. Hydraulic fluids always contain dissolved air. During operation, dissolved air may be transformed into undissolved air, leading to cavitation damages. Fluid classification, fluid product, reservoir size and design must be coordinated to take into account the dwell time and ASA value of the hydraulic fluid. The air separation capacity depends on the viscosity, temperature, basic fluid and aging. It cannot be improved by additives. According to ISO 12922 for instance, an ASA value d 15 minutes is required for viscosity class ISO VG 46, practical values on delivery are < 10 minutes, lower values are preferable. 3.1.8 Demulsifying ability and water solubility The capacity of a hydraulic fluid to separate water at a defined temperature is known as the demulsifying ability. ISO 6614 defines the demulsifying properties of hydraulic fluids. The fluid classifications HFDU based on ester and HFDR separate water, but HFD hydraulic fluids have a different water separation ability to mineral oil HLP/HVLP. At 20 °C, in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP, a multiple (> factor 3) of water can separate in the hydraulic fluid. Water solubility is also more temperature-dependent than for mineral oils. The fluid classification HFDU based on glycol usually dissolves water completely, see chapter "4.10 Water".

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

3.1.9 Filterability Filterability describes the ability of a hydraulic fluid to pass through a filter, removing solid contaminants. The hydraulic fluids used require a good filterability, not just when new, but also during the whole of their service life. This can differ greatly depending on the different basic fluids (glycols, esters) and additives (VI enhancers, anti-fogging additives). The filterability is a basic prerequisite for cleanliness, servicing and filtration of hydraulic fluids. Rexroth therefore requires the same degree of filterability of water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids as for mineral oils HLP/HVLP to DIN 51524. As ISO 12922 does not comment on the filterability of hydraulic fluids, filterability comparable to that of mineral oils HLP/ HVLP must be requested of lubricant manufacturers. Filterability is tested with the new hydraulic fluid and after the addition of 0.2 % water. The underlying standard (ISO 133571/-2) stipulates that filterability must have no negative effects on the filters or the hydraulic fluid, see chapter 4 "Hydraulic fluids in operation". 3.1.10 Corrosion protection Hydraulic fluids should not just prevent corrosion formation on steel components, they must also be compatible with non-ferrous metals and alloys. Corrosion protection tests on different metals and metal alloys are described in ISO 12922. Rexroth components are usually tested with HLP hydraulic fluids or corrosion protection oils based on mineral oils before they are delivered. 3.1.11 Additivation The properties described above can be modified with the help of suitable additives. Bosch Rexroth does not prescribe any specific additive system.


53 RE 90222/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

9/16

3.2 Classification and fields of application Table 4: Classification and fields of application Classification

Features

HFDU (glycol-based) according to ISO 12922

Base fluid: Glycols

Typical field of application

Notes

1

Mobile systems with For information on approved components, please refer to the high thermal loading respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner.

Density at 15 °C: typically > 0.97 kg/dm³

– Very good viscosity/temperature characteristics, shear stability – Resistant to aging

VI: typical > 170

– Can be water-soluble – Can be mixed with water

The classification "HFDU" is no longer listed in the current standard sheet VDMA 24317.

– Very good wear protection properties – A higher implementation temperature with the same viscosity in comparison to mineral oil is to be expected

2

– Due to the higher density in comparison to HLP, lower suction pressures are to be anticipated for pumps. Reduce the maximum speed as required and optimize suction conditions. – Prior to commissioning, contact the lubricant manufacturer, as the components are tested with mineral oil HLP/corrosion protection oil. – Incompatible with mineral oil (exceptions must be confirmed by the lubricant manufacturer).

HFDU (ester-based) Base fluid: according to Ester based on ISO 12922 regenerative raw materials, synthetic Density at 15 °C: ester and mixtures typically 0.90-0.93 of different esters kg/dm³ Because of the fire VI: typical > 160 resistance, HFDU Iodine count < 90 hydraulic fluids based on ester are usually partially The classification saturated esters "HFDU" is no longer listed in the current standard sheet VDMA 24317.

Suitable for most fields of application and components.

For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner.

3

– Preferred use of FKM seals. Please enquire about shaft seal rings and implementation temperatures under –15 °C. – Note shear stability (see chapter 4.11 "Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration" and chapter 6 "Glossary") – Fire resistance is not stable over time – In operation, a higher temperature in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP is to be expected given identical design and viscosity. Please check ATEX approvals for hydraulic components. – Limit the lower (see chapter 3.1.2) and upper implementation temperatures (see chapter 3.1.5) – Good viscosity-temperature behavior – Usually classified as insignificantly water-endangering (water hazard class WGK 1) – High dirt dissolving capacity on fluid changeovers – In unfavorable operating conditions (high water content, high temperature), HFDU on ester basis have a tendency to hydrolysis. The acidic organic decomposition products can chemically attack materials and components.

4


54 10/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

Classification

Features

Typical field of application

HFDR according to ISO 12922

Base fluid: phosphoric acid ester

Turbine control systems

Density at 15 °C: typically 1.1 kg/dm³

RE 90222/05.12

Notes For information on approved components, please refer to the respective product data sheet. For components which have not been approved according to the product data sheet, please consult your Bosch Rexroth sales partner. – Classified as hazardous materials (for transportation and storage)

VI : typical 140–160

– Hazardous working material – Water-endangering (Water hazard class 2 – WGK2) – Develops toxic vapors in case of fire – Preferred use of FKM, and possibly PTFE seals. Please enquire for shaft seal rings and implementation temperatures under –15 °C. – In operation, a higher temperature in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP is to be expected given identical design and viscosity – Phosphoric acid esters display a tendency to hydrolysis when they come into contact with moisture. Under the influence of water/moisture, they become unstable or form highly aggressive, acidic components which could damage the hydraulic fluid and component beyond repair. – Poor viscosity/temperature characteristics – Due to the higher density in comparison to HLP, lower suction pressures are to be anticipated for pumps. Reduce the maximum speed as required and optimize suction conditions. – In unfavorable operating conditions (high water content, high temperature), HFDR have a tendency to hydrolysis. The acidic inorganic decomposition products chemically attack materials and components. HFDU (continued)

Based on triglycer- Not recommended ides, mineral oils or for Rexroth comporelated hydrocarbons nents!

Hydraulic fluids based on polyalphaolefines are not recommended on account of their poor fire resistance. This classification can usually be identified from: density < 0.89; VI < 140 to 160 Hydraulic fluids based on triglycerides are not recommended on account of their aging resistance. This classification can usually be identified from: density > 0.92; VI > 190; iodine count > 90 Consult your lubricant manufacturer or your Bosch Rexroth sales partner if the classification of a hydraulic fluid is not clear.

HFDS HFDT

Based on halogeNot approved for nated hydrocarbons Rexroth compoor mixtures with nents! halogenated hydrocarbons

HFDS and HFDT have not been permitted to be manufactured or used since 1989 for environmental reasons.


55 RE 90222/05.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

11/16

4 Hydraulic fluids in operation 4.1 General The properties of hydraulic fluids can change continually during storage and operation. Please note that the fluid standard ISO 12922 merely describes minimum requirements for hydraulic fluids in new condition at the time of filling into the bins. The operator of a hydraulic system must ensure that the hydraulic fluid remains in a utilizable condition throughout its entire period of use. Deviations from the characteristic values are to be clarified with the lubricant manufacturer, the test labs or Bosch Rexroth. Bosch Rexroth will accept no liability for damage to its components within the framework of the applicable liability legislation insofar as the latter is due to non-observance of the following instructions. Please note the following aspects in operation.

4.2 Storage and handling Hydraulic fluids must be stored correctly in accordance with the instructions of the lubricant manufacturer. Avoid exposing the containers to lengthy periods of direct heat. Containers are to be stored in such a way that the risk of any foreign liquid or solid matter (e.g. water, foreign fluids or dust) ingression into the inside of the container can be ruled out. After taking hydraulic fluids from the containers, these are immediately to be properly resealed. Recommendation: – Store containers in a dry, roofed place – Store barrels on their sides – Clean reservoir systems and machine reservoirs regularly

4.3 Filling of new systems Usually, the cleanliness levels of the hydraulic fluids as delivered do not meet the requirements of our components. Hydraulic fluids must be filtered using an appropriate filter system to minimize solid particle contamination and water in the system. As early as possible during test operation, new systems should be filled with the selected hydraulic fluid so as to reduce the risk of accidentally mixing fluids (see chapter 4.5 "Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids"). Changing the hydraulic medium at a later point represents significant additional costs (see following chapter).

manufacturer or supplier of the new hydraulic fluid. The quantity of old fluid remaining should be minimized. Mixing hydraulic fluids should be avoided, see following chapter. Information about changing to a hydraulic fluid of a different classification can be found, for example, in VDMA 24314 and in ISO 7745. In addition, the information given in chapter 3.1.4 "Material compatibility" is also to be observed. Bosch Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from inadequate hydraulic fluid changeovers!

4.5 Mixing and compatibility of different hydraulic fluids If hydraulic fluids from different manufacturers or different types from the same manufacturer are mixed, gelling, silting and deposits may occur. These, in turn, may cause foaming, impaired air separation ability, malfunctions and damage to the hydraulic system. If the fluid contains more than 2 % of another fluid then it is considered to be a mixture. Exceptions apply for water, see chapter 4.10 "Water".

Problems may be encountered in particular when changing over from water-containing, fire-resistant hydraulic fluid or mineral oils to water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids (e.g. incompatibilities in the form of gelling, silting, stable foam, reduced filterability or filter blockage). This may also happen when changing products within the same classification. In the case of changeovers of the fluid in hydraulic systems, it is important to ensure compatibility of the new hydraulic fluid with the remains of the previous hydraulic fluid. Bosch Rexroth recommends obtaining verification of compatibility from the

2

Mixing with other hydraulic fluids is not generally permitted. This includes hydraulic fluids with the same classification. If individual lubricant manufacturers advertise miscibility and/or compatibility, this is entirely the responsibility of the lubricant manufacturer. Bosch Rexroth customarily tests all components with mineral oil HLP before they are delivered. Note: With connectible accessory units and mobile filtering systems, there is a considerable risk of non-permitted mixing of the hydraulic fluids! Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from mixing hydraulic fluids!

3

4.6 Re-additivation Additives added at a later point in time such as colors, wear reducers, VI enhancers or anti-foam additives, may negatively affect the performance properties of the hydraulic fluid and the compatibility with our components and therefore are not permissible. Rexroth will not accept liability for any damage to its components resulting from re-additivation!

4.7 Foaming behavior 4.4 Hydraulic fluid changeover

1

Foam is created by rising air bubbles at the surface of hydraulic fluids in the reservoir. Foam that develops should collapse as quickly as possible. Common hydraulic fluids in accordance with ISO 12922 are sufficiently inhibited against foam formation in new condition. On account of aging and adsorption onto surfaces, the defoamer concentration may decrease over time, leading to a stable foam. Defoamers may be re-dosed only after consultation with the lubricant manufacturer and with his written approval. Defoamers may affect the air separation ability.

4


56 12/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

4.8 Corrosion The hydraulic fluid is to guarantee sufficient corrosion protection of components under all operating conditions, even in the event of impermissible water contamination. Water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids are tested for corrosion protection in the same way as mineral oil HLP/HVLP. When used in practice other corrosion mechanisms are revealed in detail and in individual cases, for the most part in contact with non-ferrous and white alloys.

4.9 Air Under atmospheric conditions the hydraulic fluid contains dissolved air. In the negative pressure range, for instance in the suction pipe of the pump or downstream of control edges, this dissolved air may transform into undissolved air. The undissolved air content represents a risk of cavitation and of the diesel effect. This results in material erosion of components and increased hydraulic fluid aging. With the correct measures, such as suction pipe and reservoir design, and an appropriate hydraulic fluid, air intake and separation can be positively influenced. See also chapter 3.1.7 "Air separation ability (ASA)”.

4.10 Water Water contamination in hydraulic fluids can result from direct ingress or indirectly through condensation of water from the air due to temperature variations.

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

Water content has an affect particularly in the case of HEDU hydraulic fluid on ester basis and HFDR in that it accelerates aging (hydrolysis) of the hydraulic fluid and biological degradation, see chapter 4.11 "Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration".

4.11 Fluid servicing, fluid analysis and filtration Air, water, operating temperature influences and solid matter contamination will change the performance characteristics of hydraulic fluids and cause them to age. To preserve the usage properties and ensure a long service life for hydraulic fluid and components, the monitoring of the fluid condition and a filtration adapted to the application requirements (draining and degassing if required) are indispensable. The effort is higher in the case of unfavorable usage conditions, increased stress for the hydraulic system or high expectations as to availability and service life, see chapter 2 "Solid particle contamination and cleanliness levels". When commissioning a system, please note that the required minimum cleanliness level can frequently be attained only by flushing the system. Due to severe start-up contamination, it may be possible that a fluid and/or filter replacement becomes necessary after a short operating period (< 50 operating hours). The hydraulic fluid must be replaced at regular intervals and tested by the lubricant manufacturer or recognized accredited test labs. We recommend a reference analysis after commissioning.

HFDU hydraulic fluids on glycol basis are water-soluble or can be mixed with water. This means that any water that has ingressed into the system cannot be drained off in the sump of the reservoir.

The minimum data to be tested for analyses are:

In the case of HDFU hydraulic fluids on ester basis, undissolved water can be drained off from the reservoir sump, the remaining water content is however too high to ensure that the maximum permissible water limit values are observed in the long term.

– Water content (Karl-Fischer method)

With the fluid classification HFDR, the greater density of the ester means that the any water that has ingressed will be on the surface of the hydraulic fluid. This means that any water that has ingressed into the system cannot be drained off in the sump of the reservoir. Water in the hydraulic fluid can result in wear or direct failure of hydraulic components. Furthermore, a high water content in the hydraulic fluid negatively affects aging and filterability and increases susceptibility to cavitation. During operation, the water content in all hydraulic fluids, determined according to the "Karl Fischer method" (see chapter 6 "Glossary") for all water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids must constantly be kept below 0.1% (1000 ppm). To ensure a long service life of both hydraulic fluids and components, Bosch Rexroth recommends that values below 0.05% (500 ppm) are permanently maintained. Due to the higher water solubility in comparison to mineral oil HLP/HVLP it is urgently advised that precautions be taken when using water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids, such as a dehumidifier on the reservoir ventilation.

– Viscosity at 40 °C and 100 °C – Neutralization number NN (acid number AN)

– Particle measurement with evaluation according to ISO 4406 or mass of solid foreign substances with evaluation to EN 12662 – Element analysis (RFA (EDX) / ICP, specify test method) – Comparison with new product or available trend analyses – Assessment / evaluation for further use – Also recommended: IR spectrum No differences are needed in the maintenance and care of water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids with the appropriate suitability parameters compared to HLP/HVLP mineral oils. Attention is however drawn to the note in chapter 1.3. After changing over hydraulic fluids it is recommended that the filters be replaced again after 50 operating hours as fluid aging products may have detached themselves ("self-cleaning effect"). Compared to the pure unused hydraulic fluid the changed neutralization number NN (acid number AN) indicates how many aging products are contained in the hydraulic fluid. This difference must be kept as small as possible. The lubricant manufacturer should be contacted as soon as the trend analysis notes a significant increase in values.


57 RE 90222/05.12

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

A higher viscosity than that of new materials indicates that the hydraulic fluid has aged. Evaluation by the test lab or lubricant manufacturers is however authoritative, whose recommendation should be urgently observed. On systems where the possibility of water contamination cannot be completely ruled out (also condensation), it should be ensured via the hydraulic system circuit that fluid aging products are not accumulating in individual areas of the hydraulic system, but are being removed from the system in a controlled manner via the filtration system. This should be ensured via suitable hydraulic circuits (e.g. flushing circuit) or system manufacturer's operating instructions/specifications. In case of warranty, liability or guarantee claims to Bosch Rexroth, service verification and/or the results of fluid analyses are to be provided.

Bosch Rexroth AG

13/16

5 Disposal and environmental protection All water-free, fire-resistant hydraulic fluids, are, like mineral oilbased hydraulic fluids, subject to special disposal obligations. The respective lubricant manufacturers provide specifications 1 on environmentally acceptable handling and storage. Please ensure that spilt or splashed fluids are absorbed with appropriate adsorbents or by a technique that prevents it contaminating water courses, the ground or sewerage systems. It is also not permitted to mix fluids when disposing of hydraulic fluids. Regulations governing the handing of used oils stipulate that used oils are not to mixed with other products, e.g. substances containing halogen. Non-compliance will increase disposal costs. Comply with the national legal provisions concerning the disposal of the corresponding hydraulic fluid. Comply with the local safety data sheet of the lubricant manufacturer for the country concerned.

2

3

4


58 14/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

6 Glossary Additivation Additives are chemical substances added to the basic fluids to achieve or improve specific properties. Aging Hydraulic fluids age due to oxidation (see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance"). Liquid and solid contamination acts as a catalyzer for aging, meaning that it needs to be minimized as far as possible by careful filtration. Please refer to Hydrolysis.

Karl Fischer method Method to determine the water content in fluids. Indirect coulometric determination procedure in accordance with DIN EN ISO 12937 in connection with DIN 51777-2. Only the combination of both standards will assure adequately accurate measured values. For hydraulic fluids based on glycol, DIN EN ISO 12937 is to be applied in conjunction with DIN 51777-1.

Arrhenius equation The quantitative relation between reaction rate and temperature is described by an exponential function, the Arrhenius equation. This function is usually visualized within the typical temperature range of the hydraulic system. For a practical example, see chapter 3.1.5 "Aging resistance�.

Cavitation Cavitation is the creation of cavities in fluids due to pressure reduction below the saturated vapour pressure and subsequent implosion when the pressure increases. When the cavities implode, extremely high acceleration, temperatures and pressure may occur temporarily, which may damage the component surfaces.

Basic fluids In general, a hydraulic fluid is made up of a basic fluid, or base oil, and chemical substances, the so-called additives. The proportion of basic fluid is generally greater than 90%.

Neutralization number (NN) The neutralization number (NN) or acid number (AN) specifies the amount of caustic potash required to neutralize the acid contained in one gram of fluid.

Diesel effect

Pour point The lowest temperature at which the fluid still just flows when cooled down under set conditions. The pour point is specified in the lubricant manufacturers' technical data sheets as a reference value for achieving this flow limit.

If hydraulic fluid that contains air bubbles is compressed quickly, the bubbles are heated to such a degree that a selfignition of the air-gas mix may occur. The resultant temperature increase may lead to seal damage and increased aging of the hydraulic fluid. Partially saturated esters In contrast to saturated esters, partially saturated esters have double/multiple bonds between C atoms. Rexroth defines partially saturated esters as unsaturated bonds and mixtures of esters with unsaturated and saturated bonds. Esters with unsaturated bonds are produced on the basis of renewable raw materials. Depending on their number and position, these unsaturated bonds between the C atoms are instable. These bonds can detach themselves and form new bonds, thus changing the properties of those liquids (an aging mechanism). Attention is however drawn to the note in chapter 1.3. Hydrolysis Hydrolysis is the splitting of a chemical bond through the reaction with water under the influence of temperature. ICP (atomic emission spectroscopy) The ICP procedure can be used to determine various wear metals, contamination types and additives. Practically all elements in the periodic system can be detected with this method. Iodine count The iodine count is a yardstick for the quantity of single and multiple unsaturated bonds between C atoms in the basic fluid. A low iodine count indicates that the hydraulic fluid contains few unsaturated bonds and is thus considerably more resistant to aging than a hydraulic fluid with a high iodine count. A statement about the position at which these multiple bonds are located and about how "stable" they are against influencing factors cannot be derived simply by stating the iodine count.

RFA (wavelength dispersive x-ray fluorescence analysis) Is a procedure to determine nearly all elements in liquid and solid samples with nearly any composition. This analysis method is suitable for examining additives and contamination, delivering fast results. Shearing/shear loss Shearing of molecule chains during operation can change the viscosity of hydraulic fluids with long chain VI enhancers and anti-fogging additives. The initially high viscosity index drops. This needs to be taken into account when selecting the hydraulic fluid. The only value at present that can be used to assess viscosity changes in operation is the result of the test in accordance with DIN 51350 part -6. Please note that there are practical applications that create a much higher shear load on such hydraulic fluids than can be achieved by this test. Viscosity Viscosity is the measure of the internal friction of a fluid to flow. It is defined as the property of a substance to flow under tension. Viscosity is the most important characteristic for describing the load-bearing capacity of a hydraulic fluid. Kinematic viscosity is the ratio of the dynamic viscosity and the density of the fluid; the unit is mm²/s. Hydraulic fluids are classified by their kinematic viscosity into ISO viscosity classes. The reference temperature for this is 40 °C. Viscosity index (VI) Refers to the viscosity temperature behavior of a fluid. The lower the change of viscosity in relation the temperature, the higher the VI.


59 RE 90222/05.12

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

Bosch Rexroth AG

15/16

1

2

3

4


60 16/16

Bosch Rexroth AG

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Zum EisengieĂ&#x;er 1 97816 Lohr am Main, Germany Phone +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-0 Fax +49 (0) 93 52 / 18-23 58 documentation@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.de

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

RE 90222/05.12

Š This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


61

Rating of hydraulic fluids for Rexroth hydraulic components (pumps and motors)

RE 90235 Edition: 01.2013

Bosch Rexroth offers the rating of hydraulic fluids as service – inclusive assistance and consulting of experienced engineers.

Hydraulic fluids

Title

Hydraulic fluids based on mineral oils and related hydrocarbons

Environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-free hydraulic fluids

Fire-resistant, water-containing hydraulic fluids

Standard

DIN 51524

ISO 15380

ISO 12922

ISO 12922

Data sheets

90220

90221

90222

90223 (in preparation)

Classification

HL HLP HLP(D) HVLP HVLP(D) and more

HEPG HEES partially saturated HEES saturated HEPR HETG

HFDR HFDU (ester base) HFDU (glycol base) and more

HFC HFB HFAE HFAS

RE 90235/01.2013, Bosch Rexroth AG


62 2

Rating of hydraulic fluids Description

The safe and reliable operation of industrial and mobile

When the requirements are fulfilled the corresponding

equipment is only possible if the hydraulic fluid used is

hydraulic fluids will be listed on the following Bosch Rex-

selected with respect to the application. The main tasks of

roth documents:

the hydraulic fluid are e.g. transmission of power, lubrica-

▶ 90240: Rexroth Basic Level List (HLP/HLP(D)/HVLP/

tion of the components, reduction of friction, corrosion

HVLP(D))

prevention and heat dissipation. Unfortunately the common

in preparation:

element “hydraulic fluid” is often disregarded during con-

▶ 90241: Rexroth Basic Level List (HExx)

ceptual design.

▶ 90242: Rexroth Basic Level List (HFDx)

Increased requirements on machines and equipment cons-

▶ 90243: Rexroth Basic Level List (HFxx)

tantly raise the quality requirements on the hydraulic fluid used. For using a suitable hydraulic fluid, adequate know-

Premium Level

ledge and experience of this are necessary.

It is a precondition for the Premium Level to meet the Basic

Therefore Bosch Rexroth offers the rating of hydraulic fluids

Level.

for Rexroth hydraulic components as service.

The Premium Level contains specific fluid tests which show

Bosch Rexroth defines hydraulic fluids on the basis of the

the suitability of the hydraulic fluid with defined Rexroth

illustration on page 1. Application notes and requirements

components. According to the Rexroth components used

for Rexroth hydraulic components can be taken out of the

the corresponding test has to be passed with respect to the

data sheets mentioned in this illlustration on page 1.

oil category. When the requirements are fulfilled the corresponding

1 Description

hydraulic fluids will be listed on the following Bosch Rexroth document:

Minimum requirements

▶ 90245: Rexroth Premium Level List

At present the DIN/ISO conformity for the minimum requirement on fluids is defined in our Bosch Rexroth compo-

Note

nent data sheets. The fluid manufacturers’ technical data

The fluid tests carried out in the Premium Level can not

sheets have to include that the specific standard is met.

cover all machine and system-dependent conditions (see

The plausibility and correctness of the fluid data is not

residual risk on rating scheme on page 3). Only single

reviewed by Bosch Rexroth.

Rexroth components (type of pumps/motors used for the fluid test) can be examined.

Basic Level

Premium Level testing does not cover all systems and

Fluid data of the manufacturer has to be according to DIN /

applications. Releases for special applications are exclu-

ISO and Bosch Rexroth requirements (tightened data of

ded from the fluid rating.

standards, further Bosch Rexroth requirements). Bosch

The responsibility for selection of the hydraulic fluid

Rexroth demands the data to be confirmed in writing. The

remains with the equipment/machinery operator and the

plausibility and correctness of the fluid data is reviewed by

lubricant manufacturer.

Bosch Rexroth.

By means of the fluid test contained in the Premium Level

Furthermore retained samples (finished fluid, base oils) are

the risk in combination with Rexroth hydraulic compo-

stored.

nents can be considerably reduced and the reliability

No special Rexroth fluid test with Rexroth hydraulic compo-

significantly increased.

nents will be done.

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 90235/01.2013


63

DIN 51524 part 2 / 3 ISO 15380 ISO 12922

Basic Level

hydraulic components

Minimum requirements

Risk in combination with Rexroth

Rating of hydraulic fluids Description

Technical data sheets of the fluid manufacturers:

1 DIN / ISO conformity for the minimum requirement on fluids is defined in the Bosch Rexroth component data sheets ▶

Not reviewed by Bosch Rexroth (plausibility / correctness of the data)

Requirements on fluid manufacturer: Fluid data according to DIN / ISO and Bosch Rexroth requirements

Review of manufacturer´s data DIN 51524 part 2 / 3 ISO 15380 ISO 12922

▶ ▶

+ Bosch Rexroth requirements

Reviewed by Bosch Rexroth Listed on Rexroth Basic Level List

2

Special fluids are rated separately

Prerequisite: Basic Level passed

+ Component-related Bosch Rexroth requirements

fluid rating level

Rexroth fluid tests:

Premium Level

Reliability

Fluid rating

3

Specific fluid tests with defined Rexroth hydraulic components ▶ ▶ ▶

Reviewed by Bosch Rexroth Suitability of the fluid for Rexroth hydraulic components Listed on Rexroth Premium Level List

Special fluids are rated separately

3

Residual risk

4

RE 90235/01.2013 Bosch Rexroth AG


64 4

Rating of hydraulic fluids Process

2 Process

Basic Level

(BR*

Contacting fluid manufacturer)

FM**

Registration for “fluid rating” on website of Bosch Rexroth (www.boschrexroth.com/fluidrating)

BR

Reviewing registration data of the fluid manufacturer for plausibility

BR

Assignation of registration number to fluid manufacturer Activating of fluid manufacturer´s access to download area of “fluid rating” on the website of Bosch Rexroth

BR

Information to fluid manufacturer: 1) Registration number (=user name for login download area “fluid rating“) 2) Activating for download area is done

FM

Download of all documents (conditions, applications) necessary for “fluid rating” (Basic Level)

FM

Submitting of all documents and retained samples necessary for “fluid rating” (Basic Level) to Bosch Rexroth

BR

Reviewing of the manufacturer´s data, testing of specific fluid data, storing of retained samples

BR

when the requirements are fulfilled - hydraulic fluid will be listed on the Rexroth Basic Level List (HLP/HLP(D)/HVLP/HVLP(D): 90240, lists for other fluid categories in preparation)

Process fluid rating

The process of a fluid rating includes the following steps:

→ rated@Rexroth4Basic.HVLP → rated@Rexroth4Basic.HVLP(D)

validity period: 3 years

Premium Level

→ rated@Rexroth4Basic.HLP → rated@Rexroth4Basic.HLP(D)

FM

Request for quotation for fluid test by Bosch Rexroth

FM

Commissioning of fluid test, supply of fluid for fluid test

BR

Implementation of specific fluid test using defined Rexroth components

BR

when the requirements are fulfilled - hydraulic fluid will be listed on the Rexroth Premium Level List 90245 → rated@Rexroth4Premium.RFT-APU-CL → rated@Rexroth4Premium.RFT-APU-OL-HFC

RFT-APU-CL Rexroth Fluid Test Axial Piston Unit Closed Loop

RFT-APU-OL-HFC Rexroth Fluid Test Axial Piston Unit Open Loop-HFC

*BR: Bosch Rexroth

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 90235/01.2013

further fluid tests in preparation

**FM: fluid manufacturer


65 Rating of hydraulic fluids Fluid tests

5

3 Fluid tests 3.1 Rexroth fluid test RFT-APU-CL

Technical data of the test components

(Rexroth Fluid Test Axial Piston Unit Closed Loop)

Type

A4VG045EP

A6VM060EP

Data sheet

92004

91610

Fluid test for closed loops using a combination unit existing

Operation mode

pump

motor

of a hydraulic pump A4VG045EP and a hydraulic motor

Nominal volume

45 cm3

62 cm3

A6VM060EP. This fluid test represents the requirements on

Maximum speed (at Vg max)

4300 min-1

4450 min-1

a hydrostatic transmission.

Maximum pressure

500 bar

500 bar

Control

electric (EP)

electric (EP)

1

Features of the fluid test The suitability of the hydraulic fluid is tested at high stress under laboratory conditions. The fluid test consists of a break-in test, swivel cycle test and a corner power test.

Operating data 1. Break-in test 2000 min-1

Speed

Rating criteria

Operating pressure

250 bar

▶ Examination of the interaction fluid to component

Viscosity

10 to 15 mm2/s

Operating time

10 h

– Measurement of the component weight change respectively dimensional change

2

2. Swivel cycle test

– Material compatibility

4000 min-1

Speed

– Visual inspection of components/component surfaces – Oil analysis (SOT, during test, EOT)

Operating pressure

450 bar

Viscosity

5 to 7 mm2/s

Operating time

300 h

▶ Evidence of endurance performance ▶ Determination of efficiency (SOT, EOT)

▼ Swivel cycle (schematic diagram)

50

Test bench

3

45

▼ Schematical hydraulic circuit diagram of the RFT-APU-CL

A6VM060 EP

M A4VG045 EP

Displacement [cm3]

40 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 00

1

2

3

4

6

5

7

8

9

10 11 12 13 4

Time[s]

Displacement A4 Displacement A6 3. Corner power test Speed

4000 min-1

Operating pressure

500 bar

Viscosity

5 to 7 mm2/s

Operating time

200 h

RE 90235/01.2013 Bosch Rexroth AG


66 6

Rating of hydraulic fluids Fluid tests

3.2 Rexroth fluid test RFT-APU-OL-HFC (Rexroth Fluid Test Axial Piston Unit Open Loop-HFC)

Technical data of the test components Type

A4VSO125DR

Data sheet

92053

92053

Operation mode

pump, self-priming

motor

motor). This fluid test represents the requirements on

Nominal volume

125 cm3

125 cm3

applications demanding water-containing, fire-resistant

Maximum speed

2200 min-1

2200 min-1

hydraulic fluids of the classification HFC.

Maximum pressure

400 bar

400 bar

Fluid test for open loops using a A4VSO swashplate axial piston combination unit (hydraulic pump and hydraulic

Features of the fluid test

A4VSO125DFE

Operating data

The suitability of the hydraulic fluid is tested at high stress under laboratory conditions. The fluid test consists of a

1. Constant test 1800 min-1

Speed

constant and swivel cycle test. Rating criteria ▶ Examination of the interaction fluid to component – Wear and cavitation behaviour – Material compatibility

Operating pressure

350 bar

Displacement

Vg max, Vg min

Temperature

40°C

Operating time

200 h

2. Swivel cycle test

– Visual inspection of components/component surfaces – Measuring records of functional relevant component surfaces – Oil analysis (SOT, during test, EOT)

1800 min-1

Speed Operating pressure

350 bar

Displacement

0,5 sec Vg min / 0,5 sec Vg max

Temperature

40/50 °C

Operating time

800 h

▶ Evidence of endurance performance ▼ Swivel cycle (schematic diagram)

Test bench 100

500

90

450

M A4VSO125 DR

80

400

70

350

60

300

50

250

40

200

30

150

20

100

10

50

0

0

0,2 0,4

0,6 0,8

A4 Pump A4 Motor

Bosch Rexroth AG Mobile Applications Glockeraustraße 4 89275 Elchingen, Germany Tel. +49 7308 82-0 info.brm@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com

An den Kelterwiesen 14 72160 Horb, Germany Tel. +49 7451 92-0

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 90235/01.2013

1

1,2 1,4 1,6 1,8

Operating pressure [bar]

A4VSO125 DFE

Swivel angle [%]

▼ Schematical hydraulic circuit diagram of the RFT-APU-OL-HFC

2

Time [s] Operating pressure

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. No statements concerning the suitability of a hydraulic fluid for a specific purpose can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. Subject to change.


67

Motors

Axial piston motors

Radial piston motors

Axial piston motors are available in swash plate or bent axis

Radial piston motors fulfill high requirements in industrial

design for medium and high pressure applications.

applications regarding high efficiency at low speeds or

Our hydrostatic drives for stationary applications stand out due

broad speed ranges.

to their robustness, reliability, long life cycles, low noise emissions and high efficiency as well as high cost-effectiveness.

External gear motors External gear motors are a cost-effective alternative for rotary drives up to approximately 50 kW. The direction of rotation is either in one direction or reversible. In fan drives, constant motors and motors with proportional bypass control are used.

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


68

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


69 Contents | Axial piston motors | Motors

Axial piston motors pmax in bar

Data sheet

5 … 1000

450

91001

71

22 … 500

450

91120

117

A10FM, A10FE

10 … 63

350

91172

129

Open and closed circuits

A6VM/63

28 … 1000

450

91604

157

Open and closed circuits

A6VM/71

60 … 215

450

91610

237

Open and closed circuits

A10VM, A10VE

28 … 63

350

91703

309

Designation

Type

Size

Open and closed circuits

A2FM

Open and closed circuits

A4FM

Open and closed circuits

Component series

Page

Fixed displacement motors

1

Variable displacement motors

2

3

4

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


70

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


71

RE 91001/06.2012 Replaces: 09.07

Axial Piston Fixed Motor A2FM

1/46

Data sheet

Series 6 Size Nominal pressure/Maximum pressure 5 315/350 bar 10 to 200 400/450 bar 250 to 1000 350/400 bar Open and closed circuits

Contents Ordering code for standard program Technical data

Features 2 4

Dimensions

11

Flushing and boost pressure valve

34

Pressure-relief valve

36

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

38

Speed sensors

42

Installation instructions

44

General instructions

46

– Fixed motor with axial tapered piston rotary group of bentaxis design, for hydrostatic drives in open and closed circuits – For use in mobile and stationary applications – The output speed is dependent on the flow of the pump and the displacement of the motor. – The output torque increases with the pressure differential between the high-pressure and the low-pressure side. – Finely graduated sizes permit far-reaching adaptation to the drive case – High power density – Small dimensions – High total efficiency – Good starting characteristics – Economical design – One-piece tapered piston with piston rings for sealing


72 2/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Ordering code for standard program A2F 01

02

M 03

04

/

6

05

W

06

07

V

08

09

10

11

12

13

14

15

Sizes 250 to 1000 (only in combination with long-life bearings "L")

E-

Hydraulic fluid Mineral oil and HFD. HFD for sizes 250 to 1000 only in combination with long-life bearings "L" (without code) 01 HFB, HFC hydraulic fluid

Sizes 5 to 200 (without code)

Axial piston unit 02 Bent-axis design, fixed

03

A2F

Drive shaft bearing Standard bearing (without code)

5 to 200

Long-life bearing

250 to 500 710 to 1000 – L

Operating mode 04 Motor (plug-in motor A2FE, see RE 91008)

05

M

Size (NG) Geometric displacement, see table of values on page 7 5

10 12 16 23 28 32 45 56 63 80 90 107 125 160 180 200 250 355 500 710 1000

Series 6

06

Index 07

NG10 to 180

1

NG200

3

NG5 and 250 to 1000

0

Direction of rotation 08 Viewed on drive shaft, bidirectional

W

Seals 09 FKM (fluor-caoutchouc)

Drive shafts

V 5 –

Splined shaft DIN 5480

10 12 16 23 28 32 45 56 63 80 90 107 125 160 180 200 250 to 1000 – – –

10 Parallel keyed shaft

DIN 6885

11

– –

– –

– –

– –

– –

Mounting flanges 4-hole ISO 3019-2

= Available 1)

– –

Conical shaft1)

5 to 250

8-hole

❍ = On request

Z –

B

C

P

355 to 1000 –

– = Not available

A

= Preferred program

Conical shaft with threaded pin and woodruff key (DIN 6888). The torque must be transmitted via the tapered press fit.

B H


73 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

3/46

Ordering code for standard program A2F 01

02

M 03

04

/

6

05

Port plates for service lines2) 01 0 7 02 0 7 9 03 0

SAE flange ports A and B at rear SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite Threaded ports A and B at side, opposite Threaded ports A and B at side and rear3)

04

SAE flange ports A and B at bottom (same side)

10

BVD

Port plate

Port plate with pressure-relief valves

07

V 09

0 – –

18 8 – 18 – 19 1 – 2 –

– – – –

– – – –

1

10

11

12

13

14

– –

– –

– –

030

040

100

1

Pressure-relief valve (with pressure boost facility)

2

Flushing and boost pressure valve, mounted

7

Counterbalance valve BVD/BVE mounted5)6)

8

Flushing and boost pressure valve, integrated

9

171 178

– – – – –4) – – – –

0

– – – –

– – – –

23 to 180

200

2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7)

191 192

– – – –

▲ ▲

▲ ▲

250 to 500 710 to 10004)

– – – –

▲ = Not for new projects

F H U V

J

Standard / special version Standard version (without code) 15 Standard version with installation variants, e. g. T ports against standard open or closed Special version – = Not available

2

181 188

3

5 to 16

Special version Standard version (without code) Special version for slew drives (standard with port plate 19)

❍ = On request

1 010 017 020 027 029

Pressure-relief valve (without pressure boost facility)

= Available

15

Valves (see pages 34 to 41) Without valve

Speed sensors (see pages 42 and 43) Without speed sensor (without code) Prepared for HDD speed sensor 13 HDD speed sensor mounted7) Prepared for DSA speed sensor DSA speed sensor mounted7)

14

08

5 10-16 23 28, 32 45 56,63 80,90 107-125 160-180 200 250 355-500 1000 – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ▲ ▲ – – – – – – – – – – –

0 –

17

12 with 1-level pressure-

relief valves for mounting a counterbalance valve5) BVE

W

06

–Y -S = Preferred program

Fastening thread or threaded ports, metric Threaded ports at the sides (sizes 10 to 63) plugged with threaded plugs Please contact us. Note the restrictions on page 39. Specify ordering code of counterbalance valve according to data sheet (BVD – RE 95522, BVE – RE 95525) separately. Specify ordering code of sensor according to data sheet (DSA – RE 95133, HDD – RE 95135) separately and observe the requirements on the electronics

4


74 4/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Technical data Hydraulic fluid

Details regarding the choice of hydraulic fluid

Before starting project planning, please refer to our data sheets RE 90220 (mineral oil), RE 90221 (environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids), RE 90222 (HFD hydraulic fluids) and RE 90223 (HFA, HFB, HFC hydraulic fluids) for detailed information regarding the choice of hydraulic fluid and application conditions.

The correct choice of hydraulic fluid requires knowledge of the operating temperature in relation to the ambient temperature: in a closed circuit, the circuit temperature, in an open circuit, the reservoir temperature.

The fixed motor A2FM is not suitable for operation with HFA hydraulic fluid. If HFB, HFC or HFD or environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids are used, the limitations regarding technical data or other seals must be observed. Selection diagram -40° 1600 1000 600 400

-20°

60°

80° 100°

1600

60 40

36 νopt.

20

16

10

5 -40°

-25°

-10° 0° 10°

30°

50°

70°

Example: At an ambient temperature of X °C, an operating temperature of 60 °C is set in the circuit. In the optimum operating viscosity range (Qopt., shaded area), this corresponds to the viscosity classes VG 46 or VG 68; to be selected: VG 68. Note The case drain temperature, which is affected by pressure and speed, can be higher than the circuit temperature or reservoir temperature. At no point of the component may the temperature be higher than 115 °C. The temperature difference specified below is to be taken into account when determining the viscosity in the bearing.

VG

100

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

40°

0 10 VG 68 VG 46 VG 32 VG 2 2

200

20°

The hydraulic fluid should be chosen so that the operating viscosity in the operating temperature range is within the optimum range (Qopt see shaded area of the selection diagram). We recommended that the higher viscosity class be selected in each case.

If the above conditions cannot be maintained due to extreme operating parameters, we recommend flushing the case at port U (sizes 250 to 1000) or using a flushing and boost pressure valve (see pages 34).

5 115°

90°

Temperature t [°C] tmin = -40°C

Hydraulic fluid temperature range

tmax = +115°C

Viscosity and temperature of hydraulic fluid Viscosity [mm2/s] Temperature

Comment

Tmin t -50 °C Topt = +5 °C to +20 °C

factory preservation: up to 12 months with standard, up to 24 months with long-term

TSt t -40 °C

t d 3 min, without load (p d 50 bar), n d 1000 rpm (for sizes 5 to 200), n d 0.25 • nnom (for sizes 250 to 1000)

'T d 25 K

between axial piston unit and hydraulic fluid

T = -40 °C to -25 °C

at p d 0.7 • pnom, n d 0.5 • nnom and t d 15 min

Temperature difference

'T = approx. 12 K

between hydraulic fluid in the bearing and at port T.

Maximum temperature

115 °C

in the bearing

103 °C

measured at port T

Transport and storage at ambient temperature (Cold) start-up1)

Qmax = 1600

Permissible temperature difference Warm-up phase

Q 1600 to 400

Operating phase

Continuous operation

Q = 400 to 10 Qopt = 36 to 16

T = -25 °C to +90 °C

measured at port T, no restriction within the permissible data

Short-term operation2)

Qmin t 7

Tmax

measured at port T, t 3 min, p 0.3 • pnom

FKM shaft seal1) 1) 2)

+103 °C

T d +115 °C

see page 5

At temperatures below -25 °C, an NBR shaft seal is required (permissible temperature range: -40 °C to +90 °C). Sizes 250 to 1000, please contact us.


75 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

5/46

Technical data Sizes 250 to 1000

Finer filtration improves the cleanliness level of the hydraulic fluid, which increases the service life of the axial piston unit. To ensure the functional reliability of the axial piston unit, a gravimetric analysis of the hydraulic fluid is necessary to determine the amount of solid contaminant and to determine the cleanliness level according to ISO 4406. A cleanliness level of at least 20/18/15 is to be maintained. At very high hydraulic fluid temperatures (90 °C to maximum 115 °C), a cleanliness level of at least 19/17/14 according to ISO 4406 is necessary. If the above classes cannot be achieved, please contact us.

5 Differential pressure 'p [bar]

Filtration of the hydraulic fluid

NG250 4

1

NG355

NG710, 1000 3 NG500 2 1 0

0

500

Shaft seal

1000

1500

2000

2500

Speed n [rpm]

Permissible pressure loading

The values are valid for an ambient pressure pabs = 1 bar.

The service life of the shaft seal is influenced by the speed of the axial piston unit and the case drain pressure (case pressure). The mean differential pressure of 2 bar between the case and the ambient pressure may not be enduringly exceeded at normal operating temperature. For a higher differential pressure at reduced speed, see diagram. Momentary pressure spikes (t < 0.1 s) of up to 10 bar are permitted. The service life of the shaft seal decreases with an increase in the frequency of pressure spikes.

Temperature range

The case pressure must be equal to or higher than the ambient pressure.

2

The FKM shaft seal may be used for case drain temperatures from -25 °C to +115 °C. Note For application cases below -25 °C, an NBR shaft seal is required (permissible temperature range: -40 °C to +90 °C). State NBR shaft seal in plain text when ordering. Please contact us.

Direction of flow Direction of rotation, viewed on drive shaft

Sizes 10 to 200

Differential pressure 'p [bar]

5

clockwise

counter-clockwise

A to B

B to A

3

NG10, 12, 16 4 NG80, 90 3 NG107, 125

NG23, 28, 32 NG45 NG56, 63

Speed range No limit to minimum speed nmin. If uniformity of motion is required, speed nmin must not be less than 50 rpm. See table of values on page 7 for maximum speed.

2 NG160, 180 1 0

NG200 0

1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 7000 8000 Speed n [rpm]

Long-life bearing Sizes 250 to 1000 For long service life and use with HF hydraulic fluids. Identical external dimensions as motor with standard bearings. Subsequent conversion to long-life bearings is possible. Bearing and case flushing via port U is recommended. 4

Flushing flow (recommended) NG

250

355

500

710

1000

qv flush (L/min)

10

16

16

16

16


76 6/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Technical data (operating with mineral oil) Pressure at service line port A or B Size 5 Nominal pressure pnom __________________ 315 bar absolute Maximum pressure pmax ________________ 350 bar absolute Single operating period _____________________________ 10 s Total operating period _____________________________ 300 h Summation pressure (pressure A + pressure B) pSu 630 bar Sizes 10 to 200 Nominal pressure pnom _________________ 400 bar absolute Maximum pressure pmax ________________ 450 bar absolute Single operating period _____________________________ 10 s Total operating period _____________________________ 300 h

Minimum pressure – pump mode (inlet) To prevent damage to the axial piston motor in pump operating mode (change of high-pressure side with unchanged direction of rotation, e. g. when braking), a minimum pressure must be guaranteed at the service line port (inlet). The minimum pressure depends on the speed of the axial piston unit (see characteristic curve below). 12

Inlet pressure pabs [bar]

Operating pressure range

10 8 6 4 2 1 0

0.2

Summation pressure (pressure A + pressure B) pSu _ 700 bar Sizes 250 to 1000 Nominal pressure pnom _________________ 350 bar absolute Maximum pressure pmax ________________ 400 bar absolute Single operating period _____________________________ 10 s Total operating period _____________________________ 300 h Summation pressure (pressure A + pressure B) pSu _ 700 bar Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) ___25 bar absolute Rate of pressure change RA max with integrated pressure-relief valve_____________ 9000 bar/s without pressure-relief valve __________________ 16000 bar/s pnom

Pressure p

't

0.4 0.6 Speed n / nnom

0.8

1.0

This diagram is valid only for the optimum viscosity range from Qopt = 36 to 16 mm2/s. Please contact us if these conditions cannot be satisfied. Definition Nominal pressure pnom The nominal pressure corresponds to the maximum design pressure. Maximum pressure pmax The maximum pressure corresponds to the maximum operating pressure within the single operating period. The sum of the single operating periods must not exceed the total operating period. Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Minimum pressure at the high-pressure side (A or B) which is required in order to prevent damage to the axial piston unit. Summation pressure pSu The summation pressure is the sum of the pressures at both service line ports (A and B).

'p

Rate of pressure change RA Maximum permissible rate of pressure rise and reduction during a pressure change over the entire pressure range. Time t Single operating period t1

Note Values for other hydraulic fluids, please contact us.

t2

tn

Pressure p

Maximum pressure pmax Nominal pressure pnom

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Time t Total operating period = t1 + t2 + ... + tn


77 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

7/46

Technical data Table of values (theoretical values, without efficiency and tolerances; values rounded) Size NG 5 10 12 16 23 28

32

45

56

63

80

32

45.6

56.1

63

80.4

6300

6300

5600

5000

5000

4500

6900

6900

6200

5500

5500

5000

177

202

255

281

315

362

128

157

178

254

313

351

448

146

179

204

290

357

401

512

2.56

2.93

3.12

4.18

5.94

6.25

8.73

Displacement geometric, per revolution

Vg

cm3

4.93

Speed maximum1)

nnom

rpm

10000 8000

8000

8000

6300

nmax2)

rpm

11000 8800

8800

8800

6900

qV

L/min

49

82

96

128

144

at Vg and 'p = 350 bar T

Nm

24.75)

57

67

89

'p = 400 bar T

Nm

66

76

102

0.92

1.25

1.59

10.3

12

16

22.9

28.1

1

Input flow3) at nnom and Vg Torque4)

Rotary stiffness

c

kNm/rad 0.63

Moment of inertia for rotary group

JGR

kgm2

0.00006 0.0004 0.0004 0.0004 0.0012 0.0012 0.0012 0.0024 0.0042 0.0042 0.0072

Maximum angular acceleration

D

rad/s2

5000

5000

Case volume

V

L

0.17

0.17

0.17

0.20

0.20

0.20

0.33

0.45

0.45

0.55

Mass (approx.)

m

kg

2.5

5.4

5.4

5.4

9.5

9.5

9.5

13.5

18

18

23

Size

NG

90

107

125

160

180

200

250

355

500

710

1000

Displacement geometric, per revolution

Vg

cm3

90

106.7

125

160.4

180

200

250

355

500

710

1000

Speed maximum1)

nnom

rpm

4500

4000

4000

3600

3600

2750

2700

2240

2000

1600

1600

nmax2)

rpm

5000

4400

4400

4000

4000

3000

qV

L/min

405

427

500

577

648

550

675

795

1000

1136

1600

at Vg and 'p = 350 bar T

Nm

501

594

696

893

1003

1114

1393

1978

2785

3955

5570

'p = 400 bar T

Nm

573

679

796

1021

1146

1273

11.2

11.9

17.4

18.2

57.3

73.1

96.1

144

270

324

0.102

0.178

0.55

0.55

11000 10000 8300

5500

4300

4500

5000

5000

6500

6500

6500

14600 7500

7500

6000

2

Input flow3) at nnom and Vg Torque4)

Rotary stiffness

c

kNm/rad 9.14

Moment of inertia for rotary group

JGR

kgm2

0.0072 0.0116 0.0116 0.0220 0.0220 0.0353 0.061

Maximum angular acceleration

D

rad/s2

6000

Case volume

V

L

0.55

0.8

0.8

1.1

1.1

2.7

2.5

3.5

4.2

8

8

Mass (approx.)

m

kg

23

32

32

45

45

66

73

110

155

325

336

1)

2)

3)

4) 5)

4500

The values are valid: - for the optimum viscosity range from Qopt = 36 to 16 mm2/s - with hydraulic fluid based on mineral oils Intermittent maximum speed: overspeed for unload and overhauling processes, t < 5 s and 'p < 150 bar Restriction of input flow with counterbalance valve, see page 39 Torque without radial force, with radial force see page 8 Torque at 'p = 315 bar

4500

3500

3500

Note Operation above the maximum values or below the minimum values may result in a loss of function, a reduced service life or in the destruction of the axial piston unit. Other permissible limit values, with respect to speed variation, reduced angular acceleration as a function of the frequency and the permissible start up angular acceleration (lower than the maximum angular acceleration) can be found in data sheet RE 90261.

3

4


78 8/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Technical data Permissible radial and axial forces of the drive shafts (splined shaft and parallel keyed shaft) Size

NG

5

53)

10

10

12

12

16

23

Drive shaft

ø

mm

12

12

20

25

20

25

25

25

30

Fq max

kN

1.6

1.6

3.0

3.2

3.0

3.2

3.2

5.7

5.4

a

mm

12

12

16

16

16

16

16

16

16

Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

Fq a

with permissible torque ९ permissible pressure 'p Maximum axial force2)

Fax+ –

23

Tmax

Nm

24.7

24.7

66

66

76

76

102

146

146

'p perm

bar

315

315

400

400

400

400

400

400

400

+Fax max

N

180

180

320

320

320

320

320

500

500

–Fax max

N

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure ±Fax perm/bar N/bar 1.5

1.5

3.0

3.0

3.0

3.0

3.0

5.2

5.2

Size

28

28

32

45

56

564)

56

63

80

NG

Drive shaft Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

Fq a

with permissible torque ९ permissible pressure 'p Maximum axial force2)

Fax+ –

ø

mm

25

30

30

30

30

30

35

35

35

Fq max

kN

5.7

5.4

5.4

7.6

9.5

7.8

9.1

9.1

11.6

a

mm

16

16

16

18

18

18

18

18

20

Tmax

Nm

179

179

204

290

357

294

357

401

512

'p perm

bar

400

400

400

400

400

330

400

400

400

+Fax max

N

500

500

500

630

800

800

800

800

1000

–Fax max

N

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

5.2

5.2

7.0

8.7

8.7

8.7

8.7

10.6

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure ±Fax perm/bar N/bar 5.2 Size

NG

804)

80

90

107

107

125

160

160

180

Drive shaft

ø

mm

35

40

40

40

45

45

45

50

50

Fq max

kN

11.1

11.4

11.4

13.6

14.1

14.1

18.1

18.3

18.3

a

mm

20

20

20

20

20

20

25

25

25

Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

Fq a

with permissible torque ९ permissible pressure 'p Maximum axial force2)

Fax+ –

Tmax

Nm

488

512

573

679

679

796

1021

1021

1146

'p perm

bar

380

400

400

400

400

400

400

400

400

+Fax max

N

1000 1000 1000 1250 1250 1250 1600 1600 1600

–Fax max

N

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure ±Fax perm/bar N/bar 10.6

10.6

10.6

12.9

12.9

12.9

16.7

16.7

16.7

Size

NG

200

250

355

500

710

1000

Drive shaft

ø

mm

50

50

60

70

90

90

Fq max

kN

20.3

1.26)

1.56)

1.96)

3.06)

2.66)

a

mm

25

41

52.5

52.5

67.5

67.5

Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

Fq a

with permissible torque ९ permissible pressure 'p Maximum axial force2)

Fax+ –

Tmax

Nm

1273

5)

5)

5)

5)

5)

'p perm

bar

400

5)

5)

5)

5)

5)

+Fax max

N

1600 2000 2500 3000 4400 4400

–Fax max

N

0

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure ±Fax perm/bar N/bar 16.7 1) 2)

3) 4) 5)

With intermittent operation Maximum permissible axial force during standstill or when the axial piston unit is operating in non-pressurized condition. Conical shaft with threaded pin and woodruff key (DIN 6888) Restricted technical data only for splined shaft Please contact us.

0

0

0

0

0

5)

5)

5)

5)

5)

When at a standstill or when axial piston unit operating in non-pressurized conditions. Higher forces are permissible when under pressure, please contact us. Note Influence of the direction of the permissible axial force: +Fax max = Increase in service life of bearings –Fax max = Reduction in service life of bearings (avoid) 6)


79 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

9/46

Technical data Effect of radial force Fq on the service life of bearings By selecting a suitable direction of radial force Fq, the load on the bearings, caused by the internal rotary group forces can be reduced, thus optimizing the service life of the bearings. Recommended position of mating gear is dependent on direction of rotation. Examples: Toothed gear drive

V-belt output

NG

Mopt

Mopt

5 to 180

± 70°

± 45°

200 to 1000

± 45°

± 70°

Alternating direction of rotation t

M op t

M op

Determining the operating characteristics Input flow

qv =

Speed

n =

Torque

T =

Power

P =

Vg • n

[L/min]

1000 • Kv

1

qV • 1000 • Kv

[min-1]

Vg Vg • 'p • Kmh

[Nm]

20 • S 2S•T•n 60000

=

qv • 'p • Kt 600

[kW]

Mo

pt

Vg = Displacement per revolution in cm3 'p = Differential pressure in bar

M

op

t

n

= Speed in rpm

Kv = Volumetric efficiency

2

Kmh = Mechanical-hydraulic efficiency

A "Counter-clockwise" direction of rotation Pressure at port B

A

B Clockwise direction of rotation Pressure at port A

B

Kt = Total efficiency (Kt = Kv • Kmh)

"Counter-clockwise" direction of rotation Pressure at port B

3

4


80 10/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012


81 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

11/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 5

Y 521)

24

T2

62

6.4

48.5

75

70 8

T1

B, A

61 51

A

56

70

25°

ø60 -0.046

T1, T2

4

1

View Y

45°

45°

10

B

80

2

Drive shafts

4

24

7.3

ø15

ø12.8

10 3.2

M10 x 13)5)

C Conical shaft with threaded pin and woodruff key, 3x5 (DIN 6888), (tapering 1:10)

ø15

M4 x 0.72)3)

13.5

+0.012

ø12 +0.001

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, A4x4x20

3

9.5 10.5 22.5

Ports Designation Port for

Standard6)

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line

DIN 3852

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

350

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 3852

M10 x 1; 8 deep

3

O

T2

Drain line

DIN 3852

M10 x 1; 8 deep

3

O

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Thread according to DIN 3852, maximum tightening torque: 30 Nm The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

4


82 12/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 10, 12, 16

45°

45°

95

201)

RE 91001/06.2012

95

6

29

95

40°

ø80–0.019

T1

9

54

0 10

A

5

12 60

ø8

18.2

T2

B

Flange similar to ISO 3019-2

Drive shafts

22

28

+0.015

40

16 M6x12)3)

Key width 8

7.5

Key width 6

5

ø28

ø28

22

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS6x6x32 ø20+0.002

5

28

M6x12)3)

+0.015 ø25+0.002

16

22

Sizes 10, 12

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS8x7x32

ø28

22 7.5

ø28

M10x1.52)3)

Sizes 10, 12, 16

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W20x1.25x14x9g

22.5

Sizes 10, 12

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W25x1.25x18x9g

M10x1.52)3)

Sizes 10, 12, 16

40

34

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M12 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M12 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


83 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

13/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 10, 12, 16 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 03 – Threaded ports at side, opposite

04 – Threaded ports at side and rear

131 166

Y

Plate

Designation Port for

03

A, B

04 1) 2)

3) 4)

131 147 166

85

Standard3)

Size1)

A

91

56

A

69

91

56

B B

1

Detail Y 34

Detail Y

85 95

Y

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State4)

Service line

DIN 3852

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep 450

O

Service line

DIN 3852

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep 450

1x O each

2

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

3

4


84 14/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 23, 28, 32

45°

45° 106

251)

118

8

118

25

40°

ø100–0.022

T1

11

56

5 12

18

T2

42

A

ø1 06

23.2

B

Flange ISO 3019-2

Drive shafts

19

Key width 8

6

ø35

+0.015

M8x1.252)3)

ø25+0.002

50

28

35

Key width 8

28

+0.015

ø35

22 7.5

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS8x7x40

ø35

19

ø30+0.002

M8x1.252)3)

27

Sizes 23, 28

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS8x7x40

6

ø35

M10x1.52)3)

22 7.5

Sizes 23, 28, 32

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W25x1.25x18x9g

M10x1.52)3)

Sizes 23, 28

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W30x2x14x9g

33

Sizes 23, 28, 32

50

43

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M16 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M16 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


85 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

15/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 23, 28, 32 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite Detail Y 115

Detail Y 40.5

70

144 190

13 59

Y

117

18.2

78 106 153 173

40 13 .5

2

A

B

1

18 .

03 – Threaded ports at side, opposite

B

A

120

Y

04 – Threaded ports at side and rear Detail Y

Detail Y

2

58

70 117 144 190

B

A 144 166 190

120

Y

A

70 88 117

B

Y

120 130

10 – SAE flange ports at bottom (same side)4) Detail Y 3

158 178

18.2

B

40.5

115 59 13

91 106

40

A

Y Plate

Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

01, 02, 10

A, B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1/2 in 450 M8 x 1.25; 15 deep

O

Service line Fastening thread A/B

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

03

Service line

DIN 38525)

M27 x 2; 16 deep

450

O

04

Service line

DIN 38525)

M27 x 2; 16 deep

450

1x O each

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard Only sizes 28 and 32 The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

Note Port plates 18 and 19: see pages 37 and 40

4


86 16/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 45

45°

45° 321)

RE 91001/06.2012

108

150

12

20 42

ø1 18

T2

13.5

0 16

63 30

150

28

40 °

ø125–0.025

T1

A

B

Flange ISO 3019-2

Drive shafts

28

Key width 8

33

9.5

ø35

28

M12x1.752)3)

+0.015

ø30+0.002

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS8x7x50

9.5

ø35

M12x1.752)3)

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W30x2x14x9g

60

27 35

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


87 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

17/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 45 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite Detail Y

Detail Y

147 50.8

.8

155 207

19

166 194

Y

80 133

50 19 .8

89 122

23.8

A

B

75

04 – Threaded ports at side and rear

A

B

128

Y

10 – SAE flange ports at bottom (same side) Detail Y

Detail Y

Y

2

49

A

50.8

169 193

128 141

147 75 19

B 102 119

58

80 100 133

B

155 179 207

1

23

23.8

A

Y

Plate

Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

01, 02, 10

A, B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

3/4 in M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

450

O

M33 x 2; 18 deep

450

1x O each

04 1) 2)

3) 4) 5)

Service line Fastening thread A/B Service line

DIN

38524)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State5) 3

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

Note Port plates 18 and 19: see pages 37 and 40

4


88 18/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 56, 63 45°

45°

117

321)

150

10

A

ø1 28

T2

Flange ISO 3019-2

13.5

70

0 16

20 50

30

150

31

40 °

ø125–0.025

T1

B

Drive shafts

27

32 40

28

Key width 8

9.5

ø40

M12x1.752)3)

+0.015

ø30+0.002

Key width 10

33

28 9.5

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS8x7x50

ø40

+0.018 ø35+0.002

28

38

M12x1.752)3)

NG56

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS10x8x50

9.5

ø40

M12x1.752)3)

28 9.5

NG56, 63

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W30x2x14x9g

M12x1.752)3)

NG56

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W35x2x16x9g

ø40

NG56, 63

60

60

35

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


89 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

19/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 56, 63 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite Detail Y 147

.8

171 225

19

Y

Y

136

10 – SAE flange ports at bottom (same side) Detail Y

Detail Y

58

49

182 206

136 149

50.8

107 142

Y

2

B

A 107 130

B 87

A

75

04 – Threaded ports at side and rear

171 195 225

B

147 75 19

182 206

87 142

50 19 .8

96 130

23.8

A

B

1

Detail Y

23

50.8

A

23.8

Y

Plate

Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

01, 02, 10

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

3/4 in M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

450

O

Service line

DIN 38524)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

450

1x O each

04 1) 2)

3) 4) 5)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State5) 3

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

Note Port plates 18 and 19: see pages 37 and 40 4


90 20/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 80, 90 45°

45°

132

321)

RE 91001/06.2012

165

10

A

ø1 38

T2

63 Flange ISO 3019-2

13.5

83

0 18

20

29

165

41

40°

ø140–0.025

T1

B

Drive shafts

+0.018

ø35+0.002

M12x1.752)3)

28 9.5

Key width 10

70

70

32

45

Key width 12

ø45

ø45

36 12

38

+0.018

28

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS10x8x56

ø45

ø40+0.002

M12x1.752)3)

37

NG80

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS12x8x56

9.5

ø45

M16x22)3)

36 12

NG80, 90

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W35x2x16x9g

M16x22)3)

NG80

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W40x2x18x9g

43

NG80, 90

40

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


91 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

21/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 80, 90 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite Detail Y 166 27 .8

203 233

25

Y

99 162

104 144

57 . 25 2

27.8

A

B

1

Detail Y 57.2

160

196 257

84

A

B

Y

10 – SAE flange ports at bottom (same side) Detail Y

2

60

206 236

27.8

57.2

166 84 25

121 145

B

A

Y Plate

Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure State4) [bar]2)

01, 02, 10

A, B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 in M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

450

1) 2)

3) 4)

Service line Fastening thread A/B

O

3

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

Note Port plates 18 and 19: see pages 37 and 40

4


92 22/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 107, 125

45°

45° 401)

RE 91001/06.2012

190

140 10

T2

A

ø1 50

23 65

36.5

0

17.5

85

20

190

40

40 °

ø160–0.025

T1

B

Flange ISO 3019-2

Drive shafts

50

+0.018

ø40+0.002

28

Key width 12

9.5

ø50

ø50

37

42

Key width 14

M12x1.752)3)

36 12

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS12x8x63

43

+0.018

ø45+0.002

28

48.5

M12x1.752)3)

NG107

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS14x9x63

9.5

ø50

M16x22)3)

36 12

NG107, 125

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W40x2x18x9g

M16x22)3)

NG107

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g

ø50

NG107, 125

80

80

45

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


93 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

23/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 107, 125 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite (size 107) Detail Y 194

Y

10 – SAE flange ports at bottom (same side)

110

A

B

178

213 285

32 99

181

57 .2 25

159

120 225.5 252

31.8

A

B

1

Detail Y 27 .8

66.7

Y

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite (size 125) 2

Detail Y Detail Y

70

31.8

A

State4)

SAE J5183) 1 1/4 in DIN 13 M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) 1 in DIN 13 M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

450

O

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) 1 1/4 in DIN 13 M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

Designation Port for

Standard

01, 10

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

02 (size 107) 02 (size 125) 2)

3) 4)

Y Maximum pressure [bar]2)

Plate

Size1)

A

B

178

213 285

Y

1)

110

66 . 32 7 66.7

194 99 32

136 157 226 261

181

31 .8

B

3

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

Note Port plates 17, 18 and 19: see pages 37 and 40

4


94 24/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 160, 180

45°

45°

401)

RE 91001/06.2012

158

210

10

210

47

40 °

ø180–0.025

T1

4 17.5

96

22

25

T2

72

A

ø1 80

37.2

Flange ISO 3019-2

B

Drive shafts

55

ø45+0.002

+0.018

36 M16x22)3)

Key width 14

12

ø60

+0.018

Key width 14

90

42

44

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS14x9x70

48.5

ø50+0.002

36 12

53.5

ø60

M16x22)3)

12

ø60

12

NG160

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS14x9x70

36

36 M16x22)3)

NG160, 180

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g

ø60

NG160

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g

M16x22)3)

NG160, 180

90

50

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X5)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

O5)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

450

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


95 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

25/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions sizes 160, 180 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite Detail Y 1

Detail Y

194 66.7

121 188

237 294

32 99

Y

66 . 32 7

134 188 252 294

31 .8

31.8

A

B

B

Y

A

202

10 – SAE flange ports at bottom (same side) 2

Detail Y 70

252 290

66.7

32

194 99

149 185

B

31.8

A

Y Plate 01, 02, 10 1) 2)

3) 4)

Designation Port for A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

Standard J5183)

SAE DIN 13

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State4)

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

3

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

Note Port plates 18 and 19: see pages 37 and 40

4


96 26/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91001/06.2012

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 200 Port plate 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

401)

236

0

166

22

25

84

102.5 Flange ISO 3019-2

236

77

T1

25°

ø200–0.029

9

32

45 °

45 °

156

32 89

Y

T2

B

A

284 306

Detail Y 206 66.7

Drive shafts

A

B

44

211

31.8

M16x22)3)

+0.018 ø50+0.002

B Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS14x9x80 36 Key 12 width 14

32

ø70

53.5

ø70

M16x22)3)

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g 36 12

99

100

55

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State8)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5185) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X6)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

O6)

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7) 8)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


97 RE 91001/06.2012

A2FM Series 6

Bosch Rexroth AG

27/46

Notes

1

2

3

4


98 28/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 250

45°

45° 82 22

124

T1

26° 30

`

ø224 -0.072

U

246

9

105

501)

0

25 82

48 Flange ISO 3019-2

22

ø21 0

105

28

T2

246

Drive shafts P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS14x9x80 +0.018

ø50+0.002

36 12

Key width 14

49

ø60

53.5

ø60

M16x22)3)

36 12

M16 x 22)3)

Z Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g

82

58

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State7)

A, B

Service line (see port plates)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

T2

Drain line

DIN 38526)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X5)

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38526)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7)

400 O5)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


99 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

29/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 250 Location of the service line ports on the port plates 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

02 – SAE flange ports at side, opposite Detail Y

Detail Y

.8

82 172

93 172

A

B

66 .7 32

A

31

31.8

B

1

236

66.7

32

Y

288 314

100

267 323

Y

Plate

Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State4)

01, 02

A, B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

400

O

1) 2)

3) 4)

Service line Fastening thread A/B

2

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery)

3

4


100 30/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 355 Port plate 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

`

501) 14

22°30

83 23.5

45

U T1

°

335

0

32 198

128

18

0

Y

T2

28 83

48

171

36

102

ø280 -0.081

26° 30

`

128

MA (MB)

335

320 350 Flange ISO 3019-2

Detail Y 250 245

M20x2.52)3)

ø60+0.011

+0.030

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS18x11x100 42 15

B

A

MB

Key width 18

MA

ø70

64

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W60x2x28x9g 42 15

ø70

M20x2.52)3)

Z

79.4

36.6

Drive shafts

40 71

105

120

82

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4 )

State8)

A, B

SAE J5185) DIN 13

1 1/2 in M16 x 2; 21 deep

400

O

38527)

Service line Fastening thread A/B

T1

Drain line

DIN

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

O6)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

X6)

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38527)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

MA, M B

Measuring operating pressure

DIN 38527)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7) 8)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


101 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

31/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 500 Port plate 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

`

22°30 501)

98 1

U

45 °

27.5

T1 MA (MB)

40

142

`

0

T2

30 111

0

36

22

142

112.5 220

375

26° 30

ø315 -0.081

48

192

14

Y 375

362 396

Flange ISO 3019-2

2

Detail Y 276 270

Drive shafts

M20x2.52)3)

42 15

B

A

MB

Key width 20

MA

ø80

74.5

ø70+0.011

+0.030

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS20x12x100

79.4

36.6

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W70x3x22x9g 42 15

ø80

M20x2.52)3)

Z

3 40

67

130

105

80

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State8)

A, B

SAE J5185) DIN 13

1 1/2 in M16 x 2; 21 deep

400

O

38527)

O6)

Service line Fastening thread A/B

T1

Drain line

DIN

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

T2

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

X6)

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38527)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

MA, M B

Measuring operating pressure

DIN 38527)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7) 8)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


102 32/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91001/06.2012

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 710 Port plate 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

`

22°30

131 41.5

501) 14

°

45

U T1

0

249

45

Y

T2

35 156

22 465

102

0

183 47

236

50

183

18° 30

`

ø400 –0.089

MA (MB)

465

485 507

Flange ISO 3019-2

Detail Y 344 340

Drive shafts

44.5

91

MA 96.8

18

A

Key width 25

95

18

50

B

MB

ø100

ø90+0.013

+0.035

50

ø100

M24x32)3)

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS25x14x125 M24x32)3)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W90x3x28x9g

Z

50 170

130

105

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5185) DIN 13

2 in 400 M20 x 2.5; 30 deep

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State8) O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M42 x 2; 20 deep

3

O6)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M42 x 2; 20 deep

3

X6)

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38527)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

MA, M B

Measuring operating pressure

DIN 38527)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7) 8)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


103 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

33/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 1000 Port plate 01 – SAE flange ports at rear

`

22°30

131 41.5

501) 14

45

U T1

1

°

47

22 465

0

143

0

277

45

T2

35 156

Y

468 511

Flange ISO 3019-2

236

183

50

183

26° 30

`

ø400 –0.089

MA (MB)

2

465

Detail Y 344 340

Drive shafts

A

MA 96.8

18

B

MB Key width 25

95

18

50

3

ø100

ø90+0.013

+0.035

50

ø100

M24x32)3)

44.5

P Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885, AS25x14x125

M24x32)3)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W90x3x28x9g

Z

50 170

91

130

105

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size3)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5185) DIN 13

2 in 400 M20 x 2.5; 30 deep

O O6)

Maximum pressure [bar]4)

State8)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M42 x 2; 20 deep

3

T2

Drain line

DIN 38527)

M42 x 2; 20 deep

3

X6)

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38527)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

Measuring operating pressure

DIN 38527)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MA, M B 1) 2) 3) 4)

5) 6) 7) 8)

To shaft collar Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13) Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 44). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


104 34/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Flushing and boost pressure valve The flushing and boost pressure valve is used to remove heat from the hydraulic circuit. In an open circuit, it is used only for flushing the housing. In a closed circuit, it ensures a minimum boost pressure level in addition to the case flushing. Hydraulic fluid is directed from the respective low pressure side into the motor housing. This is then fed into the reservoir, together with the case drain fluid. The hydraulic fluid, removed out of the closed circuit must be replaced by cooled hydraulic fluid from the boost pump. With port plate 027, the valve is mounted directly on the fixed motor (sizes 45 to 180, 250); with port plate 017 (sizes 355 and 500) on a plate. Cracking pressure of pressure retaining valve (observe when setting the primary valve) Sizes 45 to 500, fixed setting_______________________16 bar Switching pressure of flushing piston 'p Sizes 45 to 500 ________________________________ 8±1 bar Flushing flow qv Orifice (throttles with integrated valve) can be used to set the flushing flows as required. Following parameters are based on: 'pND = pND – pG = 25 bar and Q = 10 mm2/s (pND = low pressure, pG = case pressure) Schematic T1

A (B)

Flushing piston Flushing orifice Pressure retaining valve

T2

B (A)

RE 91001/06.2012

A2FM Series 6

Standard flushing flows Flushing and boost pressure valve, mounted (code 7) Size

Flushing flow ø [mm] Mat. No. qv [L/min] of orifice

45

3.5

1.2

R909651766

107, 125

8

1.8

R909419696

160, 180

10

2.0

R909419697

250

10

2.0

R909419697

355, 500

16

2.5

R910803019

With sizes 45 to 180, orifices can be supplied for flushing flows from 3.5 to 10 L/min. For other flushing flows, please state the required flushing flow when ordering. The flushing flow without orifice is approx. 12 to 14 L at low pressure 'pND = 25 bar. Flushing and boost pressure valve, integrated (code 9) Size

Throttle ø [mm]

qv [L/min]

56, 63, 80, 90

1.5

6

1.8

7.3


105 Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

35/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Flushing and boost pressure valve Dimensions Port plate 027 – SAE flange ports at side

Port plate 017 – SAE flange ports at rear View X

1

View Y

A1

M16x2; 21

A

deep1)

A

98

A2 A4

B Y

X 40

A2

B

A1 A3

ø18; 40 deep

Size

A1

A2

Size

A1

A2

A3

A4

45

223

151

355

356

120

421

198

107, 125

294

192

500

397

130

464

220

160, 180

315

201

250

344

172

1)

2

DIN 13, observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques

Port plate 029 – SAE flange ports at side A1

View Y

B

A A2

3

Y

Size

A1

A2

56, 63

225

176

80, 90

257

186.7

125

4


106 36/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Pressure-relief valve The MHDB pressure-relief valves (see RE 64642) protect the hydraulic motor from overload. As soon as the set cracking pressure is reached, the hydraulic fluid flows from the highpressure side to the low-pressure side.

RE 91001/06.2012

Version without pressure boost facility "191" T1

MB B

The pressure-relief valves are only available in combination with port plates 181, 191 or 192 (counterbalance valve for mounting to port plate 181: see next page). S1

Cracking pressure setting range _____________ 50 to 420 bar With the version "with pressure boost facility" (192), a higher pressure setting can be realized by applying an external pilot pressure of 25 to 30 bar to port PSt. When ordering, please state in plain text: – Cracking pressure of pressure-relief valve – Cracking pressure with pilot pressure applied to PSt (only with version 192)

A T2

MA

Version with pressure boost facility "192" T1

MB

PSt B

S1

A T2

MA

PSt


107 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

37/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Pressure-relief valve Dimensions D1 D2 D5 D3

View Z: Version without pressure boost facility "191" or "181" D8

D7 D6

T1

Z

T2 View Y

D13

D6

D9

A

2

D4

D11 Only with port plate "181"

B

S1

View Z: Version with pressure boost facility "192" D8 PSt

Y

D10 D12

MA

MB

S1

MB

1

MB

MA

S1

D2

D3

D4

D5

D6

D7

D8

D9

D10

D11

D12

D132)

28, 32

MHDB.16 209

186

25

68

174

102

87

36

66

50.8

23.8

ø19

M10; 17 deep

45

MHDB.16 222

198

22

65

187

113

98

36

66

50.8

23.8

ø19

M10; 17 deep

56, 63

MHDB.22 250

222

19

61

208

124

105

42

75

50.8

23.8

ø19

M10; 13 deep

80, 90

MHDB.22 271

243

17.5

59

229

134

114

42

75

57.2

27.8

ø25

M12; 18 deep

107, 125 MHDB.32 298

266

10

52

250

149.5 130

53

84

66.7

31.8

ø32

M14; 19 deep

160, 180 MHDB.32 332

301

5

47

285

170

53

84

66.7

31.8

ø32

M14; 19 deep

Size

D1

149

Size

A, B

S11)

MA, M B1)

PSt1)

28, 32

3/4 in

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

M20 x 1.5; 14 deep

G 1/4

45

3/4 in

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

M20 x 1.5; 14 deep

G 1/4

56, 63

3/4 in

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

G 1/4

80, 90

1 in

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

G 1/4

107, 125

1 1/4 in

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

G 1/4

160, 180

1 1/4 in

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

M30 x 1.5; 16 deep

G 1/4

3

Assembly instructions for port plate with pressure boost facility "192": The lock nut must be counterheld when installing the hydraulic line at the pst port! 4

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size

Maximum pressure State3) [bar]2)

A, B

Service line

SAE J518

See above

450

O

S1

Supply (only with port plate 191/192)

DIN 3852

See above

5

O

MA , M B

Measuring operating pressure

DIN 3852

See above

450

X

PSt

Pilot pressure (only with port plate 192)

DIN ISO 228

See above

30

O

1) 2)

3)

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


108 38/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Function

Travel drive/winch counterbalance valves are designed to reduce the danger of overspeeding and cavitation of axial piston motors in open circuits. Cavitation occurs if the motor speed is greater than it should be for the given input flow while braking, travelling downhill, or lowering a load. If the inlet pressure drops, the counterbalance spool throttles the return flow and brakes the motor until the inlet pressure returns to approx. 20 bar. Note – BVD available for sizes 28 to 180 and BVE available for sizes 107 to 180. – The counterbalance valve must be ordered additionally. We recommend ordering the counterbalance valve and the motor as a set. Ordering example: A2FM90/61W–VAB188 + BVD20F27S/41B–V03K16D0400S12 – The counterbalance valve does not replace the mechanical service brake and park brake. – Observe the detailed notes on the BVD counterbalance valve in RE 95522 and BVE counterbalance valve in RE 95525! – For the design of the brake release valve, we must know for the mechanical park brake: - the pressure at the start of opening - the volume of the counterbalance spool between minimum stroke (brake closed) and maximum stroke (brake released with 21 bar) - the required closing time for a warm device (oil viscosity approx. 15 mm2/s)

Travel drive counterbalance valve BVD...F Application option – Travel drive on wheeled excavators Example schematic for travel drive on wheeled excavators A2FM090/61W-VAB188 + BVD20F27S/41B–V03K16D0400S12 Directional valve, pump, not included in the delivery contents.

Counterbalance valve BVD

Fixed motor A2FM

MB

Gext L´ B

S A

A´ G´ MA

T


109 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

39/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Winch counterbalance valve BVD...W and BVE Application options – Winch drive in cranes (BVD and BVE)

1

– Track drive in excavator crawlers (BVD) Example schematic for winch drive in cranes A2FM090/61W-VAB188 + BVE25W385/51ND-V100K00D4599T30S00-0 Directional valve, pump, not included in the delivery contents.

Fixed motor A2FM

Counterbalance valve BVE

MB

Gext G´ D

D´ 2

S C´ L´

C D2

MA D1

Mk VF

T

MP1

Winch with mechanical park brake

VG

Permissible input flow or pressure in operation with DBV and BVD/BVE Without valve

Restricted values in operation with DBV and BVD/BVE

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV max [L/min]

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV [L/min]

Code

28

400/450

176

16

350/420

100

181 20 191, 192 (BVD)

Motor

DBV

32

201

45

255

56

280

63

315

80

360

90

405

107

427

125

500

107

427

125

500

160

577

180

648

22

3

BVD/BVE NG

240

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV [L/min]

Code

350/420

100

188

220

171 191, 192 32

400

DBV _______________________________ pressure-relief valve BVD __________________counterbalance valve, double-acting BVE _____________________ counterbalance valve, one-sided

181 25 191, 192 (BVD/BVE)

178 320

188

4


110 40/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91001/06.2012

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Dimensions

View Y

B1 B3

Pressure-relief valve, see page 36, 37

T

B5

B Gext

B6

B2

B7

S

MB B4

A

A,B

Y

A2FM

Counterbalance valve

Size

Type

Ports

Dimensions

28, 32

BVD20..16

A, B 3/4 in

B1 209

B2 175

B3 174

B4 (S) 142

B4 (L) 147

B5 139

B6 98

B7 66

45

BVD20..16

3/4 in

222

196

187

142

147

139

98

66

56, 63

BVD20..17

3/4 in

250

197

208

142

147

139

98

75

80, 90

BVD20..27

1 in

271

207

229

142

147

139

98

75

107, 125

BVD20..28

1 in

298

238

251

142

147

139

98

84

107, 125

BVD25..38

11/4 in

298

239

251

158

163

175

120.5

84

160, 180

BVD25..38

11/4 in

332

260

285

158

163

175

120.5

84

107, 125

BVE25..38

11/4 in

298

240

251

167

172

214

137

84

160, 180

BVE25..38

11/4 in

332

260

285

167

172

214

137

84

On request

250

Ports Designation Port for A, B

Service line

S

Infeed

Br

Brake release, reduced high pressure

Gext

Brake release, high pressure

MA, M B

Measuring pressure A and B

1) 2)

3) 4)

Version

Standard

Size1)

Maximum State4) pressure [bar]2)

SAE J518

see table above

420

BVD20

DIN 38523)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

30

O X

BVD25, BVE25

DIN 38523)

M27 x 2; 16 deep

30

X

L

DIN 38523)

M12 x 1.5; 12.5 deep

30

O

S

DIN 38523)

M12 x 1.5; 12.5 deep

420

X

ISO 61493)

M12 x 1.5; 12 deep

420

X

Observe the general instructions on page 46 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


111 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

41/46

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Mounting the counterbalance valve When delivered, the counterbalance valve is mounted to the motor with two tacking screws (transport protection). The tacking screws may not be removed while mounting the service lines. If the counterbalance valve and motor are delivered separately, the counterbalance valve must first be mounted to the motor port plate using the provided tacking screws. The counterbalance valve is finally mounted to the motor by screwing on the SAE flange with the following screws:

B2

B1

1

B3

B4

6 screws (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8) ______________ length B1+B2+B3 2 screws (6, 7) __________________________ length B3+B4

Y

Tighten the screws in two steps in the specified sequence from 1 to 8 (see following scheme).

View Y

In the first step, the screws must be tightened with half the tightening torque, and in the second step with the maximum tightening torque (see following table). Thread

Strength class

SAE flange

Tightening torque [Nm]

2 6

4 8

7 3

5 1

2

M6 x 1 (tacking screw) 10.9

15.5

M10

10.9

75

M12

10.9

130

M14

10.9

205

Size

28, 32, 45

56, 63

Port plate

18

B11)

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

M12 x 1.75; 18 deep M14 x 2; 19 deep

M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

B2

782)

68

68

68

B3

customer-specific

B4

M10 x 1.5; 15 deep

M10 x 1.5; 15 deep

M12 x 1.75; 16 deep M14 x 2; 19 deep

1) 2)

80, 90

107, 125, 160, 180

Tacking screws (M6 x 1, length = B1+B2, DIN 912)

107, 125 17

85

M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

3

Minimum required thread reach 1 x ø-thread Including sandwich plate

4


112 42/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Speed sensors

Version "H" Sizes 250 to 500 with HDD sensor

On deliveries "prepared for speed sensor", the port is plugged with a pressure-resistant cover.

T1

D

A

The versions A2FM...U and A2FM...F ("prepared for speed sensor", i.e. without sensor) is equipped with a toothed ring on the rotary group.

RE 91001/06.2012

30

X

B C

With the DSA or HDD speed sensor mounted a signal proportional to motor speed can be generated. The sensors measures the speed and direction of rotation. Ordering code, technical data, dimensions and details on the connector, plus safety information about the sensor can be found in the relevant data sheet. DSA _______________________________________ RE 95133 HDD _______________________________________ RE 35135

Version "V" Sizes 23 to 200 with DSA sensor

C B

A

D

Version "V" Sizes 250 to 500 with DSA sensor On request

With HDD sensor

20 22

We recommend ordering the A2FM fixed motor complete with sensor mounted.

Without HDD sensor M6x1 (DIN 13) 8 deep

ø18.2

HDD ____________________________ with two mounting bolts

22

DSA _____________________________with one mounting bolt

View X

20

The sensor is mounted at the specially provided port D as follows:

90

°


113 RE 91001/06.2012

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Speed sensors Size

23, 28, 32

45

56, 63

80, 90

107, 125

Number of teeth

38

45

47

53

59

DSA

A

Insertion depth (tolerance ± 0.1)

18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

B

Contact surface

57.9

64.9

69.9

74.9

79.9

C

74.5

81.5

86.5

91.5

96.5

D

54.7

54.3

61.5

72.5

76.8

Size

160, 180

200

250

355

500

Number of teeth

67

80

78

90

99

HDD

DSA

43/46

A

Insertion depth (tolerance ± 0.1)

32

32

32

B

Contact surface

110.5

122.5

132.5

C

149

161

171

D

82

93

113

A

Insertion depth (tolerance ± 0.1)

18.4

18.4

32

32

32

B

Contact surface

87.4

100.9

C

104

117.5

D

86.8

97.5

1

2

3

4


114 44/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

Installation instructions General

Below-reservoir installation (standard)

During commissioning and operation, the axial piston unit must be filled with hydraulic fluid and air bled. This must also be observed following a relatively long standstill as the axial piston unit may drain back to the reservoir via the hydraulic lines.

Below-reservoir installation means that the axial piston unit is installed outside of the reservoir below the minimum fluid level.

1

2 ht min

Particularly in the installation position "drive shaft upwards" filling and air bleeding must be carried out completely as there is, for example, a danger of dry running.

ht min

hmin

hmin

T1

T2

The case drain fluid in the motor housing must be directed to the reservoir via the highest available drain port (T1, T2). For combinations of multiple units, make sure that the respective case pressure in each unit is not exceeded. In the event of pressure differences at the drain ports of the units, the shared drain line must be changed so that the minimum permissible case pressure of all connected units is not exceeded in any situation. If this is not possible, separate drain lines must be laid if necessary.

3

4 ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin

To achieve favorable noise values, decouple all connecting lines using elastic elements and avoid above-reservoir installation.

R(U)

T1

T2

In all operating conditions, the drain line must flow into the reservoir below the minimum fluid level.

Installation position See the following examples 1 to 8. Further installation positions are possible upon request. Recommended installation positions: 1 and 2. Note With sizes 10 to 200 with installation position "shaft upward", an air-bleed port R is required (state in plain text when ordering - special version). With sizes 250 to 1000, port U is provided as standard in the area near the bearings for air bleeding.

Above-reservoir installation Above-reservoir installation means that the axial piston unit is installed above the minimum fluid level of the reservoir. Recommendation for installation position 8 (drive shaft upward): A check valve in the drain line (cracking pressure 0.5 bar) can prevent draining of the motor housing.

5 Air bleed

Filling

1

–

T1

2

–

T2

3

–

T1

4

R (U)

T2

5

L1

T1 (L1)

6

L1

T2 (L1)

7

L1

T1 (L1)

8

R (U)

T2 (L1)

L1

Filling / air bleed

R

Air bleed port (special version)

U

Bearing flushing / air bleed port

T1, T2

Drain port

ht min

Minimum required immersion depth (200 mm)

hmin

Minimum required spacing to reservoir bottom (100 mm)

6 L1

L1 T2

T1

ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin

7

8 L1 L1

R(U)

T1

T2 0.5 bar

Installation position

ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin


115 RE 91001/06.2012

A2FM Series 6

Bosch Rexroth AG

45/46

1

2

3

4


116 46/46

Bosch Rexroth AG

A2FM Series 6

RE 91001/06.2012

1-Headline General instructions – The motor A2FM is designed to be used in open and closed circuits. – The project planning, installation and commissioning of the axial piston unit requires the involvement of qualified personnel. – Before using the axial piston unit, please read the corresponding instruction manual completely and thoroughly. If necessary, these can be requested from Bosch Rexroth. – During and shortly after operation, there is a risk of burns on the axial piston unit. Take appropriate safety measures (e. g. by wearing protective clothing). – Depending on the operating conditions of the axial piston unit (operating pressure, fluid temperature), the characteristic may shift. – Service line ports: - The ports and fastening threads are designed for the specified maximum pressure. The machine or system manufacturer must ensure that the connecting elements and lines correspond to the specified application conditions (pressure, flow, hydraulic fluid, temperature) with the necessary safety factors.

– The data and notes contained herein must be adhered to. – The product is not approved as a component for the safety concept of a general machine according to ISO 13849. – The following tightening torques apply: - Fittings: Observe the manufacturer's instructions regarding tightening torques of the fittings used. - Mounting bolts: For mounting bolts with metric ISO thread according to DIN 13 or with thread according to ASME B1.1, we recommend checking the tightening torque in individual cases in accordance with VDI 2230. - Female threads in the axial piston unit: The maximum permissible tightening torques MG max are maximum values for the female threads and must not be exceeded. For values, see the following table. - Threaded plugs: For the metallic threaded plugs supplied with the axial piston unit, the required tightening torques of threaded plugs MV apply. For values, see the following table.

- The service line ports and function ports can only be used to accommodate hydraulic lines.

Standard

Size of thread

Maximum permissible tight- Required tightening torque of the ening torque of the threaded plugs MV1) female threads MG max

DIN 38521)

M10 x 1

30 Nm

15 Nm2)

5 mm

M12 x 1.5

50 Nm

25 Nm2)

6 mm

M14 x 1.5

80 Nm

35 Nm

6 mm

M16 x 1.5

100 Nm

50 Nm

8 mm

M18 x 1.5

140 Nm

60 Nm

8 mm

M20 x 1.5

170 Nm

80 Nm

10 mm

M22 x 1.5

210 Nm

80 Nm

10 mm

M26 x 1.5

230 Nm

120 Nm

12 mm

M27 x 2

330 Nm

135 Nm

12 mm

M30 x 2

420 Nm

215 Nm

17 mm

M33 x 2

540 Nm

225 Nm

17 mm

M42 x 2

720 Nm

360 Nm

22 mm

G 1/4

40 Nm

Ports

DIN ISO 228 1) 2)

WAF hexagon socket of the threaded plugs

The tightening torques apply for screws in the "dry" state as received on delivery and in the "lightly oiled" state for installation. In the "lightly oiled" state, the MV is reduced to 10 Nm for M10 x 1 and 17 Nm for M12 x 1.5.

Bosch Rexroth AG Mobile Applications An den Kelterwiesen 14 Glockeraustrasse 4 72160 Horb, Germany 89275 Elchingen, Germany Tel.: +49-7451-92-0 Tel.: +49-7308-82-0 Fax: +49-7451-82-21 Fax: +49-7308-72-74 info.brm@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com/axial-piston-motors

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


117 Industrial Hydraulics

Electric Drives and Controls

Linear Motion and Assembly Technologies

Pneumatics

Service Automation

Fixed Displacement Motor A4FM

Mobile Hydraulics

RE 91 120/04.00 replaces: 03.95 and RE 91 100

for open and closed circuits

Sizes 22...500 Series 1, Series 3 Nominal pressure up to 400 bar Peak pressure up to 450 bar

Features

Index Features Ordering Code Technical Data Installation and Commissioning Guidelines Flow and Output Torque Unit Dimensions, Sizes 22, 28 Unit Dimensions, Size 40 Unit Dimensions, Size 56 Unit Dimensions, Size 71 Unit Dimensions, Size 125 Unit Dimensions, Size 250

1 2 3...5 4 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

– Axial Piston Fixed Displacement Motor A4FM of swashplate design is used in open and closed loop circuits for hydrostatic drives. – Output speed is proportional to input flow and inversely proportional to motor displacement. – Output torque increases with the pressure drop across the motor between the high and low pressure sides. – Long service life, optimum efficiencies – Compact design for special applications where A2FM cannot be applied – Proven rotary group in swashplate-technology


118 2/12

Bosch Rexroth AG | Mobile Hydraulics

A4FM | RE 91 120/04.00

Ordering Code A4F M Hydraulic fluid Mineral oil, HFD (no code) HFA, HFB, HFC-Hydraulic fluid (only sizes 71...500) Axial piston unit Swashplate design, fixed displacement

W –

E-

A4F

Mode of operation Motor Size Displacement Vg (cm3)

/

M

22

28

40

56

71 125 250 500

Series Sizes 22...56, 125...500 Size 71

3 1

Sizes 22...56 Sizes 71...500

2 0

alternating

W

Index

Direction of rotation Viewed on shaft end Seals

NBR (Nitril-caoutchouc), shaft sealing in FKM (Fluor-caoutchouc) FKM (Fluor-caoutchouc) Shaft end Splined shaft SAE Splined shaft SAE Splined shaft DIN 5480 Parallel with key DIN 6885

22

– –

Mounting flange SAE 2-hole ISO 4-hole ISO 8-hole

28

Sizes 22...56 Sizes 71...500 Sizes 71...500

40 – –

56 – –

– –

22

28

40

56

– –

– –

– –

– –

Service line connections Ports A, B: SAE at rear (with metric fixing screws) Ports A, B: SAE at side (on opposite sides) (with metric fixing screws) = available = available on enquiry – = not available

N P V

71 125 250 500 – – – – – – – –

71 125 250 500 – – – – – – – – 22...40

56

– –

S T Z P

C B H 71...500 01 02


119 RE 91 120/04.00 | A4FM

Mobile Hydraulics | Bosch Rexroth AG

3/12

Technical Data Fluid We request that before starting a project detailed information about the choice of pressure fluids and application conditions are taken from our catalogue sheets RE 90220 (mineral oil), RE 90221 (environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids) and RE 90223 (fire resistance fluids, HF). When using HF- or environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids possible limitations for the technical data have to be taken into consideration. If necessary please consult our technical department (please indicate type of the hydraulic fluid used for your application on the order sheet). The sizes 22..56 are not suitable for operation with HFA, HFB and HFC.

Notes on the selection of the hydraulic fluid In order to select the correct fluid, it is necessary to know the operating temperature in the loop (closed circuit) or the tank temperature (open circuit) in relation to the ambient temperature. 1 The hydraulic fluid should be selected so that within the operating temperature range, the operating viscosity lies within the optimum range (νopt) (see shaded section of the selection diagram). We recommend that the highest possible viscosity range should be chosen in each case. Example: At an ambient temperature of X°C the operating temperature is 60°C. Within the operating viscosity range (νopt; shaded area), this corresponds to viscosity ranges VG 46 or VG 68. VG 68 should be selected. Important: The leakage oil (case drain oil) temperature is influenced by pressure and motor speed and is always higher than the circuit temperature. However, at no point in the circuit may the temperature exceed 115°C for sizes 22...56 or 90°C for sizes 71...500. 2 If it is not possible to comply with the above condition because of extreme operating parameters or high ambient temperatures we recommend housing flushing. Please consult us.

Operation viscosity range In order to obtain optimum efficiency and service life, we recommend that the operating viscosity (at operating temperature) be selected from within the range: νopt = operating viscosity 16...36 mm2/s referred to the loop temperature (closed circuit) or tank temperature (open circuit).

Filtration The finer the filtration the better the achieved purity grade of the pressure fluid and the longer the life of the axial piston unit. To ensure the functioning of the axial piston unit a minimum purity grade of: 9 to NAS 1638 18/15 to ISO/DIS 4406 is necessary. At very high temperatures of the hydraulic fluid (90°C to max. 115°C, not permissible for sizes 71...500) at least cleanless class 3 8 to NAS 1638 17/14 to ISO/DIS 4406 is necessary. If above mentioned grades cannot be maintained please consult supplier.

Viscosity limits The limiting values for viscosity are as follows:

Size 22...56 νmin = 5 mm2/s, short term at a max. permissible temp. of tmax= 115°C νmax = 1600 mm2/s, short term on cold start (tmin = -40°C) Size 71...500 νmin = 10 mm2/s, short term at a max. permissible drain temp. tmax = 90°C νmax = 1000 mm2/s, short term on cold start (tmin = -25°C) Please note that the max. fluid temperature is also not exceeded in certain areas (for instance bearing area). At temperature of -25°C up to -40°C special measures may be required for certain installation positions, please contact us.

2500-40° 1600 1000 600 400

-20°

20°

40°

60°

80° 100°

1600

0 10 G V 68 G V 46 G V 32 G V 2 2

4

VG

viscosity ν in mm2/s

Selection diagram

200 100 60 40

36 νopt.

20

16

10

5 -40°

-25°

tmin = -40°C

-10° 0° 10°

30°

50°

fluid temperature range

70°

90°

5 115°

temperature t in °C tmax = +115°C


120 4/12

Bosch Rexroth AG | Mobile Hydraulics

A4FM | RE 91 120/04.00

Technical Data

Installation and Commissioning Guidelines valid for operation with mineral oils

Flushing of the bearings (Sizes 125...500) operating conditions, flushing quantities and notes on bearing flushing see RE 92 050 (A4VSO). Operating pressure range Maximum pressure at port A or B (Pressure data to DIN 24312) Size 22...56 71...500 Nominal pressure pN bar 400 1) 350 Peak pressure pmax bar 450 1) 400 1) Size 28 with S-shaft: 315/350 bar The summ of the pressures at ports A and B may not exceed 700 bar. Direction of flow clockwise rotation

anti-clockwise rotation

A to B

B to A

Symbol Size 22...56 A, B Service line ports T1, T2 Case drain (1 port plugged)

General At start-up and during operation the motor housing has imperatively to be filled up with hydraulic fluid (filling of the case chamber). Startup has to be carried out at low speed and without load till the system is completely bleeded. At a longer standstill the case may discharge via operating line. At new start-up a sufficient filling of the housing has to be granted. The leakage oil in the housing has to be discharged to the tank via highest positioned case drain port. Installation position - Sizes 22...56: Shaft horizontal or shaft down - Sizes 71 (series1): Shaft horizontal, vertical installation position as to agreement - Sizes 125...500: Optional, at vertical installation position bearing flushing is recommended at port U (as to RD 9205)

A

Installation below tank level Motor below min. oil level in the tank (standard) ➔ Fill up axial piston motor before start-up via highest positioned case drain port

Size 71...500 A, B Service line ports MA,MB Pressure gauge, working pressure T, R(L) Case drain, Air bleed (1port plugged) U Flushing port (Sizes71...500)

B B

T1 T2 MB

➔ Operate motor at low speed till motor system is completely filled up ➔ Minimum immerson depth of the drain line in the tank: 200mm (relative to the min. oil level in the tank).

T1

U M A

Case drain pressure pabs (bar)

A T R(L) Case drain pressure The max. permissible leakage pressure (housing pressure) is dependent on speed (see diagram). The pressure in the housing must be equal to or greater than the external pressure on the shaft sealing ring. Max. leakage pressure (housing pressure) pabs. max. _________________________ 6 bar (sizes 22...56) _________________________ 4 bar(sizes71...500) A leakage line to the tank is necessary.

6 Sizes 22, 28

5 Sizes 40, 56

T T1 T2 T2

T

Installation on top of tank level Motor on top of min. oil level in the tank ➔ Actions as installation below tank level ➔ Note: installation position "drive shaft up" for sizes 22...56 not permissible

Size 71

4

T

T1

Size 125

3 T1

Size 250

T2

2

T2

Size 500

1 0

1000

2000

3000

4000

5000

speed n (rpm)

T


121 RE 91 120/04.00 | A4FM

Mobile Hydraulics | Bosch Rexroth AG

5/12

Technical Data valid for operation with mineral oil

Table of values (theoretical values, without considering ηmh and ηv; values rounded)

Size

22

28

40

56

71

125

250

22

28

40

56

71

125

250

500

nmax continuous rpm

4250

4250

4000

3600

3200

2600

2200

1800

nmax interm.1)

rpm

5000

5000

5000

4500

Max. flow (at nmax)

qV max

L/min

93

119

160

202

227

325

550

900

Torque constants

TK

Nm/bar

0,35

0,445

0,64

0,89

1,13

1,99

3,97

7,95

Torque (at Δp = 400 bar)

Tmax

Nm

140

178

255

356

3952)

6962)

L

0,3

0,3

0,4

0,5

2,0

3,0

Displacement

Vg

Max. speed

cm3

Filling volume Moment of inertia about drive axis

kgm2

J

Actual starting torque at n = 0 rpm (Δp = 350 bar)

m

1)

1

13912) 27832) 7,0

11,0

0,0015 0,0015 0,0043 0,0085 0,0121 0,0300 0,0959 0,3325

Nm (approx.)

Weight (approx.)

500

kg

11

11

Intermittent max. speed at overspeed: Δp = 70…150 bar

2)

15

21

320

564

1127

34

61

120

2

Δp = 350 bar

Calculation of size Vg • n 1000 • ηv

Flow

qv =

Output speed

n=

Output torque

Vg • Δp • ηmh T= 20 • π

in L/min

qV • 1000 • ηV Vg in Nm

Vg Δp n ηv ηmh ηt

= = = = = =

geometric displacement per rev. in cm3 pressure differential in bar speed in rpm volumetric efficiency mech.-hyd. efficiency overall efficiency 3

= TK • Δp • ηmh Output power

P= =

T•n 9549

=

2π•T•n 60 000

in kW

qv • Δp• ηt 600

Output drive permissible axial and radial loading on drive shaft Size Distance of Fq

Fq

(from shaft shoulder) a, b, c Max. permissible radial force at distance a

b c Max. permissible axial load

Fax +

a

mm

22 17,5

28 17,5

40 17,5

56 17,5

b c Fq max Fq max

mm mm N N

30 42,5 2500 1400

30 42,5 2050 1150

30 42,5 3600 2890

30 42,5 5000 4046

Fq max N - Fax max N

1000 1557

830 1557

2416 2120

3398 2910

+ Fax max N

417

417

880

1490

Size Max. axial force at housing pressure pmax 1 bar abs. Max. axial force at housing pressure pmax 4 bar abs. Max. radial force

Fq

± Fax max N

71 1400

125 1900

250 3000

500 4000

X/2

+ Fax max N – Fax max N Fq max N

810 1990 1700

1050 2750 2500

1850 4150 4000

2500 5500 5000

± Fax X/2 X

4


122 Bosch Rexroth AG | Mobile Hydraulics

6/12

A4FM | RE 91 120/04.00

Flow and Drive Torque Size 500 400

400

1400

200

T

100

100

0

0 0

100

200

300

flow qV (L/min)

qV

drive torque T (Nm)

flow qV (L/min)

300

300

200

2800

n = 1000 rpm n = 1800 rpm

n = 1500 rpm n = 3200 rpm 1300

2600

1200

2400

1100

2200

1000

2000

900

1800

800

1600

350

Δ p (bar)

Size 125 700

700

600

600

500

500

400

400

drive torque T (Nm)

flow qV (L/min)

n = 1500 rpm n = 2600 rpm

300

300

qV

T

200

200

100

100

0

0 0

100

200

300

qV

700

T

1400

600

1200

500

1000

400

800

300

600

200

400

100

200

350

Δ p (bar) 0

1400

700

500

1000

qV 800

400

200

300

350

drive torque T (Nm)

1200

600

100

Δ p (bar)

n = 1500 rpm n = 2200 rpm

flow qV (L/min)

0

0

Size 250

600

300

T 200

400

100

200

0

0 0

100

200

300

350

Δ p (bar)

(Fluid: Hydraulic oil ISO VG 46 DIN 51519, t = 50°C)

drive torque T (Nm)

Size 71


123 RE 91 120/04.00 | A4FM

Mobile Hydraulics | Bosch Rexroth AG

7/12

Unit Dimensions, Size 22, 28 Before finalising your design, please request a certified drawing.

(SAE B)

1

B

A B, A

M8; 15 deep 2

Connections A, B Service line ports T1, T2 Leakage port / oil filling port

SAE 1/2" 420 bar (6000 psi) high pressure series M18x1,5; 12 deep

3

4

Splined shaft SAE 1" 30° pressure angle, 15 teeth, 16/32 pitch, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 ANSI B92.1a-1976

19 41,3

3/8-16UNC-2B

6

T ø55

25

ø17,7

5/16-18UNC-2B

ø55

Splined shaft SAE 7/8", 30° pressure angle, 13 teeth, 16/32 pitch, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 ANSI B92.1a-1976

38

33

S

30 7,5

22 46

ø20,8

Shaft ends


124 8/12

Bosch Rexroth AG | Mobile Hydraulics

A4FM | RE 91 120/04.00

Unit Dimensions, Size 40 Before finalising your design, please request a certified drawing.

T1

(SAE B)

B, A

T1

A

B

T2 T2

Connections A, B Service line ports T, T1, T2 Leakage port / oil filling port

Shaft ends

Z Splined shaft W 30x2x30x14x9g DIN 5480

M10; 17 deep

SAE 3/4" 420 bar (6000 psi) high pressure serie M18x1,5; 15 deep

T


125 RE 91 120/04.00 | A4FM

Mobile Hydraulics | Bosch Rexroth AG

9/12

Unit Dimensions, Size 56 Before finalising your design, please request a certified drawing.

155,4 12,7

213 181

82 7 18

1

61

T1

48

18 32 150

X 48

ø127 (SAE C)

T1

B; A T2

T2 205,4

61

2

View X 158 75

SAE 3/4" 420 bar (6000 psi) high pressure serie M 18x1,5 ; 12 deep

58

T

A

150

B

58

50,8

T, T1, T2 Leakage port / oil filling port

23,8

ø19

Connections A, B Service line ports

M10; 17 deep

3

T

4

Shaft ends

Z Splined shaft W 30x2x30x14x9g DIN 5480


126 10/12

Bosch Rexroth AG | Mobile Hydraulics

A4FM | RE 91 120/04.00

Unit Dimensions, Size 71 Before finalising your design, please request a certified drawing.

port plate 01

34

ø15

R(L) 83.5

MB

12h9

80

ø1

43

61

ø140h8

X

170 183

8

MA

83.5

132

170 176

T

263

port plate 01 View X

port plate 02

Y

B

ø25

View Y

A, B

B

MA A 224

M12; 17 deep

27.8

A M12; 17 deep

Y

to mounting flange267

27.8

87.5

57.2

37.5 37.5

ø25

87.5

MB

45°

45°

27.8

20

57.2

Connections A, B service line ports R (L) oil filling and bleed T oil drain (plugged) MA, MB measuring port for pressure (plugged)

Shaft end

Z Splined shaft W40x2x30x18x9g DIN 5480

45 37 9,5

M12

ø40k6 M12

28

,6

AS 12x8x68 DIN 6885

68 9,5

1,5

Parallel shaft with key

66 70 80

R1

P

28 55

SAE 1" (high pressure series) M27x2 M27x2 M14x1,5


127 RE 91 120/04.00 | A4FM

Mobile Hydraulics | Bosch Rexroth AG

11/12

Unit Dimensions, Size 125 Before finalising your design, please request a certified drawing.

102 ø20

port plate 01

36 29

R(L)

8

U 1

98.5

00

14h9

ø2

14

74

X

200 213

53.5

ø160h8

MB

MA 24

156

45°

45°

T

299

98.5

200 206 2

port plate 01 View X

port plate 02

ø32

View Y

A, B

41.5 41.5

B

MA A 261 to mounting flange 305

M14; 19 deep

31.8

A M14; 19 deep

Y Connections A, B service line ports R (L) T MA, MB U

1,5

Splined shaft

,5

36

54 45 12

Z W50x2x30x24x9g DIN 5480

ø50k6 M16

14x9x80 DIN 6885

80 12

Parallel shaft with key

78 82 92

R2

P

M16

Shaft end

oil filling and bleed oil drain (plugged) measuring port for pressure (plugged) Flushing port, flushing of the bearings (plugged)

36 64

31.8

102.5

ø32 66.7

102.5

MB

31.8

Y

B

3

66.7

SAE 1 1/4" (high pressure series) M33x2 M33x2 M14x1,5 M14x1,5

4


128 12/12

Bosch Rexroth AG | Mobile Hydraulics

A4FM | RE 91 120/04.00

Unit Dimensions, Size 250 Before finalising your design, please request a certified drawing.

8

129

R(L)

port plate 01

ø24

18h9

ø224h8

131

MB

0

ø28

91

64

X

45°

45°

MA T

30 203

124.5 260 268

378

port plate 01 View X

port plate 02

Y

B

36.5

View Y

B

ø38 79.4 132.5

MA

36.5

38 79.4

Y Connections A, B service line ports

385

R (L) T MA, MB U Shaft end

3

P

100 15

Splined shaft

R4

42 101 105 115 Bosch Rexroth AG Mobile Hydraulics Product Segment Axial Piston Units Elchingen Plant Glockeraustrasse 2 89275 Elchingen, Germany Telephone +49 (0) 73 08 82-0 Facsimile +49 (0) 73 08 72 74 info.brm-ak@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com/brm

SAE 1 1/2" (high pressure series) M42x2 M42x2 M14x1,5 M14x1,5

70 59 15

Z W60x2x30x28x9g DIN 5480

ø60m6 M20

Parallel shaft with key

oil filling and bleed oil drain (plugged) measuring port for pressure (plugged) Flushing port, flushing of the bearings (plugged)

M16; 21 deep

M20

333 to mounting flange

AS 18x11x100 DIN 6885

A

M16; 21 deep

A

50.5 50.5

A, B

132.5

MB

U

34.5 265 273

48 16

Horb Plant An den Kelterwiesen 14 72160 Horb, Germany Telephone +49 (0) 74 51 92-0 Facsimile +49 (0) 74 51 82 21

42 80

© 2003 by Bosch Rexroth AG, Mobile Hydraulics, 89275 Elchingen All rights reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced or stored, processed, duplicated or circulated using electronic systems, in any form or by any means, without the prior written authorization of Bosch Rexroth AG. In the event of contravention of the above provisions, the contravening party is obliged to pay compensation. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The given information does not release the user from the obligation of own judgement and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging.


129

RE 91172/02.12 Replaces: 11.10

Fixed displacement motor Axial piston design A10FM / A10FE

1/28

Data sheet

Series 52 Sizes 10 to 63 Nominal pressure 280 bar Maximum pressure 350 bar Open and closed circuit

A10FM 23...63

A10FE 10...45 (2-hole-flange)

Contents

A10FE 11...18 (8-hole-flange)

Features

Type code for standard program

2

Technical data

4

Dimensions A10FM sizes 23 to 63

8

– Fixed displacement motor in axial piston swashplate design for hydrostatic drives in open and closed circuit operation – The output speed is proportional to the inlet flow – The output torque increases with the pressure differential between the high and low pressure sides

Dimensions A10FE sizes 10 to 63

14

– For use in mobile and industrial applications

Flushing and boost pressure valve

24

– Long service life

Anti cavitation valve

24

– High permissible output speeds

Speed sensor

25

– Well proven A10-rotary group technology

Installation instructions

26

– High power to weight ratio – compact design

General instructions

28

– Plug-in version for space saving installation – Low noise level – Mechanical and hydraulic connections also acc. to SAE standards – Speed sensor optional – Integrated anti cavitation valve optional, i.e. for fan drives


130 2/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Ordering code for standard program A10F

M

01

02

/ 03

52 04

– 05

V 06

C 07

08

09

10

11

Axial piston unit 01 Swashplate design, fixed displacement, nominal pressure 280 bar, maximum pressure 350 bar

A10F

Operating mode 02 Motor, open and closed circuit

M

Size (NG) 03 Theoretical displacement see page 6

018 023 028 037 045 058 063

Series 04 Series 5, Index 2

Direction of rotation Viewed on drive shaft 05

52

clockwise

R1)

counter clockwise

L1)

bidirectional

W

Seals 06 FKM (Fluoro-rubber)

Drive shaft Splined shaft to ISO 3019-1 (SAE J744) 07 Splined shaft to ISO 3019-1 (SAE J744)

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end Mounting flange 08 SAE 2-hole

09

Ports for service lines SAE-flange ports A and B on side, same side Mounting bolts metric Threaded ports A and B,metric, on side, same side Ventile Without valves

10 With integrated flushing valve

With integrated anti cavitation valve

11

1)

Speed sensor Without speed sensor Prepared for speed sensor (for inductive speed sensor ID)

V 018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ❍

R

W

C

018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ❍

C

018 023 028 037 045 058 063 – ● ● ● ● ● ● 10N00 ❍

16N00

018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ❍

0

7

2

018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ❍

= available ❍ = on request – = not available Only necessary in conjunction with valve configuration „2“ (integrated anti cavitation valve)

D


131 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

3/28

Ordering code for standard program A10F

E

01

02

/ 03

52 04

V

05

06

07

08

09

10

11

Axial piston unit

1

01 Swashplate design, fixed displacement, nominal pressure 280 bar, maximum pressure 350 bar

A10F

Operating mode 02 Motor, open and closed circuit

E

Size (NG) 03 Theoretical displacement see page 6

010 011 014 016 018 023 028 037 045 058 063

Series 04 Series 5, Index 2

Direction of rotation Viewed on drive shaft 05

52

clockwise

R1)

counter clockwise

L1)

bidirectional

W

2

Seals 06 FKM (Fluoro-rubber)

Drive shaft Splined shaft to ISO 3019-1 (SAE J744) 07 Splined shaft to ISO 3019-1 (SAE J744)

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end Mounting flange SAE 2-hole

V 010 011 014 016 018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ❍

R

W

C

010 011 014 016 018 023 028 037 045 058 063 – – – – – – ● ● ● ● ●

C2)

08 Special 2-hole

F

Special 8-hole

H

09

Ports for service lines SAE-flange ports A and B, on side, same side mounting bolts metric Threaded ports A and B, metric, on side, same side Valves Without valves

10 With integrated flushing valve

With integrated anti cavitation valve Speed sensor Without speed sensor 11 Prepared for speed sensor

(for inductive speed sensor ID)

1) 2)

3

010 011 014 016 018 023 028 037 045 058 063 –

10N00

16N00

010 011 014 016 018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ❍

7

2

0

4

010 011 014 016 018 023 028 037 045 058 063 ●

= available ❍ = on request – = not available Only necessary in conjunction with valve configuration „2“ (integrated anti cavitation valve) R-shaft with C-flange on sizes 10 to 18 in preparation

D


132 4/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Technical data Fluids

Notes on the selection of the hydraulic fluid

Prior to project design, please see our technical data sheets RE 90220 (mineral oil) and RE 90221 (environmentally acceptable fluis) for detailed information on fluids and operating conditions.

In order to select the correct fluid, it is necessary to know the operating temperature in the tank (open circuit) in relation to the ambient temperature.

For operation on environmentally acceptable fluids please consult us (when ordering, please state in clear text the fluid to be used). Operating viscosity range To achieve optimum values for efficiency and service life we recommend an operation viscosity (at operating temperature) within the range,

The fluid should be selected so that witin the operating temperature range, the viscosity lies within the optimum range (Qopt), see shaded section of the selection diagram. We recommend to select the higher viscosity grade in each case. Example: at an ambient temperature of X °C the operating temperature in the tank is 60 °C. In the optimum viscosity range (Qopt; shaded area) this corresponds to viscosity grades VG 46 resp. VG 68; VG 68 should be selected. Important: The leakage oil (case drain oil) temperature is influenced by pressure and input speed and is always higher than the tank temperature. However, at no point of the component may the temperature exceed 115 °C.

Qopt = opt. operating viscosity 16 ... 36 mm2/s referred to the tank temperature (open circuit). Limit of viscosity range

If it is not possible to comply with the above conditions because of extreme operating parameters please consult us.

For critical operation conditions the following values apply: mm2/s

Qmin = 5 (closed circuit) 10 mm2/s (open circuit) for short periods (t d 1 min) at a max. perm. temperature of 115 °C.

Filtration of the hydraulic fluid

Please note that the max. leakage fluid temperature of 115 °C is also not exceeded in certain areas (for instance bearing area).The fluid temperature in the bearing area is approx. 5 K higher than the average leakage fluid temperature 1600 mm2/s for short periods (t d 1 min) on cold start (tmin = p d 30 bar, n d 1000 min–1, –25 °C).

Qmax =

For detailed information on operation with low temperatures see data sheet RE 90300-03-B. Selection diagram -20

20

40

60

80

100

1600

0 10 VG 68 VG 6 4 VG 32 VG 2 2

VG

200

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

0

100 60 40

36 ν opt.

20

16

10

5 -40

-25

t min = -40 °C

-10

0 10

30

50

70

90

To ensure the functional reliability of the axial piston unit, a gravimetric evaluation is necessary for the hydraulic fluid to determine the amount of contamination by solid matter and to determine the cleanliness level according to ISO 4406. A cleanliness level of at least 20/18/15 to ISO 4406 is to be maintained. If above requirements cannot be maintained please consult us.

At temperatures between -40 °C and -25 °C special measures are required, please consult us for further information.

2500-40 1600 1000 600 400

Filtration improves the cleanliness level of the hydraulic fluid, which, in turn, increases the service life of the axial piston unit.

5 115

Temperature t [°C] t max = +115 °C Fluid temperature range


133 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

5/28

Technical data Operating pressure range

Definitions

Pressure at service line port (pressure port) A or B

Nominal pressure pnom The nominal pressure corresponds to the maximum design pressure.

Nominal pressure pnom _________________ 280 bar absolute Maximum pressure pmax _______________ 350 bar absolute Single operating period ___________________________ 2,5 ms Total operating period _____________________________ 300 h Minimum pressure (high pressure side) _________ 10 bar2) max

_____________ 16000 bar/s

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Minimum pressure at the high pressure side (A or B) which is required in order to prevent damage to the axial piston unit.

pnom 't

Rate of pressure change RA Maximum permissible rate of pressure rise and pressure reduction during a pressure change, over the entire pressure range.

'p

Time t

Pressure p

Pressure p

Rate of pressure change RA

1 Maximum pressure pmax The maximum pressure corresponds to the maximum operating pressure within the single operating period. The sum of the single operating periods must not exceed the total operating period.

Single operating period

t1

t2

tn 2

Maximum pressure pmax Nominal pressure pnom

Outlet pressure at nmax Minimum pressure at low pressure side pabs max ________18 bar Minimum pressure (high pressure side)

Case drain pressure Maximum permissible case drain pressure (at port L, L1): pmax abs motor operation in open circuit _____________ 4 bar abs pmax abs motor operation in closed circuit ___________ 4 bar abs pmax abs pump/motor operation in open circuit _______ 2 bar abs

Time t Total operating period = t1 + t2 + ... + tn 3 1) Other 2)

values on request

Lower pressures time dependent, please consult us.

Direction of flow viewed on drive shaft clockwise rotation

counter clockwise rotation

A to B

B to A

4


134 6/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Technical data Table of values (theoretical values, without efficiency and tolerances: valuea rounded) Size

NG

010

011

014

016

018

023

Displacement

Vg max

cm3

10.6

11.5

14.1

16.1

18

23.5

nnom

rpm

5000

4200

4200

4200

4200

4900

qv max

L/min

53

48

59

68

76

115

Pmax

kW

24.7

22.5

27.6

31.6

35.3

53.6

Nm

37.5

30

45

53

67.5

75 105

Speed 1) at Vg max Input flow at nnom Power at nnom, 'p = 280 bar Actual starting torque at n= 0 rpm, 'p = 280 bar Torque at Vg max Torsional stiffness

'p = 280 bar

Tmax

Nm

47

51

63

72

80

R

c

Nm/rad

14835

28478

Drive shaft

W

c

Nm/rad

C

18662

c

Nm/rad

15084

18662

18662

18662

30017

Moment of inertia rotary group

JTW

kgm2

0.0006

0.00093 0.00093

0.00093

0.00093

0.0017

Maximum angular acceleration

D

rad/s2

8000

6800

6800

6800

6800

5500

Case volume

V

L

0.1

0.15

0.15

0.15

0.15

0.6

Weight approx.

m

kg

5

6.5

6.5

6.5

6.5

12

Size

NG

028

037

045

058

063

Displacement

Vg max

cm3

28.5

36.7

44.5

58

63.1

nnom

rpm

4700

4200

4000

3600

3400

qv max

L/min

134

154

178

209

215

Pmax

kW

62.5

71.8

83.1

97.4

100.1

Nm

105

125

170

205

230 281

Speed 1) at Vg max Input flow at nnom Power at nnom , 'p = 280 bar Actual starting torque at n= 0 min-1 , 'p = 280 bar Torque at Vg max Torsional stiffness

'p = 280 bar

Tmax

Nm

127

163

198

258

R

c

Nm/rad

28478

46859

46859

80590

80590

Drive shaft

W

c

Nm/rad

38489

38489

60907

60907

C

87667

c

Nm/rad

30017

46546

46546

87667

Moment of inertia rotary group

JTW

kgm2

0.0017

0.0033

0.0033

0.0056

0.0056

Maximum angular acceleration

D

rad/s2

5500

4000

4000

3300

3300

Case volume

V

L

0.6

0.7

0.7

0.8

0.8

Weight approx.

m

kg

12

17

17

22

22

1)

for maximum speed an outlet pressure (in low pressure side) of 18 bar is required (see diagram on page 7)

Note Operation above the maximum values or below the minimum values may result in a loss of function, a reduced service life or in the destruction of the axial piston unit. We recommend testing the loads by means of experiment or calculation / simulation and comparison with the permissible values.


135 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

7/28

Technical data Permissible motor speed in relation to outlet pressure Motor speed n/nmax

1,0 1

0,95 0,9 0,85 0,8

0

2

4

6

8

10 12 14 16 18

Outlet pressure pND [bar] Determination of motor size (NG) Input flow

qv =

Vg • n

[L/min]

1000 • Kv Torque

T = 1,59 • Vg • 'p • Kmh

[Nm]

100 or

T =

Tk • 'p • Kmh

Power

P =

2S•T•n 60000

Output

=

qv • 'p • Kt 600

qv • 1000 • Kv

n =

speed

[kW]

Vg

= Displacement per revolution in cm3

'p

= Differential pressure in bar

n

= Speed in rpm

Kv

= Volumetric efficiency

Kmh

= Mechanical-hydraulic efficiency

Kt

= Overall efficiency (Kt = Kv • Kmh)

Tk

= Torque constant

2

[rpm]

Vg

Permissible radial and axial forces on the drive shaft Size

3

NG

Max. radial force at X/2

Drive shaft R; W

10

11

14

16

18

23

N

250

350

350

350

350

1200

± Fax max N

400

700

700

700

700

1000

NG

28

37

45

58

63

N

1200

1500

1500

1700

1700

± Fax max N

1000

1500

1500

2000

2000

Drive shaft C Fq

Fq

Fq max X/2 X/2

X/2

X/2 X

X

Maximum axial force r Fax

4 Size Max. radial force at X/2

Drive shaft R; W

Drive shafte C Fq

Fq

Fq max X/2 X/2 X

X/2

X/2 X

Maximum axial force r Fax


136 8/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FM size 23 - 28 A10FM 23-28/52W-VxCxxN000 Port plate 10

64 61.5

150.8 30 23.8

67.5 ø14

144

146

37.5

ø101.6

L1

174

A

50.8 37.5

0 - 0.054

Flange ISO 3019-1

9.5 6.3

L1

L L

66

B

ø19

12.5 80 178.8

45°

Port plate 16 64 61.5

150.8 30

84 82.5 ø14

144

146

L1

174

31

ø42

A

31

0

ø101.6 - 0.054

Flange ISO 3019-1

9.5 6.3

L1

L

178.8

L 66

B

12.5 80

45°


137 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

9/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Maße in mm.

Dimensions A10FM size 23 - 28 Drive shafts Splined shaft 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 22-4(B))

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 22-3(B)) Taper 125 : 1000

1

25 41

25.4

View A-B 6.35 +0.025

22

6.35 +0.025

A

ø4

3.2 +0.1

2.2

+0.006

ø22.22

5

(ø19.024)

16

ø21.774 -0.006

Usable spline lenght

C

5/8-18UNF-2A

1/4-20UNC-2B2)

R

B 3 -0.2 14.4 19 55.5

2

Ports Standard

Size2)

Designation

Port for

A, B

Service line (high pressure series) SAE J518

3/4 in

Port plate 10 A, B Port plate 16 L

Mounting bolts

DIN 13

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

Service line

DIN 3852

L1

Max. pressure State [bar]3) 350 O

M27 x 2; 16 deep

350

O

Case drain

ISO

119265)

3/4-16 UNF-2B; 11 deep

4

O4)

Case drain

ISO 119265)

3/4-16 UNF-2B; 11 deep

4

X4)

1)

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) The counterbore can be deeper than stipulated in the standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


138 10/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FM size 37 - 45 A10FM 37-45/52W-VxCxxN000 Port plate 10

69 66

163 9.5 6.3

28

78 ø14

A

23,8

144

37.5

ø101.6

L1

174 146

50.8 37.5

0 - 0.054

Flange ISO 3019-1

L1

L

L

69

ø19

12.5 84

B

45°

193 125 Port plate16 69 66

163 28

ø42 144

34

L1

34

ø101.6 - 00.054

81 79.5 ø14 20

A

Flange ISO 3019-1

174 146 141

9.5 6.3

L1

L

L B 69

12.5 84 193

45° 125


139 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

11/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FM size 37 - 45 Drive shafts Splined shaft 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 25-4(B-B))

R

W

Splined shaft 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 22-4(B))

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 22-3(B))

C

29.5

Usable spline lenght

41

28.6

A

Section A-B 6.35 +0.025 3.2 +0.1

3.2

1

6.35 +0.025

ø21.41

25

45.9

Taper 125 : 1000 M16x1.5

5

ø25.4

5

16

ø25.16 +0.006 –0.006

Usable spline lenght

16

1/4-20UNC-2B2)

1/4-20UNC-2B2)

9.5 6.3

B 3-0.2 18

30 52.9 60.6

2

Ports Standard

Size2)

Designation

Port for

Max. pressure State [bar]3) 350 O

A, B

Service line (high pressure series) SAE J518

3/4 in

Port plate 10 A, B Port plate 16 L

Mounting bolts

DIN 13

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

Service line

DIN 3852-1

M27 x 2; 16 deep

350

O

Case drain

ISO

119265)

7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

4

X4)

1)

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) The counterbore can be deeper than stipulated in the standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


140 12/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FM size 58 - 63 A10FM 58-63/52W-VxCxxN000 Port plate 10

78 74.5

182.5 36

A

23.8

101 ø14 17

M10

9.5 7.8

145

37.5

0

L1

174 146

50.8 37.5

ø101.6 - 0.054

Flange ISO 3019-1

L1

L

L

76

ø19

B

.5

12.5 97.5 207.5

45°

Port plate 16 78 74.5

182.5 9.5 7.8

36

A

104 102 ø14

1 20

ø42 ø48 174 146

37.5

L1

37.5

ø101.6 - 00.054

Flange ISO 3019-1

L1

L

B

L .5

76

12.5 97.5 207.5

45°


141 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

13/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10FM size 58 - 63 Drive shafts Drive shaft 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 25-4(B-B))

40

Usable spline lenght

28

55.4

45.9

3.2

28.6

A

1 Section A-B 7.94 +0.025 3.2 +0.1

5

Taper 125 : 1000

7.94 +0.025

ø27.36

6

9.5 7.8

16 1-12UNF-2A

19

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 32-3(C))

C

ø31.51 +0.006 –0.006

5/16-18UNC-2B2) Usable spline lenght

W

1/4-20UNC-2B2)

Drive shaft 1 1/4 in 14T 12/24DP1) (SAE J744; 32-4(C))

R

B 3-0.2

30 23,6 58.5 66.4

2

Ports Standard

Size2)

Designation

Port for

A, B

Service line (high pressure series) SAE J518

3/4 in

Port plate 10 A, B Port plate 16

Mounting bolts

DIN 13

M10 x 1.5; 17deep

Service line

DIN 3852-1

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

M27 x 2; 16 deep 7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep 7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

Max. press. [bar]3) 350

State

350

O

4

O4)

4

X4)

O

1)

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) The counterbore can be deeper than stipulated in the standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 2)

3

4


142 14/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10FE size 10 A10FE 10/52W-VxC16N000

55.5 34

0

ø11

27

Y ø10 0

ø78

134 106.4

ø82.55 - 0.054

Flange ISO 3019-1

L 10

100

7.6 20

A

B

A

00

13

ø1

30

30

48.5

50

17

30°

48.5

85

B

L


143 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

15/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FE size 10 Drive shaft Tapered shaft with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 22-3(B))

C

24 3-0.2

1 2.2

22

25.4

A

Section A-B

B

6.35

ø4 14.4

3.2

ø19.024 ø21.774 +0.006 - 0.006 ø21.91

5/8-18UNF-2A

139

125:1000

2

Ports Designation

Port for

Standard

Size2)

A, B

Service line

DIN 3852-1

M18 x 1.5; 17 deep

Max. pressu- State re [bar]3) 350 O

L

Case drain

DIN 3852-1

M14 x 1.5; 13 deep

4

O4)

1)

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 3

4


144 16/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FE size 11 - 18 A10FE 11-18/52W-Vxx16N000 143.5

Mounting flange H Special flange

ø6.6

28

30° M14x1.5

10

95 6.4

30°

L 4

A

18

B

48.5 15 12

30°

x1.

5

1 1 2 47 8.5

ø122

ø95 ø100 h6

M

° 45 22.5

° ø112

34 32

A

B

153

174 146

12.5

97.5 9.5

30.5

24

Y

ø122

ø101.6

0 - 0.054

30° ø95

L 151.8

34

A ø14

B

48.5

17

A

50

30

ø1 00

13

48.5

L

30

Mounting flange C flange to ISO 3019-1

L B 207.3


145 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

17/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10FE size 11 - 18 Drive shafts R5) Splined shaft 3/4 in 11T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 19-4(A-B))

C

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 22-3(B))

A1

Usable spline lenght

21

3-0.2

2.2

22

25.4

A

Section A-B 6.35

B ø4 14.4

3.2

ø19.024

14

1

Taper : 1000 A125 2 5/8-18UNF-2A

5 ø21.774 –+0.006 0.006 ø21.91

1/4-20UNC-2B

A1

125:1000

Mounting flange

A1

Mounting flange

A1

A2

H

126,6

H

144.2

19

C

C

151.8

24

2

Ports Designation

Port for

Standard

Size2)

A, B

Service line

DIN 3852-1

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

L

Case drain

DIN 3852-1

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

DIN 3852-1

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

4

X4)

Max. pressu- State re [bar]3) 350 O

1)

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) R-shaft with C-flange for size 10 resp. 11 to 18 in preparation. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 2)

3)

3

4


146 18/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10FE size 23 - 28 A10FE 23-28/52W-VxFxxN000

Port plate 10

76 148 76.7 12.5

81

62.5 23.8

67.5 ø14

A

B

22 104.7

L

L1

73

144

184 160

37.5

0

ø135 - 0.063 ø116 ø66

50.8 37.5

40°

ø19 12.7 82

125

Y

73

Y 3.4

1.9

5

Port plate 16

84 82.5

76 148

81

67

76.7

ø14

A

16

L

B

12.5

73

22 104.7

73

144

125

160

184

L1

31

31

0

ø135 - 0.063 ø116 ø66

ø42

Y


147 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

19/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10FE size 23 - 28 Drive shafts

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 22-3(B))

Usable 16 spline lenght 25

ø21.774 +0.006 – 0.006 ø22.22

1/4-20UNC-2B

5

129.6 19 3-0.2

1

25.4

2.2

22

A

Section A-B 6.35

B ø4 14.4

3.2

C

ø19.024

Drive shaft 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 22-4(B))

5/8-18UNF-2A

R

Taper 125 : 1000

81 115.1

2

Ports Standard

Size2)

Designation

Port for

Max. pressure [bar]3) 350

State

A, B

Service line (high pressure series) SAE J518

3/4 in

Port plate 10 A, B Port plate 16 L

Mounting bolts

DIN 13

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

Service line

DIN 3852-1

Case drain

ISO

119265)

M27 x 2; 16 deep

350

O

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

3/4-16 UNF-2B; 11 deep

4

O4)

3/4-16 UNF-2B; 11 deep

4

X4)

O

1)

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) The counterbore can be deeper than stipulated in the standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


148 20/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10FE size 37 - 45 A10FE 37-45/52W-VxFxxN000 Port plate 10

76.3

78 148

88

67

81.9

ø14

A

23.8

20 144

37.5

L1

184 160 141

50.8 37.5

0

40°

ø135 - 0.063 ø130 ø70

Y

L1

L

L

ø19 12.7

B

14 28 112

73

73

Y 3.4

1.9

5

Port plate 16

14 88

81 79.5

68.5

81.9

Ø14

A

Y

20 144

184 160

34

0

34

ø135 - 0.063 ø130 ø70

40° L

B

12.7 28

112

71

73 145


149 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

21/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FE size 37 - 45 Drive shafts

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 25-3(B-B)) 142 18 3-0.2

3.2

30

M16x1.5

Section A-B 6.35 +0.025

Taper 125 : 1000

3.2 +0.1

6.35 +0.025

B

ø25.16

127

1 28.6

A

+0.006 –0.006

ø25.4

5

Usable 16 spline lenght 29.5

Splined shaft 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 22-4(B))

1/4-20UNC-2B

W

C

ø21.41

Splined shaft 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 25-4(B-B))

1/4-20UNC-2B

R

2

5

Usable 16 spline lenght 25

122

3

Ports Port for

A, B

Service line (high pressure range) SAE J518

3/4 in

Port plate 10 A, B Port plate 16 L

Mounting bolts

DIN 13

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

Service line

DIN 3852-1

Case drain

ISO

119265)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

1)

Standard

Size2)

Designation

Max. pressure [bar]3) 350

State

M27 x 2; 16 deep

350

O

7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

4

O4)

7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

4

X4)

O

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) The counterbore can be deeper than stipulated in the standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


150 22/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FE size 58 - 63 A10FE 58-63/52W-VxFxxN000 Port plate 10 90.1

18

100.2

101 23.8

Y

A L1

145

50.8 37.5 Ø19 29.8

70.5

37.5

Ø160 - 00.063 Ø153.7 -0.2 Ø125 Ø80

235 200

19°

70.5

45°

L

B 48

125.2

Ø17 48 170

View Y 2:1 15.5

0

Port plate 16 90.1

10

( 153.7) - 0.1

0.5x45° 5.2 +0.2

18

100.2

104 102

1 20

A

Y

L1

45°

ø42 ø48

70.5 235 200

70.5

37.5

Ø160 - 00.063 Ø153.7 -0.2 Ø125 Ø80

37.5

19°

L

B 29.8

125.2

48

Ø17 48 170


151 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

23/28

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions A10FE size 58 - 63 Drive shafts

1

Taper 125 : 1000

3.2 28.6 Ă˜4 A

Section A-B 14.1 3 -0.2

30

23.6 34.9

7.94 +0.025 3.54 -0.1

B

148.7 137.7

Splined shaft 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744; 25-4(B-B))

1/4-20UNC-2B

W

Tapered with woodruff key and threaded end (SAE J744; 32-3(C))

7.94+0.025

6

Usable 19 spline lenght 40

C

( 27.385) ( 27.76) 31.51 +0.006 -0.006 1-12UNF-2A

Splined shaft 1 1/4 in 14T 12/24DP1) (SAE J744; 32-4(C))

5/16-18UNC-2B

R

2

5

Usable 16 spline lenght 28

128.2

3

Ports Port for

A, B

Service line (high pressure range) SAE J518

3/4 in

Port plate 10 A, B Port plate 16 L

Mounting bolts

DIN 13

M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

Service line

DIN 3852-1

Case drain

ISO

119265)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

1)

Standard

Size2)

Designation

Max. pressure [bar]3) 350

State

M27 x 2; 16 deep

350

O

7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

4

O4)

7/8-14 UNF-2B; 13 deep

4

X4)

O

ANSI B92.1a-1996, 30° pressure angle, flat base, flank centering, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instructions on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Pressure data in bar absolut. 4) Depending on the installation position, L or L must be connected (see also page 26 - 27). 1 5) The counterbore can be deeper than stipulated in the standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


152 24/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Before finalising your design request a certified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Flushing and boost pressure valve Ordering Option N007

Standard flushing flow

This valve assembly is used to flush an unacceptable heat load out of the closed loop circuit, and to maintain the necessary minimum boost pressure (16 bar, fixed setting). The valve is integrated into the port plate.

With low press. side pND = 20 bar and an orifice dia. 1,6 mm: 5,5 L/min (sizes 23 - 63). Other orifice diameters are available, please state in clear text.

A built-in fixed orifice determines the flushing flow, which is taken out of the low pressure side of the loop and directed into the motor housing. It leaves the housing together with the case drain flow. This combined flow is replenished with fresh oil by means of the boost pump.

Further flushing flows for sizes 23 - 63 see table: Flushing flow [L/min]

Orifice ø [mm]

3.5

1.2

5.5

1.6

9

2

Schematic

Dimensions A10FM / A10FE

L

Port plate 10

Port plate16

A

A

A1

A1

A1

A1

A

B

B

B A2

L1

L

L1

Port for A; B

Service line

L, L1

Case drain (L1 plugged)

Size (NG)

A1

A2

23/28

72

72

37/45

77

77

58/63

77

82

Anti cavitation valve Ordering option N002

Schematic

When stopping a system with a relatively large mass (i.e. fan drive) the anti-cavitation valve provides fluid to the motor inlet during the coasting time.

Counter clockwise rotation

Clockwise rotation

L

The valve assembly is integrated inside the port plate.

Important

L A

A

B

B

It is necessary to specify a direction of rotation (clockwise or counter clockwise) looking at the shaft end of the motor. The outside dimensions are identical to the standard units except the A10FE 11 - 18 with the 8-hole mounting flange, for the difference in lenght see unit dimensions.

L1 Port for A; B

Service line

L, L1

Case drain (L1 plugged)

L1


153 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

25/28

Speed sensor Ordering option D

Schematic

The version A10FM...D comprises gearing around the rotary unit (prepared for speed pickup).

DL

In this case, the rotating cylinder barrel can provide a speed dependent signal, which can be picked up by a suitable sensor and processed for further evaluation. Sensor port (D) will be closed for delivery.

1

A

A motor, prepared for speed sensing will be delivered without the necessary accessory parts which must be ordered separately.

B

Inductive speed sensor ID R 18/20-L250 (see RE 95130) and mounting parts (spacer and 2 seals per kit) can be ordered separately with the following part numbers:

L1

Size (NG)

Ordering Nr.

Nr. of teeth

23/28

R902428802

48

37/45

R902433368

48

A; B

Service line

58/63

in preparation

9

L, L1

Case drain (L1 plugged)

Port for 2

Dimensions

A3

A10FM....D

D

A1

A2

A3

A1

A2

Size (NG)

Port „D“ (plugged)

23/28

61

15.5

101.8

M18 x 1.5

37/45

66

17

84.2

M18 x 1.5

58/63

69

14.8

128.5

M18 x 1.5

A1

A2

A3

Port „D“ (plugged)

3

A10FE.....D

A2 A1

Size (NG)

A3

D

23/28

61

15.5

27.7

M18 x 1.5

37/45

66

17

33.9

M18 x 1.5

58/63

69

14.8

46.1

M18 x 1.5 4


154 26/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

Installation instructions General At all times, the axial piston unit must be filled with fluid and air bled during commissioning and operation. This must also be observed after a prolonged period of standstill as the system may drain back to the reservoir via the hydraulic lines. The case drain fluid in the motor housing must be directed to tank via the highest available tank port and must drain the fluid below the minimum fluid level in the reservoir.

Installation position See following examples 1 to 8. Recommended installation positions: 1 and 3 resp. 2 and 4. Additional installation positions are available on request. Below reservoir installation (standard) Below reservoir installation means, that the motor is mounted below the minimum fluid level.

1

Above reservoir installation Above reservoir installation means, that the motor is mounted above the minimum fluid level. A check valve in the case drain line is only permissible under certain conditions; please consult us.

2

5 SB

SB L1

6

F L1

L1 F

L1

L

L

A/B

L

L

A/B

A/B

A/B SB

3

4

7

8 F

SB

L

A/B

F

L

SB

A/B

L

A/B

A/B

L

L1

SB

L1

L1

SB

L1

SB

Install. position

Air bleed

Filling

Install. position

Air bleed

Filling

1, 2

–

L1

5, 6

F

L1 (F)

3, 4

–

L

7, 8

F

L (F)

L/L1 = Case drain port, F = Air bleed resp. filling port, , SB = Baffle.


155 RE 91172/02.12 | A10FM / A10FE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

27/28

Notes

1

2

3

4


156 28/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10FM / A10FE Series 52 | RE 91172/02.12

General instructions – The motor A10FM and A10FE has been designed to be used in open and closed circuits. – Project planning, assembly and commissioning of the axial piston unit require the involvement of qualified personnel. – Before operating the axial piston unit read the relevant operating manual thoroughly and completely. If needed request this information from Rexroth – During and shortly after operation, there is a risk of burns on the axial piston unit and especially on the solenoids. Take appropriate safety measures (e.g. by wearing protective clothing). - Pressure ports: The ports and fastening threads are designed for the specified maximum pressure. The machine or system manufacturer must ensure that the connecting elements and lines correspond to the specified operating conditions (pressure, flow, hydraulic fluid, temperature) with the necessary safety factors. – The service line ports and function ports are only designed to accommodate hydraulic lines. – The data and notes contained herein must be adhered to. – The product is not approved as a component for the safety concept of a general machine according to DIN 13849. – The following tightening torques apply: - Fittings: Observe the manufacturer‘s instructions regarding the tightening torques of the fittings used. - Mounting bolts: For fixing screws with metric ISO thread according to DIN 13 or thread according to ASME B1.1, we recommend checking the tightening torque individually according to VDI 2230. - Mounting bolts threads and threaded ports in the axial piston unit: The maximum permissible tightening torques MG max are maximum values for the female threads and must not be exceeded. For values, see the following table. - Threaded plugs: For the threaded plugs, supplied with the axial piston unit, the required tightening torques MV apply. For values, see the following table. Ports Standard DIN 3852

ISO 11926

1)

Thread sizes

Maximum permissible tightening torque for the female threads MG max

Required tightening torque for the threaded plugs MV

WAF hexagon socket of the threaded plugs

M14 x 1.5

80 Nm

35 Nm1)

6 mm

M18 x 1.5

140 Nm

60 Nm1)

8 mm

M27 x 2

330 Nm

135 Nm1)

12 mm

3/4-16 UNF-2B 160 Nm

62 Nm

5/16 in

7/8-14 UNF-2B 240 Nm

110 Nm

3/8 in

The tightening torques apply for screws in the “dry” state as received on delivery and in the “lightly oiled” state for installation.

Bosch Rexroth AG Axial Piston Units An den Kelterwiesen 14 72160 Horb a.N., Germany Telephone +49 (0) 74 51 92-0 Fax +49 (0) 74 51 82 21 info.brm-ak@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com/axial-piston-motor

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


157

RE 91604/06.12 Replaces: 07.09

Axial Piston Variable Motor A6VM

1/80

Data sheet

Series 63 Size Nominal pressure 28 to 200 400 bar/450 bar 250 to 1000 350 bar/400 bar Open and closed circuits

Contents Ordering code for standard program Technical data

Features 2 5

HD – Proportional control hydraulic

10

EP – Proportional control electric

14

HZ – Two-point control hydraulic

18

EZ – Two-point control electric

19

– Variable motor with axial tapered piston rotary group of bentaxis design, for hydrostatic drives in open and closed circuits – For use in mobile and stationary applications – The wide control range enables the variable motor to satisfy the requirement for high speed and high torque. – The displacement can be infinitely changed from Vg max to Vg min = 0.

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related

21

DA – Automatic control speed-related

27

Electric travel direction valve (for DA, HA.R)

29

Dimensions 28 to 1000

30

– The output torque increases with the pressure differential between the high-pressure and low-pressure side and with increasing displacement.

Connector for solenoids

70

– Wide control range with hydrostatic transmissions

Flushing and boost pressure valve

71

– Wide selection of control devices

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

73

– Cost savings through elimination of gear shifts and possibility of using smaller pumps

Swivel angle indicator

77

Speed sensors

78

Installation instructions

79

General instructions

80

– The output speed is dependent on the flow of the pump and the displacement of the motor.

– Compact, robust motor with long service life – High power density – Good starting characteristics – Small swing torque


158 2/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Ordering code for standard program A6V 01

02

M 03

04

/ 63 W 05

06

07

08

09

– V

10

11

12

– 13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

Hydraulic fluid Mineral oil and HFD. HFD for sizes 250 to 1000 only in combination with long-life bearings "L" (without code) 01 HFB, HFC hydraulic fluid

Sizes 28 to 200 (without code) Sizes 250 to 1000 (only in combination with long-life bearings "L")

E

Axial piston unit 02 Bent-axis design, variable

03

A6V

Drive shaft bearing Standard bearing (without code)

28...200 250 355 500 1000 ● ● ● ● –

Long-life bearing

L

Operating mode 04 Motor (plug-in motor A6VE, see RE 91606)

M

Sizes (NG) 05 Geometric displacement, see table of values on page 8

Control devices Proportional control hydraulic

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000

'p = 10 bar ●

'p = 25 bar ●

HD2

'p = 35 bar –

HD3

HZ

HZ1

Two-point control hydraulic

HZ3

12 V

EP1

24 V

EP2

12 V

EZ1

24 V

EZ2

12 V

EZ3

24 V Automatic control high-pressure related with minimum pressure increase 'p d approx. 10 bar with pressure increase 'p = 100 bar

EZ4

HA1

HA2

DA DA1

Proportional control electric Two-point control electric

06

Automatic control speed-related pSt/pHD = 3/100 pSt/pHD = 5/100

hydraulic travel direction valve

pSt/pHD = 8/100

DA2

24 V

DA3

DA4

12 V

DA5

24 V

DA6

hydraulic travel direction valve electric travel direction valve + electric Vg max-circuit

Pressure control (only for HD, EP) Without pressure control (without code) Pressure control fixed setting

= Available 1)

● 12 V

hydraulic travel direction valve electric travel direction valve + electric Vg max-circuit

07

HD1

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ●

hydraulic override, two-point

1)

1)

1)

1)

E

hydraulic remote control, proportional

G

❍ = On request

▲ = Not for new projects

Fitted as standard with version D (sizes 250 to 1000)

– = Not available

= Preferred program

D


159 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

3/80

Ordering code for standard program A6V 01

08

02

M 03

04

/ 63 W 05

06

07

08

09

– V

10

11

12

– 13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

Overrides for controls HA1 and HA2 Without override (without code)

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ●

Hydraulic override, remote control, proportional Electric override, two-point

T

Electric override + electric travel direction valve

1

12 V

U1

24 V

U2

12 V

R1

24 V

R2

Series 09 Series 6, index 3

63

Direction of rotation 10 Viewed on drive shaft, bidirectional

W

displacement2)

Setting ranges for Vg min = 0 to 0.7 Vg max (without code) 11 Vg min = 0 to 0.4 Vg max

Vg min > 0.4 Vg max to 0.8 Vg max

2

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● – – – –

Vg max = Vg max to 0.8 Vg max

1

Vg max = Vg max to 0.8 Vg max

2

Seals 12 FKM (fluor-caoutchouc)

V

Drive shafts Splined shaft DIN 5480

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ● ● ● ● – ● ● – – – –

13

Parallel keyed shaft DIN 6885

14

Mounting flanges ISO 3019-2

8-hole Port plates for service lines3) SAE flange ports A and B at rear

01 02 15

15 SAE flange ports

A and B at side, opposite + rear Port plate with 1-level pressure-relief valves for mounting a counterbalance valve4)

BVD

2) 3) 4) 5)

6)

Z

P

3 B H

0

7

017

0

020

7

027

0

150

370 378

● ●6)

37 0 38

BVE

8

38

Valves (see pages 71 to 76) Without valve

0

Flushing and boost pressure valve mounted

7

Counterbalance valve mounted5)

8

❍ = On request

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

= Available

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● – – –

4-hole

A

▲ = Not for new projects

– = Not available cm3,

–6)

= Preferred program cm3

Specify exact settings for Vg min and Vg max in plain text when ordering: Vg min = ... Vg max = ... Metric fastening thread Only possible in combination with HD, EP and HA control. Note the restrictions on page 74. Specify ordering code of counterbalance valve according to data sheet (BVD – RE 95522, BVE – RE 95525) separately. Note the restrictions on page 74. Counterbalance valve MHB32, please contact us.

010

380 388

4


160 4/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Ordering code for standard program A6V 01

02

M 03

04

/ 63 W 05

06

07

08

09

10

– V 11

12

– 13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

Speed sensors (see page 78) Without speed sensor

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 10007) ●

0

Prepared for HDD speed sensor

F

H

Prepared for DSA speed sensor

U

DSA speed sensor mounted8)

V

Swivel angle sensor (see page 77) Without swivel angle sensor (without code)

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● –

16 HDD speed sensor mounted8)

17 Optical swivel angle sensor

V

Electric swivel angle sensor

E

Connector for solenoids (see page 70) Without connector (without solenoid, only with hydraulic controls) 18

19

28 to 200 ●

250 to 1000 –

(size 250 to 1000 without code)

DEUTSCH – molded connector, 2-pin – without suppressor diode

HIRSCHMANN connector – without suppressor diode (without code)

0 P

Beginning of control At Vg min (standard for HA)

28 55 80 107 140 160 200 250 355 500 1000 ●

A

At Vg max (standard for HD, HZ, EP, EZ, DA)

B

Standard / special version Standard version (without code) 20 Standard version with installation variants, e. g. T ports against standard open or closed

–Y

Special version

= Available 7) 8)

❍ = On request

-S

▲ = Not for new projects

– = Not available

= Preferred program

Please contact us. Specify ordering code of sensor according to data sheet (DSA – RE 95133, HDD – RE 95135) separately and observe the requirements on the electronics.


161 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

5/80

Technical data Hydraulic fluid

Details regarding the choice of hydraulic fluid

Before starting project planning, please refer to our data sheets RE 90220 (mineral oil), RE 90221 (environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids), RE 90222 (HFD hydraulic fluids) and RE 90223 (HFA, HFB, HFC hydraulic fluids) for detailed information regarding the choice of hydraulic fluid and application conditions.

The correct choice of hydraulic fluid requires knowledge of the operating temperature in relation to the ambient temperature: in a closed circuit, the circuit temperature, in an open circuit, the reservoir temperature. 1

The variable motor A6VM is not suitable for operation with HFA hydraulic fluid. If HFB, HFC, or HFD or environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids are used, the limitations regarding technical data or other seals must be observed.

1600

Example: At an ambient temperature of X °C, an operating temperature of 60 °C is set in the circuit. In the optimum viscosity range (Qopt., shaded area), this corresponds to the viscosity classes VG 46 or VG 68; to be selected: VG 68.

36

Note The case drain temperature, which is affected by pressure and speed, can be higher than the circuit temperature or reservoir temperature. At no point of the component may the temperature be higher than 115 °C. The temperature difference specified below is to be taken into account when determining the viscosity in the bearing.

Selection diagram -40° 1600 1000 600 400

-20°

40°

60°

80°

100°

0 10 VG 68 VG 46 VG 32 VG 2 2

VG

200 100

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

20°

60 40

Qopt

20

16

10

5 -40°

-25°

-10° 0° 10°

30°

50°

70°

tmin = -40 °C Hydraulic fluid temperature range

The hydraulic fluid should be chosen so that the operating viscosity in the operating temperature range is within the optimum range (Qopt see shaded area of the selection diagram). We recommended that the higher viscosity class be selected in each case.

2

If the above conditions cannot be maintained due to extreme operating parameters, we recommend flushing the case at port U or using a flushing and boost pressure valve (see pages 71 and 72).

5 115°

90°

tmax = +115 °C

3 Viscosity and temperature of hydraulic fluid Viscosity [mm2/s] Temperature Transport and storage at ambient temperature (Cold) start-up1)

Qmax = 1600

Permissible temperature difference Warm-up phase

Q < 1600 to 400

Comment

Tmin t -50 °C Topt = +5 °C to +20 °C

factory preservation: up to 12 months with standard, up to 24 months with long-term

TSt t -40 °C

t d 3 min, without load (p d 50 bar), n d 1000 rpm (sizes 28 to 200), n d 0.25 • nnom (sizes 250 to 1000)

'T d 25 K

between axial piston unit and hydraulic fluid

T = -40 °C to -25 °C

At p d 0.7 • pnom, n d 0.5 • nnom and t d 15 min

'T = approx. 12 K

between hydraulic fluid in the bearing and at port T.

Operating phase Temperature difference

The bearing temperature can be reduced by flushing via port U. Maximum temperature

2)

in the bearing measured at port T

Continuous operation

Q = 400 to 10 Qopt = 36 to 16

T = -25 °C to +90 °C

measured at port T, no restriction within the permissible data

Short-term operation2)

Qmin t 7

Tmax

measured at port T, t < 3 min, p < 0.3 • pnom

FKM shaft seal1) 1)

115 °C 103 °C

+103 °C

T d +115 °C

see page 6

At temperatures below -25 °C, an NBR shaft seal is required (permissible temperature range: -40 °C to +90 °C). Sizes 250 to 1000, please contact us.

4


162 6/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Technical data Filtration of the hydraulic fluid

Temperature range

Finer filtration improves the cleanliness level of the hydraulic fluid, which increases the service life of the axial piston unit.

The FKM shaft seal may be used for case drain temperatures from -25 °C to +115 °C.

To ensure the functional reliability of the axial piston unit, a gravimetric analysis of the hydraulic fluid is necessary to determine the amount of solid contaminant and to determine the cleanliness level according to ISO 4406. A cleanliness level of at least 20/18/15 is to be maintained.

Note For application cases below -25 °C, an NBR shaft seal is required (permissible temperature range: -40 °C to +90 °C). State NBR shaft seal in plain text when ordering. Please contact us.

At very high hydraulic fluid temperatures (90 °C to maximum 115 °C), a cleanliness level of at least 19/17/14 according to ISO 4406 is necessary.

Influence of case pressure on beginning of control

If the above classes cannot be achieved, please contact us.

An increase in case pressure affects the beginning of control of the variable motor when using the following control options:

Shaft seal

HD, HA.T (sizes 28 to 200) _____________________ increase HD, EP, HA, HA.T (sizes 250 to 1000) _____________ increase DA _________________________________________ decrease

Permissible pressure loading The service life of the shaft seal is influenced by the speed of the axial piston unit and the case drain pressure (case pressure). The mean differential pressure of 2 bar between the case and the ambient pressure may not be enduringly exceeded at normal operating temperature. For a higher differential pressure at reduced speed, see diagram. Momentary pressure spikes (t < 0.1 s) of up to 10 bar are permitted. The service life of the shaft seal decreases with an increase in the frequency of pressure spikes.

With the following controls, an increase in the case pressure has no influence on the beginning of control: EP, HA, HA.R, HA.U (sizes 28 to 200) The factory settings for the beginning of control are made at pabs = 2 bar (sizes 28 to 200) and pabs = 1 bar (sizes 250 to 1000) case pressure.

Direction of flow Direction of rotation, viewed on drive shaft clockwise

counter-clockwise

Sizes 28 to 200

A to B

B to A

Differential pressure 'p [bar]

The case pressure must be equal to or higher than the ambient pressure. 5 NG55

3 2 1 0

Long-life bearings

NG28

4

Sizes 250 to 1000

NG80 NG107, 140

For long service life and use with HF hydraulic fluids. Identical external dimensions as motor with standard bearings. Subsequent conversion to long-life bearings is possible. Bearings and case flushing via port U is recommended.

NG160, 200

2000

4000 6000 Speed n in rpm

8000

10000

Differential pressure 'p [bar]

Sizes 250 to 1000 NG250 NG500

3

NG355

2 NG1000

1 0

1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 3500 4000 Speed n in rpm The values are valid for an ambient pressure pabs = 1 bar. 0

500

NG

250

qv flush (L/min) 10

5 4

Flushing flow (recommended) 355

500

1000

16

16

16


163 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

7/80

Technical data Operating pressure range

Definition

(operating with mineral oil)

Nominal pressure pnom The nominal pressure corresponds to the maximum design pressure.

Pressure at service line port A or B Sizes 28 to 200 Nominal pressure pnom _________________ 400 bar absolute Maximum pressure pmax ________________ 450 bar absolute Single operating period _____________________________ 10 s Total operating period at ___________________________ 300 h

Maximum pressure pmax The maximum pressure corresponds to the maximum operating pressure within the single operating period. The sum of the single operating periods must not exceed the total operating period.

Nominal pressure pnom _________________ 350 bar absolute

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Minimum pressure at the high-pressure side (A or B) which is required in order to prevent damage to the axial piston unit.

Maximum pressure pmax ________________ 400 bar absolute Single operating period _____________________________ 10 s Total operating period _____________________________ 300 h

Summation pressure pSu The summation pressure is the sum of the pressures at both service line ports (A and B).

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) ___25 bar absolute

Rate of pressure change RA Maximum permissible rate of pressure rise and reduction during a pressure change over the entire pressure range.

Sizes 250 to 1000

Summation pressure (pressure A + pressure B) pSu _ 700 bar Rate of pressure change RA max with integrated pressure-relief valve_____________ 9000 bar/s without pressure-relief valve __________________ 16000 bar/s

2

pnom 't Pressure p

Minimum pressure – pump mode (inlet) To prevent damage to the axial piston motor in pump operating mode (change of high-pressure side with unchanged direction of rotation, e. g. when braking), a minimum pressure must be guaranteed at the service line port (inlet). This minimum pressure is dependent on the speed and displacement of the axial piston unit (see characteristic curve below).

1

'p

Time t 3

14 Vg max

12 10

Single operating period t1

0.3 Vg max

4 2 1 0

1) For 2) For

0.41) 0.22)

0.71) 1.01) 0.52) 0.82) Speed n / nnom

tn

Maximum pressure pmax Nominal pressure pnom

Vg x

8 6

t2

Pressure p

Inlet pressure pabs [bar]

16

1.31) 1.12)

1.61) 1.42)

sizes 28 to 200 sizes 250 to 1000

This diagram is valid only for the optimum viscosity range from Qopt = 36 to 16 mm2/s. Please contact us if the above conditions cannot be satisfied. Note Values for other hydraulic fluids, please contact us.

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Time t Total operating period = t1 + t2 + ... + tn

4


164 8/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

Technical data Table of values (theoretical values, without efficiency and tolerances; values rounded) Size

NG

Displacement geometric1), per revolution

28

55

80

107

140

160

200

250

355

500

1000

Vg max cm3

28.1

54.8

80

107

140

160

200

250

355

500

1000

Vg min cm3 Vg x

Speed maximum2) (while adhering to the maximum permissible input flow) at Vg max nnom

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

cm3

18

35

51

68

88

61

76

188

270

377

762

rpm

5550 4450 3900 3550 3250 3100

at Vg < Vg x (see diagram below)

nmax

rpm

8750

7000 6150

5600 5150

4900 4600 3600 2950 2650 1600

at Vg 0

nmax

rpm

10450 8350 7350

6300 5750

5500 5100

3600 2950 2650 1600

qV max L/min

156

244

312

380

455

496

580

675

795

1000

1600

T T

Nm Nm

179 157

349 305

509 446

681 596

891 778

1019 891

1273 1114

– 1391

– 1978

– 2785

– 5571

Input flow3) at nnom and Vg max Torque4) at Vg max and 'p = 400 bar at Vg max and 'p = 350 bar Rotary stiffness Vg max to Vg/2

2900 2700

2240 2000 1600

cmin

KNm/rad 6

10

16

21

34

35

44

60

75

115

281

cmax

KNm/rad 18

32

48

65

93

105

130

181

262

391

820

Moment of inertia for rotary group

JGR

kgm2

0.0014 0.0042 0.008 0.0127 0.0207 0.0253 0.0353 0.061 0.102 0.178

Maximum angular acceleration

D

rad/s2

47000 31500 24000 19000 11000 11000 11000 10000 8300 5500 4000

Case volume

V

L

0.5

0.75

1.2

1.5

1.8

2.4

2.7

3.0

5.0

7.0

16.0

Mass (approx.)

m

kg

16

26

34

47

60

64

80

100

170

210

430

Vg/2 to 0 (interpolated)

1)

2)

3) 4)

0.55

The minimum and maximum displacement are infinitely adjustable, see ordering code, page 3. (standard setting for sizes 250 to 1000 if not specified in the order: Vg min = 0.2 • Vg max, Vg max = Vg max). The values are valid: - for the optimum viscosity range from Qopt = 36 to 16 mm2/s - with hydraulic fluid based on mineral oils Restriction of input flow with counterbalance valve, see page 74 Torque without radial force, with radial force see page 9

Note Operation above the maximum values or below the minimum values may result in a loss of function, a reduced service life or in the destruction of the axial piston unit. Other permissible limit values, with respect to speed variation, reduced angular acceleration as a function of the frequency and the permissible startup angular acceleration (lower than the maximum angular acceleration) can be found in data sheet 90261.

Permissible displacement in relation to speed

Determining the operating characteristics

Displacement Vg / Vg max

1.0

5)

qv =

Speed

n =

Torque

T =

Power

P =

NG160, 200

0.8 0.75 0.63 0.6

NG28, 55, 80, 107, 140

0.4 0.38 NG250, 355, 500

0.2 0 0.2

Input flow

5)

0.4

0.6

0.8

1.0

1.2 1.4 1.58 1.3 1.52 Speed n / nnom

Values in this range on request

Vg • n

[L/min]

1000 • Kv qV • 1000 • Kv

[min-1]

Vg Vg • 'p • Kmh

[Nm]

20 • S 2S•T•n 60000

Vg = Displacement per revolution in

=

cm3

'p = Differential pressure in bar n

= Speed in rpm

Kv = Volumetric efficiency Kmh = Mechanical-hydraulic efficiency Kt

= Total efficiency (Kt = Kv • Kmh)

qv • 'p • Kt 600

[kW]


165 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

9/80

Technical data Permissible radial and axial forces of the drive shafts Size

NG

28

28

55

55

80

80

107

107

140

Drive shaft

ø

mm

30

25

35

30

40

35

45

40

45

Fq

Fq max

N

4838

6436

8069

7581

10283 10266 12215

13758 15982

a

a

mm

17.5

14

20

17.5

22.5

20

25

22.5

25

with permissible torque

Tmax

Nm

179

179

349

281

509

444

681

681

891

≙ Permissible pressure 'p at Vg max

pnom perm. bar

400

400

400

322

400

349

400

400

400

Maximum axial force2)

+Fax max N

315

315

500

500

710

710

900

900

1030

–Fax max N

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

11.3

13.3

Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

Fax + –

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure

Fax perm./bar N/bar 4.6

4.6

7.5

7.5

9.6

9.6

11.3

Size

NG

160

160

200

250

355

500

1000

Drive shaft

ø

mm

50

45

50

50

60

70

90

Fq

Fq max

N

16435 18278 20532 12003) 15003) 19003) 26003)

a

Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

2

a

mm

27.5

25

27.5

41

52.5

52.5

67.5

with permissible torque

Tmax

Nm

1019

1019

1273

4)

4)

4)

4)

≙ Permissible pressure 'p at Vg max

pnom perm. bar

400

400

400

4)

4)

4)

4)

Maximum axial force2)

+Fax max N

1120

1120

1250

1200

1500

1900

2600

–Fax max N

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

15.1

17.0

4)

4)

4)

4)

Fax + –

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure 1) 2) 3)

4)

Fax perm./bar N/bar 15.1

1

With intermittent operation. Maximum permissible axial force during standstill or when the axial piston unit is operating in non-pressurized condition. When at a standstill or when axial piston unit operating in non-pressurized conditions. Higher forces are permissible when under pressure, please contact us. Please contact us.

3

Note Influence of the direction of the permissible axial force: +Fax max

= Increase in service life of bearings

–Fax max

= Reduction in service life of bearings (avoid)

Effect of radial force Fq on the service life of bearings By selecting a suitable direction of radial force Fq, the load on the bearings, caused by the internal rotary group forces can be reduced, thus optimizing the service life of the bearings. Recommended position of mating gear is dependent on direction of rotation. Examples: Toothed gear drive V-belt drive

t

° = 45

ϕop = t 45 °

Alternating direction of rotation

ϕ

pt

=

70°

ϕo

pt

=

7

o

ϕ op

Alternating direction of rotation

"Counter-clockwise" direction of rotation

"Clockwise" direction of rotation

"Counter-clockwise" direction of rotation

Pressure at port B

Pressure at port A

Pressure at port B

4


166 10/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

HD – Proportional control hydraulic The proportional hydraulic control provides infinite setting of the displacement, proportional to the pilot pressure applied to port X.

HD2 Pilot pressure increase 'pSt = 25 bar

– Beginning of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed at minimum pilot pressure)

A pilot pressure increase of 25 bar at port X results in a decrease in displacement from Vg max to 0 cm3 (sizes 28 to 200) or from Vg max to 0.2 Vg max (sizes 250 to 1000).

– End of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum permissible speed at maximum pilot pressure)

Beginning of control, setting range ______________5 to 35 bar

80 70 60

– The beginning of control and the HD characteristic are influenced by the case pressure. An increase in case pressure causes an increase in the beginning of control (see page 6) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic. – A leakage flow of maximum 0.3 L/min can escape at port X due to internal leakage (operating pressure > pilot pressure). The control is to be suitably configured to avoid an independent build-up of pilot pressure.

HD1 Pilot pressure increase 'pSt = 10 bar A pilot pressure increase of 10 bar at port X results in a decrease in displacement from Vg max to 0 cm3 (sizes 28 to 200) or from Vg max to 0.2 Vg max (sizes 250 to 1000). Beginning of control, setting range ______________2 to 20 bar Standard setting: Beginning of control at 3 bar (end of control at 13 bar)

Beginning of control setting range

– Please state the desired beginning of control in plain text when ordering, e. g.: beginning of control at 10 bar.

Sizes 28 to 200 Sizes 250 to 1000 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 Vg min Vg / Vg max

16

A pilot pressure increase of 35 bar at port X results in a decrease in displacement from Vg max to 0.2 Vg max. Beginning of control, setting range ______________7 to 50 bar Standard setting: Beginning of control at 10 bar (end of control at 45 bar) HDR3 characteristic

90

Pilot pressure increase

8

0.8 1.0 Vg max Displacement

80 70 60 50

12

4 2

10 5

(sizes 250 to 1000)

Beginning of control setting range

20

20

HD3 Pilot pressure increase 'pSt = 35 bar

Pilot pressure pSt [bar]

Pilot pressure increase 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 Vg min Vg / Vg max

Beginning of control setting range

Sizes 28 to 200 Sizes 250 to 1000

24

40 35 30

0.8 1.0 Vg max Displacement

HD1 characteristic 32.5 30 28

50

Pilot pressure pSt [bar]

HD2 characteristic

NG250 to 1000 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 Vg min Vg / Vg max

Pilot pressure pSt [bar]

– The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 450 bar can occur at port G.

Standard setting: Beginning of control at 10 bar (end of control at 35 bar)

Pilot pressure increase

Note – Maximum permissible pilot pressure: pSt = 100 bar

40 30 20 10 7

0.8 1.0 Vg max Displacement


167 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

11/80

HD – Proportional control hydraulic Schematic HD1, HD2, HD3 Sizes 250 to 1000

Schematic HD1, HD2, HD3 Sizes 28 to 200

X G X

1

G MB

U U

B

T1 B

Vg min

Vg min

Vg max

Vg max A

T2

2

T1 M1

T2

MA

A M

3

Note The spring return feature in the control part is not a safety device The control part can stick in an undefined position by internal contamination (contaminated hydraulic fluid, abrasion or residual contamination from system components). As a result, the control will no longer respond correctly to the operator's commands. Check whether the application on your machine requires additional safety measures, in order to bring the driven actuator into a controlled and safe position (immediate stop). If necessary, make sure these are properly implemented.

4


168 12/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

HD – Proportional control hydraulic Schematic HD.D Sizes 250 to 1000

HD.D Pressure control, fixed setting

X

The pressure control overrides the HD control function. If the load torque or a reduction in motor swivel angle causes the system pressure to reach the setpoint of the pressure control, the motor will swivel towards a larger displacement. The increase in the displacement and the resulting reduction in pressure cause the control deviation to decrease. With the increase in displacement the motor develops more torque, while the pressure remains constant.

G

U

Setting range of the pressure control valve Sizes 28 to 200 ___________________________ 80 to 400 bar Sizes 250 to 1000 _________________________ 80 to 350 bar

MB

B

MA

A

Vg min

Vg max

Schematic HD.D Sizes 28 to 200 G X

T1

U

T2

M

T1 B

Vg min Vg max A

T2 M1

G2


169 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

13/80

HD – Proportional control hydraulic HD.E Pressure control, hydraulic override, two-point

HD.G Pressure control, remote control Sizes 250 to 1000

Sizes 28 to 200 The pressure control setting can be overridden by applying an external pilot pressure at port G2, realizing a 2nd pressure setting. Required pilot pressure at port G2: pSt = 20 to 50 bar Please state the 2nd pressure setting in plain text when ordering. Schematic HD.E G1 X

U

When the set pressure value is reached, the remote control pressure control continually regulates the motor to maximum displacement Vg max. A pressure-relief valve (not included in the delivery contents), which is located separately from the motor and which is connected to port X3, assumes the task of controlling the internal pressure cut-off valve. So long as the target pressure value has not been reached, pressure is evenly applied to the valve from both sides in addition to the force of the spring, and the valve remains closed. The target pressure value is between 80 bar and 350 bar. When the target pressure value is reached at the separate pressure-relief valve, this will open, reliving the pressure on the spring side to the reservoir. The internal control valve switches and the motor swivels to maximum displacement Vg max. The differential pressure at the control valve is set as standard to 25 bar. As a separate pressure-relief valve, we recommend:

2

DBD 6 (hydraulic) as per RE 25402

G2

T1

1

The maximum line length should not exceed 2 m. B

Schematic HD.G X

Vg min

G2

Vg max A

MB

U

B

T2

3

M1 Vg min

Sizes 250 to 1000 (HD.D) Vg max

Pressure control with 2nd pressure setting for HD.D provided as standard (see page 12). The pressure control setting can be overridden by applying an external pilot pressure at port G2, realizing a 2nd pressure setting. Required pilot pressure at port G2: pSt t 100 bar

T1

T2

MA

A

M

Please state the 2nd pressure setting in plain text when ordering.

4

X3


170 14/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

EP – Proportional control electric The proportional electric control provides infinite setting of the displacement, proportional to the control current applied to the solenoid (sizes 28 to 200) or proportional valve (sizes 250 to 1000). For sizes 250 to 1000, the pilot oil supply at port P requires an external pressure of pmin = 30 bar (pmax = 100 bar). – Beginning of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed at minimum control current) – End of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum permissible speed at maximum control current) Characteristic

Sizes 28 to 200 Sizes 250 to 1000 0.2 Vg min

0.4

0.6

Vg / Vg max

0.8

1.0

Vg max

Technical data, solenoid Sizes 28 to 200 EP1 Voltage

EP2

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Control current Beginning of control

400 mA

End of control

1200 mA

600 mA

1.54 A

0.77 A

Limiting current

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C) 5.5 :

200 mA

22.7 :

Dither frequency

100 Hz

100 Hz

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

1600 max

800 max

1400

700

The following electronic controllers and amplifiers are available for controlling the proportional solenoids:

1200

600

1000

500

800

400

– BODAS controller RC Series 20 _________________________________ RE 95200 Series 21__________________________________ RE 95201 Series 22 _________________________________ RE 95202 Series 30 _______________________ RE 95203, RE 95204 and application software

600

300

400

200

– Electric amplifier VT 2000, series 5X (see RE 29904) (for stationary application)

200

100

Further information can also be found on the Internet at www.boschrexroth.com/mobile-electronics

EP1 (12 V)

EP2 (24 V)

Note The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 450 bar can occur at port G. The following only needs to be noted for sizes 250 to 1000: – The beginning of control and the EP characteristic are influenced by the case pressure. An increase in case pressure causes an increase in the beginning of control (see page 6) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic.

Type of protection see connector design page 70

– Analog amplifier RA _________________________ RE 95230

Technical data, proportional valve Sizes 250 to 1000 EP1

EP2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Beginning of control at Vg max

900 mA

450 mA

End of control at Vg min

1400 mA

700 mA

Limiting current

2.2 A

1.0 A

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C) 2.4 :

12 :

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70 See also proportional pressure-reducing valve DRE 4K (RE 29181).

Note The spring return feature in the control part is not a safety device The control part can stick in an undefined position by internal contamination (contaminated hydraulic fluid, abrasion or residual contamination from system components). As a result, the control will no longer respond correctly to the operator's commands. Check whether the application on your machine requires additional safety measures, in order to bring the driven actuator into a controlled and safe position (immediate stop). If necessary, make sure these are properly implemented.


171 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

15/80

EP – Proportional control electric Schematic EP1, EP2 Sizes 28 to 200

Schematic EP1, EP2 Sizes 250 to 1000 MST

1

G U

P

Proportional pressure-reducing valve DRE 4K (see RE 29181)

T1 B

G

MB

U

B

Vg min Vg min

Vg max

A

2

Vg max

T2 M1

T1

T2

MA

A

M

3

4


172 16/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

EP – Proportional control electric Schematic EP.D Sizes 250 to 1000

EP.D Pressure control, fixed setting

MST

The pressure control overrides the EP control function. If the load torque or a reduction in motor swivel angle causes the system pressure to reach the setpoint of the pressure control, the motor will swivel towards a larger displacement. The increase in the displacement and the resulting reduction in pressure cause the control deviation to decrease. With the increase in displacement the motor develops more torque, while the pressure remains constant. Setting range of the pressure control valve: Sizes 28 to 200 ___________________________ 80 to 400 bar Sizes 250 to 1000 _________________________ 80 to 350 bar

U

Schematic EP.D Sizes 28 to 200

G

MB

B

MA

A

Vg min

G

U

P

Proportional pressure-reducing valve DRE 4K (see RE 29181)

Vg max

T1

T1

T2

M

B

G2

Vg min Vg max

A

T2 M1


173 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

17/80

EP – Proportional control electric EP.E Pressure control, hydraulic override, two-point

EP.G Pressure control, remote control Sizes 250 to 1000

Sizes 28 to 200 The pressure control setting can be overridden by applying an external pilot pressure at port G2, realizing a 2nd pressure setting. Required pilot pressure at port G2: pSt = 20 to 50 bar Please state the 2nd pressure setting in plain text when ordering. Schematic EP.E G1

U

G2

T1

When the set pressure value is reached, the remote control pressure control continually regulates the motor to maximum displacement Vg max. A pressure-relief valve (not included in the delivery contents), which is located separately from the motor and which is connected to port X3, assumes the task of controlling the internal pressure cut-off valve. So long as the target pressure value has not been reached, pressure is evenly applied to the valve from both sides in addition to the force of the spring, and the valve remains closed. The target pressure value is between 80 bar and 350 bar. When the target pressure value is reached at the separate pressure-relief valve, this will open, reliving the pressure on the spring side to the reservoir. The internal control valve switches and the motor swivels to maximum displacement Vg max. The differential pressure at the control valve is set as standard to 25 bar. As a separate pressure-relief valve, we recommend:

1

2

DBD 6 (hydraulic) as per RE 25402 The maximum line length should not exceed 2 m. B

Schematic EP.G Vg min MST

Vg max A

P

T2 M1

Proportional pressure-reducing valve DRE 4K (see RE 29181) U

G

3 MB

B

MA

A

Sizes 250 to 1000 (EP.D) Pressure control with 2nd pressure setting for EP.D provided as standard (see on page 16).

Vg min

The pressure control setting can be overridden by applying an external pilot pressure at port G2, realizing a 2nd pressure setting.

Vg max

Required pilot pressure at port G2: pSt t 100 bar Please state the 2nd pressure setting in plain text when ordering.

T1

T2

M

X3

4


174 18/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

HZ – Two-point control hydraulic The two-point hydraulic control allows the displacement to be set to either Vg min or Vg max by switching the pilot pressure at port X on or off.

Schematic HZ1 Sizes 28, 140, 160, 200

– Position at Vg max (without pilot pressure, maximum torque, minimum speed)

X

– Position at Vg min (with pilot pressure > 10 bar activated, minimum torque, maximum permissible speed)

G

Characteristic HZ U

10

Vg min Displacement

T1

Pilot pressure 'pS [bar]

100

B

Vg min Vg max

A

0 Vg max

T2 M1

Note – Maximum permissible pilot pressure: 100 bar – The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 450 bar can occur at port G.

Schematic HZ Sizes 250 to 1000

– A leakage flow of maximum 0.3 L/min is present at port X (operating pressure > pilot pressure). To avoid a build-up of pilot pressure, pressure is to be relieved from port X to the reservoir.

U

X G

B

MA

A

Vg min

Schematic HZ3 Sizes 55 to 107 U

MB

Vg max

T1 B

Vg min

T1

Vg max

A

T2

G

X

T2

M


175 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

19/80

EZ – Two-point control electric The two-point electric control with switching solenoid (sizes 28 to 200) or control valve (sizes 250 to 1000) allows the displacement to be set to either Vg min or Vg max by switching the electric current at the switching solenoid or control valve on or off. Note The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 450 bar can occur at port G.

Schematic EZ1, EZ2 Sizes 28, 140, 160, 200

1

G U

T1 B

Technical data, solenoid with Ø37 Sizes 28, 140, 160, 200 EZ1

Vg min Vg max

EZ2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Displacement Vg max

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg min

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70

A

T2 M1

Schematic EZ3, EZ4 Sizes 55 to 107 U

T1

Technical data, solenoid with Ø45 Sizes 55 to 107 EZ3

2

B

EZ4

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Displacement Vg max

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg min

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

4.8 :

19.2 :

Nominal power

30 W

30W

Minimum required current

1.5 A

0.75 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70

3

Vg min Vg max

A

T2 G

Technical data, control valve Sizes 250 to 1000 EZ1

EZ2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Displacement Vg max

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg min

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

6:

23 :

Nominal power

26 W

26W

Minimum required current

2A

1.04 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70

4


176 20/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

EZ – Two-point control electric Schematic EZ1, EZ2 Sizes 250 to 1000 G

U

MB

B

MA

A

vg min

vg max

T1

T2

M

RE 91604/06.12


177 RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

Bosch Rexroth AG

21/80

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related The automatic high-pressure related control adjusts the displacement automatically depending on the operating pressure. The displacement of the A6VM motor with HA control is Vg min (maximum speed and minimum torque). The control unit measures internally the operating pressure at A or B (no control line required) and upon reaching the beginning of control, the controller swivels the motor from Vg min to Vg max with increase of pressure. The displacement is modulated between Vg min and Vg max, thereby depending on load conditions.

1

– Beginning of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum speed) – End of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed) Note – For safety reasons, winch drives are not permissible with beginning of control at Vg min (standard for HA). – The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 450 bar can occur at port G.

2

– The beginning of control and the HA characteristic are influenced by the case pressure. An increase in case pressure causes an increase in the beginning of control (see page 7) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic. Only for HA1T (sizes 28 to 200) and HA1, HA2, HA.T, (sizes 250 to 1000). – A leakage flow of maximum 0.3 L/min is present at port X (operating pressure > pilot pressure). To avoid a build-up of pilot pressure, pressure is to be relieved from port X to the reservoir. Only for control HA.T.

3

4


178 22/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related Schematic HA1 Sizes 28 to 200

HA1 With minimum pressure increase An operating pressure increase of 'p d approx. 10 bar results in an increase in displacement from 0 cm3 to Vg max (sizes 28 to 200) or from 0.2 Vg max to Vg max (sizes 250 to 1000).

M1 U

T1

Beginning of control, setting range Sizes 28 to 200 ___________________________ 80 to 350 bar Sizes 250 to 1000 _________________________ 80 to 340 bar

B

Vg min

Please state the desired beginning of control in plain text when ordering, e. g.: beginning of control at 300 bar.

Vg max

A

400 T2

350

G

300

200

150

X

Pressure increase 'p d 10 bar

250

Beginning of control setting range

Operating pressure p[bar]

Characteristic HA1

Sizes 250 to 1000 X G

100 80 50

Sizes 28 to 200 Sizes 250 to 1000

U

0 0.2 Vg min

0.4

0.6 Vg/Vg min

0.8

MB

B

MA

A

1.0 Vg max

Displacement

Vg max

Vg min

T1

T2

M


179 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

23/80

HA – Automatic high-pressure related control Schematic HA2 Sizes 28 to 200

HA2 With pressure increase An operating pressure increase of 'p = approx. 100 bar results in an increase in displacement from 0 cm3 to Vg max (sizes 28 to 200) or from 0.2 Vg max to Vg max (sizes 250 to 1000).

M1 U

T1

1

Beginning of control, setting range Sizes 28 to 200 ___________________________ 80 to 350 bar Sizes 250 to 1000 _________________________ 80 to 250 bar

B

Please state the desired beginning of control in plain text when ordering, e. g.: beginning of control at 200 bar.

Vg min Vg max

A

400

350

250

200

150

100 80

G

Pressure increase 'p d 100 bar

300

T2

Beginning of control setting range

Operating pressure p [bar]

Characteristic HA2

2 X

Sizes 250 to 1000 X G

50

Sizes 28 to 200 Sizes 250 to 1000

U

MB

B

MA

A

3

0 0.2 Vg min

0.4

0.6 Vg/Vg max

0.8

1.0 Vg max

Vg max

Displacement Vg min

T1

T2

4 M


180 24/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related Schematic HA1.T Sizes 250 to 1000

HA.T Override hydraulic remote control, proportional

X G

With the HA.T3 control, the beginning of control can be influenced by applying a pilot pressure to port X. For each 1 bar of pilot pressure increase, the beginning of control is reduced by 17 bar (sizes 28 to 200) or 8 bar (sizes 250 to 1000). U

Example (sizes 28 to 200): Beginning of control setting

300 bar

300 bar

Pilot pressure at port X

0 bar

10 bar

Beginning of control at

300 bar

130 bar

MB

B

MA

A

Vg max

Note Maximum permissible pilot pressure 100 bar.

Vg min

Schematic HA1.T Sizes 28 to 200

M1 U

T1

T1

T2

B

M

Schematic HA2.T Sizes 28 to 200

Vg min Vg max

A U

M1 T1 B

T2 G Vg min Vg max

X

A

T2 G

X


181 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

25/80

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related Schematic HA2U1, HA2U2

HA.U1, HA.U2 Override electric two-point

M1

Sizes 28 to 200 With the HA.U1 or HA.U2 control, the beginning of control can be overridden by an electric signal to a switching solenoid. When the override solenoid is energized, the variable motor swivels to maximum swivel angle, without intermediate position. The beginning of control is adjustable between 80 and 300 bar (specify required setting in plain text when ordering).

U

T1

1 B

Vg min Vg max

Technical data, solenoid with Ø45 U1

A

U2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized

Displacement Vg max

energized

de-energized energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

4.8 :

19.2 :

Nominal power

30 W

30 W

Minimum required current

1.5 A

0.75 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

T2 G

2

Type of protection see connector design page 70 Schematic HA1U1, HA1U2

U

M1 T1 B

Vg min

3

Vg max

A

T2 G

4


182 26/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related HA.R1, HA.R2 Override electric, travel direction valve electric (see page 29) Sizes 28 to 200

Schematic HA1R1, HA1R2 M1 U

T1

With the HA.R1 or HA.R2 control, the beginning of control can be overridden by an electric signal to switching solenoid b. When the override solenoid b is energized, the variable motor swivels to maximum swivel angle, without intermediate position. The travel direction valve ensures that the preselected pressure side of the hydraulic motor (A or B) is always connected to the HA control, and thus determines the swivel angle, even if the high-pressure side changes (e. g. -travel drive during a downhill operation). This thereby prevents undesired jerky deceleration and/or braking characteristics.

B

Vg min Vg max

A

T2

Depending on the direction of rotation (direction of travel), the travel direction valve is actuated through the pressure spring or the switching solenoid a (see page 29 for further details).

G

b

Technical data, solenoid a with Ø37 (travel direction valve) R1 Voltage

a

R2

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized de-energized Schematic HA2R1, HA2R2

Direction of rotation

Operating pressure in

ccw

B

energized

cw

A

de-energized de-energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

M1 U

T1 B

Vg min Vg max

Type of protection see connector design page 70

A

Technical data, solenoid b with Ø45 (electric override) R1

R2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg max

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

4.8 :

19.2 :

Nominal power

30 W

30 W

Minimum required current

1.5 A

0.75 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70

T2 G

b

a


183 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

27/80

DA – Automatic control speed-related The variable motor A6VM with automatic speed-related control is intended for use in hydrostatic travel drives in combination with the variable pump A4VG with DA control. A drive-speed-related pilot pressure signal is generated by the A4VG variable pump, and that signal, together with the operating pressure, regulates the swivel angle of the hydraulic motor. Increasing pump speed, i.e. increasing pilot pressure, causes the motor to swivel to a smaller displacement (lower torque, higher speed), depending on the operating pressure. If the operating pressure exceeds the pressure setpoint set on the controller, the variable motor swivels to a larger displacement (higher torque, lower speed).

DA, DA1, DA4 Hydraulic travel direction valve Dependent on the direction of rotation (travel direction), the travel direction valve is switched by using pilot pressures connections X1 or X2.

1

Direction of rotation

Operating pressure in

Pilot pressure in

cw

A

X1

ccw

B

X2

Schematic DA1, DA4 Sizes 28 to 200 X3

Pressure ratio pSt/pHD: 3/100, 5/100, 8/100 X1

DA closed loop control is only suitable for certain types of drive systems and requires review of the engine and vehicle parameters to ensure that the motor is used correctly and that machine operation is safe and efficient. We recommend that all DA applications be reviewed by a Bosch Rexroth application engineer. Detailed information is available from our sales department and on the Internet at www.boschrexroth.com/da-control.

X2 2

G U

T1 B

Note The beginning of control and the DA characteristic are influenced by case pressure. An increase in case pressure causes a decrease in the beginning of control (see page 6) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic.

Vg min Vg max A

3

T2 M1 Schematic DA Sizes 250 to 1000 X2

X1 G MST

4 U

MB

B

MA

A

Vg min

Vg max

T1

T2

M


184 28/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

DA – Automatic control speed-related Schematic DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6 Sizes 28 to 200

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6 Electric travel direction valve + electric Vg max-circuit

a

The travel direction valve is either spring offset or switched by energizing switching solenoid a, depending on the direction of rotation (travel direction).

X3 X1

When the switching solenoid b is energized, the DA control is overridden and the motor swivels to maximum displacement (high torque, lower speed) (electric Vg max-circuit).

G U

b

T1

Technical data, solenoid a with Ø37 (travel direction valve) DA2, DA5 Voltage

B DA3, DA6

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Direction of rotation

Operating pressure in

ccw

B

de-energized de-energized

cw

A

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70 Technical data, solenoid b with Ø37 (electric override) DA2, DA5

DA3, DA6

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg max

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 70

Vg min Vg max A

T2 M1


185 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

29/80

Electric travel direction valve (for DA, HA.R) Application in travel drives in closed circuits. The travel direction valve of the motor is actuated by an electric signal that also switches the swivel direction of the travel drive pump (e. g. A4VG with DA control valve). If the pump in the closed circuit is switched to the neutral position or into reverse, the vehicle may experience jerky deceleration or braking, depending on the vehicle's mass and current travel speed.

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6 control (see page 28)

b a

b a

1

When the travel direction valve of the pump (e. g. 4/3-directional valve of the DA-control) is switched to – the neutral position, the electric circuitry causes the previous signal on the travel direction valve on the motor to be retained. – reversing, the electric circuitry causes the travel direction valve on the motor to switch to the other travel direction following a time delay (approx. 0.8 s) with respect to the pump.

HA1R., HA2R. control (see page 26)

2

As a result, jerky deceleration or braking is prevented in both cases. Schematic – electric travel direction valve Travel direction valve 24 V DC

K2

a

Solenoid a Pump

V N R

K1.1

Solenoid b Pump

b Switching solenoid a on the travel direction valve

V1

K2.1 K1.2 A3

B3

K1 A2

24 V DC

3

Solenoid a Motor

Note The shown diodes and relays are not included in the delivery of the motor.

4


186 30/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 28 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite 216 154

261)

58

G

U

45

45

25

136

Y

Flange ISO 3019-2

118

T2 7

max. 13.4

16 25

58

M1

109.62) 1873)

1) 2) 3)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y) Splined shaft DIN 5480 W25x1.25x18x9g

19 6

19

ø35

50.8

22 7.5

ø35

Z

M8x1.251)2)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W30x2x14x9g

M10x1.51)2)

A

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

23.8 27 35

1) 2)

28 43

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

118

ø1

Z

ø11

20 65

271)

2.52)

60

12

ø62

ø100

-0.022

°3 0

'

174

T1


187 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

31/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 28 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

1

B

A

B

A

45

45

2

132

146

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

3/4 in M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M16 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


188 32/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 28 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point 244

216

G1 174

G1,G2

136

136

M1

M1 M1

M1

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting

213 183

35.5

G

35.5

G

X

G

214 189

G

X

A

A

B

136

136

B

X 87 119

89 109

X

G2

A

B

A

B

174

G

G

M1

M1 M1

M1

HD.E

HZ1

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic

X

244 189

X

G1

X

G

X

G

87 122

G1,G2

B

A

A 136

G2 136

B

213 183

35.5

89 109

35.5

M1

M1 M1

M1


189 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 28 EZ1, EZ2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 214

1

209

M1

M1

166

96

G

G

A 130 148

B

A X

G

136

B

33/80

G

35.5

M1 M1

135

X

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 209

209

M1

M1

96

96

M1

M1

A

B

216

G

a

G

G

216

A

B

3

G b 110

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit 110

G X3

X2

X1 ,X2

A

216 175

X3 B

G A

M1 X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

136

M1

X1 X3 G

136

B

8.5

X1

G X3 93 120

X1

216 152

130 155

160

M1 M1

4


190 34/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 55 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45° 321)

67

13.5

142)

G

24

12. 5°

ø73

0

Flange ISO 3019-2

max. 14.6

151

Y

16

T2

20

31

303)

Z 79

ø125

-0.025

U

150

G 176

T1

74

7.5

67

M1

M1

1122)

150

2123) 243 1) 2) 3)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y) Splined shaft DIN 5480 W30x2x14x9g

28 9.5 50.8

ø45

19

28 9.5

ø45

Z

M12x1.751)2)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W35x2x16x9g

M12x1.751)2)

A

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

23.8 32 40

1) 2)

27 35

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)


191 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

35/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 55 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

B B

A

B

01 SAE flange port A and B at rear only HZ3, EZ4, EZ4

02 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite only HZ3, EZ3, EZ4

1

A

B

A

A 2 37.5 37.5 166

152 54 152

54 166

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

3/4 in M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


192 36/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 55 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point 272 243

G1 176

G

G2 B

A

G2

A

M1

151

151

B

G1 176

G

M1 M1

M1

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting 240 210

G

G

35.5

X

G

X

240 215

G

90 110

X

88.5

B

A 151

A 151

B

M1

M1

M1

HD.E

HZ3

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic

227 183

X

G1

X

93 126

G1,G2

272 211

M1

100

35.5

B

G2

A

M1

X

M1

61

1)

G

24 311) 117 146

A

151

B

X 89 120

35.5

X 151 2151)

G

Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear


193 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

37/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 55 EZ3, EZ4

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 237

227 183

M1 100

A 142 157

B

A 24 311) 146

B

G G

G

X

35.5

G

X

159

1)

124 1)

215

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 237

237

M1

M1

M1

104

104

M1

G

A a

G

G

225

B

A 225

B

1

104

M1

3

G

b 110

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit

X2

X1, X2

X3

G X3

M1

X1

b a

G

X1 X3

G

A 151

B

243 202

8.5

M1

X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

B

4

A 151

G X3

94 120

X1

110

132 155

243 178

160

M1

M1


194 38/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 80 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45°

208 321)

76 13.5

7.5

G

T1

G

0

Y

T2

Flange ISO 3019-2

343) 167

18

86

ø140

165

86

132)

27.5

Z

ø83

-0.025

78

182

U

max. 14.6 23

31

76

M1

M1

1122)

165

2393) 269 1) 2) 3)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y)

37 45

2)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W35x2x16x9g

28

32 40

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

25

57.2

9.5

ø50

Z

M12x1.751)2)

36 12

ø50

M16x21)2)

A Splined shaft DIN 5480 W40x2x18x9g

1)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

27.8


195 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

39/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 80 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

B A

B

01 SAE flange port A and B at rear only HZ3, EZ3, EZ4

02 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite only HZ3, EZ3, EZ4

1

A

B

A

A

B

2 42 54 164

54

42

177

164

178

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

Service line Fastening thread A/B

1 in M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

450

O

38525)

T1

Drain line

DIN

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


196 40/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 80 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point 271

G

299

G

G1 182

182

G1

G2 A

B

A

G2

M1

167

167

B

M1

M1

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting

G

G

G

X

G

X

96 116

X

268 243

35.5

268 238

A

B

A

M1

167

167

B

M1

M1

HD.E

HZ3

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic 254 208

301 244

X

G1

X

95 129

G1,G2

M1

114

35.5

A

A 27 351) 132 161

B G2 167

B

M1

X 95 126

35.5

M1

X 61

M1 1)

G

X 171 2421)

G

Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear


197 Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

41/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 80 EZ3, EZ4

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 266

254 208

M1

114

A 152

B

A 27 351) 161

B

G

X

183

2421)

124 1)

G

X

35.5

G

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 266

266

M1

M1

M1 114

114

M1

A

G

a

G

G

239

B

A 239

B

1

114

M1

172

RE 91604/06.12

3

G b 110

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit 271 207

X2

X1, X2

G X3

110

X3

100 126

X1

b a

G

M1

X1 X3

G

A 167

B

270 230

8.5

B

A 167

X1

G X3

138 161

160

M1

X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

M1

M1

4


198 42/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 107 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE-SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

220 40

1)

45°

78 7.5

17.5

T1

G

G

190

102) 30

12. 5° 87

Z

ø90

0

383)

Y Flange ISO 3019-2

max. 14.6 39

25

175

20

97

ø160

-0.025

188

U

T2

78

M1

M1

1262)

190

2573) 290 1) 2) 3)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y)

28 9.5

42 50

37 45

1) 2)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

27.8

25

57.2

ø60

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W40x2x18x9g

ø60

36 12

Z

M12x1.751)2)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g

M16x21)2)

A

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear


199 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

43/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 107 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

02 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite only HZ3, EZ3, EZ4

B B

A

B

01 SAE flange port A and B at rear only HZ3, EZ3, EZ4 1

B

A

A

A 2 42

M1

180 65

180

42 194

65 194

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 in M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

3

4


200 44/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 107 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

290

313

G

G1

G1

187

188

G

G2 A

B

G2

A

175

175

B

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting

288 257

G

G

G

X

290 258

X

G

101 121

X

40.5

A

B

A

M1

175

175

B

M1

M1

HD.E

HZ3

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic

40.5

G1

X 122

X

A

G2

M1

30 381) 143 172

A

B

X

175

B

M1

270 220

311 258

101 136

G1,G2

X 101 133

40.5

61

M1 1)

G

X

182 2561)

G

Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear


201 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

45/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 107 EZ3, EZ4

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 270 220

1

281

M1

G 2561)

124

1)

B

A 164 183

A 30 381) 172

B

115 122

122

M1

G

G

X

40.5

199

G X

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 281

281

M1

M1

122

122

M1

M1

G

A a

G

G

249

B

A 249

B

3

G

b 112

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit

290 216

G X3

X2

X3

X1, X2 G X3

290 238

8.5

X1

b a

G 107 132

X1

112

A

M1

M1

X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

4

G B

A 175

175

B

X1 X3 145 171

174

M1

M1


202 46/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 140 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

247 401)

45°

92 17.5

7.5

G

G

33

112)

99

12

ø94

Z 4

22

Y

T2

Flange ISO 3019-2

195

423)

97

ø180

-0.025

.5°

196

T1

210

U

max. 14.9 28

39

92

M1

1392)

M1

210

2883) 321 1) 2) 3)

Drive shaft

Service line port (detail Y)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g 36

42 50

1) 2)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

32

66.7

12

ø60

M16x21)2)

Z

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

31.8


203 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

47/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 140 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

1

A

B

A

B

2

76 204

76 226

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN

38525)

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

3

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


204 Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 140 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point 342

321

G2 A

G2 195

B

A 195

B

195

196

G

G1

G1

G

M1

M1

M1

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting

G

G

G

X

321 290

G

X

A

B

A

M1

195

195

B

X 108

109 132

X

40.5

322 289

40.5

M1

M1

M1

HD.E

HZ1

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic

40.5

X

342 290

G1

319 285

40.5

X X

M1

G

G

A

B

G2

A

M1

M1

195

195

B

X 108 132

108 144

G1,G2

141

48/80

M1

M1


205 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

49/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 140 EZ1, EZ2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 321

G

315

1

M1

M1

A 178 198

B

A 195

B

132

186

G

G

M1

X 225

40.5

M1

G

X

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 315

315

M1

M1 132

M1

132

M1

A

G

G

G

264

B

A 264

B

a

3

G

b 112

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit

322 247

X2

X1

b a

G

A

M1

M1

X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

X1 X3

4

G B

A 195

195

B

X3

X1, X2 G X3

322 270

8.5

153 179

G X3

115

X1

112

140

174

M1

M1


206 50/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 160 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE-SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45°

254 401)

92.5 17.5

7.5

G

G

34

122)

102

.5° 12

-0.025

ø100

Z 4

22

Y Flange ISO 3019-2

max. 14.9 39

197

433)

110

ø180

210

T1

195

U

T2

28

M1

M1

92.5 1412)

210 3)

295

330 1) 2) 3)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y) Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g

36 12

44 55

1) 2)

ø70

ø70

12

42 50

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

32

M16x21)2)

36

Z

66.7

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g

M16x21)2)

A

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

31.8


207 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

51/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 160 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

1

A

B

A

B

2

76 204

76 226

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN

38525)

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

3

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


208 Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 160 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

349

330

195

195

G2 B

A

A

G2

197

B

G1

G1

G

G

M1

M1

M1

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting

G

X

X

328 297

G

108 137

G

G

M1

A 197

B

A 197

B

X 108 141

X

40.5

329 296

40.5

M1

M1

M1

HD.E

HZ1

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic

40.5

X

G1 X

326 291

40.5

X

M1

G

G

A

M1

G2

M1

107 137

X

B

A 197

B

197

108 144

G1,G2

349 297

197

52/80

M1

M1


209 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

53/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 160 EZ1, EZ2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 328

G

1

322

M1 187

137

G

M1

A 181 197

B

A 197

B

M1

G

X

40.5

M1

232

G

X

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 322

322

M1

M1

M1

B

A

G

a

G

G

266

A 266

B

133

137

M1

3

G

b 112

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit

A

M1

X1

b a

G

197

B

X3

X1, X2 G X3

M1

X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

X1 X 3

G B

4

A 197

X2

330 277

8.5

140

G X3

115

X1

112

153 178

328 254

174

M1

M1


210 54/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 200 EP1, EP2 – Proportional control electric Port plate 02 – SAE-SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45°

267 401)

96 22

7.5

T1

G

G

192)

36

107

12

ø108

236

Z 0

Flange ISO 3019-2

max. 14.9 39

46.53)

Y

209

25

117

ø200

-0.029

.5°

200

U

T2

32 96

M1

1472)

M1

236

3)

314

345 1) 2) 3)

Drive shaft

Service line port (detail Y)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g

36

31.8 44 55

1) 2)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

32

66.7

12

ø70

M16x21)2)

A

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear


211 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

55/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 200 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

1

A

B

A

B

2

82 216

82 235

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

450

O

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN

38525)

M26 x 1.5; 16 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.E, EP.E)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

X

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

3

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA1, DA4)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

450

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


212 Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 200 EP.D

EP.E

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting

Proportional control electric, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point 368

345

G1

200

199

G1,G2

A

G2 209

B

A 209

B

M1

M1

M1

M1

HD1, HD2

HD.D

Proportional control hydraulic

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting

G

G

X

G

346 313

G

X

B

A

A

M1

209

209

B

X 112

113 143

X

40.5

345 312

40.5

M1

M1

M1

HD.E

HZ1

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control hydraulic override, two-point

Two-point control hydraulic

40.5

X

B

A

G1 X

345 308

40.5

X

G

G

A

209

209

B

G2

M1

M1

X 111

113 149

G1,G2

362 309

145

G

G

143

56/80

M1

M1


213 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

57/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 200 EZ1, EZ2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

Two-point control electric

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional 343

G

339

M1

M1 191

A 190 206

B

A 209

B

G

M1

G

X

40.5

M1

X

245

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

2

HA1U1, HA2U2

HA1R1, HA2R2

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric, two-point

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 339

339

M1

M1

M1

A 276

B 276

A

143

143

M1

B

G

G

1

143

G

a

G

3

G

b 112

DA1, DA4

DA2, DA3, DA5, DA6

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max-circuit

X3

X1, X2 G X3

X1

b a

G

X1 X3 157

X2

347 294

8.5

146

G X3

119

X1

112

4 183

345 271

174

G

M1

M1

X1, X2 pipe fitting 8B-ST according to DIN 2353-CL Use installed fittings!

B

A 209

A 209

B

M1

M1


214 58/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 250 HD1, HD2 – Proportional control hydraulic HZ – Two-point control hydraulic Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite 383 3421) 326 287

U

45°

45°

33°

max. 188

123

°1

5'

T1

0

25

236 22

571) 248

5

Z

T2 14 50

24

105

44

13

ø200 -0.072

G

X

82

105

48

6

Y

236

M1

25 82

M 1)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g

Cyl. shaft with key AS14x9x80 (DIN 6885)

P

32 31.8

82 *)

2)

*)

ø60

58

1)

66.7

M16x2

+0.018

ø50+0.002

36 12

53.5

49

1)2)

36 12

ø60

M16x21)2)

Z

Port plate 01/15 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

Key width 14

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)


215 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

59/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 250 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 15 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite, A1 and B1 at rear

01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

48.5

48.5

48.5

G

G

G

X

X

X

1

B

MB

MA

B1 A1

B A

A

B

A

MB

MA

MB

224

2

M

M

M

MA

56

56

56

236

56

224

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

400

O

A1, B1

Additional service line for plate 15 Fastening thread A1/B1

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

400

O

3

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.D, EP.D)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

P

Pilot oil supply (EP)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X3

Remote control valve (HD.G, EP.G)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

O

M

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MA, M B

Measuring pressure A/B

DIN

MSt

Measuring pilot pressure

DIN 38525)

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


216 60/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 250 EP1, EP2

EP.D, EP.G

Proportional control electric

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G) 383 333

B

X

G

P

B

A

248

A

P

152 max.188

G

X P

256 272

P

383 333

118 36

G X

152 max. 188

G X

118 36

M

M X1

M

G2

HD.D, HD.G

EZ1, EZ2

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

Two-point control electric

48.5

383 326

G

X

G

G

G2 ,X3

383

128.5

G

B

A

170

123 max.188

X

M 251

35

B

M X3

G2

M

M 251

35

248

256 272

A

M

G2, X3

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

DA

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

384

M

159

X1

G

X2

MST X1 G

B

125 max. 188

170

M

384 307

48.5

X 248

B

A

248

210

X G

max. 275

A

M G

M


217 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

61/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 355 HD1, HD2 – Proportional control hydraulic HZ – Two-point control hydraulic Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite 432

1

3861) 366

335

322

X

M

max. 203

0 335

49

128

32

641)

137

128

13 °1 5'

°

ø280 -0.081

60

0

2

36

279

T2 50

'

3 °=

T1

Z

14

18

45

U

22°30

16

95

8X

48

45°

G

Y

28 95

M

1)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W60x2x28x9g

Cyl. shaft with key AS18x11x100 (DIN 6885)

P

3

*)

36.5

40

79.4

42 15

64

ø70

+0.030

ø60+0.011

M20x2.51)2)

42 15

ø70

M20x2.51)2)

Z

Port plate 01/15 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

71 82

105 *)

1) 2)

Key width 18

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

4


218 62/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 355 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

61.5

54

G

15 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite, A1 and B1 at rear

54

G

X

X

G

X B

B

A

MB

MA

A B1 A1

B A MB

MA MB M

M 298

MA M 70 70 270

70 70 284

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/2 in M16 x 2; 24 deep

400

O

A1, B1

Additional service line for plate 15 Fastening thread A1/B1

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/2 in M16 x 2; 24 deep

400

O X4)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.D, EP.D)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

P

Pilot oil supply (EP)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X3

Remote control valve (HD.G, EP.G)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

O

M

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MA, M B

Measuring pressure A/B

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MSt

Measuring pilot pressure

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


219 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

63/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 355 EP1, EP2

EP.D, EP.G

Proportional control electric

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

G

119 36

431 387

P

P

G

X

G

431 387

P

1

G

X

A

B

A

279

268 271 288

B

164 max.203

164 max. 203

X

X

119 36

M

X3 M

M

33

G2

HD.D, HD.G

EZ1, EZ2

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

Two-point control electric

54

G

G

X

130.5

G2

X3 2

431

G

B

190

137 max. 203

X

431 366

G

M

272 287

B

A

33

G2

M G2

272 287

M

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

DA

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve 108

432

M

431 366

G

M

X1

MST

X2

X1 G

190

A

B 234 max. 300

X G

A

M

X

54 279

279

B

3

M X3

137 max. 203

X3 M

279

268 271 288

A

G

M

4


220 64/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91604/06.12

A6VM Series 63

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 500 HD1, HD2 – Proportional control hydraulic HZ – Two-point control hydraulic Port plate 02 – SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

490 4391) 417 370 48

110

'

22

217

375

148 55

141 141

36

0

306

Z

T2 14 50

0

40

711)

ø315

-0.081

13 °1 5'

°

60

T1

3 °=

U

22°30

5' 33°4 20 24 M

G

45 8x

X

Y

30 110

375

M 1)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W70x3x22x9g

Cyl. shaft with key AS20x12x100 (DIN 6885)

P

42

*)

36.5 ø80

67 80

105 *)

1) 2)

Key width 20

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

40

79.4

M20x2.5

1)2)

+0.030

42 15

74.5

ø70+0.011

15

ø80

M20x2.51)2)

Z

Port plate 01/15 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear


221 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

65/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 500 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z)

61.5

15 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite, A1 and B1 at rear

01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

61.5

61.5

G

G X

X

G

X B

B

B

A

MB

B1 A1 MA

MB

MA

2

M

M 298

A

A

MA MB M

1

78 78 310

78 78 298

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/2 in M16 x 2; 24 deep

400

O

A1, B1

Additional service line for plate 15 Fastening thread A1/B1

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/2 in M16 x 2; 24 deep

400

O X4)

3

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M33 x 2; 18 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.D, EP.D)

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

P

Pilot oil supply (EP)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA)

DIN 2353-CL 8B-ST

40

O

X3

Remote control valve (HD.G, EP.G)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

O

M

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MA, M B

Measuring pressure A/B

DIN

MSt

Measuring pilot pressure

DIN 38525)

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


222 66/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 500 EP1, EP2

EP.D, EP.G

Proportional control electric

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

G

126 43

490 438

P

X P G

P

X

P G

X

B

A

306

A

287 288 306

B

176 217

176 217

X

490 438

126 43

G

G2 M

X3

M

23

M

X3, M 315 317

HD.D, HD.G

EZ1, EZ2

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

Two-point control electric

61.5

490 418

G

137.5

490

G

X G

G

B

A

217

148 217

X

G2

B

X3

23

M

G2

X3, M 315 317

306

287 288 306

A

M

G2

M

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T

DA

Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control speed related, with hydraulic travel direction valve

490

M

G

490 418

120

X1

MST X2 G

M

A

G 61.5

B 258 max. 325

A

X 322

X

G

306

B

151 217

217

X2

M M


223 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

67/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 1000 HD1, HD2 – Proportional control hydraulic HZ – Two-point control hydraulic Port plate 02 – SAE-SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite 618 5551) 537 476

45

36

24

M

50

45

0

465

70

°=

0

274

189

15' 13°

ø400 -0.089

8x

183

2 377

Z

T2 14 50

'

22

T1

183

U

22°30

45°

G

X

147

891)

47

1

Y

465

35 147

M 1)

Drive shafts

Service line port (detail Y)

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W90x3x28x9g

Cyl. shaft with key AS25x14x125 (DIN 6885)

P

50

105

Key width 25

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

44.5

50

96.8

130 *)

2)

*)

ø100

+0.035

ø90+0.013

M24x31)2)

50 18

95

91

1)

3

18

ø100

M24x31)2)

A

Port plate 01/15 – SAE flange ports A and B at rear

4


224 68/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 1000 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 01 SAE flange ports A and B at rear

02 SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

70

70

G

15 SAE flange port A and B at side, opposite, A1 and B1 at rear

70

G

X

G

X

X

B B

B

A

A MA MB

MA MB

MB

370

MA

M

M

M

A

B1 A1

98 98 370

98 98 384

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Maximum pressure [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

2 in M20 x 2.5; 24 deep

400

O

A1, B1

Additional service line for plate 15 Fastening thread A1/B1

SAE J5183) DIN 13

2 in M20 x 2.5; 24 deep

400

O X4)

T1

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M42 x 2; 20 deep

3

T2

Drain line

DIN 38525)

M42 x 2; 20 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

G2

2nd pressure setting (HD.D, EP.D)

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

P

Pilot oil supply (EP)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

U

Bearing flushing

DIN 38525)

M18 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HD, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

3

X

X3

Remote control valve (HD.G, EP.G)

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

O

M

Measuring stroking chamber

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MA, M B

Measuring pressure A/B

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

MSt

Measuring pilot pressure

DIN 38525)

M14 x 1.5; 12 deep

400

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on page 79). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


225 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

69/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 1000 EP1, EP2

EP.D, EP.G

Proportional control electric

Proportional control electric, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

135 52

617 544

P

X

135 52

G

P G

617 544

P

X

1

X

P G

B

A

219 274

219 274

G X

B

M

M G2

X3

M

373 388

377

A

51

420

M G2,X3 2

HD.D, HD.G

EZ1, EZ2

Proportional control hydraulic, with pressure control fixed setting; remote control (EP.G)

Two-point control electric

B

G

G

X

617

G

B

A

373 388

A

146.5

274

G

189 274

X

617 537

377

70

M G2

X3 51

420

3

M

M

M

G2,X3

HA1, HA2 / HA1T, HA2T Automatic control high-pressure related, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

M

618

M 274

4

B

G

328 max. 395

A

X 70 415

X

G


226 70/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Connector for solenoids DEUTSCH DT04-2P-EP04

HIRSCHMANN DIN EN 175 301-803-A/ISO 4400

Sizes 28 to 200

Sizes 250 to 1000

Molded, 2-pin, without bidirectional suppressor diode

Without bidirectional suppressor diode

There is the following type of protection with mounted mating connector: IP67 __________________________________ DIN/EN 60529

There is the following type of protection with mounted mating connector: IP65 ________________________________DIN/EN 60529

and IP69K _______________________________ DIN 40050-9

The seal ring in the cable fitting is suitable for line diameters of 4.5 mm to 10 mm.

Circuit symbol

The HIRSCHMANN connector is included in the delivery contents of the motor. Mounting bolt M3 Tightening torque MA = 0.5 Nm

Cable fitting M16 x 1.5 Tightening torque MA = 1.5 - 2.5 Nm

DEUTSCH DT06-2S-EP04 Bosch Rexroth Mat. No. R902601804 Consisting of:

(2)

DT designation

(1)

65.4

Mating connector

– 1 housing ____________________________ DT06-2S-EP04 ø37

– 1 wedge ______________________________________ W2S – 2 sockets ___________________________ 0462-201-16141 The mating connector is not included in the delivery contents. This can be supplied by Bosch Rexroth on request. Für EZ3, EZ4 and HA.U, HA.R (for electric override)

36.7 (2)

(2) (1) 40

36.7

(1)

50 68.5

Changing connector orientation If necessary, you can change the connector orientation by turning the solenoid housing.

50 68.5

ø45

ø37

To do this, proceed as follows:

50 68.5

1. Loosen the mounting nut (1) of the solenoid. To do this, turn the mounting nut (1) one turn counter-clockwise. 2. Turn the solenoid body (2) to the desired orientation. 3. Retighten the mounting nut. Tightening torque: 5+1 Nm. (WAF26, 12-sided DIN 3124) On delivery, the connector orientation may differ from that shown in the brochure or drawing.


227 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

71/80

Flushing and boost pressure valve The flushing and boost pressure valve is used to remove heat from the hydraulic circuit.

Schematic EP Sizes 28 to 200

In an open circuit, it is used only for flushing the housing. In a closed circuit, it ensures a minimum boost pressure level in addition to the case flushing. Hydraulic fluid is directed from the respective low pressure side into the motor housing. This is then fed into the reservoir, together with the case drain fluid. The hydraulic fluid, removed out of the closed circuit must be replaced by cooled hydraulic fluid from the boost pump.

1 G U

T1

The valve is mounted onto the port plate or integrated (depending on the control type and size).

B

Cracking pressure of pressure retaining valve (observe when setting the primary valve) fixed setting _____________________________________16 bar

Vg min Vg max

Switching pressure of flushing piston 'p _________ 8¹1 bar Flushing flow qv Orifices can be used to set the flushing flows as required. Following parameters are based on: 'pND = pND – pG = 25 bar and Q = 10 mm2/s (pND = low pressure, pG = case pressure)

A

2 T2

Flushing piston Flushing orifice

Size

Flushing flow qV [L/min]

Mat. No. of orifice

28, 55

3.5

R909651766

80

5

R909419695

107

8

R909419696

140, 160, 200

10

R909419697

250

10

R909419697

355, 500, 1000

16

R910803019

Pressure retaining valve

M1

Schematic Sizes 250 to 1000 U

MB B

With sizes 28 to 200, orifices can be supplied for flushing flows from 3.5 to - 10 L/min. For other flushing flows, please state the required flushing flow when ordering. The flushing flow without orifice is approx. 12 to 14 L at low pressure 'pND = 25 bar.

B1

Flushing orifice

3

Vg min

Vg max

T1

T2

MA A A1

Flushing piston Pressure 4 retaining valve


228 72/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

Flushing and boost pressure valve Dimensions Sizes 28 to 200 HD, HZ1, DA, EP, EZ1, EZ2

HZ3, EZ3, EZ4

A3

A2

HA1, HA2

A1

A4

NG

A1

A2

A3

A4

28

214

125

161

55

243

133

176

236

80

273

142

193

254

107

288

144

200

269

140

321

154

218

160

328

154

220

200

345

160

231

Sizes 250 to 1000 HD, HZ, DA, EP, EZ,

A1

HA1, HA2

A2

NG

A1

A2

250

357

402

355

397

446

500

440

504

1000

552

629

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.


229 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

73/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Function Travel drive/winch counterbalance valves are designed to reduce the danger of overspeeding and cavitation of axial piston motors in open circuits. Cavitation occurs if the motor speed is greater than it should be for the given input flow while braking, travelling downhill, or lowering a load. If the inlet pressure drops, the counterbalance spool throttles the return flow and brakes the motor until the inlet pressure returns to approx. 20 bar.

1

Note – BVD available for sizes 55 to 200 and BVE available for sizes 107 to 200. – The counterbalance valve must be ordered additionally. We recommend ordering the counterbalance valve and the motor as a set. Ordering example: A6VM80HA1T/63W–VAB38800A + BVD20F27S/41B–V03K16D0400S12 – For safety reasons, controls with beginning of control at Vg min (e. g. HA) are not permissible for winch drives! – The counterbalance valve does not replace the mechanical service brake and park brake. – Observe the detailed notes on the BVD counterbalance valve in RE 95522 and BVE counterbalance valve in RE 95525. – For the design of the brake release valve, we must know for the mechanical park brake: 2

- the pressure at the start of opening - the volume of the counterbalance spool between minimum stroke (brake closed) and maximum stroke (brake released with 21 bar) - the required closing time for a warm device (oil viscosity approx. 15 mm2/s)

Travel drive counterbalance valve BVD...F Application option – Travel drive on wheeled excavators Example schematic for travel drive for wheeled excavators A6VM80HA1T/63W–VAB38800A + BVD20F27S/41B–V03K16D0400S12 Pump, directional valve, not included in the delivery contents

Counterbalance valve BVD

3

Variable motor A6VM...HA1T M1

Gext

T1

MB

U

L´ B

B´ Vg min Vg max

S A

A´ 4

G´ T2

MA G

X


230 74/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Winch counterbalance valve BVD...W and BVE Application options – Winch drive in cranes (BVD and BVE) – Track drive in excavator crawlers (BVD) Example schematic for winch drive in cranes A6VM80HD1D/63W–VAB38800B + BVE25W38S/51ND-V100K00D4599T30S00-0 G X

Pump, directional valve, Counterbalance valve not included in the BVE delivery contents Gext

Variable motor A6VM...HD1D MB

T1

U

G´ D

B

D´ Vg min Vg max

S A

C´ L´

C

MA

D2 D1

Mk VF

T2

Winch with mechanical park brake

M1

MP1

VG

Permissible input flow or pressure in operation with DBV and BVD/BVE Without valve Motor

DBV

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

55

400/450

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV [L/min]

Code

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV [L/min]

Code

244

22

350/420

240

380

20 (BVD)

350/420

220

388

320

388

312

107

380

107

380

140

455

160

496

200 350/400

BVD/BVE

qV max [L/min]

80

250

Restricted values in operation with DBV and BVD/BVE

32

400

370 380

580

On request

675

On request

DBV _______________________________ pressure-relief valve BVD __________________counterbalance valve, double-acting BVE _____________________ counterbalance valve, one-sided

378 25 (BVD/BVE)


231 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

75/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Dimensions A6VM...HD or EP1)

A6VM...HA A1

A5

A2

A8

A9

A6 A7

1

A2

B

A10

Gext S A3

S

A, B MB, (MA)

A7 A6

A4

A4

A

A, B B

A Br

A5

A6VM

Counterbalance valve

NG...plate

Type

55...38

BVD20...17

80...38 107...37

MB, (MA) A8

2

Ports

Dimensions

A, B

A1

A2

A3

A4

A5

A6

A7

A8

A9

A10

3/4 in

311

302

143

50

98

139

75

222

326

50

BVD20...27

1 in

340

331

148

55

98

139

75

222

355

46

BVD20...28

1 in

362

353

152

59

98

139

84

234

377

41

107...38

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

380

370

165

63

120.5

175

84

238

395

56

140...38

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

411

401

168

67

120.5

175

84

238

426

53

160...38

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

417

407

170

68

120.5

175

84

238

432

51

200...38

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

448

438

176

74

120.5

175

84

299

463

46

107...38

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

380

370

171

63

137

214

84

238

397

63

140...38

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

411

401

175

67

137

214

84

238

423

59

160...38

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

417

407

176

68

137

214

84

238

432

59

200...38

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

448

438

182

74

137

214

84

299

463

52

3

Ports Designation Port for A, B

Service line

S

Infeed

Br

Brake release, reduced high-pressure

Version

A6VM Plate

MA, M B 1)

2) 3)

4) 5)

Brake release, high-pressure Measuring pressure A and B

Size2)

Maximum State5) pressure [bar]3)

SAE J518

see table above

420

O

BVD20

DIN 38524) M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

30

X

BVD25, BVE25

DIN 38524) M27 x 2; 16 deep

30

X

L

DIN 38524) M12 x 1.5; 12.5 deep

30

O

7 8

Gext

Standard

S

DIN

38524)

M12 x 1.5; 12 deep

30

O

420

X

M18 x 1.5; 14.5 deep 420

X

DIN 38524) M12 x 1.5; 12.5 deep ISO

61494)

At the mounting version for the controls HD and EP, the cast-in port designations A and B on the counterbalance valve BVD do not correspond with the connection drawing of the A6VM motor. The designation of the ports on the installation drawing of the motor is binding! Observe the general instructions on page 80 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

4


232 76/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Mounting the counterbalance valve When delivered, the counterbalance valve is mounted to the motor with two tacking screws (transport protection). The tacking screws may not be removed while mounting the service lines. If the counterbalance valve and motor are delivered separately, the counterbalance valve must first be mounted to the motor port plate using the provided tacking screws. The counterbalance valve is finally mounted to the motor by screwing on the SAE flange with the following screws: 6 screws (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8) ______________ length B1+B2+B3 2 screws (6, 7) __________________________ length B3+B4 Tighten the screws in two steps in the specified sequence from 1 to 8 (see following scheme). In the first step, the screws must be tightened with half the tightening torque, and in the second step with the maximum tightening torque (see following table). Thread

Strength class

Tightening torque [Nm]

M6 x 1 (tacking screw) 10.9

15.5

M10

75

10.9

M12

10.9

130

M14

10.9

205

B1

2)

4

8 5 2)

26

B2

B3

1 1)

73 B4

1) 2)

SAE flange Tacking screw (M6 x 1, length = B1 + B2, DIN 912)

NG...plate

55...38

80...38, 107...37

107, 140, 160, 200...38

B13)

M10 x 1.5 17 deep

M12 x 1.75 15 deep

M14 x 2 19 deep

B2

68

68

85

B3

customer-specific

B4

M10 x 1.5 15 deep

3)

M12 x 1.75 16 deep

Minimum required thread reach 1 x Ă˜-thread

M14 x 2 19 deep

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.


233 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

77/80

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Swivel angle indicator (sizes 250 to 1000) Optical swivel angle indicator (V)

Electric swivel angle indicator (E)

The swivel position is indicated by a pin on the side of the port plate. The length of pin protruding depends on the position of the lens plate.

The motor position is measured by an inductive position transducer. This converts the stroke of the control device into an electric signal.

If the pin is flush with the port plate, the motor is at the beginning of control. At max. swivel, the pin length is 8 mm (visible after removing the cap nut).

This signal is used to forward the swivel position to an electric controller.

Example: beginning of control at Vg max

Example: beginning of control at Vg min

Inductive position transducer, type IW9–03–01 type of protection according to DIN/EN 60529: IP65

Vg min Vg max

U

MB

s

MB

U

B

U a

a

Vg min

Vg max

T1

A5

B

Vg max

Vg min

T1

T2

2

MA

A

MA A

T2

Beginning of control Vg max

A5

A1

Beginning of control Vg min

s191)

A1

Beginning of control Vg min

A3

A3

A6

A6

3

Beginning of control Vg max

A4

A1

A22)

A1

A4 A22)

NG

A1

A22)

A3

A4

A53)

A6

NG

A1

A22)

A3

A4

A6

250

136.5

256

73

238

11

5

250

182

256

73

238

5

355

159.5

288

84

266

11

8

355

205

288

84

266

8

500

172.5

331

89

309

11

3

500

218

331

89

309

3

1000

208.5

430

114

402

11

3

1000

254

430

114

402

3

1) 2) 3)

1

Size Dimension to mounting flange Required clearance for removal of cap nut

4


234 78/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Speed sensors Version A6VM...U and A6VM...F ("prepared for speed sensor", i.e. without sensor) is quipped with a toothed ring on the rotary group.

Dimensions Version "V" with DSA sensor (sizes 28 to 200)

X

On deliveries "prepared for speed sensor", the port is plugged with a pressure-resistant cover.

C

B

A

With the speed sensor DSA or HDD mounted, a signal proportional to the motor speed can be generated. The sensors measure the speed and direction of rotation. Ordering code, technical data, dimensions and details on the connector, plus safety information about the sensor can be found in the relevant data sheet. DSA _______________________________________ RE 95133 HDD _______________________________________ RE 95135 Version "V" (sizes 28 to 200) Suitable for mounting the DSA speed sensor. The sensor is fastened at the upper reservoir port T1.

Dimensions Version "H" with HDD sensor (sizes 355 and 500)

Note With speed measuring, only port T2 can be used to drain the case drain.

X 30°

We recommend ordering the A6VM variable motor complete with installed sensor. Schematic Sizes 28 to 200 U

U

Suitable for mounting the HDD speed sensor. The sensor is flanged onto the port provided for this purpose with two mounting bolts.

Version "H" (sizes 355 and 500)

Sizes 250 to 1000 U D

n

View X vg min

T2

T1

ø18.2

20 22

vg max

With DSA sensor

20 22

With HDD sensor Without HDD sensor M6 x 1 (DIN 13) 8 deep

90

T2

Size

55

80

107

140

160

200

250

355

500

Number of teeth

54

58

67

72

75

80

78

90

99

On request -

32.5

DSA

A

Insertion depth (tolerance -0.25) 18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

B

Contact surface

75

79

88

93

96

101

66.2

75.2

77.2

91.2

91.7

95.2

C HDD

-

A‘

Insertion depth (tolerance r 0.1)

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

32.5

B‘

Contact surface

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

122.5

132.5

C‘

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

161

171

D‘

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

93

113

E‘

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

145

154


235 RE 91604/06.12

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

79/80

Installation instructions General

Below-reservoir installation (standard)

During commissioning and operation, the axial piston unit must be filled with hydraulic fluid and air bled. This must also be observed following a relatively long standstill as the axial piston unit may drain back to the reservoir via the hydraulic lines.

Below-reservoir installation means that the axial piston unit is installed outside of the reservoir below the minimum fluid level.

1

2 ht min

Particularly in the installation position "drive shaft upwards" filling and air bleeding must be carried out completely as there is, for example, a danger of dry running.

1

ht min

hmin

hmin T1

U

T2

The case drain fluid in the motor housing must be directed to the reservoir via the highest available drain port (T1, T2). For combinations of multiple units, make sure that the respective case pressure in each unit is not exceeded. In the event of pressure differences at the drain ports of the units, the shared drain line must be changed so that the minimum permissible case pressure of all connected units is not exceeded in any situation. If this is not possible, separate drain lines must be laid if necessary.

T2

T1

3

U

4 ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin

2

To achieve favorable noise values, decouple all connecting lines using elastic elements and avoid above-reservoir installation.

U T2

In all operating conditions, the drain line must flow into the reservoir below the minimum fluid level.

T1

T2

T1 U

Installation position

Recommended installation positions: 1 and 2. Note In certain installation conditions, an influence on the control characteristics can be expected. Gravity, dead weight and case pressure can cause minor shifts in control characteristics and changes in response time. Installation position

Air bleed

Filling

1

–

T1

2

–

T2

3

–

T1

4

U

T1

5

U (L1)

T1 (L1)

6

L1

T2 (L1)

7

L1

T1 (L1)

8

U

T1 (L1)

Above-reservoir installation Above-reservoir installation means that the axial piston unit is installed above the minimum fluid level of the reservoir. Recommendation for installation position 8 (drive shaft upward): A check valve in the drain line (cracking pressure 0.5 bar) can prevent draining of the motor housing.

5

3

6 L1

L1

U T1

T2

T2

T1

ht min

U

ht min

hmin

hmin

7

8

L1

Filling / air bleed

U

Bearing flushing / air bleed port

T1, T2

Drain port

ht min

Minimum required immersion depth (200 mm)

T1

hmin

Minimum required spacing to reservoir bottom (100 mm)

U

U

L1

T2

L1

T1

T2

0.5 bar

See the following examples 1 to 8. Further installation positions are possible upon request.

ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin

4


236 80/80

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 63

RE 91604/06.12

General instructions – The motor A6VM is designed to be used in open and closed circuits. – The project planning, installation and commissioning of the axial piston unit requires the involvement of qualified personnel. – Before using the axial piston unit, please read the corresponding instruction manual completely and thoroughly. If necessary, these can be requested from Bosch Rexroth. – During and shortly after operation, there is a risk of burns on the axial piston unit and especially on the solenoids. Take appropriate safety measures (e. g. by wearing protective clothing). – Depending on the operating conditions of the axial piston unit (operating pressure, fluid temperature), the characteristic may shift. – Service line ports: - The ports and fastening threads are designed for the specified maximum pressure. The machine or system manufacturer must ensure that the connecting elements and lines correspond to the specified application conditions (pressure, flow, hydraulic fluid, temperature) with the necessary safety factors.

– The data and notes contained herein must be adhered to. – The product is not approved as a component for the safety concept of a general machine according to ISO 13849. – The following tightening torques apply: - Fittings: Observe the manufacturer's instruction regarding tightening torques for the fittings used. - Mounting bolts: For mounting bolts with metric ISO thread according to DIN 13 or thread according to ASME B1.1, we recommend checking the tightening torque in individual cases in accordance with VDI 2230. - Female threads in the axial piston unit: The maximum permissible tightening torques MG max are maximum values for the female threads and must not be exceeded. For values, see the following table. - Threaded plugs: For the metallic threaded plugs supplied with the axial piston unit, the required tightening torques of threaded plugs MV apply. For values, see the following table.

- The service line ports and function ports can only be used to accommodate hydraulic lines.

Ports Standard

Size of thread

DIN 3852

M12 x 1.5 M14 x 1.5 M16 x 1.5 M18 x 1.5 M22 x 1.5 M26 x 1.5 M27 x 2 M33 x 2 M42 x 2

1)

2)

Maximum permissible tightening torque of the female threads MG max 50 Nm 80 Nm 100 Nm 140 Nm 210 Nm 230 Nm 330 Nm 540 Nm 720 Nm

Required tightening torque of the threaded plugs MV1) 25 Nm2) 35 Nm 50 Nm 60 Nm 80 Nm 120 Nm 135 Nm 225 Nm 360 Nm

WAF hexagon socket of the threaded plugs 6 mm 6 mm 8 mm 8 mm 10 mm 12 mm 12 mm 17 mm 22 mm

The tightening torques apply for screws in the "dry" state as received on delivery and in the "lightly oiled" state for installation. In the "lightly oiled" state, the MV is reduced to 17 Nm for M12 x 1.5.

Bosch Rexroth AG Mobile Applications An den Kelterwiesen 14 Glockeraustrasse 4 72160 Horb, Germany 89275 Elchingen, Germany Tel.: +49-7451-92-0 Tel.: +49-7308-82-0 Fax: +49-7451-82-21 Fax: +49-7308-72-74 info.brm@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com/axial-piston-motors

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


237

RE 91610/04.13 Replaces: 06.12

Axial Piston Variable Motor A6VM

1/72

Data sheet

Series 71 Sizes 60 to 215 Nominal pressure 450 bar Maximum pressure 500 bar Open and closed circuits

Contents Ordering code for standard program Technical data

Features 2 5

HP – Proportional control hydraulic

10

EP – Proportional control electric

12

HZ – Two-point control hydraulic

15

EZ – Two-point control electric

16

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related

17

DA – Automatic control speed-related

22

Electric travel direction valve (for DA, HA.R)

24

Dimensions size 60 to 215

– Variable motor with axial tapered piston rotary group of bentaxis design, for hydrostatic drives in open and closed circuits – For use in mobile and stationary applications – The wide control range enables the variable motor to satisfy the requirement for high speed and high torque. – The displacement can be infinitely changed from Vg max to Vg min = 0. – The output speed is dependent on the flow of the pump and the displacement of the motor.

25

– The output torque increases with the pressure differential between the high-pressure and low-pressure side and with increasing displacement.

Connector for solenoids

61

– Wide control range with hydrostatic transmissions

Flushing and boost pressure valve

62

– Wide selection of control devices

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

64

Speed sensor

68

– Cost savings through elimination of gear shifts and possibility of using smaller pumps

Setting range for displacement

69

Installation instructions

71

General instructions

72

– Compact, robust motor with long service life – High power density – Good starting characteristics – Version with 9-piston rotary group – Good low speed characteristics – High uniformity


238 2/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91610/04.13

A6VM Series 71

Ordering code for standard program A6V M 01

02

0 0 03

04

05

06

07

08

/ 71 M W V 0 09

10

11

12

13

14

15

– 16

17

18

19

20

21

Axial piston unit 01 Bent-axis design, variable, nominal pressure 450 bar, maximum pressure 500 bar

A6V

Operating mode 02 Motor

M

Sizes (NG) 03 Geometric displacement, see table of values on page 8

Control devices Proportional control hydraulic

positive control negative control

Proportional control electric

positive control negative control

04

Two-point control hydraulic

negative control

Two-point control electric

negative control

150

170

HP1

'pSt = 25 bar

HP2

'pSt = 10 bar

HP5

'pSt = 25 bar

HP6

U = 12 V DC

EP1

U = 24 V DC

EP2

U = 12 V DC

EP5

U = 24 V DC

EP6

HZ5

HZ7

U = 12 V DC

EZ5

U = 24 V DC

EZ6

U = 12 V DC

EZ7

U = 24 V DC

EZ8

HA1

HA2

DA0

U = 12 V DC

DA1

U = 24 V DC

DA2

060

085

115

150

170

215

'p = 100 bar

00

D1

hydraulic remote control, proportional

T3

electric, two-point

U = 12 V DC

U1

U = 24 V DC

U2

electric and travel direction valve, electric

U = 12 V DC

R1

U = 24 V DC

R2

Connector for solenoids1) (see page 61) Without connector (without solenoid, only with hydraulic controls)

0

DEUTSCH - molded connector, 2-pin, without suppressor diode

P

= Available 1)

215

115

Pressure control fixed setting, only for HP5, HP6, EP5 and EP6

06

215

Pressure control/overrides Without pressure control/override

controls

170

085

hydr. travel direction valve

Override of the

150

Automatic control speed-related, negative control pSt/pHD = 5/100

05 HA1 and HA2

115

060

with minimum pressure increase 'p ≤ approx. 10 bar

elect. travel direction valve + electric Vg max circuit

085

'pSt = 10 bar

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control

with pressure increase

060

❍ = On request

– = Not available

Connectors for other electric components can deviate.


239 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

3/72

Ordering code for standard program A6V M 01

02

0 0 03

04

05

06

07

08

/ 71 M W V 0 09

10

11

12

13

14

15

– 16

17

18

19

20

21

Additional function 1

1

07 Without additional function

0

Additional function 2 08 Without additional function

0

Response time damping (for selection, see control) Without damping (standard with HP and EP) 09

Damping

0

HP, EP, HP5,6D. and EP5,6D., HZ, EZ, HA with counterbalance valve BVD/BVE

1

One-sided in inlet to large stroking chamber (HA)

4

One-sided in outlet from large stroking chamber (DA)

7

Setting ranges for displacement2) Vg max-adjusting screw Vg min-adjusting screw

060

085

115

150

170

215

Without adjusting screw short (0-adjustable)

Short 10

Medium

2 A

medium

B

long

C

extra long

D

short (0-adjustable)

E

medium

F

long

G H

extra long

short (0-adjustable)

J

medium

K

long

L

extra long

M

3

Series 11 Series 7, index 1

71

Configuration of ports and fastening threads 12 Metric, port threads with O-ring seal according to ISO 6149

M

Direction of rotation 13 Viewed on drive shaft, bidirectional

W

Seals 14 FKM (fluor-caoutchouc)

V

Drive shaft bearing 15 Standard bearing

0

Mounting flanges ISO 3019-2 16

= Available 2)

4

125-4

060 ●

085 –

115 –

150 –

170 –

215 –

M4

140-4

N4

160-4

P4

180-4

R4

200-4

S4

❍ = On request

– = Not available

The settings for the adjusting screws can be found in the table (page 69 and 70).


240 4/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91610/04.13

A6VM Series 71

Ordering code for standard program A6V M 01

02

0 0 03

Drive shafts Splined shaft ANSI B92.1a

17

Splined shaft DIN 5480

04

05

06

07

08

/ 71 M W V 0 09

10

11

12

14

15

060

16

17

18

19

20

21

1 1/4 in 14T 12/24DP

085 –

115 –

150 –

170 –

215 –

S7

1 1/2 in 17T 12/24DP

S9

1 3/4 in 13T 8/16DP

T1

2 in 15T 8/16DP

T2

W35x2x16x9g

Z8

W40x2x18x9g

Z9

W45x2x21x9g

A1 A2

060

085

115

150

170

215

1

2

BVD20

7

BVD25, BVE25

8

060

085

115

150

170

215

0

W

W50x2x24x9g Port plates for service lines SAE flange ports A and B at rear 18

13

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite Port plate with 1-level pressure-relief valves for mounting a counterbalance valve3) Valves (see page 62 to 67) Without valve Counterbalance valve BVD/BVE mounted4)

Flushing and boost pressure valve mounted, flushing on both sides Flushing flow with: 'p = pND – pG = 25 bar and Q = 10 mm2/s (pND = low pressure, pG = case pressure) 19 Only possible with port plates 1 and 2

Flushing flow qv [L/min] 3.5

A

5

B

8

C

10

D

14

F

17

G

20

●5)

H

25

●5)

J

30

●5)

K

35

L

40

M

Speed sensors (see page 68) Without speed sensor

060

085

115

150

170

215

0

20 Prepared for DSM speed sensor

U

V

DSM speed sensor mounted6) Standard / special version Standard version

0

21 Standard version with installation variants, e. g. T ports against standard open or closed

Special version = Available 3) 4)

5) 6)

Y S

❍ = On request

– = Not available

Only possible in combination with HP, EP and HA control. Note the restrictions on page 65. Specify ordering code of counterbalance valve acc. to data sheet (BVD – RE 95522, BVE – RE 95525) separately. Note the restrictions on page 65. Not for EZ7, EZ8 and HZ7 DSA on request. Specify ordering code of DSM acc. to data sheet RE 95132 separately and observe the requirements on the electronics.


241 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

5/72

Technical data Hydraulic fluid

Details regarding the choice of hydraulic fluid

Before starting project planning, please refer to our data sheets RE 90220 (mineral oil), RE 90221 (environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids) and RE 90222 (HFD hydraulic fluids) for detailed information regarding the choice of hydraulic fluid and application conditions.

The correct choice of hydraulic fluid requires knowledge of the operating temperature in relation to the ambient temperature: in a closed circuit, the circuit temperature; in an open circuit, the reservoir temperature. 1

The variable motor A6VM is not suitable for operation with HFA hydraulic fluid. If HFB, HFC or HFD or environmentally acceptable hydraulic fluids are used, the limitations regarding technical data or other seals must be observed. Please contact us. Selection diagram -40° 1600 1000 600 400

-20°

40°

60°

80°

100°

1600

0 10 VG 68 VG 46 VG 32 VG 2 2

100 60 40

36 Qopt

20

16

10

5 -40°

-25°

tmin = -40 °C

-10° 0° 10°

30°

50°

70°

Example: At an ambient temperature of X °C, an operating temperature of 60 °C is set in the circuit. In the optimum operating viscosity range (Qopt., shaded area), this corresponds to the viscosity classes VG 46 or VG 68; to be selected: VG 68. Note The case drain temperature, which is affected by pressure and speed, can be higher than the circuit temperature or reservoir temperature. At no point of the component may the temperature be higher than 115 °C. The temperature difference specified below is to be taken into account when determining the viscosity in the bearing.

VG

200

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

20°

The hydraulic fluid should be chosen so that the operating viscosity in the operating temperature range is within the optimum range (Qopt see shaded area of the selection diagram). We recommended that the higher viscosity class be selected in each case.

2

If the above conditions cannot be maintained due to extreme operating parameters, we recommend flushing the case at port U or using a flushing and boost pressure valve (see pages 62 and 63).

5 115°

90°

Temperature t [°C]

Hydraulic fluid temperature range

tmax = +115 °C

3 Viscosity and temperature of hydraulic fluid Viscosity [mm2/s] Transport and storage at ambient temperature (Cold) start-up1)

Qmax = 1600

Temperature

Comment

Tmin t -50 °C Topt = +5 °C to +20 °C

factory preservation: up to 12 months with standard, up to 24 months with long-term

TSt t -40 °C

t d 3 min, without load (p d 50 bar), n d 1000 rpm

'T d 25 K

between axial piston unit and hydraulic fluid

T = -40 °C to -25 °C

at p d 0.7 • pnom, n d 0.5 • nnom and t d 15 min

Temperature difference

'T = approx. 12 K

between hydraulic fluid in the bearing and at port T. The bearing temperature can be reduced by flushing via port U.

Maximum temperature

115 °C

in the bearing

103 °C

measured at port T

Continuous operation Q = 400 to 10 Qopt = 36 to 16

T = -25 °C to +90 °C

measured at port T, no restriction within the permissible data

Tmax

measured at port T, t < 3 min, p < 0.3 • pnom

Permissible temperature difference Warm-up phase

Q < 1600 to 400

Operating phase

Short-term operation FKM shaft seal1) 1)

Qmin t 7

+103 °C

T d +115 °C

see page 6

At temperatures below -25 °C, an NBR shaft seal is required (permissible temperature range -40 °C to +90 °C).

4


242 6/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Technical data Filtration of the hydraulic fluid Finer filtration improves the cleanliness level of the hydraulic fluid, which increases the service life of the axial piston unit. To ensure the functional reliability of the axial piston unit, a gravimetric analysis of the hydraulic fluid is necessary to determine the amount of solid contaminant and to determine the cleanliness level according to ISO 4406. A cleanliness level of at least 20/18/15 is to be maintained. At very high hydraulic fluid temperatures (90 °C to maximum 115 °C), a cleanliness level of at least 19/17/14 according to ISO 4406 is necessary.

Influence of case pressure on beginning of control An increase in case pressure affects the beginning of control of the variable motor when using the following control options: HP, HA.T3 ____________________________________ increase DA _________________________________________ decrease With the following controls, an increase in the case pressure has no influence on the beginning of control: HA.R and HA.U, EP, HA The factory setting of the beginning of control is made at pabs = 2 bar case pressure.

If the above classes cannot be achieved, please contact us.

Direction of flow Shaft seal

Direction of rotation, viewed on drive shaft

Permissible pressure loading The service life of the shaft seal is influenced by the speed of the axial piston unit and the case drain pressure (case pressure). The mean differential pressure of 2 bar between the case and the ambient pressure may not be enduringly exceeded at normal operating temperature. For a higher differential pressure at reduced speed, see diagram. Momentary pressure spikes (t < 0.1 s) of up to 10 bar are permitted. The service life of the shaft seal decreases with an increase in the frequency of pressure spikes. The case pressure must be equal to or higher than the ambient pressure.

Differential pressure 'p [bar]

2000

Speed n [rpm] 4000 6000

8000

10000

5 NG85 4 NG60

3 2

NG115, 150 NG170, 215

1

NG60 NG85

0 NG215 NG150 NG115 NG170

The values are valid for an ambient pressure pabs = 1 bar. Temperature range The FKM shaft seal may be used for case drain temperatures from -25 °C to +115 °C. Note For application cases below -25 °C, an NBR shaft seal is required (permissible temperature range -40 °C to +90 °C). State NBR shaft seal in plain text when ordering. Please contact us.

clockwise

counter-clockwise

A to B

B to A


243 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

7/72

Technical data Operating pressure range

Definition

(operating with mineral oil)

Nominal pressure pnom The nominal pressure corresponds to the maximum design pressure.

Pressure at service line port A or B Nominal pressure pnom _________________ 450 bar absolute Maximum pressure pmax ________________ 500 bar absolute Single operating period _____________________________ 10 s Total operating period _____________________________ 300 h Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) ___25 bar absolute Summation pressure (pressure A + pressure B) pSu __ 700 bar Rate of pressure change RA max with integrated pressure-relief valve_____________ 9000 bar/s without pressure-relief valve __________________ 16000 bar/s pnom

Pressure p

1

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Minimum pressure at the high-pressure side (A or B) which is required in order to prevent damage to the axial piston unit. Summation pressure pSu The summation pressure is the sum of the pressures at both service line ports (A and B). Rate of pressure change RA Maximum permissible rate of pressure rise and reduction during a pressure change over the entire pressure range.

't

'p

Single operating period t1

t2

2

tn

Time t

16

Pressure p

Maximum pressure pmax Nominal pressure pnom

Minimum pressure – pump mode (inlet) To prevent damage to the axial piston motor in pump operating mode (change of high-pressure side with unchanged direction of rotation, e. g. when braking), a minimum pressure must be guaranteed at the service line port (inlet). This minimum pressure is dependent on the speed and displacement of the axial piston unit (see characteristic curve below).

Inlet pressure pabs [bar]

Maximum pressure pmax The maximum pressure corresponds to the maximum operating pressure within the single operating period. The sum of the single operating periods must not exceed the total operating period.

Minimum pressure (high-pressure side) Time t

3

Total operating period = t1 + t2 + ... + tn

14 Vg max

12 10

Vg x

8 6

0.3 Vg max

4 2 1 0

0.4

0.7 1.0 Speed n / nnom

1.3

1.6

This diagram is valid only for the optimum viscosity range from Qopt = 36 to 16 mm2/s. Please contact us if the above conditions cannot be satisfied. Note Values for other hydraulic fluids, please contact us.

4


244 8/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91610/04.13

A6VM Series 71

Technical data Table of values (theoretical values, without efficiency and tolerances; values rounded) Nenngröße

NG

60

85

115

150

170

215

Displacement geometric, per revolution

Vg max

cm3

62.0

85.2

115.6

152.1

171.8

216.5

Vg min

cm3

0

0

0

0

0

0

Vg x

cm3

37

51

69

91

65

82

at Vg max

nnom

rpm

4450

3900

3550

3250

3100

2900

at Vg < Vg x (see diagram below)

nmax

rpm

7200

6800

6150

5600

4900

4600

at Vg 0

nmax

rpm

8400

8350

7350

6000

5750

5500

qV max

L/min

276

332

410

494

533

628

T

Nm

444

610

828

1089

1230

1550

cmin

kNm/rad 15

22

37

44

52

70

cmax

kNm/rad 45 68 104 124 156 196 kgm2 0.0043 0.0072 0.0110 0.0181 0.0213 0.0303

Speed maximum1) (while adhering to the maximum permissible input flow)

Input flow2) at nnom and Vg max Torque3) at Vg max and 'p = 450 bar Rotary stiffness Vg max to Vg/2 Vg/2 to 0 (interpolated) Moment of inertia for rotary group

JGR

Maximum angular acceleration

D

rad/s2

21000

17500

15500

11000

11000

10000

Case volume

V

L

0.8

1.0

1.5

1.7

2.3

2.8

Weight (approx.)

m

kg

28

36

46

61

62

78

Note Operation above the maximum values or below the minimum values may result in a loss of function, a reduced service life or in the destruction of the axial piston unit. Other permissible limit values, with respect to speed variation, reduced angular acceleration as a function of the frequency and the permissible start up angular acceleration (lower than the maximum angular acceleration) can be found in data sheet RE 90261.

Determining the operating characteristics

Permissible displacement in relation to speed

Displacement Vg / Vg max

1.0 0.8

NG85, 115, 150

0.6

NG60

3) 4)

Speed

n =

Torque

T =

Power

P =

0.2 4)

0.4

0.6

0.8

1.0

1.2

Speed n / nnom

2)

qv =

NG170, 215

0.4 0.38

0 0.2

1)

Input flow

1.4 1.74 1.58 1.62

The values are valid: - for the optimum viscosity range from Qopt = 36 to 16 mm2/s - with hydraulic fluid based on mineral oils Restriction of input flow with counterbalance valve, see page 65 Torque without radial force, with radial force see page 10 Values in this range on request

Vg • n

[L/min]

1000 • Kv qV • 1000 • Kv

[min-1]

Vg Vg • 'p • Kmh

[Nm]

20 • S 2S•T•n 60000

=

qv • 'p • Kt

Vg = Displacement per revolution in cm3 'p = Differential pressure in bar n

= Speed in rpm

Kv = Volumetric efficiency Kmh = Mechanical-hydraulic efficiency Kt

= Total efficiency (Kt = Kv • Kmh)

600

[kW]


245 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

9/72

Technical data Permissible radial and axial forces of the drive shafts Size

NG

Drive shaft Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

60

85

115

150

150

170

in

1 1/4

1 1/2

1 3/4

1 3/4

2

2

215 2

Fq

Fq max

N

7620

12463

14902

15948

17424

19370

22602

a

a

mm

24.0

27.0

33.5

33.5

33.5

33.5

33.5 1445

with permissible torque

Tmax

Nm

310

595

828

890

1089

1230

≙ permissible pressure 'p at Vg max

pnom perm.

bar

315

440

450

370

450

450

420

Maximum axial force2)

+Fax max

N

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

– Fax max

N

500

710

900

1030

1030

1120

1250

+Fax

N/bar 7.5

9.6

11.3

13.3

13.3

15.1

17.0 215

Fax + –

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure

perm./bar

Size

NG

Drive shaft

60

85

115

150

170

mm

W35

W40

W40

W45

W45

W50

Fq

Fq max

N

10266

12323

16727

19534

21220

25016

a

a

mm

20.0

22.5

22.5

25.0

25.0

27.5

Permissible nominal pressure at Vg max pnom perm.

bar

450

450

450

450

440

450

Permissible torque

Tmax

Nm

444

610

828

1089

1200

1550

Maximum radial force1) at distance a (from shaft collar)

Maximum axial force2)

Fax + –

Permissible axial force per bar operating pressure 1) 2)

+Fax max

N

0

0

0

0

0

0

– Fax max

N

500

710

900

1030

1120

1250

+Fax

N/bar 7.5

9.6

11.3

13.3

15.1

17.0

perm./bar

1

2

With intermittent operation. Maximum permissible axial force during standstill or when the axial piston unit is operating in non-pressurized condition.

Note Influence of the direction of the permissible axial force:

3

+ Fax max = Increase in service life of bearings – Fax max = Reduction in service life of bearings (avoid) Effect of radial force Fq on the service life of bearings By selecting a suitable direction of radial force Fq, the load on the bearings, caused by the internal rotary group forces can be reduced, thus optimizing the service life of the bearings. Recommended position of mating gear is dependent on direction of rotation. Examples: Toothed gear drive V-belt drive

t

φ op

= 45°

φop = t 45 °

t op

0° =7

φo

pt

4

=7 0°

Alternating direction of rotation

φ

Alternating direction of rotation

"Counter-clockwise" direction of rotation

"Clockwise" direction of rotation

"Counter-clockwise" direction of rotation

Pressure at port B

Pressure at port A

Pressure at port B


246 10/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

HP – Proportional control hydraulic HP5

HP1 35

Beginning of control Pilot Setting range pressure increase

HP1, HP2 positive control – Beginning of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum permissible speed at minimum pilot pressure) – End of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed at maximum pilot pressure) HP5, HP6 negative control – Beginning of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed at minimum pilot pressure) – End of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum permissible speed at maximum pilot pressure)

– The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 500 bar can occur at port G. – Please state the desired beginning of control in plain text when ordering, e. g.: beginning of control at 10 bar. – The beginning of control and the HP characteristic are influenced by the case pressure. An increase in the case pressure causes an increase in the beginning of control (see page 6) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic.

HP1, HP5 pilot pressure increase 'pSt = 10 bar HP1 positive control A pilot pressure increase of 10 bar at port X results in an increase in displacement from Vg min to Vg max. HP5 negative control A pilot pressure increase of 10 bar at port X results in a decrease in displacement from Vg max to Vg min. Beginning of control, setting range ______________2 to 20 bar Standard setting: Beginning of control at 3 bar (end of control at 13 bar) Note The spring return feature in the control part is not a safety device The control part can stick in an undefined position by internal contamination (contaminated hydraulic fluid, abrasion or residual contamination from system components). As a result, the control will no longer respond correctly to the operator's commands. Check whether the application on your machine requires additional safety measures, in order to bring the driven actuator into a controlled and safe position (immediate stop). If necessary, make sure these are properly implemented.

25 20 15 12 10 5 2

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 Vg / Vg max Vg max Vg min

Displacement

HP2, HP6 pilot pressure increase 'pSt = 25 bar HP2 positive control A pilot pressure increase of 25 bar at port X results in an increase in displacement from Vg min to Vg max. HP6 negative control A pilot pressure increase of 25 bar at port X results in a decrease in displacement from Vg max to Vg min. Beginning of control, setting range ______________5 to 35 bar Standard setting: Beginning of control at 10 bar (end of control at 35 bar) Characteristic HP6

HP2

70

Beginning Pilot pressure of control increase Setting range

Note – Maximum permissible pilot pressure: pSt = 100 bar

30

Pilot pressure pSt [bar]

Characteristic

60 50 40 35 30

Pilot pressure pSt [bar]

The proportional hydraulic control provides infinite setting of the displacement, proportional to the pilot pressure applied to port X.

20 10 5

0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 Vg / Vg max Vg max Vg min

Displacement


247 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

11/72

HP – Proportional control hydraulic Schematic HP1, HP2: positive control

HP5D1, HP6D1 Pressure control, fixed setting

M1 U

The pressure control overrides the HP control function. If the load torque or a reduction in motor swivel angle causes the system pressure to reach the setpoint of the pressure control, the motor will swivel towards a larger displacement.

T1

Vg min

The increase in the displacement and the resulting reduction in pressure cause the control deviation to decrease. With the increase in displacement the motor develops more torque, while the pressure remains constant.

Vg max

Setting range of the pressure control valve_____ 80 to 450 bar

B

1

A Schematic HP5D1, HP6D1: negative control T2

G G X

2

X

U

T1

Schematic HP5, HP6: negative control

B

Vg min X

Vg max A

G U

3

T2

T1 B

M1

Vg min Vg max A

4

T2 M1


248 12/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

EP – Proportional control electric The proportional electric control provides infinite setting of the displacement, proportional to the control current applied to the solenoid. EP1, EP2 positive control – Beginning of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum permissible speed at minimum control current) – End of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed at maximum control current) EP5, EP6 negative control – Beginning of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed at minimum control current) – End of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum permissible speed at maximum control current) Characteristic EP5, EP6

0 0.2 Vg min

EP1, EP2

0.4 0.6 Vg / Vg max

0.8 1.0 Vg max

Technical data, solenoid EP1, EP5 Voltage

EP2, EP6

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Control current Beginning of control

400 mA

End of control

1200 mA

600 mA

1.54 A

0.77 A

Limiting current

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C) 5.5 :

200 mA

22.7 :

Dither frequency

100 Hz

100 Hz

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 61 The following electronic controllers and amplifiers are available for controlling the proportional solenoids: – BODAS controller RC Series 20 _________________________________ RE 95200 Series 21__________________________________ RE 95201 Series 22 _________________________________ RE 95202 Series 30 _______________________ RE 95203, RE 95204 and application software

1600 max

800 max

1400

700

1200

600

1000

500

– Electric amplifier VT 2000, series 5X (see RE 29904) (for stationary application)

800

400

Further information can also be found on the Internet at www.boschrexroth.com/mobile-electronics

600

300

400

200

200

100

EP5 EP1 (12 V)

– Analog amplifier RA _________________________ RE 95230

EP6 EP2 (24 V)

Note The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 500 bar can occur at port G.

Note The spring return feature in the control part is not a safety device The control part can stick in an undefined position by internal contamination (contaminated hydraulic fluid, abrasion or residual contamination from system components). As a result, the control will no longer respond correctly to the operator's commands. Check whether the application on your machine requires additional safety measures, in order to bring the driven actuator into a controlled and safe position (immediate stop). If necessary, make sure these are properly implemented.


249 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

13/72

EP – Proportional control electric Schematic EP1, EP2: positive control

Schematic EP5, EP6: negative control

M1 U

1

T1 B

G U

Vg min

T1

Vg max B A Vg min Vg max

T2 G

A

2

T2 M1

3

4


250 14/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

EP – Proportional control electric EP5D1, EP6D1 Pressure control, fixed setting The pressure control overrides the EP control function. If the load torque or a reduction in motor swivel angle causes the system pressure to reach the setpoint of the pressure control, the motor will swivel towards a larger displacement. The increase in the displacement and the resulting reduction in pressure cause the control deviation to decrease. With the increase in displacement the motor develops more torque, while the pressure remains constant. Setting range of the pressure control valve ____ 80 to 450 bar

Schematic EP5D1, EP6D1: negative control

G

U

T1 B

Vg min Vg max A

T2 M1

RE 91610/04.13


251 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

15/72

HZ – Two-point control hydraulic The two-point hydraulic control allows the displacement to be set to either Vg min or Vg max by switching the pilot pressure at port X on or off.

Schematic HZ5: negative control Sizes 150 to 215

HZ5, HZ7 negative control – Position at Vg max (without pilot pressure, maximum torque, minimum speed)

X

– Position at Vg min (with pilot pressure > 10 bar activated, minimum torque, maximum permissible speed) Characteristic HZ5, HZ7

1

G U

T1

10

Vg min Displacement

Pilot pressure 'pS [bar]

100

0 Vg max

Note – Maximum permissible pilot pressure: 100 bar – The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 500 bar can occur at port G.

B

Vg min Vg max A

2

T2 M1

Schematic HZ7: negative control Sizes 60 to 115 U

T1 B 3 Vg min Vg max A

T2 G

X

4


252 16/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

EZ – Two-point control electric The two-point electric control allows the displacement to be set to either Vg min or Vg max by switching the electric current to a switching solenoid on or off. Note The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 500 bar can occur at port G.

Technical data, solenoid with Ø45 Sizes 60 to 115 EZ7

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Displacement Vg max

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg min

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

4.8 :

19.2 :

Nominal power

30 W

30W

Minimum required current

1.5 A

0.75 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 61

Technical data, solenoid with Ø37 Sizes 150 to 215 EZ5

Schematic EZ7, EZ8: negative control Sizes 60 to 115

EZ6

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Displacement Vg max

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg min

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

U

T1 B

Vg min Vg max

Type of protection see connector design page 61

A

Schematic EZ5, EZ6: negative control Sizes 150 to 215

T2 G

G U

T1 B

Vg min Vg max A

T2 M1

EZ8

Voltage


253 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

17/72

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related

– Beginning of control at Vg min (minimum torque, maximum speed) – End of control at Vg max (maximum torque, minimum speed)

250

150

1

100 80

– The control oil is internally taken out of the high-pressure side of the motor (A or B). For reliable control, an operating pressure of at least 30 bar is required in A (B). If a control operation is performed at an operating pressure < 30 bar, an auxiliary pressure of at least 30 bar must be applied at port G via an external check valve. For lower pressures, please contact us. Please note that pressures up to 500 bar can occur at port G.

HA1 With minimum pressure increase, positive control

300

200

Note – For safety reasons, winch drives are not permissible with beginning of control at Vg min (standard for HA).

– The beginning of control and the HA.T3 characteristic are influenced by case pressure. An increase in case pressure causes an increase in the beginning of control (see page 6) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic.

350

Pressure increase 'p d approx. 10 bar

HA1, HA2 positive control

400

Beginning of control setting range

The displacement of the A6VM motor with HA control is Vg min (maximum speed and minimum torque). The control unit measures internally the operating pressure at A or B (no control line required) and upon reaching the beginning of control , the controller swivels the motor from Vg min to Vg max with increase of pressure. The displacement is modulated between Vg min and Vg max, thereby depending on load conditions.

Characteristic HA1 Operating pressure p [bar]

The automatic high-pressure related control adjusts the displacement automatically depending on the operating pressure.

2

50 0 0.2 Vg min

0.4

0.6 Vg / Vg max

0.8

1.0 Vg max

Displacement Schematic HA1

U

M1 T1 3 B

An operating pressure increase of 'p d approx. 10 bar results in an increase in displacement from Vg min towards Vg max. Vg min

Beginning of control, setting range ___________ 80 to 350 bar

Vg max

Please state the desired beginning of control in plain text when ordering, e. g.: beginning of control at 300 bar.

A

T2 G 4 X


254 18/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related HA2 With pressure increase, positive control

Schematic HA2

An operating pressure increase of 'p = approx. 100 bar results in an increase in displacement from Vg min to Vg max.

U

Beginning of control, setting range ___________ 80 to 350 bar

M1 T1

Please state the desired beginning of control in plain text when ordering, e. g.: beginning of control at 200 bar Characteristic HA2

Vg min

Operating pressure p [bar]

B

Vg max

450

A 400 T2

250 200 150 100 80

Beginning of control setting range

300

Pressure increase 'p = approx. 100 bar

350

50 0 0.2 Vg min

0.4

0.6 Vg / Vg max

0.8

1.0 Vg max

Displacement

G

X


255 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

19/72

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related Schematic HA2.T3

HA.T3 Override hydraulic remote control, proportional With the HA.T3 control, the beginning of control can be influenced by applying a pilot pressure to port X.

U

M1 T1

1

For each 1 bar of pilot pressure increase, the beginning of control is reduced by 17 bar. Beginning of control setting

300 bar

B

300 bar

Pilot pressure at port X

0 bar

10 bar

Vg min

Beginning of control at

300 bar

130 bar

Vg max

Note Maximum permissible pilot pressure 100 bar.

A

Schematic HA1.T3 T2 G M1 U

2

T1 X B Vg min Vg max A

T2 G

3 X

4


256 20/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related Schematic HA2U1, HA2U2

HA.U1, HA.U2 Override electric, two-point With the HA.U1 or HA.U2 control, the beginning of control can be overridden by an electric signal to a switching solenoid. When the override solenoid is energized, the variable motor swivels to maximum swivel angle, without intermediate position. The beginning of control is adjustable between 80 and 300 bar (specify required setting in plain text when ordering).

U

M1 T1 B

Technical data, solenoid with Ø45

Vg min

U1

U2

Vg max

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg max

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

4.8 :

19.2 :

Nominal power

30 W

30 W

Minimum required current

1.5 A

0.75 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 61 Schematic HA1U1, HA1U2

U

M1 T1 B

Vg min Vg max A

T2 G

A

T2 G


257 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

21/72

HA – Automatic control high-pressure related HA.R1, HA.R2 Override electric, travel direction valve electric (see page 24) With the HA.R1 or HA.R2 control, the beginning of control can be overridden by an electric signal to switching solenoid b. When the override solenoid b is energized, the variable motor swivels to maximum swivel angle, without intermediate position.

Schematic HA1R1, HA1R2

U

M1 T1 B

The travel direction valve ensures that the preselected pressure side of the hydraulic motor (A or B) is always connected to the HA control, and thus determines the swivel angle, even if the high-pressure side changes (e. g. -travel drive during a downhill operation). This thereby prevents undesired jerky deceleration and/or braking characteristics. Depending on the direction of rotation (direction of travel), the travel direction valve is actuated through the pressure spring or the switching solenoid a (see page 24 for further details).

1

Vg min Vg max A

T2 G

Technical data, solenoid a with Ø37 (travel direction valve)

2

R1

R2

a

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Voltage No override Direction of rotation

b

de-energized de-energized Operating pressure in

ccw

B

energized

cw

A

de-energized de-energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Schematic HA2R1, HA2R2

21.7 : M1 U

T1 B

Type of protection see connector design page 61 Technical data, solenoid b with Ø45 (electric override)

3

Vg min R1

Vg max

R2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg max

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

4.8 :

19.2 :

Nominal power

30 W

30 W

Minimum required current

1.5 A

0.75 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Type of protection see connector design page 61

A

T2

G

b

a

4


258 22/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

RE 91610/04.13

A6VM Series 71

DA – Automatic control speed-related The variable motor A6VM with automatic speed-related control is intended for use in hydrostatic travel drives in combination with the variable pump A4VG with DA control.

DA0 Hydraulic travel direction valve, negative control

A drive-speed-related pilot pressure signal is generated by the A4VG variable pump, and that signal, together with the operating pressure, regulates the swivel angle of the hydraulic motor.

Dependent on the direction of rotation (travel direction), the travel direction valve is switched by using pilot pressures connections X1 or X2.

Increasing pump speed, i.e. increasing pilot pressure, causes the motor to swivel to a smaller displacement (lower torque, higher speed), depending on the operating pressure.

Direction of rotation

Operating pressure in

Pilot pressure in

cw

A

X1

If the operating pressure exceeds the pressure setpoint set on the controller, the variable motor swivels to a larger displacement (higher torque, lower speed).

ccw

B

X2

Schematic DA0

Pressure ratio pSt/pHD ____________________________ 5/100 DA closed loop control is only suitable for certain types of drive systems and requires review of the engine and vehicle parameters to ensure that the motor is used correctly and that machine operation is safe and efficient. We recommend that all DA applications be reviewed by a Bosch Rexroth application engineer.

X3 X1 X2

Detailed information is available from our sales department and on the Internet at www.boschrexroth.com/da-control. Note The beginning of control and the DA characteristic are influenced by case pressure. An increase in case pressure causes a decrease in the beginning of control (see page 6) and thus a parallel shift of the characteristic.

G U

T1 B

Vg min Vg max A

T2 M1


259 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

23/72

DA – Automatic control speed-related DA1, DA2 Electric travel direction valve + electric Vg max-circuit, negative control

Schematic DA1, DA2

The travel direction valve is either spring offset or switched by energizing switching solenoid a, depending on the direction of rotation (travel direction).

a X3 X1

When the switching solenoid b is energized, the DA control is overridden and the motor swivels to maximum displacement (high torque, lower speed) (electric Vg max-circuit).

DA1

G U

Technical data, solenoid a with Ø37 (travel direction valve)

1

b

T1 B

DA2

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

Voltage Direction of rotation

Operating pressure in

ccw

B

de-energized de-energized

cw

A

energized

energized

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C) Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

Vg min Vg max A

2

T2 M1

Type of protection see connector design page 61 Technical data, solenoid b with Ø37 (electric override) DA1

DA2

Voltage

12 V (±20 %) 24 V (±20 %)

No override

de-energized de-energized

Displacement Vg max

energized

energized

Nominal resistance (at 20 °C)

5.5 :

21.7 :

Nominal power

26.2 W

26.5 W

Minimum required current

1.32 A

0.67 A

Duty cycle

100 %

100 %

3

Type of protection see connector design page 61

4


260 24/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Electric travel direction valve (for DA, HA.R) Application in travel drives in closed circuits. The travel direction valve of the motor is actuated by an electric signal that also switches the swivel direction of the travel drive pump (e. g. A4VG with DA control valve). If the pump in the closed circuit is switched to the neutral position or into reverse, the vehicle may experience jerky deceleration or braking, depending on the vehicle's mass and current travel speed.

DA1, DA2 control (see page 23)

b a

b a

When the travel direction valve of the pump (e. g. 4/3-directional valve of the DA-control) is switched to – the neutral position, the electric circuitry causes the previous signal on the travel direction valve on the motor to be retained. – reversing, the electric circuitry causes the travel direction valve on the motor to switch to the other travel direction following a time delay (approx. 0.8 s) with respect to the pump.

HA1R., HA2R. control (see page 21)

As a result, jerky deceleration or braking is prevented in both cases. Schematic - electric travel direction valve Travel direction valve 24 V DC

K2

a

Solenoid a Pump

V N R

K1.1

Solenoid b Pump

Switching solenoid a on the travel direction valve

V1

K2.1 K1.2 A3

b

B3

K1 A2

24 V DC Solenoid a Motor

Note The shown diodes and relays are not included in the delivery of the motor.


261 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

25/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 60 EP5, EP6 – Proportional control electric, negative control Port plate 2 — SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45° 183 321)

13.5

7.5

G

G

150

142) 24

12.5 °

176

T1

U 72.5

1

108

Z 303) 154

84

0 16

Y

31

max. 14.6 20 67 1122)

T2

2

M1

M1

150

3)

212 243

19

50.8

23

ø73

0

ø125 -0.025

View Y

3

23.8

Flange FlanschISO ISO3019-2 3019-2

4

1) 2) 3)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear


262 26/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 60 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 2

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

2

SAE flange ports A and B at rear

B B

A

B

A

54

54 165

Drive shafts

28 9.5

28 9.5

ø45

M12 x 1.753)4)

Z8 Splined shaft DIN 5480 W35x2x16x9g

ø45

7/16-14UNC-2B2)3)

S7 Splined shaft 1 1/4 in 14 T 12/24DP1)

40 48

1) 2) 3) 4)

SAE flange ports A and B at rear only HZ7, EZ7/8

B

A

A

152 152

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite only HZ7, EZ7/8

32 40

ANSI B92.1a, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Thread according to ASME B1.1 Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

37.5 37.5 165


263 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

27/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 60 Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Pmax [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

3/4 in M10 x 1.5; 17 deep

500

O

T1

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M27 x 2; 19 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

U

Bearing flushing

ISO 61495)

M18 x 1.5; 14.5 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HP, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA0)

ISO 8434-1

SDSC–L8xM12–F

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on pages 71). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

1

2

3

4


264 28/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 60 EP1, EP2

EP5D1, EP6D1

Proportional control electric, positive control

Proportional control electric, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting 243

239

M1 G

A

G

G

B

A 154

225

B

G

176

107

M1

M1

M1

HP1, HP2

HP5, HP6

Proportional control hydraulic, positive control

Proportional control hydraulic, negative control

240 210

35.5

239

M1

X

G

G

A

B

A

G

G

X

35.5

M1 X

160

HP5D1, HP6D1 Proportional control hydraulic, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

35.5

240 215

X

G

X 89 120

G

A 154

B

M1

M1

154

139 159

B

X 90 110

107

M1

M1


265 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 60 HZ7

EZ7, EZ8

Two-point control hydraulic, negative control

Two-point control electric, negative control

227 183

227 183

1

100

100

A

B

X 61

1)

A 24 311) 146

24 311) 117 146

B

X

G

151 2151)

G

G

G 2151)

124

Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear

1)

Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear

HA1, HA2 / HA1T3, HA2T3

HA1U1, HA2U2

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric, two-point

239

2

239

M1

M1

M1

A

107

107

M1

B

A

G

G

G

X

35.5

X

160

225

139 159

B

29/72

3

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

HA1R1, HA2R2 Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 239

M1 107

M1

A 225

B

a

G

G b 110

4


266 30/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 60 DA0

DA1, DA2

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max- circuit

243 178

G X3

X2

X1 ; X2

X3

G X3

243 202

8.5

X1

b

X 1 X3

a

94 120

X1

110

G G

A B

A 154

154

B

132 155

160

M1

M1 X1, X2 Pipe fitting SDSC – L8xM12 – F acc. to ISO 8434-1 Use assembled fitting!

M1

M1


267 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

31/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 85 EP5, EP6 – Proportional control electric, negative control Port plate 2 — SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45°

208 321)

117

1 13.5

7.5

G

T1

G

165

132) 27.5

12 .5

°

80

182

U

Z

Y 31

max. 14.6 23 76 1122)

343) 167

91

0 18

2

T2 M1

M1

165

2393) 271

57.2 27.8

3 25

0

23

ø140 -0.025 ø83

View Y

Flange FlanschISO ISO3019-2 3019-2

4

1) 2) 3)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear


268 32/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 85 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 2

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

2

SAE flange ports A and B at rear

B A

B

A

164 54

54 177

Drive shafts Z9 Splined shaft DIN 5480 W40x2x18x9g

36 12

ø50

M16 x 23)4)

28 9.5

ø50

7/16-14UNC-2B2)3)

S9 Splined shaft 1 1/2 in 17 T 12/24DP1)

44 54

1) 2) 3) 4)

SAE flange ports A and B at rear only HZ7, EZ7/8

B

A

A

B

164

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite only HZ7, EZ7/8

37 45

ANSI B92.1a, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Thread according to ASME B1.1 Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

42 42 177


269 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

33/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 85 Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Pmax [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 in M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

500

O

T1

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M27 x 2; 19 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

U

Bearing flushing

ISO 61495)

M18 x 1.5; 14.5 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HP, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA0)

ISO 8434-1

SDSC–L8xM12–F

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on pages 71). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

1

2

3

4


270 34/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 85 EP1, EP2

EP5D1, EP6D1

Proportional control electric, positive control

Proportional control electric, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting 271

266

M1

G

G 182

113

M1

A

G

G

B

A 167

238

B

M1

M1

HP1, HP2

HP5, HP6

Proportional control hydraulic, positive control

Proportional control hydraulic, negative control

268 238

35.5

266

X

M1

G

G

A

B

A

G 35.5

G

X

183

M1 X

HP5D1, HP6D1 Proportional control hydraulic, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

35.5

268 243

G

X 95 126

X

A 167

B

M1

M1

167

152 172

B

X 96 116

113

M1

G

RE 91610/04.13

M1


271 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

35/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 85 HZ7

EZ7, EZ8

Two-point control hydraulic, negative control

Two-point control electric, negative control

254 208

254 208

A

B

A

X

1)

X

G

61

27 351) 161

27 351) 132 161

B

112

112

1

171 2421)

G

G

G 124

Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear

1)

2421)

Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear

2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T3, HA2T3

HA1U1, HA2U2

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric, two-point

266

266

M1

M1

M1

A

B

A

G 35.5

G

X

183

239

152 172

B

113

113

M1

G X

3

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

HA1R1, HA2R2 Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 266

M1

113

M1

A 239

B

a

G

G b 110

4


272 36/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 85 DA0

DA1, DA2

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max- circuit

271 207

G X3

X2

X1; X2

G X3

X3

270 230

8.5

X1

b

X1 X3

a

G

100 126

X1

110

G

A B

A 167

167

B

138 161

160

M1

M1

X1, X2 Pipe fitting SDSC – L8xM12 – F acc. to ISO 8434-1 Use assembled fitting!

M1

M1


273 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

37/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 115 EP5, EP6 – Proportional control electric, negative control Port plate 2 — SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

220 401)

45° 1

126 17.5

7.5

T1

G

G

190

102) 30

91

12.5 °

188

U

Z 383) 175

102

0 20

max. 14.6 39 25 78 1262)

Y

T2

2

M1

M1

190

2573) 290

27.8

25

57.2

0

25

ø160 -0.025 ø90

View Y

3

Flange ISO Flansch ISO3019-2 3019-2

4

1) 2) 3)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear


274 38/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 115 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 2

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

2

SAE flange ports A and B at rear

B B

A

B

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite only HZ7, EZ7/8

A

SAE flange ports A and B at rear only HZ7, EZ7/8

B

A

42

M1

180 65

65 193

180

Drive shafts

12

36 12

ø60

M16 x 23)4)

36

Z9 Splined shaft DIN 5480 W40x2x18x9g

ø60

5/8-11UNC-2B2)3)

T1 Splined shaft 1 3/4 in 13 T 8/16DP1)

55 67

1) 2) 3) 4)

A

37 45

ANSI B92.1a, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Thread according to ASME B1.1 Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)

42 193


275 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

39/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 115 Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Pmax [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 in M12 x 1.75; 17 deep

500

O

T1

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M27 x 2; 19 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M33 x 2; 19 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

U

Bearing flushing

ISO 61495)

M18 x 1.5; 14.5 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HP, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA0)

ISO 8434-1

SDSC–L8xM12–F

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on pages 71). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

1

2

3

4


276 40/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 115 EP1, EP2

EP5D1, EP6D1

Proportional control electric, positive control

Proportional control electric, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

281

290

M1

B

G

G 188

121

M1

G

B

A 175

249

A

G

HP1, HP2

HP5, HP6

Proportional control hydraulic, positive control

Proportional control hydraulic, negative control

281

288 257

40.5

M1

X

G

G

A

B

A

G

X

40.5

199

G

M1

X

HP5D1, HP6D1 Proportional control hydraulic, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

40.5

290 258

X

G

X 101 133

G

A 175

B

M1

M1

175

164 180

B

X 101 121

121

M1

M1


277 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

41/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 115 HZ7

EZ7, EZ8

Two-point control hydraulic, negative control

Two-point control electric, negative control

270 220

270 220

A

B

A 30 381) 172

30 381) 143 172

B

121

121

1

X 61

1)

X

G

182 2561)

G

G

2561)

124

Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear

1)

G

Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear

2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T3, HA2T3

HA1U1, HA2U2

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric, two-point 281

281

M1

M1

M1

A

B

A

G 40.5

G

X

199

G X

249

164 180

B

121

121

M1

3

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

HA1R1, HA2R2 Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 281

M1

M1 121

4

A 249

B

a

G

G b 112


278 42/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 115 DA0

DA1, DA2

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max- circuit

X2

X1, X2

G X3

X3

X1

b a

G

M1

X1 X 3

G

A 175

B

290 238

8.5

M1

X1, X2 Pipe fitting SDSC – L8xM12 – F acc. to ISO 8434-1 Use assembled fitting!

B

A 175

G X3

107 132

X1

112

145 168

290 216

174

M1

M1


279 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

43/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 150 EP5, EP6 – Proportional control electric, negative control Port plate 2 — SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

247 401)

45°

140.5

1 17.5

7.5

U

G

G

210

112) 33

12. 5

°

100

196

T1

Z 4

Y 39

max. 14.9 28 90.5 1392)

423) 195

109

22

T2

2

M1

M1

210

2883) 321

66.7 31.8

3 32

25

ø94

0 ø180 -0.025

View Y

Flange FlanschISO ISO3019-2 3019-2

4

1) 2) 3)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear


280 44/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 150 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

2

SAE flange ports A and B at rear

1

A

B

A

B

76 204

76 226

Drive shafts

36 12

55 67

1) 2) 3) 4)

36 12

ø60

ø60

36 12

A1 Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g

M16 x 23)4)

5/8-11UNC-2B2)3)

T2 Splined shaft 2 in 15 T 8/16DP1)

ø60

5/8-11UNC-2B2)3)

T1 Splined shaft 1 3/4 in 13 T 8/16DP1)

RE 91610/04.13

53 67

42 50

ANSI B92.1a, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Thread according to ASME B1.1 Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)


281 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

45/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 150 Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Pmax [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

500

O

T1

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M27 x 2; 19 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M33 x 2; 19 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

U

Bearing flushing

ISO 61495)

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HP, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA0)

ISO 8434-1

SDSC–L8xM12–F

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

ISO 61495)

M14 x1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on pages 71). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

1

2

3

4


282 46/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 150 EP1, EP2

EP5D1, EP6D1

Proportional control electric, positive control

Proportional control electric, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

315

321

M1

A B

A 195

264

B

G

G

196

132

M1

G

G

M1

M1

HP1, HP2

HP5, HP6

Proportional control hydraulic, positive control

Proportional control hydraulic, negative control

320 289

40.5

315

X

G

G

B

A

A

G

X 225

40.5

M1

G

X

HP5D1, HP6D1 Proportional control hydraulic, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

40.5

321 290

G

X

X 108 141

G

A 195

B

M1

M1

195

178 195

B

X 109 132

M1 132

M1

M1


283 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 150 HZ5

EZ5, EZ6

Two-point control hydraulic, negative control

Two-point control electric, negative control

G

G

X

G

108 132

G

186

X

1

319

319 285

40.5

A

B

A

M1

195

195

B

47/72

M1

M1

M1 2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T3, HA2T3

HA1U1, HA2U2

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric, two-point 315

315

M1

M1

M1

A

B

A

G

X 225

40.5

G

264

178 195

B

132

132

M1

G

X

3

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

HA1R1, HA2R2 Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 315

M1

M1 132

4

A 264

B

a

G b 112

G


284 48/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 150 DA0

DA1, DA2

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max- circuit

G X3

X2

X1, X2 G X3

X3

322 270

8.5

X1

b a

X1 X3

G

115 140

X1

112

G A

M1

M1

X1, X2 Pipe fitting SDSC – L8xM12 – F acc. to ISO 8434-1 Use assembled fitting!

B

A 195

195

B

153 176

322 247

174

M1

M1


285 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

49/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 170 EP5, EP6 – Proportional control electric, negative control Port plate 2 — SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45°

254 141

401)

1 17.5

7.5

T1

G

G

210

122) 34

12. 5°

103

195

U

Z 4

433) 197

112

22

Y

39

max. 14.9 28 91 1412)

2

T2 M1

M1

210

2953 ) 328

31.8

3 32

0

66.7

ø180 -0.025 ø100

25

View Y

Flange ISO 3019-2 Flansch ISO 3019-2

4

1) 2) 3)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear


286 50/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 170 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 2

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

SAE flange ports A and B at rear

A

B

A

B

76

76 226

204

Drive shafts A1 Splined shaft DIN 5480 W45x2x21x9g

36 12

ø70

M16 x 23)4)

36 12

ø70

5/8-11UNC-2B2)3)

T2 Splined shaft 2 in 15 T 8/16DP1)

53 67

1) 2) 3) 4)

RE 91610/04.13

42 50

ANSI B92.1a, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Thread according to ASME B1.1 Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)


287 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

51/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 170 Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Pmax [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

500

O

T1

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M27 x 2; 19 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M33 x 2; 19 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

ISO 61495)

M14 x1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

U

Bearing flushing

ISO 61495)

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HP, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA0)

ISO 8434-1

SDSC–L8xM12–F

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on pages 71). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

1

2

3

4


288 52/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 170 EP1, EP2

EP5D1, EP6D1

Proportional control electric, positive control

Proportional control electric, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

322

328

M1

G

G

195

133

M1

A B

A 197

266

B

G

G

M1

M1

HP1, HP2

HP5, HP6

Proportional control hydraulic, positive control

Proportional control hydraulic, negative control

322

326 296

40.5

M1

X

G

G

A

B

A

G

X 232

40.5

G

M1

X

HP5D1, HP6D1 Proportional control hydraulic, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

40.5

328 297

X

G

X 108 141

G

197

A

M1

M1

197

181 197

B

X 108 133

133

M1

B

RE 91610/04.13

M1


289 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 170 HZ5

EZ5, EZ6

Two-point control hydraulic, negative control

Two-point control electric, negative control

G

X

G

G 187

G

107 133

X

1

326

326 291

40.5

53/72

A 197

B

A 197

B

M1

M1

M1

M1 2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T3, HA2T3

HA1U1, HA2U2

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric, two-point

322

322

M1

M1

M1

133

133

M1

B

A

A

G

X

G 232

40.5

266

181 197

B

G X

3

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

HA1R1, HA2R2 Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric and travel direction valve electric

322

M1

133

M1

A 266

B

a

G

G b 112

4


290 54/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 170 DA0

DA1, DA2

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max- circuit

G X3

X2

X3

X1; X2 G X3

328 277

8.5

X1

b a

G

115 140

X1

112

X1 X3

G

M1

M1

X1, X2 Pipe fitting SDSC – L8xM12 – F acc. to ISO 8434-1 Use assembled fitting!

B

A 197

A 197

B

153 176

328 254

174

M1

M1


291 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

55/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 215 EP5, EP6 – Proportional control electric, negative control Port plate 2 — SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

45°

45°

267 401)

1

151 22

7.5

U

T1

G

236

192) 36

107

12. 5°

200

G

Z 0

125

25

39

max. 14.9 32 96 1472)

46.53) 209

Y T2

2

M1

M1

236

3143) 345

31.8

32

66.7

29

ø108

0 ø200 -0.029

View Y

3

Flange FlanschISO ISO3019-2 3019-2

4

1) 2) 3)

To shaft collar Center of gravity Port plate 1 — SAE flange ports A and B at rear


292 56/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 215 Location of the service line ports on the port plates (view Z) 2

1

SAE flange ports A and B at side, opposite

SAE flange ports A and B at rear

A

B

A

B

82 216

82 235

Drive shafts A2 Splined shaft DIN 5480 W50x2x24x9g

36 12

ø70

M16 x 23)4)

36 12

ø70

5/8-11UNC-2B2)3)

T2 Splined shaft 2 in 15 T 8/16DP1)

53 67

1) 2) 3) 4)

RE 91610/04.13

44 55

ANSI B92.1a, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Thread according to ASME B1.1 Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Center bore according to DIN 332 (thread according to DIN 13)


293 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

57/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 215 Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size1)

Pmax [bar]2)

State6)

A, B

Service line Fastening thread A/B

SAE J5183) DIN 13

1 1/4 in M14 x 2; 19 deep

500

O

T1

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M33 x 2; 19 deep

3

X4)

T2

Drain line

ISO 61495)

M42 x 2; 19.5 deep

3

O4)

G

Synchronous control

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

U

Bearing flushing

ISO 61495)

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

3

X

X

Pilot signal (HP, HZ, HA1T/HA2T)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

100

O

X

Pilot signal (HA1 and HA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

3

X

X1, X2

Pilot signal (DA0)

ISO 8434-1

SDSC–L8xM12–F

40

O

X1

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

O

X3

Pilot signal (DA1, DA2)

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

40

X

M1

Measuring stroking chamber

ISO 61495)

M14 x 1.5; 11.5 deep

500

X

1) 2)

3) 4) 5) 6)

Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. Only dimensions according to SAE J518, metric fastening thread is a deviation from standard. Depending on installation position, T1 or T2 must be connected (see also installation instructions on pages 71). The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)

1

2

3

4


294 58/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 215 EP1, EP2

EP5D1, EP6D1

Proportional control electric, positive control

Proportional control electric, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

339

345

M1

M1

G

A B

A 209

275

B

200

140

G

G

G

M1

M1

HP1, HP2

HP5, HP6

Proportional control hydraulic, positive control

Proportional control hydraulic, negative control

343 312

40.5

339

M1

X

G

G

A

B

A

G

G

X

40.5

M1 X

245

HP5D1, HP6D1 Proportional control hydraulic, negative control, with pressure control fixed setting

344 313

40.5

G

X

X 112 145

G

A 209

B

M1

M1

209

190 206

B

X 113 140

140

M1

M1


295 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 215 HZ5

EZ5, EZ6

Two-point control hydraulic, negative control

Two-point control electric, negative control

1

G

G

X

G 191

G

111 140

X

343

343 308

40.5

A

A 209

B 209

B

59/72

M1

M1

M1

M1

2

HA1, HA2 / HA1T3, HA2T3

HA1U1, HA2U2

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override hydraulic remote control, proportional

Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric, two-point 339

339

M1

M1 140

M1

140

M1

B

A

A

G

G

X

40.5

245

276

190 206

B

G

X

3

G

HA1 and HA2, X plugged HA1T and HA2T, X open

HA1R1, HA2R2 Automatic control high-pressure related, positive control, with override electric and travel direction valve electric 339

M1 140

M1

A 276

B

a

G b 112

G

4


296 60/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Dimensions size 215 DA0

DA1, DA2

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with hydraulic travel direction valve

Automatic control speed related, negative control, with electric travel direction valve and electric Vg max- circuit

345 271

174

X1

G X3

X2

X1, X2

112

G X3

X3

345 294

8.5

X1

b a

X1 X3 157 180

119 144

G

G

M1

M1 X1, X2 Pipe fitting SDSC – L8xM12 – F acc. to ISO 8434-1 Use assembled fitting!

B

A 209

A 209

B

M1

M1


297 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

61/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Connector for solenoids DEUTSCH DT04-2P-EP04 Molded, 2-pin, without bidirectional suppressor diode There is the following type of protection with mounted mating connector: IP67 ___________________________________DIN/EN 60529

1

and IP69K _______________________________ DIN 40050-9 Circuit symbol

Mating connector DEUTSCH DT06-2S-EP04 Bosch Rexroth Mat. No. R902601804 Consisting of:

DT designation

2

– 1 housing ____________________________ DT06-2S-EP04 – 1 wedge ______________________________________ W2S – 2 sockets ___________________________ 0462-201-16141 The mating connector is not included in the delivery contents. This can be supplied by Bosch Rexroth on request. For EZ7, EZ8 and HA.U, HA.R (for electric override)

36.7 (2)

(2) (1)

50 68.5

Ø45

ø37

40

36.7

(1)

3

50 68.5

Changing connector orientation If necessary, you can change the connector orientation by turning the solenoid housing. To do this, proceed as follows: 1. Loosen the mounting nut (1) of the solenoid. To do this, turn the mounting nut (1) one turn counter-clockwise. 2. Turn the solenoid body (2) to the desired orientation. 3. Retighten the mounting nut. Tightening torque: 5+1 Nm. (WAF26, 12-sided DIN 3124) On delivery, the connector orientation may differ from that shown in the brochure or drawing.

4


298 62/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Flushing and boost pressure valve The flushing and boost pressure valve is used to remove heat from the hydraulic circuit.

Schematic EP Port Sa only for sizes 150 to 215

In an open circuit, it is used only for flushing the housing. In a closed circuit, it ensures a minimum boost pressure level in addition to the case flushing. Hydraulic fluid is directed from the respective low pressure side into the motor housing. This is then fed into the reservoir, together with the case drain fluid. The hydraulic fluid, removed out of the closed circuit must be replaced by cooled hydraulic fluid from the boost pump.

G U

T1

The valve is mounted onto the port plate or integrated (depending on the control type and size).

B

Cracking pressure of pressure retaining valve (observe when setting the primary valve) Sizes 60 to 215, fixed setting _______________________16 bar

Vg min Vg max

Switching pressure of flushing piston 'p Sizes 60 to 115 (small flushing valve) ______________ 8±1 bar Sizes 115 to 215 (medium and large flushing valve)17.5±1.5 bar Flushing flow qv Orifices can be used to set the flushing flows as required. Following parameters are based on: 'pND = pND – pG = 25 bar und Q = 10 mm2/s (pND = low pressure, pG = case pressure) Small flushing valve for sizes 60 to 115 Material number of orifice R909651766 R909419695 R909419696 R909419697 R909444361

ø [mm] 1.2 1.4 1.8 2.0 2.4

qv [L/min] 3.5 5 8 10 14

Code A B C D F

qv [L/min] 20 25 30

Code H J K

Medium flushing valve for size 115 Material number of orifice R909431310 R909435172 R909449967

ø [mm] 2.8 3.5 5.0

Large flushing valve for sizes 150 to 215 Material number of orifice R909449998 R909431308 R909431309 R909431310 R902138235 R909435172 R909436622 R909449967

ø [mm] 1.8 2.0 2.5 2.8 3.1 3.5 4.0 5.0

qv [L/min] 8 10 17 20 25 30 35 40

Code C D G H J K L M

For a flushing flow greater than 35 L/min, it is recommended that port Sa be connected in order to prevent an increase in case pressure. An increased case pressure reduces the flushing flow.

A

T2 Flushing piston Flushing orifice Pressure retaining valve M1

Sa


299 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Flushing and boost pressure valve Dimensions of sizes 60 to 115 (small flushing valve) HP5, HP6 EP5, EP6 DA

Dimensions for sizes 150 to 215 (large flushing valve) HA1, HA2 HP1, HP2 EP1, EP2

HZ7 EZ7, EZ8

HP5, HP6, DA EP5, EP6 HZ5, EZ5, EZ6

Sa

1 B2 A2

A2

HA1, HA2 HP1, HP2 EP1, EP2

63/72

B3 A3

A3

Z

Sa B1

A4

A1

NG

A1

A2

A3

A4

060

243

133

176

236

085

273

142

194

254

115

287

143

202

269

Dimensions of size 115 (medium flushing valve) HP5, HP6 EP5, EP6 DA

Sa

38 2

NG

A1

B1

A2

B2

A3

B3

B4

150

325

239

165

142

230

187

166

170

332

246

165

142

233

190

172

215

349

263

172

148

244

201

185

151

HA1, HA2 HP1, HP2 EP1, EP2

B4 A1

205

3

292 NG

Sa1)

150

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

170

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

215

M22 x 1.5; 15.5 deep

1)

ISO 6149, ports plugged (in normal operation) Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard.

4


300 64/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Function Travel drive/winch counterbalance valves are designed to reduce the danger of overspeeding and cavitation of axial piston motors in open circuits. Cavitation occurs if the motor speed is greater than it should be for the given input flow while braking, travelling downhill, or lowering a load. If the inlet pressure drops, the counterbalance spool throttles the return flow and brakes the motor until the inlet pressure returns to approx. 20 bar. Note – BVD available for sizes 60 to 215 and BVE available for sizes 115 to 215. – The counterbalance valve must be ordered additionally. We recommend ordering the counterbalance valve and the motor as a set. Ordering example: A6VM085HA1T30004A/71MWV0N4S97W0-0 + BVD20F27S/41B–V03K16D0400S12 – For safety reasons, controls with beginning of control at Vg min (e. g. HA) are not permissible for winch drives! – The counterbalance valve does not replace the mechanical service brake and park brake. – Observe the detailed notes on the BVD counterbalance valve in RE 95522 and BVE counterbalance valve in RE 95525! – For the design of the brake release valve, we must know for the mechanical park brake: - the pressure at the start of opening - the volume of the brake piston between minimum stroke (brake closed) and maximum stroke (brake released with 21 bar) - the required closing time for a warm device (oil viscosity approx. 15 mm2/s)

Travel drive counterbalance valve BVD...F Application option – Travel drive on wheeled excavators Example schematic for travel drive on wheeled excavators A6VM085HA1T30004A/71MWV0N4S97W0-0 + BVD20F27S/41B–V03K16D0400S12 Pump, directional valve, not included in the delivery contents

Counterbalance valve BVD

Variable motor A6VM...HA1T M1

Gext

T1

MB

U

L´ B

B´ Vg min Vg max

S A

A´ G´ T2

MA G

X


301 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

65/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Winch counterbalance valve BVD...W and BVE Application options – Winch drive in cranes (BVD and BVE) 1

– Track drive in excavator crawlers (BVD) Example schematic for winch drive in cranes A6VM085HP5D10001A/71MWV0N4S97W0-0 + BVE25W38S/51ND-V100K00D4599T30S00-0 G X

Pump, directional valve, not included in the delivery contents

Variable motor A6VM...HP5D

Counterbalance valve BVE Gext

MB

T1

U

G´ D

2 B

D´ Vg min Vg max

S A

C´ L´

C

MA

D2 D1

Mk VF

Winch with mechanical park brake T2 M1

MP1

3

VG

Permissible input flow or pressure in operation with DBV and BVD/BVE Without valve Motor

Restricted values in operation with DBV and BVD/BVE DBV

BVD/BVE

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV max [L/min]

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV [L/min]

Code

NG

pnom/pmax [bar]

qV [L/min]

Code

60

450/500

276

22

350/420

240

7

20 (BVD)

350/420

220

7W

8

25 (BVD/BVE)

320

8W

85

332

115

410

115

410

150

494

170

533

215

628

32

400

On request

DBV _______________________________ pressure-relief valve BVD __________________counterbalance valve, double-acting BVE _____________________ counterbalance valve, one-sided

4


302 66/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE Dimensions

A6VM...HP5, HP6 and EP5, EP61)

A6VM...HA, HP1, HP2 and EP1, EP2 A1 A2

A8

A5

A9 A2

A6 A7

A10

Gext B

S A3

S

A, B

A, B B

MB, (MA)

A7 A6

A4

A4

A

A MB, (MA)

Br A8

A5

A6VM

Counterbalance valve

NG...plate

Type

Ports

Dimensions

A, B

A1

A2

A3

A4

A5

A6

A7

A8

A9

A10

60...7

BVD20...17

3/4 in

311

302

143

50

98

139

75

222

326

50

85...7

BVD20...27

1 in

340

331

148

55

98

139

75

222

355

46

115...7

BVD20...28

1 in

362

353

152

59

98

139

84

234

377

41

115...8

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

380

370

165

63

120.5

175

84

238

395

56

150...8

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

411

401

168

67

120.5

175

84

238

426

53

170...8

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

417

407

170

68

120.5

175

84

238

432

51

215...8

BVD25...38

1 1/4 in

448

438

176

74

120.5

175

84

299

463

46

115...8

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

380

370

171

63

137

214

84

238

397

63

150...8

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

411

401

175

67

137

214

84

238

423

59

170...8

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

417

407

176

68

137

214

84

238

432

59

215...8

BVE25...38

1 1/4 in

448

438

182

74

137

214

84

299

463

52

Ports Designation Port for A, B

Service line

S

Infeed

Br

Brake release, reduced high pressure

Gext

Brake release, high pressure

MA, M B

Measuring pressure A and B

1)

2) 3)

4) 5)

Version

A6VM plate

Standard

Size2)

Pmax [bar]2)

State5)

SAE J518

see table above

420

O

BVD20

DIN 38524) M22 x 1.5; 14 deep

30

X

BVD25, BVE25

DIN 38524) M27 x 2; 16 deep

30

X

L

7

DIN 38524) M12 x 1.5; 12.5 deep 30

O

8

DIN 38524) M12 x 1.5; 12 deep

O

S

30

DIN 38524) M12 x 1.5; 12.5 deep 420 ISO

61494)

M18 x 1.5; 14.5 deep 420

X X

At the mounting version for the controls HP5, HP6 and EP5, EP6, the cast-in port designations A and B on the counterbalance valve BVD do not correspond with the connection drawing of the A6VM motor. The designation of the ports on the installation drawing of the motor is binding! Observe the general instructions on pages 72 for the maximum tightening torques. Momentary pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = Must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation)


303 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Counterbalance valve BVD and BVE

67/72

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Mounting the counterbalance valve When delivered, the counterbalance valve is mounted to the motor with two tacking screws (transport protection). The tacking screws may not be removed while mounting the service lines. If the counterbalance valve and motor are delivered separately, the counterbalance valve must first be mounted to the motor port plate using the provided tacking screws. The counterbalance valve is finally mounted to the motor by screwing on the SAE flange with the following screws:

1

6 screws (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8) ______________ length B1+B2+B3 2 screws (6, 7) __________________________ length B3+B4 Tighten the screws in two steps in the specified sequence from 1 to 8 (see following scheme). In the first step, the screws must be tightened with half the tightening torque, and in the second step with the maximum tightening torque (see following table). Thread

Strength class

Tightening torque [Nm]

M6 x 1 (tacking screw) 10.9

15.5

M10

10.9

75

M12

10.9

130

M14

10.9

205

B1

2)

4

8 5 2)

26

B2

2

B3

1 1)

73

3

B4

1) 2)

SAE flange Tacking screw (M6 x 1, length = B1 + B2, DIN 912)

NG...plate

60...7

85...7 115...7

115...8, 150...8, 170...8

B13)

M10 x 1.5 17 deep

M12 x 1.75 15 deep

M14 x 2 19 deep

B2

68

68

85

B3

customer-specific

B4

M10 x 1.5 15 deep

3)

M12 x 1.75 16 deep

Minimum required thread reach 1 x Ă˜-thread

4 M14 x 2 19 deep


304 68/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Before finalizing your design, request a binding installation drawing. Dimensions in mm.

Speed sensor

Dimensions Version "V" with mounted speed sensor

Version A6VM...U ("prepared for speed sensor", i.e. without sensor) is equipped with a toothed ring on the rotary group. With the speed sensor DSM mounted, a signal proportional to motor speed can be generated. The DSM sensor measures the speed and direction of rotation.

C

B A

Ordering code, technical data, dimensions and details on the connector, plus safety information about the sensor can be found in the relevant data sheet (DSM – RE 95132). The sensor is mounted on the port provided for this purpose with a mounting bolt. On deliveries without sensor, the port is plugged with a pressure-resistant cover. We recommend ordering the A6VM variable motor complete with sensor mounted. Schematic U

U

n

T1

T2

Size

60

85

115

150

170

215

Number of teeth

54

58

67

72

75

80

A

Insertion depth (tolerance -0.25) 18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

18.4

B

Contact surface

75

79

88

93

96

101

66.2

75.2

77.2

91.2

91.7

95.2

C

RE 91610/04.13


305 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

69/72

Setting range for displacement 60

85

115

150

Vg max (cm3/rev) Vg min (cm3/rev) Vg max (cm3/rev) Vg min (cm3/rev) Vg max (cm3/rev) Vg min (cm3/rev)

A

B

to

from

to

from

to

from

to

from

to

from

to

from

to

from

to

62.0

62.0

0.0

15.0

85.2

85.2

0.0

31.5

115.6

115.6

0.0

24.0

152.1

152.1

0.0

44.0

without screw

M10 x 60 R909154690

without screw

M12 x 70 R909085976

without screw

62.0

> 15.0

85.2

> 31.5

115.6

62.0

without screw 62.0

30.5

M10 x 70 R909153779 > 30.5

43.0

85.2

without screw 85.2

85.2

52.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 52.0

59.0

without screw

M10 x 80 R909154058

without screw

M12 x 90 R909154041

x

x

x

x

< 62.0

47.5

M10 x 60 R909154690 < 62.0

F

47.5

M10 x 60 R909154690 < 62.0

47.5

0.0

15.0

M10 x 60 R909154690 > 15.0

30.5

M10 x 70 R909153779 > 30.5

43.0

< 85.2

55.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 < 85.2

55.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 < 85.2

55.5

0.0

115.6

31.5

52.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 52.0

59.0

G

M10 x 60 R909154690

M10 x 80 R909154058

M12 x 70 R909085976

M12 x 90 R909154041

H

x

x

x

x

without screw

< 115.6

< 47.5

33.0

M10 x 70 R909153779 < 47.5

K

33.0

M10 x 70 R909153779 < 47.5

33.0

0.0

15.0

M10 x 60 R909154690 > 15.0

30.5

M10 x 70 R909153779 > 30.5

43.0

< 55.5

35.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 55.5

35.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 55.5

35.0

0.0

31.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 > 31.5

52.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 52.0

115.6

59.0

L

M10 x 70 R909153779

M10 x 80 R909154058

M12 x 80 R909153075

M12 x 90 R909154041

M

x

x

x

x

93.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 < 115.6

93.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 < 115.6

93.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 < 115.6

J

115.6

without screw

M12 x 70 R909085976 > 31.5

115.6

without screw

115.6 D

E

Vg min (cm3/rev)

from

62.0 C

Vg max (cm3/rev)

93.5

M12 x 70 R909085976 > 24.0

47.5

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 47.5

71.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 71.0

80.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 0.0

24.0

M12 x 70 R909085976 > 24.0

47.5

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 47.5

71

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 71.0

80.0

M12 x 70 R909085976

M12 x 100 R909153975

< 93.5

0.0

71.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 93.5

71.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 93.5

71.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 93.5

71.0

M12 x 80 R909153075

Specify exact settings for Vg min and Vg max in plain text when ordering: Vg min = ... cm3, Vg max = ... cm3 Theoretical, maximum setting: for Vg min = 0.7 • Vg max for Vg max = 0.3 • Vg max Settings that are not listed in the table may lead to damage. Please contact us.

24.0

M12 x 70 R909085976 > 24.0

47.5

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 47.5

71.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 71.0

80.0

M12 x 100 R909153975

without screw 152.1

152.1

without screw 152.1

152.1

without screw 152.1

152.1

without screw < 152.1

111.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 152.1

111.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 152.1

111.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 152.1

111.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 111.0

87.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 111.0

87.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 111.0

87.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 111.0

87.0

M12 x 90 R909154041

1

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 44.0

69.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 69.0

99.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 99.0

106.0

M12 x 110 R909154212 0.0

44.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 44.0

2

69.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 69.0

99.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 99.0 106.0 M12 x 110 R909154212 0.0

44.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 44.0

3

69.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 69.0

99.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 99.0

106.0

M12 x 110 R909154212

4


306 70/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

Setting range for displacement 170 Vg max (cm3/rev)

A

from

to

from

to

from

to

171.8

171.8

0.0

35.0

216.5

216.5

0.0

44.5

without screw

112.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 112.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 139.0

M

112.0

M12 x 90 R909154041

< 139.0 L

139.0

M12 x 80 R909153075

< 139.0 K

139.0

M12 x 80 R909153075

< 139.0 J

139.0

M12 x 80 R909153075

< 171.8 H

139.0

M12 x 80 R909153075

< 171.8 G

171.8

without screw

< 171.8 F

171.8

without screw

< 171.8 E

171.8

without screw

171.8 D

Vg min (cm3/rev)

to

171.8 C

Vg max (cm3/rev)

from

171.8 B

215

Vg min (cm3/rev)

112.0

M12 x 90 R909154041

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 35.0

63.5

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 63.5

98.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 98.0

120.0

M12 x 110 R909154212 0.0

35.0

M10 x 80 R909153075 > 35.0

63.5

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 63.5

98.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 98.0

120.0

M12 x 110 R909154212 0.0

35.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 35.0

63.5

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 63.5

98.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 98.0

120.0

M12 x 110 R909154212

without screw 216.5

216.5

without screw 216.5

216.5

without screw 216.5

216.5

without screw < 216.5

175.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 216.5

175.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 216.5

175.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 216.5

175.0

M12 x 80 R909153075 < 175.0

141.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 175.0

141.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 175.0

141.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 < 175.0

141.0

M12 x 90 R909154041

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 44.5

80.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 80.0

115.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 115.0

150.0

M12 x 110 R909154212 0.0

44.5

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 44.5

80.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 80.0

115.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 115.0

150.0

M12 x 110 R909154212 0.0

44.5

M12 x 80 R909153075 > 44.5

80.0

M12 x 90 R909154041 > 80.0

115.0

M12 x 100 R909153975 > 115.0

150.0

M12 x 110 R909154212

Specify exact settings for Vg min and Vg max in plain text when ordering: Vg min = ... cm3, Vg max = ... cm3 Theoretical, maximum setting: for Vg min = 0.7 • Vg max for Vg max = 0.3 • Vg max Settings that are not listed in the table may lead to damage. Please contact us.

RE 91610/04.13


307 RE 91610/04.13

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

71/72

Installation instructions General

Below-reservoir installation (standard)

During commissioning and operation, the axial piston unit must be filled with hydraulic fluid and air bled. This must also be observed following a relatively long standstill as the axial piston unit may drain back to the reservoir via the hydraulic lines.

Below-reservoir installation means that the axial piston unit is installed outside of the reservoir below the minimum fluid level.

1

2 ht min

Particularly in the installation position "drive shaft upwards" filling and air bleeding via flushing port U must be carried out completely as there is, for example, a danger of dry running.

1 ht min

hmin

hmin T1

U

T2

The case drain fluid in the motor housing must be directed to the reservoir via the highest available drain port (T1, T2). For combinations of multiple units, make sure that the respective case pressure in each unit is not exceeded. In the event of pressure differences at the drain ports of the units, the shared drain line must be changed so that the minimum permissible case pressure of all connected units is not exceeded in any situation. If this is not possible, separate drain lines must be laid if necessary.

T2

T1

3

U

4 ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin 2

To achieve favorable noise values, decouple all connecting lines using elastic elements and avoid above-reservoir installation.

T1

In all operating conditions, the drain line must flow into the reservoir below the minimum fluid level.

U

U T2 T1 T2

Installation position

Recommended installation position: 1 and 2. Note In certain installation positions, an influence on the control characteristics can be expected. Gravity, dead weight and case pressure can cause minor shifts in control characteristics and changes in response time.

Above-reservoir installation Above-reservoir installation means that the axial piston unit is installed above the minimum fluid level of the reservoir. Recommendation for installation position 8 (drive shaft upward): A check valve in the drain line (cracking pressure 0.5 bar) can prevent draining of the motor housing.

5 L1 T1

Installation position

Air bleed

1

–

T1

2

–

T2

3

–

T1

4

U

T1

T2

5

U (L1)

T1 (L1)

ht min

6

L1

T2 (L1)

7

L1

T1 (L1)

U

T1 (L1)

8 L1

Filling / air bleed

U

Bearing flushing / air bleed port

Filling

T1, T2 Drain port ht min Minimum required immersion depth (200 mm) hmin

Minimum required spacing to reservoir bottom (100 mm)

3

6 U

L1 T2

T1 U ht min hmin

hmin

7

8

4 U

L1

T2 T1

L1

T1

T2 0.5 bar

See the following examples 1 to 8. Further installation positions are possible upon request.

U

ht min

ht min

hmin

hmin


308 72/72

Bosch Rexroth AG

A6VM Series 71

RE 91610/04.13

General instructions – The motor A6VM is designed to be used in open and closed circuits. – The project planning, installation and commissioning of the axial piston unit requires the involvement of qualified personnel. – Before using the axial piston unit, please read the corresponding instruction manual completely and thoroughly. If necessary, these can be requested from Bosch Rexroth. – During and shortly after operation, there is a risk of burns on the axial piston unit and especially on the solenoids. Take appropriate safety measures (e. g. by wearing protective clothing). – Depending on the operating conditions of the axial piston unit (operating pressure, fluid temperature), the characteristic may shift. – Service line ports: - The ports and fastening threads are designed for the specified maximum pressure. The machine or system manufacturer must ensure that the connecting elements and lines correspond to the specified application conditions (pressure, flow, hydraulic fluid, temperature) with the necessary safety factors. - The service line ports and function ports can only be used to accommodate hydraulic lines.

– The data and notes contained herein must be adhered to. – Not all versions of the product are approved for use in a safety function pursuant to ISO 13849. If you require characteristic values relating to reliability (e. g. MTTFd) for functional safety, please consult the responsible contact person at Bosch Rexroth. – The following tightening torques apply: - Fittings: Observe the manufacturer's instructions regarding the tightening torques of the fittings used. - Mounting bolts: For mounting bolts with metric ISO thread according to DIN 13 or thread according to ASME B1.1, we recommend checking the tightening torque in individual cases in accordance with VDI 2230. - Female threads in the axial piston unit: The maximum permissible tightening torques MG max are maximum values of the female threads and must not be exceeded. For values, see the following table. - Threaded plugs: For the metallic threaded plugs supplied with the axial piston unit, the required tightening torques of threaded plugs MV apply. For values, see the following table.

Standard

Size of thread

Maximum permissible tightening torque of the female threads MG max

Required tightening torque of the threaded plugs MV

WAF hexagon socket of the threaded plugs

ISO 6149

M10 x 1 M12 x 1.5 M14 x 1.5 M16 x 1.5 M18 x 1.5 M22 x 1.5 M27 x 2 M33 x 2 M42 x 2 M12 x 1.5 M22 x 1.5 M27 x 2

30 Nm 50 Nm 80 Nm 100 Nm 140 Nm 210 Nm 330 Nm 540 Nm 720 Nm 50 Nm 210 Nm 330 Nm

15 Nm 25 Nm 45 Nm 55 Nm 70 Nm 100 Nm 170 Nm 310 Nm 330 Nm 25 Nm1)2) 80 Nm1) 135 Nm1)

5 mm 6 mm 6 mm 8 mm 8 mm 10 mm 12 mm 17 mm 22 mm 6 mm 10 mm 12 mm

Ports

DIN 3852

1)

2)

The tightening torques apply for screws in the “dry” state as received on delivery and in the “lightly oiled” state for installation. In the “lightly oiled” state, the MV is reduced to 17 Nm for M12 x 1.5.

Bosch Rexroth AG Mobile Applications Glockeraustraße 4 89275 Elchingen, Germany Tel. +49 7308 82-0 info.ma@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


309 Electric Drives and Controls

Hydraulics

Linear Motion and Assembly Technologies

Pneumatics

Axial piston variable motor A10VM Plug-in version A10VE

Service

RE 91703/03.10 Replaces: 06.09

1/28

Data sheet

Series 52 Size 28 to 85 Nominal pressure 280 bar Maximum pressure 350 bar Open and closed circuit

A10VM

Features

Contents Features

1

Ordering code for standard program

2

Technical data

4

Two-point direct control DG

7

Two-point control, hydraulically operated HZ/HZ6

8

Two-point control, electrically operated EZ

A10VE

9

Dimensions size A10VM 28 to 85

10

Dimensions size A10VE 28 to 63

18

Integrated flushing and boost press. relief valve, N007

24

Connector for solenoids

25

Speed pickup

26

Mounting position

27

General instructions

28

– Dual displacement motor, axial piston swashplate design, for hydrostatic transmissions in open and closed circuits – Output speed is directly proportional to inlet flow and inversely proportional to motor displacement – Output torque increases proportional to the pressure difference between high and low pressure sides and increasing displacement – Heavy duty bearings for long service life – High permissible output speed – Well proven A10-rotary unit technology – High power/weight ratio – compact dimensions – Cost effective – Low noise – External control pressure supply possible – Minimum displacement can be set externally – SAE-2-bolt mounting flange on A10VM – Special 2-bolt mounting flange on A10VE


310 2/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Ordering code for standard program A10V M 01

02

/ 03

52

W

05

06

04

– 07

V 08

C 09

10

11

12

13

14

Axial piston unit 01 Swash plate design, variable, nominal pressure 280 bar, maximum pressure 350 bar

A10V

Operating Mode 02 Motor, open and closed circuit

M

Size (NG) 03 Displacement Vg max in cm3

028 045 063 085

Control devices

028 045 063 085

Two point control

04

Stroking time orifice

without

HZ

with

HZ6

Electricaly with solenoid valve Stroking time orifice control voltage 12V

without

EZ1

with

EZ6

Electricaly with solenoid valve Stroking time orifice control voltage 24V

without

EZ2

with

EZ7

Directly operated, external control supply, without pilot valve Hydraulically operated

DG

Series 05 Series 5, Index 2

52

Direction of rotation 06 Viewed on shaft end

Bi-directional 028

Minimum displacement 07

045

W 063

085

Vg min (in cm3) steplessly adjustable

from/to

8/28

12/25

16/38

22/50

1

Adjustment state in clear text

from/to

26/45

40/62

48/85

2

Seals 08 FKM (flour-rubber)

V

Drive shaft 09

028 045 063 085

Splined shaft, ANSI B92.1a-1976, for higher drive torque

R

Splined shaft, ANSI B92.1a-1976, for reduced drive torque

W

Mounting flange 10 SAE J744 2-bolt

C

Ports for service lines ●

● 10N00

❍ 11N00

❍ 16N00

Without valves

0

Integrated flushing valve, only with side ports (10N00 and 16N00)

7

Without speed pickup

Prepared for inductive type of speed pickup ID R

D

HIRSCHMANN - connector – without suppressor diod

H

DEUTSCH - connector, molded, 2-pin – without suppressor diod

P

SAE flanges , at side-same side, metric fixing screws 11 SAE flanges at rear, metric fixing screws

Threaded ports on side, same side, metric thread Valves 12

Speed pickup 13

Connector for solenoids 14

= available

❍ = in preparation

– = not available

▲ = not for new projects


311 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

3/28

Ordering code for standard program A10V E 01

02

/ 03

52

W

05

06

04

– 07

V 08

F 09

10

11

12

13

14

Axial piston unit 01 Swash plate design, variable, nominal pressure 280 bar, maximum pressure 350 bar

A10V

1

Operating mode 02 Motor, plug in type, open and closed circuit

E

Size (NG) 03 Displacement Vg max in cm3

028 045 063

Control devices

028 045 063

Two point control

Stroking time orifice

without

HZ

with

HZ6

Stroking time orifice

without

EZ1

with

EZ6

Stroking time orifice

without

EZ2

with

EZ7

Directly operated, external control supply, without pilot valve Hydraulically Electricaly with solenoid valve

04

control voltage 12V Electricaly with solenoid valve control voltage 24V

DG

2

Series 05 Series 5, Index 2

52

Direction of rotation 06 Viewed on shaft end

Bi-directional

Minimum displacement 07

W

028

045

063

Vg min (in cm3) stepples adjustable

from/to

10/28

12/25

16/38

1

Adjustment please state in clear text

from/to

26/45

40/62

2

Seals

3

08 FKM (flour-rubber)

V

Drive shaft 09

028 045 063

Splined shaft, ANSI B92.1a-1976, for higher drive torque

R

Splined shaft, ANSI B92.1a-1976, for reduced drive torque

W

Mounting flange 10 Special 2-bolt

F

Ports for service line ●

● 10N00

❍ 11N00

● 16N00 4

Without valves

0

Integrated flushing valve, only with side ports (10N00 and 16N00)

7

Without speed pickup

Prepared for inductive type of speed pickup ID R

D

HIRSCHMANN - connector – without suppressor diod

H

DEUTSCH - connector, molded, 2-pin – without suppressor diod

P

SAE flanges at side-same side, metric fixing screws 11 SAE flanges at rear, metric fixing screws

Threaded ports on side , same side, metric thread Valves 12

Speed pickup 13

Connector for solenoids 14

= available

❍ = in preparation

– = not available

▲ = not for new projects


312 4/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Technical data Fluid

Filtration of fluid

Prior to project design please see our data sheets RE 90220 (mineral oil), RE 90221 (ecologically acceptable fluids) and RE90223 (HF-fluids) for detailed information on fluids and application conditions.

The finer the filtration the better the achieved cleanliness of the fluid and the longer the life of the axial piston unit. To ensure a reliable functioning of the axial piston unit, a minimum cleanliness of

When operating on ecologically acceptable fluids, limitations to the techical data may be necessary. Please contact us and state the fluid used in clear text when ordering.

20/18/15 to ISO 4406 is necessary. At very high fluid temperatures (90 °C to max. 115 °C) the minimum cleanliness has to be at least 19/17/14 to ISO 4406.

Operating viscosity range For optimum efficiency and service life we recommend an operating viscosity (at operating temperature) in the range Qopt = opt. operating viscosity 16...36 mm2/s referred to circuit temperature in closed circuits or tank temperature in open circuits. The following limits are valid for extreme operating conditions: Qmin = Qmin =

5 mm2/s (closed circuit) 10 mm2/s (open circuit)

If above cleanliness classes cannot be met please consult us. Operating pressure range Pressure at port A or B (Pressure data to DIN 24312) Nominal pressure pN 280 bar 1) Maximum pressure pmax 350 bar With motors connected in series please consult us. Case drain pressure

briefly (t d 1 min) at max. permissible temperature of 115 °C.

Max. permissible pressure at leakage port L

Please note, that the max. fluid temperature of 115 °C may also not be exceeded in certain areas (for instance bearing area) The temperature in the bearing area is approx. 5 K higher than the average fluid temperature.

pabs max operation as a motor in open circuit pabs max operation as a motor in closed circuit pabs max motor/pump operation in open circuit

At temperatures between –25 °C and –40 °C special measures may be required for certain installation positions. Please consult us for further information For detailed information on operation at very low temperatures see RE 90300-03-B. Notes on the selection of the hydraulic fluid In order to select the correct fluid, it is necessary to know the operating temperature in the tank (open circuit), circuit temperature (closed circuits), in relation to the ambient temperature.

Important: The leakage fluid (case drain fluid) temperature is influenced by pressure and motor speed and is always higher than the tank temperature. However, at no point in the circuit may the temperature exceed 115 °C. If it is not possible to comply with the above conditions because of extreme operating parameters or high ambient temperatures please consult us

clockwise

counter-clockwise

B to A

A to B

Adjustment of displacement The minimum displacement is steplessly adjustable within the range of the screw lenghts 1 or 2 (see ordering code). Please state minimum displacement in clear text when ordering. Selection diagram 2500-40° 1600 1000 600 400

-20°

20°

40°

60°

80°

100°

1600

0 10 VG 68 VG 46 VG 32 VG 2 2

Example: at an ambient temperature of X °C the operating temperature in the tank is 60 °C. In the optimum viscosity range (Qopt; shaded area) this corresponds to viscosity grades VG 46 resp. VG 68; select VG 68.

Direction of rotation, viewed on shaft end

VG

The fluid should be selected, so that within the operating temperatue range, the viscosity lies within the optimum range (Qopt), see shaded section of the selection diagram. We recommend to select the higher viscosity grade in each case.

Direction of rotation

200 100

Viscosity Q [mm2/s]

Qmax = 1600 mm2/s briefly (t d 1 min) on cold start (tmin = -25°C, p d 30 bar, n d 1000 rpm).

4 bar abs 4 bar abs 2 bar abs

60 40

36 ν opt.

20

16

10

5 -40°

-25°

-10° 0° 10°

30°

50°

70°

90°

5 115°

Temperature range t in °C tmin = -40°C

Fluid temperature range

tmax = +115°C


313 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

5/28

Technical data Table of values (theoretical values, without efficiency levels and tolerances; values rounded) Size

28

45

63

Vg max

cm3

28

45

62

87

Vg min

cm3

8 (VM)/10(VE)

12

16

22

max. at Vg max

n0 max

min-1

4700

4000

3300

3100

max. at Vg min

n0 max zul

min-1

5400

4600

3900

3560

n0 min

min-1

250

250

250

250

qV0 max

L/min

131,6

180

205

270

TK

Nm/bar 0,445

0,716

1,002

1,35

Tmax

Nm

125

200

276

387

92

Displacement

85 1

Speed1)

Min. speed in cont. operation Inlet flow bei n0 max and Vg max Torque constant2) at Vg max Torque pN= 280 bar

at Vg max

Actual starting torque at n = 0 min-1

pN = 280 bar

T

Nm ca.

149

205

253

Rotary stiffness

Shaft R

c

Nm/rad 26000

41000

69400

152900

c

Nm/rad 19800

34400

54000

117900

J

kgm2

0,0033

0,0056

0,012

Shaft W Mass moment of inertia (about output shaft)

0,0017

Filling volume

V

L

0,6

0,7

0,8

1,0

Weight approx.

m

kg

14

18

26

34

1) 2)

2

At maximal speed in closed circuit operation make sure that motor outlet pressure is at least t 18 bar. In open circuit 'p 280bar at pboostpress. 2bar In closed circuit 'p 260bar at pboostpress. 20bar

3 Minimum required outlet pressure (low pressure) at port A (B) depending on motor speed

Outlet pressure pHD [bar]

25

20

permissible range

15

10

4

5

0 0,8

0,9

1

Motor speed n/nmax

1,1

1,2


314 6/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Technical data Calculating size Vg • n

Flow

qV =

Torque

T

=

or

T

= TK • 'p • Kmh

Output power P

Output speed n

1,59 • Vg • 'p •Kmh

[Nm]

100 2S • T • n

=

=

[L/min]

1000 • KV

60000

=

qV • 'p • Kt

[kW]

600

qv • 1000 • Kv

Vg

= Displacement per rev. in cm3

'p

= Differential pressure in bar

n

= speed in rpm

KV

= Volumetric efficiency

Kmh

= Mechanical-hydraulic efficiency

Kt

= Total efficiency (Kt = KV • Kmh)

TK

= Torque constant

[min-1]

Vg

Permissible radial and axial forces on drive shaft Size

28

45

63

85

Fq

Max. radial force

at X/2

Fq max

N

1200

1500

1700

2000

Fax

N

1000

1500

2000

3000

X/2 X/2 X

Max. axial force

r Fax


315 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

7/28

Two-point direct control DG Normally the motor is at max. displacement. By applying an external pressure to port G, the control piston is directly pressurized and the motor swivels back to min. displacement

Circuit diagram

L L1

The minimum required control pressure is pSt t 40 bar

G G1 A 1

Please note, that this minimum required control pressure at port G depends directly on the operating pressure pB in port A or B. (Pressure in A or B),see control pressure diagram below. With a control pressure above this minimum required pressure level the motor will destroke properly. Control pressure diagram

B

Control pressure pSt [bar]

140 100

Ports for

60 40 20 0 0 20 40 60

100

140

180

220

260 280

A, B

Pressure

L, L1

Caise drain (L1 plugged)

G, G1

For external control pressure (G1 plugged)

2

Operating pressure pB [bar]

Control pressure

= 0 bar

^ = Vg max

Control pressure

t 40 bar

^ = Vg min (see circuit diagram)

The max. permissible control pressure is pSt = 280 bar. Vgmin adjustment please state in clear text with order 3

4


316 8/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Two-point control, hydraulically operated HZ/HZ6 Normally the motor is at max. displacement. By applying a pilot pressure pX to port X the pilot valve shifts and the control piston is pressurized causing the motor to swivel to min. displacement (pX t 30bar).

Circuit diagram HZ

X

The necessary control pressure is via a shuttle valve taken out of the motor pressure side A or B. A minimum pressure difference of 'pA,B t 20 bar between the motor pressure sides is required.

L L1

A

Only Vg max or Vg min are possible. Vg min - adjustment please state in clear text when ordering.

280

Pilot pressure pSt [bar]

B Ports for

30 10

Pressure

L, L1

Caise drain (L1 plugged)

X

Pilot pressure (plugged)

Circuit diagram HZ6

0 Vg min

A, B

Displacement

Pilot pressure pX = 0 bar

^ = Vg max

Pilot pressure pX t 30 bar

^ = Vg min

Vg max

X

Techn. data HZ/HZ6 Minimum pilot pressure

30 bar

Maximum permissible pilot pressure

280 bar

L L1

A

Version HZ6 with stroking time shuttle orifice Slow down of swivel action by means of shuttle orifice. This enables a smooth swivel action. Standard orifice size = 0.21 mm; other sizes on request.

B Ports for A, B

Pressure

L, L1

Caise drain (L1 plugged)

X

Pilot pressure (plugged)


317 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

9/28

Two-point control, electrically operated EZ1) Normally the motor is at maximum displacement. By energizing the solenoid of the control valve, the control piston is pressurized and the motor swivels to minimum displacement.

Circuit diagram EZ1/2

The control pressure is via a shuttle valve taken out of the motor pressure side A or B. A minimum pressure difference of 'pA,B t 20 bar between the pressure sides is required.

L L1

A

1

The motor can only swivel between Vg max or Vg min. Vg min - adjustment please state in clear text when ordering.

12V / 24V

B Ports for A, B

Pressure

L, L1

Caise drain (L1 plugged)

2

0 V g min

V g max

De-energized

^ = Vg max

Energized

^ = Vg min

Connection to solenoid according to DIN 43650

Plug connection to DIN EN 175301-803-A Cable screw joint M 16x1.5

Techn. data EZ Version

EZ 1/6

EZ 2/7

Supply voltage

12V DC

24V DC

Nom. current at 20°C

1.5 A

0.8 A

Duty cycler

100% ED

100% ED

Plug protection class to DIN 43650

IP 65

IP 65

PE A 1

PE A 2

1

2

3

Circuit diagram EZ6/7 Ambient temperature range -20°C to +60°C. If the above temperature range cannot be met please consult us

Features – with spring return at solenoid

L L1

A

– Solenoid plug can be turned 4 x 90°

4

Version EZ6/7 with stroking time shuttle orifice. Slow down of swivel action by means of shuttle orifice. This enables a smooth swivel action. Standard orifice size = 0.21mm; other sizes on request.

B Ports for

More information see page 25 1)

A, B

Pressure

L, L1

Caise drain (L1 plugged)

Shown in the unit dimensions: DIN connector from HIRSCHMANN; Preferred for mobile applications (other dimensions): DEUTSCH connector molded, 2-pin – without suppressor diode


318 10/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size28 A10VM 28DG/52WX-VXC10N000

67 45

90 12 9.5 17

67.5 94

°

ø101.6 h8

G 45

L

69.7 59.6

G1

Flange SAE (J744 101-2 (B))

.5

83

66

14.3

68

27

L1

146 172

115 109.8

G1

B

12

161 189

19

37.5

A

50.8 37.5

G

23.8

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3)

State

A, B

Pressure (High presure series, code 62)

SAE J518

3/4 in

350

O

Fixing thread (port plate 10)

DIN 13

M10; 17 deep

Pressure (port plate 16)

DIN 3852-15) M27x2; 16 deep

350

O O4)

A, B

O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

3/4-16UNF-2B

4

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

3/4-16UNF-2B

4

X4)

G

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

O

G1

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

X

X

Pilot pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20UNF-2B; 10 deep

350

O

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 2) Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must be connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)


319 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

11/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 28 A10VM 28HZX(EZX)/52WX-VXC16N000 106 89

90

16

1

L 45°

82.5 94

L ø101.6 h8

48

14.3

Flange SAE (J744 101-2 (B))

12 9.5

.5

27

L1

66

83

68

146 172

A10VM 28HZX/52WX-VXC16N000

A10VM 28EZX/52WX-VXC16N000

153.5

2

208

B

111

31

A

31

M27x2

A

M27x2

X

B 3

12 161 189

Drive shaft Splined 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 22-4 (B)) ø7/8in 1/4-20UNC-2B

R

usable spline length

4 16

25 6.3 41


320 12/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 45 A10VM 45DG/52WX-VXC10(11)N000

73 49 9.5

45°

99

L1

L1

78 102.5

G

L 78 66

G1 78

ø101.6 h8

L

77

Flange SAE (J744 101-2 (B))

87

14.3

Z

146 172

Port plate 10

View Z Port plate 11

175 110.5

ø19 37.5

50

A .8

B

50

B

ø19

L1

50.8 37.5

A

.8

30

L 12

23

23

.8

23.8

.8

30°

30°

38

38

Ports Designation Port for

Standard

Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3)

State

A, B

350

O

A, B

Pressure (high pressure series, code 62)

SAE J518

3/4 in

Fixing thread (port plate 10)

DIN 13

M10; 17 deep

Pressure (port plate 16)

DIN 3852-15) M27x2; 16 deep

350

O

O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

X4)

G

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

O

G1

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

X

X

Pilot pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20UNF-2B; 10 deep

350

O

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must be connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)

2)

3)


321 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

13/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 45 A10VM 45HZX(EZX)/52WX-VXC11(16)N000 110 95

99

Flange SAE (J744 101-2 (B))

45°

L1 79.5 102.5

L1

77 14.3

57

ø101.6 h8

L

1

L

87

78

146 172

2 A10VM 45HZX/52WX-VXC16N000 9.5

A10VM 45EZX/52WX-VXC11N000

165

218,5

30

X

34

34

115

A

L1 L 12

L1

3

L

B

189

175 205

Drive shaft

16

usable spline 29.5 6.3 length 45.9

W

Splined 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 22-4 (B)) ø7/8in 1/4-20UNC-2B

Splined 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 25-4 (B-B)) ø1in 1/4-20UNC-2B

R

usable spline length

4 16

25 6.3 41


322 14/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 63 A10VM 63DG/52WX-VXC10N000

G

117

70.5 45

14.3

87 83.5 65

ø101.6 h8

45°

101 107

# --10 001 N02.105 FD6000 M6-1.0 09156493 DUESE

L1

Flange SAE (J744 101-2 (B))

G1

78 .5

92

Z

146 172

219.5 122.5 107.5

9.5 40

ø19

B

A

B 15

50.8 37.5 37.5

A

23.8 194.5

Ports Designation Port for A, B A, B

Standard

Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3)

State

350

O

Pressure (high pressure series, code 62) SAE J518

3/4 in

Fixing thread (port plate 10)

DIN 13

M10; 17 deep

Pressure (port plate 16)

DIN 3852-15) M27x2; 16 deep

350

O O4)

O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

X4)

G

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

O

G1

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

X

X

Pilot pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20UNF-2B; 10 deep

350

O

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must bee connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must bee connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)

2)


323 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

15/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 63 A10VM 63HZX(EZX)/52WX-VXC10(16)N000

110.5

45°

117 40

L1

1

14.3

87 62

78 .5

92

ø101.6

h8

102

L 107

9.5

Flange SAE (J744 101-2 (B))

146 172

219.5

A10VM 63HZX/52WX-VXC16N000

A10VM 63EZX/52WX-VXC10N000

2

165

A

37.5 90.5

A

L1

37.5

L1

110.5

219.5

X

B

B

3 194.5

Drive shaft

usable spline length

W

Splined 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 25-4 (B-B)) 1/4-20UNC-2B

Splined 1 1/4 in 14T 12/24DP1) (SAE J744 - 32-4 (C))

19

4 16

ø1in

ø1 1/4in 5/16-18UNC-2B

R

40 6.3 55.4

usable spline length

29 6.3 45.9


324 16/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 85 A10VM 85DG/52WX-VXC10N000 256.5

78 55

Flange SAE (J744 127-2 (C))

40

L1

G

G1

L

45°

112.4

ø127

95

h8

90

102 87 17.5

128

L1

93.5

130

163.5 158.7

12.7

181 210

45

57.2

A

ø25 45

L1

B 20

223.5

27.8

Ports Designation Port for A, B

Standard

Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3) 350

Pressure (high pressure sereis, code 62)

SAE J518C

1 in

Fixing thread (port plate 10)

DIN 13

M12; 17 deep

State O O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

1 1/16-12UN-2B

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

1 1/16-12UN-2B

4

X4)

G

external control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

O

G1

external control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

X

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must be connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)

2)


325 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

17/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VM size 85 A10VM 85EZX/52WX-VXC10N000

130

Flange SAE (J744 127-2 (C))

L1

45°

112.4

95

17.5

Ø127 h8

90 128

L

1

L 93.5

L1

256.5

2 123

40

A

57.2 45

12.7

181 210

A

B 20

Ø25

45

L1

B

27.8

3

223.5

Drive shaft

usable spline length

W

Splined 1 1/4 in 14T 12/24DP1) (SAE J744 - 32-4 (C)) ø1 1/4in 5/16-18UNC-2B

Splined 1 1/2 in 17T 12/24DP1) (SAE J744 - 38-4 (C-C)) ø1 1/2in 7/16-14UNC-2B

R

28

42 61.9

usable spline length

4 19

33 6.3 55.4


326 18/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VE size 28 A10VE 28DG/52WX-VXF16N000

67 45

35

G1 G L

94 69.7 59.6

15°

82.5 84

Y

R

83

31

L

45°

ø 135 h8 ø 133 ø 115 ø 68

66

ø14 31

80

12.7

L1 66

35 41.2 36

160 184

View Y

A

31

31

1.9

3.4 6.5

B

12

87

115

Ports Designation

Port for

Standard

Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3)

State

A, B

Pressure (high pressure series, code 62) SAE J518

3/4 in

350

O

Fixing thread (port plate 10)

DIN 13

M10; 17 deep

Pressure (port plate 16)

DIN 3852-15) M27x2; 16 deep

350

O

A, B

O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

3/4-16UNF-2B

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

3/4-16UNF-2B

4

X4)

G

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep 350

O

G1

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep 350

X

X

Pilot pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20UNF-2B; 10 deep

O

350

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must be connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)

2)


327 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

19/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VE size 28 A10VE 28HZX(EZX)/52WX-VXF10N000 106

35

80

Y

R

83

31

14

ø 135 h8 ø 133 ø 115 ø 68

L

31

48

67.5 94

15°

1

L

L1

45°

12.7 35

66

66 160 184

A10VE 28HZX/52WX-VXF10N000

A10VE 28EZX/52WX-VXF10N000

2

143

89

X A

Ø19 50.8

37.5

37.5

50.8

89

111

A

View Y

B

3.4 6.5 1.9

23.8 12

B

3

87 111

Drive shaft Splined 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 22-4 (B))

ø7/8in

4 1/4-20UNC-2B

R

usable spline length

16

25 34.8


328 20/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VE size 45 A10VE 45DG/52WX-VXF10(11)N000

76 28

17

G L G1

78 66

19°

78 102.5

Y

ø135 h8 ø110 ø71.7

66

49

L

L

ø14 48

87,2

R

87

48

W

L1

40°

12.7

66

28

View Y Port plate 10 6.5

View W port plate 11

29.2

102.5

.8 50 ø19

23

23.8 14

A .8

B

50

B

50.8 37.5 72

A

ø19 37.5

1.9

3.4

160 185

.8

93.7 123.7

30°

23 .8 38

30°

38

Ports Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3)

Pressure (high pressure series, code 62) SAE J518

3/4 in

350

Fixing thread (port plate 10, 11)

M10; 17 deep

Designation Port for A, B

Standard

DIN 13

State O O

A, B

Pressure (port plate 16)

DIN 3852-15) M27x2; 16 deep

350

O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

X4)

G

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

O

G1

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20 UNF-2B; 12 deep

350

X

X

Pilot pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20UNF-2B; 10 deep

350

O

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must be connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)

2)


329 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

21/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VE size 45 A10VE 45HZX(EZX)/52WX-VXF16N000 87.2

111.5

28

66 17

L

ø14 87

48

ø135 h8 ø110 ø71

L

1

48

57

19°

16 79.5 102.5

Y

L1

40° 12.7

66

28

160 ø185

View Y 6.5

A10VE 45HZX/52WX-VXF16N000 95

2

A10VE 45EZX/52WX-VXF16N000 149

A

34

34

96.5

A

116.5

X

1.9

3.4

B

B

3

14 93.7 123.7

Drive shaft

16

usable spline 29.5 length 39.8

W

Splined 7/8 in 13T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 22-4 (B))

ø7/8 in 1/4-20UNC-2B

Splined 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 25-4 (B-B))

ø1in 1/4-20UNC-2B

R

usable spline length

4

16

25 34.8


330 22/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VE size 63 A10VE 63HZ/52WX-VXF10N000 90.1

113 98

40

70.5 17

L 48

64

101 110

45°

ø 17

92.4

48

L 19 °

ø160 h8 ø 125 ø 80

Y

L1 15.5

70.5

40

200 ø 235

135.4 99.5

ø19

X

B

18 110.4

View Y

50.8 37.5 37.5

10 5.2

3.15

A

23.8

Ports Designation A, B

Size2)

Max. press. [bar]3)

Pressure (high pressure series, code 62) SAE J518

3/4 in

350

Fixing thread (port plate 10)

M10; 17 deep

Port for

Standard

DIN 13

State O O

A, B

Pressure (port plate 16)

DIN 3852-15) M27x2; 16 deep

350

O

L

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

O4)

L1

Case drain

ISO 119265)

7/8-14UNF-2B

4

X4)

X

External control pressure

ISO 119265)

7/16-20UNF-2B; 10 deep 350

O

ANSI B92.1a-1976, 30° pressure angle, flat root, side fit, tolerance class 5 Observe the general instruction on page 28 for the maximum tightening torques. 3) Short-term pressure spikes may occur depending on the application. Keep this in mind when selecting measuring devices and fittings. 4) Depending on installation position L oder L1 must be connected (see also page 27). 5) The spot face can be deeper than specified in the appropriate standard. O = must be connected (plugged on delivery) X = Plugged (in normal operation) 1)

2)


331 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

23/28

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Dimensions A10VE size 63 A10VE 63EZX/52WX-VXF16N000 90

120

153

70.5 17

40

Ø80

48

Z 92

48

Ø160

h8

Ø17

102

L Ø125

1

L 110

19°

Y

L1

L1

45°

15.5

40

70.5 Ø200 Ø235

2

A

37.5

37.5

B

View Y 10 18

3

5.2

3.15

110

Drive shaft Splined 1 1/4 in 14T 12/24DP1) (SAE J744 - 32-4 (C))

usable spline length

W

Splined 1 in 15T 16/32DP1) (SAE J744 - 25-4 (B-B)) 4 ø1 in 1/4-20UNC-2B

ø1 1/4in 5/16-18UNC-2B

R

19 40 49.4

usable spline length

16 29 39.9


332 24/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Integrated flushing and boost press. relief valve, N007 The flushing and boost pressure relief valve is used in closed circuits to flush an unacceptable heat load out of the circuit and to maintain a minimum boost pressure level (fixed setting). The valve is integrated into the port plate. A built-in fixed orifice determines the flushing flow, which is taken out of the low pressure side of the loop and directed into the motor housing. It leaves the housing together with the case drain flow. This combined flow must be replenished with fresh, cool fluid by means of the boost pump. Standard flushing flow With a pressure of pND = 20 bar in the low pressure side of the circuit and an orifice dia. of ø1.6 mm the flushing flow amounts to 5.5 L/min (Size 28 - 85). Other orifice diameters can be ordered in clear text. Further flushing flows for sizes 28 - 85 see table:

Flushing flow (L/min)

Orifice dia. in mm

3.5

1.2

5.5

1.6

7.2

1.8

Circuit diagram e.g. A10VO..HZ/...N007

X

L L1

A

B Ports for A, B

pressure

L, L1

case drain (L1 plugged)

X

pilot pressure


333 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

25/28

Connector for solenoids DEUTSCH WKM08130D-01-C-V-XXDN, 2-pin Molded, without bidirectionale suppressor diode (Standard) __________________________________________P Rexroth part-No. R902650409 _______________________12V R902650408 ______________________ 24V Technical data of electric Voltage

Cocurrent flow

Supply voltage

12 or 24 V

Nominal current

1.5 A

Voltage tolerance

-15 % bis +15 %

Operating period

100 %

Protection class

IP 65

HIRSCHMANN DIN EN 175 301-803-A /ISO 4400 (not for new projects) without bidirectional suppressor diode ____________________ H Degree of protection to DIN/EN 60529: IP65 The sealing ring in the cable gland (M16x1,5) is suitable for cables 4.5 mm to 10 mm in diameter.

1

The HIRSCHMANN-connector is part of the scope of supply of the motor.

Fixing thread M3 tightening torque: MA = 0.5 Nm

cable gland M16x1.5 tightening torque: MA = 1.5 - 2.5 Nm

Technical data of hydraulic maximum 25 L/min

Sealing

FKM (flour-rubber)

Operating temperature of fluid

-20 °C to +120 °C

Viskosity range

10 mm2/s to 420 mm2/s

Function

D

SW 26, 12kt DIN (2) 3124 (1)

65,4

maximum 350 bar

Flow

2

Ø37

Nominal pressure

50

36.2

68,5 SW 24

Note for round solenoids: SW 1 in

3

The position of the connector can be changed by turning the solenoid body.

(1)

36.3

Proceed as follows: – 1. Loosen fixing nut (1) – 2. Turn the solenoid body (2) to the desired position. – 3. Tighten the fixing nut

2 12

Tightening torque of fixing nut: 5+1 Nm

63

(2) The female connector is not part of the scope of supply. This can be supplied by Rexroth on request.

4

Electronic controls Control Electric pressure control 1)

Electronic function Regulated current outout

Current outputs for 2 valves, sparately controllable

Electronics

Further information

RA

analogue

RD 95 230

VT2000

analogue

RD 29 904

RC2-2/21 1)

digital

RD 95 201


334 26/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

Before finalising your design please request a certifified installation drawing. Dimensions in mm

Speed pickup The version A10VM/E...D („prepared for speed pickup“) comprises gearing around the rotary unit.

Circuit diagram

In this case, the rotating cylinder barrel can provide a speed dependent signal, which can be picked up by a suitable sensor and processed for further evaluation. The sensor port will be plugged for delivery. This preparation for speed pickup does not include the necessary working parts. They must be ordered separately as a kit with a corresponding part number. Inductive speed sensor ID R 18/20-L250 (see RE 95130) and mounting parts (spacer and 2 seals per kit) can be ordered separately under the following part numbers: Size

Part Nr.

Number of teeth

28

R902428802

48

45

R902437557

48

63

R902428802

56

85

in preparation

L L1 A

B D

Dimension port D A10VM 28

61

25°

112

A1

A2

A3

45

96

69.2

45°

63

140.5

71

57.5°

85

130

91.3

45°

A3

A1

A

Size

2

A10VM 45, 63 and 85

A10VE 45

69 .2

44

33 °


335 RE 91703/03.10 | A10VM/A10VE Series 52

Bosch Rexroth AG

27/28

Mounting position The motor housing must be filled during start up and operation. The drain line must be arranged, so that the housing cannot empty itself when the motor is at standstill. The end of the drain line must enter the tank below the minimum fluid level. In all installation positions the highest case drain port must be used to fill the housing and to connect the drain line.

1

In case of a vertical installation please consult us.

A10VM

2

A10VE

3

4


336 28/28

Bosch Rexroth AG

A10VM/A10VE Series 52 | RE 91703/03.10

General instructions – The A10VM/VE is designed for operation in open and closed circuits – Systems design, installation and commissioning requires trained technicians or tradesmen. – Be sure to read the entire operating instructions throughly and completely befor using the axial piston unit. If necessary, request them at Rexroth. – All hydraulic ports can only be used for the fastening of hydraulic service lines. – During and shortly after operation of a axial piston unit the housing and especially a solenoid can be extremely hot, avoid being burned; take suitable safety measures (wear protective clothing). – Dependent on the operating conditions of the axial piston unit (operating pressure, fluid temperature) deviations in the performance curves can occur. – Pressure ports: All materials and port threads are selected and designed in such a manner, that they can withstand the maximum pressure. The machine and system manufacturer must ensure, that all connecting elements and hydraulic lines are suitable for the actual operating pressures. – Pressure cut off and pressure control are not suitable for providing system protection against excessive pressures. A suitable overall main line relief valve must be incorporated. – All given data and information must be adhered to. – The following tightening torques are valid: - Female threads in the axial piston unit: the maximum permissible tightening torques MGMax are maximum values for the female threads in the pump casting and may not be exceeded. Value see table below. - Fittings: please comply with the manufacturer‘s information regarding the max. permissible tightening torques for the used fittings. - Fastening bolts: for fastening bolts to ISO 68 we recommend to check the permissible tightening torques in each individual case to VDI 2230. - Plugs: for the metal plugs, supplied with the axial piston unit the following min. required tightening torques MV apply (see table).

Threaded port sizes

Maximum permissible tightening torque of the threaded holes MG max

Requiered tightening torque of the locking screws MV

WAF hexagon socket of the locking screws

7/8-14 UNF-2B

ISO 11926

240 Nm

127 Nm

3/8 in

7/16-20UNF-2B

ISO 11926

40 Nm

15 Nm

3/16 in

3/4-16 UNF-2B

ISO 11936

160 Nm

62 Nm

5/16 in

1 1/16-12 UNF-2B ISO 11926

360 Nm

147 Nm

9/16 in

M14x1,5

DIN 3852

80 Nm

35 Nm

6 mm

M16x1,5

DIN 3852

100 Nm

50 Nm

8 mm

M18x1,5

DIN 3852

140 Nm

60 Nm

8 mm

M22x1,5

DIN 3852

210 Nm

80 Nm

10 mm

M27x2

DIN 3852

330 Nm

135 Nm

12 mm

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Axial Piston Units An den Kelterwiesen 14 72160 Horb a. N., Germany Telephon +49 (0) 74 51 92-0 Fax +49 (0) 74 51 82 21 info.brm-ak@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com/axial-piston-motors

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging. Subject to change.


337 Contents | External gear motors | Motors

External gear motors Designation External gear motors

Type

Size

Component series

AZMF, AZMN, AZMG

8 … 45

1X

pmax in bar

Data sheet

Page

14026

339

1

2

3

4

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


338

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


339

RE 14 026/05.09 Replaces: RE 14 026/01.05

External Gear Motors

AZMF ... , AZMN ... , AZMG ...

Model F = 8 ... 22.5 cm3/rev N = 25 und 28 cm3/rev G = 22.5 ... 45 cm3/rev

Contents Function Overview Ordering code Drive shaft Front cover Port connections Motors with integral Valves and Sensors Design calculations for Motors Diagrams Specifications Drive arrangement Connectors Dimension Drawings Notes

Page 2 3 4 6 7 8 9 10 10 14 16 17 19 40

General Rexroth external gear motors are produced in 3 different models, with different displacements being produced by means of gears of differing widths. Different versions of motors are achieved by the use of different flanges, shafts, valves and integrated speed sensors.

Features – – – –

High pressures combined with small size and low weight Large speed ranges Broad viscosity and temperature ranges Reversible motors for 2- and 4-quadrant operation

Fields of application – Road construction machines as road rollers and pavers – Agricultural machines and forestry technology as harvesters and forestry machines – Street vehicles such as busses, trucks and special vehicles and above all in hydrostatic fan drives.


340 2/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

Function If pressurized oil is fed into the motor, a torque can be obtained from the shaft leading out of the housing. Here, a distinction is made between motors that rotate on one direction and reversible motors.

External gear motors that rotate in one direction These are of asymmetrical design, i.e. the high and low pressure sides are defined and not interchangeable at will. In this case, reversible operation is not possible. In order to ensure a high efficiency level, a special running-in method is used for motors. Leakage oil is discharged internally to the outlet side. Pressure loading of the outlet is limited by the shaft seal.

Reversible external gear motors The displacement method in external gear motors is the reverse of the pump process. Reversible motors have a special feature, however. Their symmetrical construction means that the high or low pressure chambers are separate from the bearing and shaft seal chamber. The resulting leakage oil is routed through a separate oil drain gland in the housing cover. This oil drainage enables the motor to be subjected to load via the return line, which in turn allows the use of series connections. Due to the connection between the shaft seal and the low-pressure end, however, standard motors and pumps can only withstand a pressure of up to approx. 3 bar. The figure shows a reversible gear motor for 4-quadrant operation, i.e. both output and input torque in both directions. (Hydraulic motor becomes a pump if load reversal occurs.)

pA

RE 14 026/05.09


341 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

3/40

Product overview “Model F” preferential range Version

Page 19

Version

Page 24

Version

Page 29

1

20

25

30

21

26

31

2

22

27

32

23

28

34

3

Product overview “Model N” preferential range Version

Page 35

Version

Page 36

4

Product overview “Model G” preferential range Version

Page 37

Version

Page 38

Version

Page 39


342 4/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Ordering code External Gear Motors Model “F” AZ

M

F

1x

– 022

R

C

B

20

M

B

200xx

S0001

Function Special design*)

M = Motor Series 1x = Standard bearing Size (F)

Valve adjustment

8.0 cm3/rev 11.0 cm3/rev 14.0 cm3/rev 16.0 cm3/rev 19.0 cm3/rev 22.5 cm3/rev

= 008 = 011 = 014 = 016 = 019 = 022

PRV 200 bar PRV Rear cover Standard PRV drain oil line connection (axial) PRV excess flow internal

Direction of rotation Right Left Universal

=R =L =U

Front cover

Port connections

suitable front cover

N

Tang drive

F

Spline shaft DIN 5482 B 17 x 14

S

Tapered keyed shaft 1 : 5 for flange A

=L =D

NBR =M FPM =P NBR, WDR in FPM = K

Drive shafts

Tapered keyed shaft 1 : 5

=B =G

Seals

*) The special equipments partly contained on the pages 20–35, are not considered in the representation of the ordering code.

C

= 200 xx = 180 xx

B

P

T

B

P

A

B

Square flange Centring Ø 80 mm

20

Rectangular flange

P

2-bolt mounting Centring Ø 50 mm

30

Rectangular flange

O

Square flange Centring Ø 36.47 mm

A

Outboard bearing Ø 80 mm, Type 1

N

2-bolt mounting Centring Ø 50 mm

T

4-bolt mounting Ø 52 mm, with O-ring


343 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

5/40

Ordering code External Gear Motors Model “N” AZ

M

N

1x

– 020

R

C

B

20

M

B

S0001 1

Function Special design

M = Motor Series 1x = Standard bearing Size (N)

Rear cover

25.0 cm3/rev = 025 28.0 cm3/rev = 028

Standard Special design

Direction of rotation

Seals

Right Left

NBR FPM

=R =L

=B =X =M =P 2

Drive shafts

Front cover

Port connections

suitable front cover

C

Tapered keyed shaft 1 : 5

B

B

Square flange Centring Ø 100 mm

20

Rectangular flange

External Gear Motors Model “G” AZ

M

G

1x

– 022

R

C

B

20

M

B

S0001 3

Function Special design

M = Motor Model G = 22.5...56 cm3/rev Size (G)

Rear cover

22.5 cm3/rev 28.0 cm3/rev 32.0 cm3/rev 45.0 cm3/rev

= 022 = 028 = 032 = 045

Standard Special design Seals

NBR =M NBR, WDR in FPM = K

Direction of rotation Right Left Universal

=B =X

=R =L =U

Drive shafts

Front cover

Port connections

suitable front cover

C

Tapered keyed shaft 1 : 5

B

B

Square flange Centring Ø 105 mm

N

Tang drive

M

M

2-bolt mounting Ø 52 mm, with O-ring

20

Rectangular flange

4


344 Hydraulics

External gear motors

Drive shaft model “F”

Drive shaft model “N”

40.2 ± 0.6 **) 38 ± 0.6 *) 7.8 ± 0.35 17

DIN 128-A12-FSt

C

18.75± 1

Ø17−0.027

1.8 1:5

= 70+15 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M14x1.5-m-06

45.5± 0.6

3 x5 DIN 6888

5°42 '38 "

C

RE 14 026/05.09

Ø20–0.11

Bosch Rexroth AG

2

6/40

DIN 936M12x1.5-m-06 = 50 +10 Nm

1:5 DIN 128-A14-FSt 4x6.5 DIN 6888

N

**) in combination with front cover 씲 B

2.7+0.5

P **) in combination with front cover 씲

8−− 0.025 0.083

Ø17− 0.027

6.5+0.3

Motor without shaft seal

Drive shaft model “G”

C

51± 0.6

22.9±1

2.4

Ø16.5− 0.27

2 ± 0.5

45+0,5 −1

1: 5

DIN EN ISO 8674 M14x1.5-8-A = 70 +10 Nm

25

–0.025 10–0.083

15.3+0.2 22.9±1

5°42 '38 " ±1

2

'

19.2

Ø27–0.130

DIN 128-A14-FSt 4x 6.5 DIN 6888

5x7.5 DIN 6888 DIN 128-A16-FSt

N

9.5 ± 0.7 für reverence-Ø 20.00

Ø20−−0.0265 0.117

S

1:5

B 17x14 DIN 5482 tooth thickness sw = 3.200 − 0.030

min. 14.8 usable shaft length

= 100+10 Nm 11± 0.5 DIN EN ISO 8673BM16x1.5-m-06 8" 5°4 2 Ø25–0.130 '3

26 − 0.8 **) 23.5− 0.8 *)

F

Motor without shaft seal 3.5± 0.3 11± 0.3


1:5

12.5

1.8+0.2 3+0.2

153± 1.5

9+0.2

R

±0

88.4±0.2

110±1.5

10

.5

4x M10 −10.9 = 50 +10 Nm 12.5+1

30 ±0.1

72 ±0.2 90 ±1.5

N

8− 0.2

34.3 ±1. 5

P

30 ±0.1 34.3 ± 1.5

14.3 ±0.1

min. 10.6

7.2 ± 0.1

14.3 ± 0.1

7.2 ± 0.1 min. 10.6

60 ± 0.2

15.7 ±1

Hydraulics

120 ±1.5

100 ±0.2 34.5 ±0.1

60 ± 0.2

8.5 ±0.11

15.7 ± 1

±5

R9

0.020 Ø50−− 0.064

120 ±1.5

44.5 ±1.5

34.5 ±0.1

100 ± 0.2 9 ± 0.11

Ø18

RE 14 026/05.09

9.5 ±0.2

60±0.2 30±0.1 0.020 Ø50 −−0.064

112+1.5 −1

71.4 ±0.2

34.3±1.5

96.1±0.2 32.5 ±0.1

15,7 ±1

Ø80−− 0.060 0.106 7.2 ± 0.1

Ø80−− 0.060 0.106 15.7 ±1

10.3+0.3

14.3±0.1

7.2±0.1 min. 10.6

19 ± 0.1

55± 1.5

60± 0.2

T

44.2± 0.1

4.8 ± 0.1

11± 0.135

15.7 ±1

O

36 −0.5 Ø47.9−0.1 Ø52 −0.030 −0.076

15.7±1

Ø36.47− 0.05

12.5− 0.4

132± 0.2

2

B

Ø22+0.5

18.75± 1

B

R8

Ø100–0.054

External gear motors

345 Bosch Rexroth AG 7/40

Front cover model “F” 60 ±0.2

1

2x M10−10.9 = 50 +10 Nm 60 ±0.2

R9

2

87+1.5 −1 2xM10−10.9 = 50 +10 Nm

A ±5

3

72 ± 0.2 90 ± 1.5

Front cover model “N”

4


346 8/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Front cover model “G”

41

63.9 18.1

Ø44

Ø52–0.030 –0.076

Ø47.8–0.2

41

49.1±1.5

7.2± 0.1

58±1.5

11± 0.135

1:5

15.3+0.2

M

10

165±1.8

48±0.1

2.4 145±0.2

22.9± 1

Ø105–0.036 –0.090

R

min. 10.6

8± 0.1

B

2+0.2

20

3.2+0.2

102±0.2 122±1.8

2 x M10–10.9 = 55+5 Nm

Port connections 4 45° 5°

Size cm3

8.0 ... 22.5 22.5 ... 45.0 cm3

Synopsis of Type 20

Inlet side C D 15 35 18 55

Size cm3

8.0 ... 22.5 22.5 ... 45.0 cm3

30 C D

Synopsis of Type 30

Rectangular flange

E

C D

Synopsis of Type 20

20

E M6 utilizable depth 13 M8 utilizable depth 13

Outlet side C D 20 40 26 55

E M6 utilizable depth 13 M8 utilizable depth 13

Port connections (direction of rotation universal) C D E 15 35 M6 utilizable depth 13 18 55 M8 utilizable depth 13

Rectangular flange

E

Size 4 ... 8 cm3 11 ... 28 cm3

Inlet side C D 13.5 30.2

E C M6 utilizable depth 13

Outlet side D E 13.5 30.2 20.0 39.7

M6 utilizable depth 13 M8 utilizable depth 13


347 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

9/40

External gear motors with integrated valves, sensors T

P

1

Pages 31, 32 Gear motor with integrated, pilot-operated proportional pressure relief valve and rotary shaft seal relieved of load thanks to the three-chamber design. The use of gear motors without this relief of the rotary shaft seal is not recommended due to the loads from the oil return line, particularly when the oil is cold. The basis of this drive unit is a motor model “F”. The pilot proportional pressure relief valve is integrated in the rear end cover. This unit has the following advantages:

– No pipework necessary for the functioning of the prop. pressure relief valve – Integrated pressure relief – Fail-safe function in the event of power loss – Drag speed virtually zero – Motor speed prop. controllable – Unaffected by pressure loads from the outlet Additional information see: Hydrostatic fan drives 1 987 761 700 http://www.boschrexroth.com/brm

2

External gear motors with pressure relief valve

p1

3

return port pressure < 3 bar (10 bar at starting)

Page 23

External gear motors with integrated speed sensor The DSM1-10 Hall-effect speed sensor was specially developed for tough use in mobile work machines. The sensor detects the speed signal of ferromagnetic gear wheels. In this process, as an active sensor, it supplies a signal with constant amplitude independent of the rotational speed. Due to its compact, sturdy design, the gear motor with integrated sensor is suitable for the applications such as

Page 34

– In fan drives for buses, trucks and construction machinery from 7 to 20 kW – As a vibration drive for road rollers and road construction machinery For additional information see: Speed Sensor DSM RE 95 132 http://www.boschrexroth.com/brm

4


348 10/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Design calculations for motors It is also necessary to allow for different efficiencies such as:

The design calculations for motors are based on the following parameters: V Q p M n P

[cm3/rev] [l/min] [bar] [Nm] [rev/min] [kW]

ηv Volumetric efficiency ηhm Mechanical-hydraulic efficiency ηt Total efficiency

Displacement Inlet flow rate Pressure (p1, pA) Output torque Output speed Output power

Q

n P M pA

Q Δp Δp · Q

[%] ηv ηhm ηt

V·n –1 ηv · 10

V=

Δp =

M · 104 1.59 · V · ηhm

V = 1.59 ·

P=

n M P

Q · ηv · 10 n

Q= p1

p

The following formulas describe the various relationships. They include correction factors for adapting the parameters to the usual units encountered in practice. Note: Diagrams providing approximate selection data can be found on subsequent pages. These graphs contain the levels of efficiency in each case.

n=

M · 104 Δp · ηhm

Q · ηv · 10 V

M = 1.59 · V · Δp · ηhm ·10–4

Q · Δp · ηt · 10–4 6

V [cm3/rev]

Q [l/min]

Δp [bar]

n [rev/min]

P [kW]

M [Nm]

Diagrams Model “F”

Note: η [%]

υ = 35 mm2/s, T = 50 °C V = 8 cm3/ Urev

80 12 1

cm 3

24

0b ar

10

40

8

11

8

P [kW]

14

Q [l/min]

50

0

18

0

12

0

6

50

0

150

20

6

100

15

4

50

10

30 20

10 0

Q = f ( n,V ) incl. ηv P = f ( n, p) incl. ηt incl. ηhm M = f ( n, p)

0

1000

2000 n [min-1]

3000

4000

2

0

0

1000

2000 n [min-1]

3000

4000

M [Nm]

16

p=

25

200

Q

=

60

19

22

,5

70

30

p = 250 bar

)

p = 250 bar p = 20 bar 1 ) = 200 bar


349 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

11/40

V = 16 cm 3/ Urev

V = 11 cm 3/ Urev 20

Bosch Rexroth AG

25

40

p = 250 bar

60

p = 250 ba

1

r

35

18

200 200

45

20

30

50

15

0

15

0

p=

15

30

0

20

100

0

10

10

15

50

M [Nm]

0

20

P [kW]

20

100

8

15

2

5

6 100

4

100 5

0

0

50

50

2 0

150 M [Nm]

10

25

0 25

12

p=

P [kW]

150

25

ba

r

14

ba

r

16

0

1000

2000

3000

0

4000

0

1000

2000

n [min-1]

3000

4000

n [min-1]

V = 22,5 cm 3/ Urev

V = 19 cm 3/ Urev 60

25

3 80

25

p = 200 ba

r

p = 200 ba

r

45

20

60

20

0

ba r

150

P [kW]

M [Nm]

40

15 0

100

15

0

4

15

10

15

50

10

20

50

0

10

00

1

5

0

5

0

50

50

0

0

1000

2000

n

[min-1]

3000

M [Nm]

p=

r ba 0

30

20

100

p=

P [kW]

15

20

150

4000

0

0

1000

2000 n [min-1]

3000

4000


350 12/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Diagrams Model “N” υ = 35 mm2/s, T = 50 °C 100

28

p = 200 bar p = 20 bar

90

25

80 70

Q [l/min]

60 50 40 30 20 10 0

Q = f ( n,V ) incl. ηv P = f ( n, p) incl. ηt incl. ηhm M = f ( n, p)

0

1000

2000

3000

n [min-1]

V = 25 cm 3/ Urev

V = 28 cm 3/ Urev 25

80

25

80

p = 200 ba

r

50

5

0

0 15 40

15

100

100 20

10

50

0

5

50

0

20

150

60

1000

2000 n [min- ] 1

3000

0

15

40

0

0

10

50

0

1000

2000

n [min-1]

20

0

3000

M [Nm]

P [kW]

p=

100

10

20

M [Nm]

P [kW]

150

15

60

20 0

20

p=

ba

r

0

ba

r

p = 200 bar


351 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Diagrams Model “G”

Bosch Rexroth AG

13/40

υ = 35 mm2/s, T = 50 °C V = 22,5 cm 3/ Urev

140 v

1

p = 200 bar r

Q

=

45

120

80

25

cm 3 /reU

p = 200 bar p = 20 bar

ba 0

2,5

2

P [kW]

28 80

0 15 40

15 100

M [Nm]

p=

150

32

Q [l/min]

60

20

38

20

100

60 10

0 20

10

50

2

40 5

20

0

Q = f ( n,V ) incl. ηv P = f ( n, p) incl. ηt incl. ηhm M = f ( n, p)

0

1000

2000

0

3000

50

0

1000

n [min-1]

2000

0

3000

n [min-1] V = 32 cm 3/ Urev

V = 28 cm 3/ Urev 30

100

3

100

30

p = 200 bar 80

ba

r

25

40

20

60 50

1

100

40

15

0

10

10

50

0

20

10

0

5

50

5

0

1000

2000

n [min-1]

4

0

3000

0

10

50

20

50

0

1000

2000 n [min-1]

M [Nm]

100

P [kW]

0

15

15

20

60 M [Nm]

P [kW]

20

0

p=

ba

r

150

p=

150

20

80

0

p = 200 bar

25

0

3000


352 Bosch Rexroth AG

External gear motors

Hydraulics

V = 38 cm 3/ Urev

V = 45 cm 3/ Urev 120

50

p = 200

45

bar

50

105

75

25

r

ba

45

0

15

20

50

15

100

10

60

35

P [kW]

p=

0 20

M [Nm]

P [kW]

100

30 15 0

50

5 0

120

150

40

150 35

140

p = 200 bar

45

90

40

30

RE 14 026/05.09

100 80

100

30

p=

25

50

0

20

r

ba

0

15

20

60 40

M [Nm]

14/40

20

100

15 10

0

50

5 0

1000

2000

n

3000

0

0

[min-1]

1000

2000

3000

n [min-1]

Specifications General Construction Mounting Port connections Direction of rotation (looking on shaft) Mounting position Load on shaft Ambient temperature range Fluids Viscosity

Fluid temperature range Filter ***)

external gear motor Flange or through-bolting with spigot screw, flange One direction of rotation or reversible any radial and axial forces after consulting –30 °C...+80 °C with NBR seals*) –20 °C...+110 °C with FPM seals**) mineral oil-based hydraulic fluids to DIN/ISO, other fluids upon request 12…800 mm2/s permitted range 20…100 mm2/s recommended range 12…2,000 mm2/s permitted for starting max. +80 °C with NBR seals*) max. 110 °C with FPM seals**) contamination at least class 19/16 according to ISO 4406 to be obtained with filter b20 = 75. For higher lifespan demands we recommend a corre spondingly higher filter class.

***) NBR = Perbunan® ***) FPM = Viton® ***) During the application of control systems or devices with critical counter-reaction, such as steering and brake valves, the type of filtration selected must be adapted to the sensitivity of these devices/systems. Safety requirements pertaining to the whole systems are to be observed. In the case of applications with frequent load cycles please consult us.


353 External gear motors

Hydraulics

RE 14 026/05.09

Model F Displacement max. continuous pressure p1 max. starting pressure p2 min. rotational speed max. rotational speed p1 Motor outlet pressure pA Leakage-oil line pressure pL

cm3/rev bar min–1

5.5 1) 250 280 500 4,000 p1

bar

11

14

3,500

3,000

16

19 180 210

15/40

22.5

1

p1 pL < 3 bar*)

pA

Model N Displacement max. continuous pressure p1 max. starting pressure p2 min. rotational speed max. rotational speed p1 Motor outlet pressure pA Leakage-oil line pressure pL

cm3/rev bar min–1

25 210 240 500 3,000

Model G Displacement max. continuous pressure p1 max. starting pressure p2 min. rotational speed max. rotational speed p1 Motor outlet pressure pA Leakage-oil line pressure pL

cm3/rev bar min–1

3 bar*)

pA

p1

28 200 230

p1

bar

2

pA

22.5 180 210 500 3,000

3 bar*)

28

32

38

2,800

2,600

45

p1

bar

3 pA

3 bar*)

On request *) Short-term when starting 10 bar drive shaft

p [bar]

1)

8

Bosch Rexroth AG

for one direction of rotation counter-clockwise rotation

clockwise rotation

p2

4

p1

t [s]

reversible

p1 max. continuous pressure p2 starting pressure (depending on the application, this must be taken into consideration when setting the pressure of the hydraulic system’s pressure-relief valve).


354 16/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Power take-off 1. Flexible couplings The coupling must not transfer any radial or axial forces to the motor. The maximum radial run out of shaft spigot is 0.2 mm. Refer to the fitting instructions provided by the coupling manufacturer for details of the maximum permitted shaft misalignment. 2. Sleeve couplings Used on shafts with DIN or SAE splining. Note: There must be no radial or axial forces exerted on the motor or sleeve coupling. The sleeve must be free to move axially. The distance between the motor shaft and drive shaft must be 2+1. Oil-bath or oil-mist lubrication is necessary.

Ø25h11 2+1

Model “F” 12

min. 8

Ø30

Ø52±+0.046

1 Drive shaft Case-hardened steel DIN 17 210, e.g. 20 MnCrS 5 case-hardened 0.6 deep; HRc 60 ±3. Surface for sealing ring ground without rifling Rmax. ≤ 4μm

Ø52.7±+0.3

1

The recommended arrangements and dimensions for the drive end and sealing are as follows.

2 Radial shaft seal Rubber-covered seal (see DIN 3760, Type AS or double-lipped ring). Cut 15° chamfer or fit shaft seal with protective sleeve.

Mmax. [Nm] 190 130

30°

3. Drive shaft with tang For the close-coupling of the motors to gearboxes, etc. the motors shaft has a special drive shaft with tang which combines with a center coupling 3. There is no shaft seal.

Spline shaft DIN SAE

34

A

2

Mmax. [Nm] 65

2.5–0.5

V [cm3/rev] 8...14 16 19 22.5

pmax. [bar] 280 230 190 160

0.2 A

3

V pmax. [cm3/rev] [bar] 8...22.5 pmax.


355 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

4. Outboard bearing Model “F” Outboard bearings eliminate possible problems when the motors are driven by V-belts or gearwheels. The diagrams below show the maximum overhung and thrust loads that can be tolerated, referring to a bearing life of LH = 1,000 hours.

Mmax. [Nm] 65

17/40

V [cm3/rev] 16 19 22.5

pmax. [bar] 230 190 160 1

a 1400

1200

Fr

Fr [N]

1000 Fa

n=

n = 00 20 [min – 1 n = 00 ] n = 300 0 40 00

800

600

400 10

2 15

20

30

40

50

60

a [mm] Fr is reduced by 0.7 Fa when axial loading Fa is applied. 3

Connectors Gear motor flange, 3-bolt, 90° angle, for square flange 30 see page 8 L4

M6-8.8 M8-8.8

L3

LK

= 10+3 Nm = 25+5 Nm

L5

L2

L1

Ø DB

LA

4

Ø D3 Ø D1

LK

D1

D3

L1

L2

L3

L4

L5

LA

S1

DB

S1

Screws O-ring Weight 3 pieces NBR *) [kg] 30 12L 10 37 30.0 10 37.5 46 38 22 6.4 M6x22 16x2.5 0.13 30 15L 12 37 30.0 10 37.5 47 38 27 6.4 M6x22 16x2.5 0.14 30 18L 15 37 30.0 10 37.5 47 38 32 6.4 M6x22 16x2.5 0.17 40 22L 19 43 35.5 14 41.0 53 48 36 8.4 M8x30 24x2.5 0.29 40 28L 24 43 35.5 14 41.0 53 48 41 8.4 M8x30 24x2.5 0.40 Complete screw connection with O-ring, metric screw set, nut/mother and sleeve fitting *) NBR = Perbunan®

Ordering-No. 1 515 702 146 1 515 702 147 1 515 702 148 1 515 702 149 1 515 702 150

p [bar] 250 250 160 160 160


356 18/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

External gear motors

Hydraulics

RE 14 026/05.09

Connectors (continuation) Gear motor flange, straight, for square flange 20 see page 8 LA

Ø DB

Ø D1

L2

M6-8.8 = 10+3 Nm

L1

LK

D1

D3

L1

L2

L4

LA

S1

S1

Ø D1

LK

LA

Ø D3

L4

DB

Screws O-ring Weight Ordering-No. 4 pieces NBR *) [kg] 35 10L 8 30 23.0 39.0 40 19 6.4 M6x22 20x2.5 0.09 1 515 702 064 35 12L 10 30 23.0 39.0 40 22 6.4 M6x22 20x2.5 0.10 1 515 702 065 35 15L 12 30 23.0 38.0 40 27 6.4 M6x22 20x2.5 0.10 1 515 702 066 40 15L 12 35 28.0 43.0 42 27 6.4 M6x22 24x2.5 0.12 1 515 702 067 40 18L 15 35 27.5 44.0 42 32 6.4 M6x22 24x2.5 0.13 1 515 702 068 40 22L 19 35 27.5 44.5 42 36 6.4 M6x22 24x2.5 0.12 1 515 702 069 40 28L 24 42 27.5 34.5 42 41 6.4 M6x22 24x2.5 0.15 1 515 702 008 Complete screw connection with O-ring, metric screw set, nut/mother and sleeve fitting *) NBR = Perbunan®

p [bar] 315 315 250 100 100 100 100

Gear motor flange, 90° angle, for square flange 20 see page 8 L4

M6-8.8 M8-8.8

L3

L5

L2

L1

LK

LA Ø DB

LA

Ø D3

= 10+3 Nm = 25+5 Nm

S1

Ø D1

Ø D1

LK

D1

D3

L1

L2

L3

L4

L5

LA

S1

DB

Screws O-ring Weight Ordering-No. 2 pcs. 2 pcs. NBR *) [kg] 35 10L 8 38 31.0 16.5 26.5 47.0 40 19 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 35 20 x 2.5 0.16 1 515 702 070 35 12L 10 38 31.0 16.5 26.5 47.0 40 22 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 35 20 x 2.5 0.16 1 515 702 071 35 15L 12 38 31.0 16.5 26.5 46.0 40 27 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 35 20 x 2.5 0.15 1 515 702 072 35 16S 12 38 29.5 20.0 31.0 48.0 40 30 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 40 20 x 2.5 0.18 1 515 702 002 35 18L 15 38 29.5 20.0 31.0 47.0 40 32 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 40 20 x 2.5 0.18 1 545 702 006 35 20S 16 45 34.5 25.0 38.0 56.0 40 36 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 45 20 x 2.5 0.24 1 515 702 017 40 15L 12 38 31.0 22.5 36.5 46.0 42 27 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 22 24 x 2.5 0.15 1 515 702 076 40 18L 15 38 30.5 22.5 36.5 47.0 42 32 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 22 24 x 2.5 0.17 1 515 702 074 40 20S 16 40 29.5 22.5 35.5 50.0 42 36 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 45 24 x 2.5 0.20 1 515 702 011 40 22L 19 38 30.5 22.5 36.5 47.5 42 36 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 22 24 x 2.5 0.17 1 515 702 075 40 28L 22 40 32.5 28.0 43.0 49.0 42 41 6.4 M6 x 20 M6 x 50 24 x 2.5 0.24 1 515 702 010 40 35L 31 41 30.5 34.0 55.0 52.0 42 50 6.4 M6 x 22 M6 x 60 24 x 2.5 0.33 1 515 702 018 55 20S 17 45 34.5 24.0 40.0 56.0 58 36 8.4 M8 x 25 M8 x 50 33 x 2.5 0.44 1 515 702 004 55 30S 26 49 35.5 32.0 50.0 62.0 58 50 8.4 M8 x 25 M8 x 50 33 x 2.5 0.50 1 515 702 006 55 35L 31 49 38.5 32.0 51.5 62.0 58 50 8.4 M8 x 25 M8 x 60 33 x 2.5 0.47 1 515 702 005 55 42L 38 49 38.0 40.0 64.5 61.0 58 60 8.4 M8 x 25 M8 x 70 33 x 2.5 0.60 1 515 702 019 Complete screw connection with O-ring. metric screw set. nut/mother and sleeve fitting *) NBR = Perbunan®

p [bar] 315 315 250 315 250 315 100 100 250 100 100 100 250 250 100 100


357 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

19/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 38± 0.6

B±1.2

1 .5

A± 0.4

7.2± 0.1

±0

44.5± 1.5 120± 1.5

1.8

100+1.5 –1

45°

Ø18

1:5

100± 0.2 9± 0.11 34.5± 0.1

45° 15.7± 1

–0.060 Ø80–0.106

R

15

12.5–0.4

35± 0.15

M6

72± 0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

2

90±1.5

7.8± 0.35

84–0.2

3–0.025

5°42 '38 " ±1 ' Ø17–0.11

9

As shown in drawing

Inlet and outlet port changed 17 40± 0.15 DIN 128-A12-FSt

20

3 M6

= 50+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8673M12x1.5-m-06

45°

A 511 240 001

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

3 x5 DIN 6888

Ordering code AZMF – 1x – 첸 AZMF – 10 – 첸 AZMF – 10 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 11 14 16 19 19 22.5

첸 첸 첸 C B 20 M B 첸 첸 첸 C B 20 K B* 첸 첸 첸 C B 20 M B – S0012 **

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 425 300 0 511 525 300 0 511 525 304 – 0 511 625 308 – 0 511 725 304 **

N

R 0 511 425 001 0 511 525 001 – 0 511 625 005 0 511 625 003 0 511 625 009 * 0 511 725 005 **

4

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 210 210 210 180 180 210

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

2.9 3.0 3.2 3.4 3.6 3.6 3.9

[mm] A 43.2 47.0 47.5 47.5 47.5 47.5 61.1

B 91.1 96.3 101.3 104.7 109.7 109.7 125.3


358 20/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 23.5–0.8 7.2± 0.1

B± 0.7 A± 0.4

±0

44.5± 1.5

45°

Ø18

9± 0.11

100+1.5 –1

120± 1.5

100± 0.2 34.5± 0.1

45° 15.7± 1

–0.060 Ø80–0.106

R

.5

9

15

12.5–0.4

35± 0.15

M6

72± 0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

90±1.5

84–0.2

Ø16.5–0.27

2–0.5

As shown in drawing

Inlet and outlet port changed min. 14.8 usable shaft length

40± 0.15

DIN 5482 B 17 x 14 tooth thickness sw = 3.200–0.030

20 M6

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 11 14 16 19 22.5

첸 첸 첸 F B 20 M B

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 425 301 0 511 525 301 0 511 525 303 0 511 625 301 0 511 625 300 0 511 725 303

45°

N

R 0 511 425 002 0 511 525 002 – 0 511 625 001 0 511 625 002 0 511 725 004

A 511 241 001

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 210 210 210 180 180

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

2.9 3.0 3.2 3.4 3.6 3.8

[mm] A 43.2 47.0 47.5 47.5 47.5 61.1

B 91.0 96.0 101.0 104.4 109.4 126.8


359 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

21/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 71.4± 0.2

B± 0.7 A± 0.4

1 8.5± 0.11

R

4.8± 0.1

40.5±1.5 +1.5 113–1

96.1± 0.2 32.5± 0.1

15.7±1

100+1.5 –1

Ø36.47–0.05

9

13.5

19± 0.1

30.2± 0.15

22± 0.4

+1.5 88–1

M6

= 10+ 3 Nm

2

As shown in drawing

84–0.2

Ø16.5–0.27

0.5± 0.5

Inlet and outlet port changed min. 14.8 usable shaft length

D

DIN 5482 B 17 x 14 tooth thickness sw = 3.200–0.030

C

3

A 511 241 021

E

4

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 19 22.5

첸 첸 첸 F O 30 M B

n

N

Ordering-No.

L – 0 511 625 303 –

R 0 511 425 003 – 0 511 725 305

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 180 180

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500

Max. kg rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 2.9 3,000 3.7 3,000 3.9

Dimension [mm] A 44.9 49.0 56.6

B 90.7 109.1 114.5

C 13.5 20.0 20.0

D 30.2 39.7 39.7

E M6 = 10+3 M8 = 25+5 M8 = 25+5


360 22/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 45+0.5 –1

B±0.7 .5

A± 0.4

8–0.2

±0

120± 1.5

34.5± 0.1

100± 0.2

100+1.5 –1

9.5± 0.22

45°

2

Ø80–0.060 –0.106 15.7±1

45°

9

44.5±1.5

R

1:5 12.5+1

15 35± 0.15

72± 0.2 = 10+ 3 Nm

M6

90±1.5

4–0.03

5°42 '38 " ±1 ' Ø20–0.065 –0.117

9.5± 0.7

84–0.2

As shown in drawing

Inlet and outlet port changed 19.2 40± 0.15 DIN 128-A12-FSt

20 M6

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

A 511 243 021

= 70+15 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M12x1.5-m-06

45°

4x6.5 DIN 6888

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 AZMF – 10 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 11 14 16 16 19 22.5

첸 첸 첸 S A 20 M B 첸 첸 첸 S A 20 M B – S0012

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 445 300 0 511 545 300 0 511 545 301 0 511 645 300 – 0 511 645 302 0 511 745 300*

N

R 0 511 445 001 0 511 545 001 – 0 511 645 001 0 511 645 003 – 0 511 745 001*

Max. operating pressure [bar] 250 250 250 250 230 190 160

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 2,500

kg

Dimension

3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.8 4.2 4.8

[mm] A 74.7 78.5 79.0 79.0 93.0 79.0 92.6

B 120.6 125.6 130.6 134.0 134.0 139.0 156.4


361 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

23/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 45+0.5 –1 ±0

120

± 1.5

34.5± 0.1

100± 0.2

9.5± 0.2

45°

2

15.7± 1

45°

9

44.5±1.5

R

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

1

.5

A± 0.4

8–0.2

1:5 20

12.5+1

40± 0.15

M6

72± 0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

90±1.5

2

9.5± 0.7 Other position of the drive shaft 86–0.8

4–0.03

5°42 '38 " ±1' Ø20–0.065 –0.117

As shown in drawing

19.2 max. 11 27±1

B±0.7

DIN 128-A14-FSt

"X" 3

= 70+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M12x1.5-m-06

A 511 243 709

Ø24

100+1.5 –1

X

4x6.5 DIN 6888 Inlet M 18 x 1.5 useable depth min. 12 = 50+10 Nm

4

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 11

첸 첸 첸 S A 20 M D XXXXX – S0076

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 445 301 0 511 545 302

N

R 0 511 445 003 0 511 545 003

Max. operating pressure [bar] 200 150

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500

kg

Dimension

3.6 3.8

[mm] A 74.7 79.1

B 133.1 138.1


362 24/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 4± 0.8

Ø21

45°

2.7+0.5

15

6.5+0.2

35± 0.15

4 x M10–10.9 = 50 +10 Nm

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

14.3±0.1

60±0.2

100+1.5 –1

8–0.025 –0.083

15.7±1

Ø17.8–0.07

45°

30±0.1 34.3±1.5

A± 0.4

7.2

60±0.2

min. 10.6

B± 0.5 ± 0.1

+0.3

84–0.2

Ø36–0.5

Ø47.9–0.1

–0.030 Ø52–0.076

10.3

As shown in drawing

Inlet and outlet port changed 1.8+0.2 3+0.2

Motor without radial shaft seal 40± 0.15 20 M6

= 10+ 3 Nm

45°

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 11 16 19 22.5

첸 첸 첸 N T 20 M B

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 415 300 0 511 515 300 0 511 615 301 0 511 615 300 0 511 715 300

A 511 232 001

incl. 1 900 210 145 incl. 1 510 240 000 resp. 1 510 240 009

45°

N

R 0 511 415 001 0 511 515 001 0 511 615 002 0 511 615 001 0 511 715 001

Max. operating pressure [bar] 250 250 230 190 160

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

2.5 2.6 3.0 3.2 3.4

[mm] A 40.7 44.5 45.0 45.0 52.6

B 80.3 85.3 93.7 98.7 104.1


363 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

25/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor B±0.7 38± 0.6

1

L±0.4 A± 0.4

7.2± 0.1

±

1:5

44.5± 1.5 120± 1.5

34.5± 0.1 100± 0.2

100+1.5 –1

31.4±1

Ø18

Ø22

1.8

45°

9

9± 0.11

45° 15.7± 1

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

R

5 0.

12.5–0.4

15 35± 0.15

2

72± 0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

±1.5

90

84–0.2

5°42 '38 "± Ø17–0.027 1'

7.8± 0.35

17 Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 useable depth min.13 = 15+5 Nm

35± 0.15 DIN 128-A12-FSt = 50+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8673M12x1.5-m-06

M6

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

A 511 240 610

3 x5 DIN 6888

3

15

45°

4

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 첸 첸 U C B 20 M L AZMF – 10 – 첸 첸 첸 U C B 20 K L* DisplaceOrdering-No. ment [cm3/rev] 8 11 16 22.5

Universal 0 511 425 601 0 511 525 604 0 511 625 602 0 511 725 601 *

Max. operatingpressure [bar] 210 210 210 180

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

3.4 4.2 3.9 3.9

[mm] A 43.2 47.0 47.5 55.1

B 90.7 95.9 104.3 114.6

L 85.8 90.8 99.2 109.6


364 26/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor B±0.7 L±0.4

23.5–0.8 7.2± 0.1

.5

A± 0.4

±0

44.5± 1.5 120± 1.5

100± 0.2 34.5± 0.1

100+1.5 –1

Ø22 12.5–0.4

31.4±1

45°

15 35± 0.15

9

9± 0.11

45° 15.7± 1

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

R

72± 0.2 = 10+ 3 Nm

M6

90±1.5

84–0.2

Ø16.5–0.27

2± 0.5

min. 14.8 usable shaft length DIN 5482 B 17 x 14 tooth thickness sw = 3.200–0.030

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 useable depth min.13 = 15+5 Nm

35± 0.15 15

45°

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 첸 첸 U F B 20 M L DisplaceOrdering-No. ment [cm3/rev] 8 11 16 19 22.5

Universal 0 511 425 603 0 511 525 601 0 511 625 603 0 511 625 605 0 511 725 602

= 10+ 3 Nm

A 511 241 607

M6

45°

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 210 210 180 180

Min. rotating speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotating speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

2.9 3.0 3.4 3.6 3.8

[mm] A 43.2 47.0 47.5 47.5 55.1

B 91.0 96.0 104.4 109.4 114.8

L 85.8 90.8 99.2 104.2 109.6


365 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

27/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor B±0.8 45+0.5 –1

1

L±0.4 . ±0

± 0.7

8–0.2

A

44.5± 1.5

9

120± 1.5

34.5± 0.1

100± 0.2

31.4±1

100+1.5 –1

Ø22

2

45°

9.5± 0.11

45° 15.7± 1

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

R

5

1:5 12.5+1

15 35± 0.15

2

72± 0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

90±1.5

84–0.2

4–0.03

5°42 '38 " ±1 ' Ø20–0.065 –0.117

9.5± 0.7

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 useable depth min.13 = 15+5 Nm

19.2

3

35± 0.15 DIN 128-A12-FSt

15

= 70+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M12x1.5-m-06

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

A 511 243 612

4x6.5 DIN 6888

M6

45°

4

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 첸 첸 U S A 20 M L DisplaceOrdering-No. ment [cm3/rev] 8 11 16 19

Universal 0 511 445 601 0 511 545 601 0 511 645 601 0 511 645 603

Max. operating pressure [bar] 250 250 230 190

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

3.5 3.6 4.0 4.2

[mm] A 74.8 78.6 79.1 79.1

B 120.8 125.8 134.2 139.2

L 116.9 121.9 130.3 135.3


366 28/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor B± 0.5

4± 0.8

2.7+0.5

15

6.5+0.2

35± 0.15

M6

= 10+ 3 Nm

14.3±0.1

60±0.2

100+1.5 –1

Ø21

45°

31.4±1

45°

60±0.2 30±0.1 34.3±1.5

A± 0.4

Ø22

8–0.025 –0.083

15.7±1

Ø17.8–0.07

7.2± 0.1

min. 10.6

L± 0.7

4 x M10–10.9 = 50 +10 Nm

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 useable depth min.13 = 15+5 Nm 84–0.2

Ø47.9–0.1 Ø36–0.5

Ø52–0.030 –0.076

10.3+0.3

1.8+0.2

Motor without radial shaft seal

3+0.2 35± 0.15 15 M6

= 10+ 3 Nm

45°

A 511 232 624

incl. 1 900 210 145 incl. 1 510 240 000 resp. 1 510 240 009

45°

Ordering code AZMF – 10 – 첸 첸 첸 U N T 20 M L – S0164 DisplaceOrdering-No. Max. ment operating pressure [cm3/rev] Universal [bar] 8 0 511 415 605 250 11 0 511 515 602 250 16 0 511 615 607 230 19 0 511 615 608 190 22.5 0 511 715 601 160

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

2.5 2.6 3.0 3.2 3.4

[mm] A 40.7 44.5 45.0 45.0 52.6

B 80.3 85.3 93.7 98.7 104.1

L 82.8 87.8 96.2 101.2 106.6


367 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

29/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor B±0.5

1 60±0.2 30±0.1 34.3±1.5

A± 0.4

±0.2

100+1.5 –1

60

Ø22

31.4±1

1.8

45°

14.3±0.1

45° 15.7± 1

Ø50–0.020 –0.064

7.2± 0.1

max. 9

L±0.4

min. 10.6

40.2± 0.6

1:5 15 35± 0.15

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

2

2 x M10–10.9 = 50 +10 Nm

Ø21

84–0.2

3–0.025

5°42 '38 "± Ø17–0.027 1'

10.3± 0.35

17

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 useable depth min.13 = 15+5 Nm

35± 0.15 DIN 128-A12-FSt

3

15

= 50+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8673M12x1.5-m-06

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

A 511 230 611

M6

45°

3x5 DIN 6888

4

Ordering code AZMF – 1X – 첸 첸 첸 U C P 20 M L DisplaceOrdering-No. ment [cm3/rev] 8 11 14 16

Universal 0 511 415 606 0 511 515 601 0 511 515 605 0 511 615 609

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 210 210 210

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 3,500 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

2.8 2.8 3.1 3.1

[mm] A 40.7 44.5 45.0 45.0

B 80.3 85.3 90.3 93.7

L 83.3 88.3 93.3 96.7


368 30/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor

60±0.2 30±0.1

60

14.3±0.1

±0.2

1.8

Ø21

45°

34.3±1.5

A± 0.4

45° 15.7± 1

Ø50–0.020 –0.064

7.2± 0.1

16±1

L±0.4

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 useable depth min.13 = 15+5 Nm

1:5 15 35± 0.15

min. 10.6

B±0.5 40.2± 0.6

M6

= 10+ 3 Nm

2 x M10–10.9 = 50 +10 Nm

84–0.2

38.5± 0.5

5°42 '38 "± Ø17–0.027 1'

10.3± 0.35

17 35± 0.15 DIN 128-A12-FSt

15

+10

= 50 Nm DIN EN ISO 8673M12x1.5-m-06

45°

= 10+ 3 Nm

A 511 230 618

M6

45°

3x5 DIN 6888

Ordering code AZMF – 11 – 첸 첸 첸 U C N 20 M B – S0077 DisplaceOrdering-No. Max. ment operating pressure [cm3/rev] Universal [bar] 8 0 511 415 607 210

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000

kg

Dimension

2.9

[mm] A 40.7

B 80.3

L 80.3


369 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

31/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor not contained in delivery

1

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 = 15+5 Nm 14±1 24 4x6.5 DIN 6888

45°

= 70+15 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M14x1.5-8-A

45°

20 40± 0.15

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

2

19.2

84–0.5

0°±20° 39.5–0.5

Ø20–0.065 –0.117

4–0.03

5°42 '38 " ±1

'

DIN 128-A14-FSt

As shown in drawing

Position of drain oil port on anti-clockwise rotation

Position of connectors

9.5±0.7

Position of shaft on anti-clockwise rotation

12.5+1

90±1.5

35± 0.15 15

72± 0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

L

– – 0 511 645 306 0 511 645 307 –

N

R 0 511 645 007 0 511 645 005 * – – 0 511 645 011 *

120± 1.5

9.5

A 511 243 726

.5

n

Ordering-No.

±0

[cm3/rev] 16 16 16 16 16

첸 첸 첸 S A 20 P GXXXX 첸 첸 첸 S A 20 P GXXXX*

9

A±0.4

B±0.7

Ordering code AZMF – 11 – 첸 AZMF – 12 – 첸 Displacement

R

8–0.2 +0.5 45–1

44.5± 1.5

86.7±4.3

45°

161.6±4.6

2

45°

34.5± 0.1

P

100± 0.2

3

15.7± 1

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

1:5

24.5±2

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000

PVR

[bar] 130 170 170 210 210

Coil nominal current [I] 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5

kg

Dimension

5.0 5.0 5.1 5.1 5.1

[mm] A 79.0 79.0 79.0 79.0 79.0

B 137.7 137.7 137.7 137.7 137.7

4


370 32/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor

not contained in delivery

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 = 15+5 Nm 14±1 24 4x6.5 DIN 6888 45°

= 70+15 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M14x1.5-8-A

20 40± 0.15

DIN 128-A14-FSt

= 10+3 Nm

M6

19.2

84–0.5

0°±20° 39.5–0.5

4–0.03

5°42 '38 " ±1 ' Ø20–0.065 –0.117

45°

As shown in drawing

Position of drain oil port on anti-clockwise rotation

Position of connectors

9.5±0.7

Position of shaft on anti-clockwise rotation

12.5+1

90±1.5

35± 0.15 15

M6

= 10

+3

72±0.2

Nm

120± 1.5 44.5± 1.5

A 511 240 770

161.6

.5

24.5±2

±0

B±0.7

9

A±0.4

R

8–0.2 45+0.5 –1

9.5

100± 0.2 86.7±4.3

45°

±4.6

2

45°

34.5± 0.1

P

15.7

±1

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

1:5


371 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

33/40

Dimensions in mm F-Motor Ordering code AZMF – 11 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 8 8 8 8 8 11 11 11 11 14 16 16 16 19 19 19 22.5 22.5 22.5 22.5

첸 첸 첸 C B 20 P GXXXX

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 425 302 – – – – – – 0 511 525 309 0 511 525 308 – – 0 511 625 309 – – – – 0 511 725 311 – – –

N R

– 0 511 425 015 0 511 425 013 0 511 425 012 0 511 425 014 0 511 525 013 0 511 525 011 – – 0 511 525 014 0 511 625 019 – 0 511 625 020 0 511 625 018 0 511 625 022 0 511 625 021 – 0 511 725 021 0 510 725 023 0 511 725 027

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 3,500 3,500 3,500 3,500 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000

PRV

[bar] 210 90 130 170 150 170 180 90 180 210 210 210 210 210 210 180 210 210 210 170

Coil nominal current [I] 0.75 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 0.75 1.5 0.75 1.5 1.5 1.5 0.75 1.5 0.75 0.75 1.5 1.5 0.75 1.5

kg

Dimension

4.7 4.6 4.7 4.7 4.7 4.7 4.8 4.8 4.8 4.9 5.0 5.0 5.0 5.1 4.0 5.1 5.3 5.3 5.3 5.2

[mm] A 48.7 48.7 48.7 48.7 48.7 47.5 47.5 47.5 47.5 43.2 47.5 47.5 47.5 47.5 47.5 47.5 55.1 55.1 55.1 55.1

B 98.3 98.3 98.3 98.3 98.3 103.5 103.5 103.5 103.5 108.5 111.7 111.7 111.7 116.7 116.7 116.7 122.1 122.1 122.1 122.1

1

2

3

4


372 34/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm F-Motor 45+0.5 –1

B±1 .5

A± 0.4

8–0.2

±0

1:5

44.5±1.5

9

120±1.5

45° Ø100–1.5 –1

45°

100±0.2 34.5±0.1 9.5+0.22

2

15.7± 1

Ø80–0.060 –0.106

R

20 12.5+1

40± 0.15

72±0.2

= 10+ 3 Nm

M6

90±1.5

38.5± 0.5

Speed sensor DSM R917000301 see data sheet RE 95132 84–0.2

4–0.03

5°42 '38 " ±1 ' Ø20–0.065 –0.117

9.5± 0.7

19.2 35± 0.15 DIN 128-A14-FSt

M6

= 10+ 3 Nm Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 = 15+5 Nm

15

= 70+15 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M14x1.5-8-A

u

45°

n

A 511 243 901

4x6.5 DIN 6888

45° L± 0.5

Ordering code AZMF – 12 – 첸 첸 첸 U S A 20 P L – S0079 DisplaceOrdering-No. Max. ment operating pressure [cm3/rev] Universal [bar] 16 0 511 645 607 230

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 3,000

kg

Dimension

3.6

[mm] A 79

B 146.7

L 127.7


373 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

35/40

Dimensions in mm N-Motor 45.5± 0.6

B±1 A

9

Ø22+0.5

153± 1.5

44.2± 0.1 11± 0.135

132± 0.2

122.5±1.5

45°

2

Ø100–0.054 18.75± 1

45°

2

18

12.5

= 25+5 Nm

M8

55± 0.15

± 0.2

88.4

110±1.5

4–0.025

10.5± 0.4

As shown in drawing 92–0.2

Ø95.2–0.15 Ø20–0.11

10

55± 1.5

R

1:5

1

.5

±0

± 0.5

+0.2

Inlet and outlet port changed

20

3

55± 0.15 26 DIN 128-A14-FSt

M8

= 25+5 Nm

= 70+15 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M14x1.5-m-06

45° A 511 340 001

45°

4x6.5 DIN 6888 2.5±0.1

3.8± 0.1

Ordering code AZMN – 11 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 25 28

첸 첸 첸 C B 20 M B

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 725 307 0 511 725 309

N

R – 0 511 725 019

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 200

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 3,000 3,000

kg

Dimension

6.3 6.3

[mm] A 55.0 56.6

B 116.1 119.1

4


374 36/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm N-Motor B±1 45.5± 0.6

A± 0.5 12+1

9+0.2

18 55± 0.15

12.5 10.5± 0.4

= 25+5 Nm

M8

88.4± 0.2 110±1.5

4–0.025

92–0.2

As shown in drawing 53.8–0.5

Ø95.2–0.15 Ø20–0.11

55± 1.5

11± 0.135

Ø22+0.5

1:5

132± 0.2

122.5±1.5

45°

10

153± 1.5

45°

R

44.2± 0.1

4 Ø2

2

18.75± 1

Ø100–0.054

.5

±0

Drain oil line connection M12x1.5 utilizable depth min.12 = 15+5 Nm

Inlet and outlet port changed

20 55± 0.15 26

DIN 128-A14-FSt

M8

= 25+5 Nm

+15

= 70 Nm DIN EN ISO 8674M14x1.5-m-06

45° A 511 340 013

45° 4x6.5 DIN 6888 2.5±0.1 3.8±0.1

Ordering code AZMN – 11 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 25 28

첸 첸 첸 C B 20 P B – S0097

n

Ordering-No.

L – 0 511 725 312

N

R 0 511 725 024 –

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210 210

Min. rotation speed [min–1]

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 3,000 2,800

kg

Dimension

10.3 6.1

[mm] A 60.5 62.0

B 120.8 123.8


375 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

37/40

Dimensions in mm G-Motor 51± 0.6

B±1

1

A± 0.4

8± 0.1

58±1.5

45°

11± 0.135

145±0.2

144±0.8

165±1.8

48±0.1

45° 22.9±1

Ø105–0.036 –0.090

2.4

R

10

1:5

18 20

55± 0.15

2

= 25+5 Nm

M8

102±0.2 122±1.8

'

As shown in drawing

110–0.2

5–0.03

5°4 2'3 Ø25–0.130 8" ± 1

11± 0.5

Inlet and outlet port changed

25

3

55± 0.15 26 M8

= 25+5 Nm

DIN 128-A16-FSt = 100+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8673BM16x1.5-m-06

45°

A 511 440 001

45° 5x7.5 DIN 6888

Ordering code AZMG – 11 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 22.5 32 45

첸 첸 첸 C B 20 M B

n

Ordering-No.

L 0 511 725 300 0 511 725 301 0 511 725 302

N

R 0 511 725 001 0 511 725 002 0 511 725 003

Max. operating pressure [bar] 180 180 180

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 3,000 2,800 2,600

kg

Dimension

9.1 9.6 10.1

[mm] A 61.0 64.5 69.5

B 128.7 137.2 149.2

4


376 38/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Dimensions in mm G-Motor 51± 0.6

B±1 A± 0.4

145±0.2 = 25+5 Nm

18 20

11± 0.135

14+1 73.2±1.5

1:5

M8

165±1.8

48±0.1

45°

22.9±1

Ø105–0.036 –0.090

45°

10

58±1.5

R

2.4

8± 0.1

13

102±0.2

55± 0.15

122±1.8 Drain oil line connection M18x1.5 = 50+10 Nm

11± 0.5

110–0.2

5–0.03

5°4 2'3 Ø25–0.130 8" ±

1'

25

55± 0.15 18

M8

= 25+5 Nm

DIN 128-A16-FSt

144±0.8

= 100+10 Nm DIN EN ISO 8673BM16x1.5-m-06

45°

A 511 440 601

45° 5x7.5 DIN 6888

Ordering code AZMG – 11 – 첸 첸 첸 U C B 20 K X* – S0077 AZMG – 11 – 첸 첸 첸 U C B 20 M X* – S0077 DisplaceOrdering-No. Max. ment operating pressure [cm3/rev] Universal [bar] 22.5 0 511 725 600 210 28 0 511 726 603 210 32 0 511 726 604* 210

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500 500 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 3,000 3,000 2,800

kg

Dimension

9.0 9.2 9.4

[mm] A 61.0 63.0 64.5

B 128.7 133.7 137.2


377 External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth AG

39/40

Dimensions in mm G-Motor B± 0.5

9+0.5

1 41

45°

45°

41 49.1±1.5

min. 10.6

A± 0.4

63.9

Ø144±0.8

18.1

10–0.025 –0.083

22.9±1

Ø27–0.130

7.2± 0.1

2

3.5± 0.3

18

11± 0.3

= 25+5 Nm

M8

55± 0.15

2 x M10–10.9 = 55+5 Nm

+0.2

Ø20± 0.5 110–0.2

Ø44

Ø52–0.030 –0.076

Ø47.8–0.2

15.3

As shown in drawing

Inlet and outlet port changed 3

2+0.2

Motor without radial shaft seal

+0.2

3.2

55± 0.15 26 M8

1 900 210 145

incl. 1 510 240 002

Ordering code AZMG – 11 – 첸 Displacement [cm3/rev] 45

45°

첸 첸 첸 N M 20 M B

n L

Ordering-No.

N

A 511 432 001

incl.

= 25+5 Nm

45°

R 0 511 715 002

Max. operating pressure [bar] 210

Min. rotation speed [min–1] 500

Max. rotation speed [min–1] 2,600

kg

Dimension

8.4

[mm] A 70.5

B 151.2

4


378 40/40

Bosch Rexroth AG

Hydraulics

External gear motors

RE 14 026/05.09

Notes Filter recommendation The major share of premature failures in external gear motors is caused by contaminated pressure fluid. As a warranty cannot be issued for dirt-specific wear, we recommended filtration compliant with cleanliness level 20/18/15 ISO 4406, which reduces the degree of contamination to a permissible dimension in terms of the size and concentration of dirt particles: Operating pressure [bar ] Contamination class NAS 1638 Contamination class ISO 4406 To be reached with βX = 75

>160 9 18/15 20

<160 10 19/16 25

We recommend that a full-flow filter always be used. Basic contamination of the pressure fluid used may not exceed class 20/18/15 according to ISO 4406. Experience has shown that new fluid quite often lies above this value. In such instances a filling device with special filter should be used. General – The motors supplied by us have been checked for function and performance. No modifications of any kind may be made to the pumps; any such changes will render the warranty null and void! – Motor may only be operated in compliance with permitted data (see pages 14 – 18). Project planning notes Comprehensive notes and suggestions are available in Hydraulics Trainer, Volume 3 RE 00 281, “Project planning notes and design of hydraulic systems”. Where external gear motors are used we recommend that the following note be adhered to.

Bosch Rexroth AG Hydraulics Produktbereich Außenzahnradmaschinen Robert-Bosch-Straße 2 D-71701 Schwieberdingen Tel. +49 (0) 711-811 10 63 Fax +49 (0) 711-811 26 18 83 brm-az.info@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com/brm

Technical data All stated technical data is dependent on production tolerances and is valid for specific marginal conditions. Note that, as a consequence, scattering is possible, and at certain marginal conditions (e.g. viscosity) the technical data may change. Characteristics When designing the external gear motor, note the maximum possible service data based on the characteristics displayed on pages 10 to 14. Additional information on the proper handling of hydraulic products from Bosch Rexroth is available in our document: “General product information for hydraulic products” RE 07 008. Leakage oil line A leakage oil line must be connected directly to the tank in reversible motors or motors stressed by run-back. Observe sufficient dimensions. Contained in delivery The components with characteristics as described under device measurements and ordering code, pages 19 – 39, are contained in delivery. You can find further information in our publication: “General Operating Instructions for External Gear Units” RE 07 012-B1.

© This document, as well as the data, specifications and other information set forth in it, are the exclusive property of Bosch Rexroth AG. It may not be reproduced or given to third parties without its consent. The data specified above only serve to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging.


379 Contents | Radial piston motors | Motors

Radial piston motors Designation

Type

Size

Radial piston motors (Hägglunds)

CBM

2000 … 6000

MKM, MRM

11 … 250

Fixed displacement

Component series

1X

pmax in bar

Data sheet

Page

350

15300

381

315

15190

417

1

2

3

4

RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08, Bosch Rexroth AG


380

Bosch Rexroth AG, RE 00112-02, edition: 2013-08


381

Radial piston hydraulic motor

RE 15300

Type Hägglunds CBM

Edition: 2012-08

▶ Size: 2000 … 6000 ▶ Capacity: 75 838 … 380 133 cm3/rev [4 628 - 23 197 in3/rev] ▶ Specific torque: 1 200 … 6 000 Nm/bar [61 024 … 305 119 ft-lbs/1000 psi] ▶ Nominal speed: 8 … 53 rpm ▶ Maximum operating pressure: 350 bar [5 076 psi]

Features

Contents

▶ The most powerful direct drive in the world.

Features

1

▶ 50 % more torque - now torque up to 1970 kNm

Quick selection diagram

2

▶ High torque to weight ratio

Functional description

3

▶ Modular design

Calculation fundementals

4

Motor data Ordering codes

5 6-7

Dimensions

8 … 11

Accessories

12 … 16

Hägglunds tandem motors Recommended charge pressure Overall efficiency

17 18 19 …20

Flushing of motor case

21

Volumetric losses

21

Pressure loss

22 … 23

Choice of hydraulic fluid

24 … 25

Versatile mounting - examples of installations

26

Declaration of incorporation

27

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


382 2/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Quick selection diagram for Hägglunds CBM motors The diagram below represents the torque and speed, corresponding to a modified rating life L10mh= 40 000 h. Oil viscosity in motor case 40 cSt. Contamination level not exceeding ISO 4406:1999 18/16/13 (NAS 1638, class 7). The diagram is based on a charge pressure of 15 bar (218 psi).

1 600 For operation outside these areas, please contact your nearest sales representative

1 400

Torque [kNm]

1 200 1 000 CBM 6000 800

CBM 5000

600

CBM 4000 CBM 3000

400 CBM 2000 200 0

0

2

4

6

8

10

12

14

16

18

20

22

24

26

28

30

32

34

Speed [rpm] Fig 1a: Quick selection diagram

2 000

CBM 6000

1 800 1 600

CBM 5000

Torque [kNm]

1 400

CBM 4000

1 200 1 000

CBM 3000 800 600

CBM 2000

400 200 0 0

2

4

6

8

10

12

14

16

Speed [rpm] Fig 1b: Max torque diagram

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08

18

20

22

24

26

28

30


383 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

3/28

Functional description Bosch Rexroth‘s hydraulic industrial motor Hägglunds CBM is of the radial-piston type with a rotating cylinder block/

1

hollow shaft and a stationary housing. The cylinder block is mounted in fixed roller bearings in the housing. An even number of pistons are radially located in bores inside the cylinder block, and the valve plate directs the incoming and

2

8

1

3

outgoing oil to and from the working pistons. Each piston is working against a cam roller. 9

When the hydraulic pressure is acting on the pistons, the cam rollers are pushed against the slope on the cam ring that is rigidly connected to the housing, thereby producing a torque. The cam rollers transfer the reaction force to the pistons which are guided in the cylinder block. Rotation therefore occurs, and the torque available is propor tional to the pressure in the system.

4 7

Oil main lines are connected to ports A and C in the connection block and drain lines to ports D1, D2, D3 or D4 in the motor housing.

2

6

5

The motor is connected to the shaft of the driven machine through the hollow shaft of the cylinder block. The torque is transmitted by splines. Valid patents US 4522110, US 005979295A, SE 456517, EP 0102915, JP

Fig. 2: Hägglunds CBM motor

83162704, GB 1385693, EP 0524437. Quality To assure our quality we maintain a Quality Assurance System, certified to standard ISO 9001.

1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Cam ring Cam roller Piston Cylinder block, spline Housing cover

6. 7. 8. 9.

Cylindrical roller bearing Wearing part Connection housing Distributor

3

4

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


384 4/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Calculation fundementals

T·n (kW) on driven shaft 9549

Output power

P=

Output torque

T = Ts·( p - p l - pc )·

(

= 98%)

m

p= T T S·

Pressure required ( m= 98%)

m

m

+ p l + pc

(Nm) (bar)

T·n (hp) on driven shaft 5252 T ·( p - p l - p c)· m (lbf·ft) T= s 1000 (psi) p = T·1000 + p l + pc T s· m

P=

Flow rate required

q=

n · Vi + ql 1000

(l/min)

q=

n · Vi + ql 231

(gpm)

Output speed

n=

q - ql · 1000 Vi

(rpm)

n=

q - ql · 231 Vi

(rpm)

Inlet power

Pin=

q · ( p - pc ) 600

(kW)

Pin=

q · (p - pc ) 1714

(hp)

Quantity

Metric

US

Power

Symbol P

=

kW

hp

Output torque

T

=

Nm

ft-lbs

Specific torque

Ts

=

Nm/bar

ft-lbs/1000

Rotational speed

n

=

rpm

rpm

pressure of 12 bar (174 psi) above case pressure. When a

Required pressure

p

=

bar

psi

closed loop system is used, a minimum of 15% of oil is to

Pressure loss

∆p

=

bar

psi

be exchanged in the main loop.

Charge pressure

pc

=

bar

psi

Flow rate required

q

=

l/min

gpm

Max speed

Total volumetric loss

ql

=

l/min

gpm

Maximum speed is the maximum allowed speed. Special

Displacement

Vi

=

cm3/rev in3/rev

considerations are necessary regarding charge pressure,

=

0.98*

cooling and choice of hydraulic system for speeds rated

psi

Mechanical efficiency

Definitions Rated speed1) Rated speed is the highest allowed speed for a charge

ηm

*Not valid for starting efficiency

above. 1)

Operating above rated conditions requires approval from Bosch Rexroth.

Accepted conditions for standard type of motor: 1. Oil viscosity 15 - 40 - 10000 cSt. See page 21. 2. Temperature -35 °C to +70 °C (-31 °F to +158 °F). 3. Running case pressure 0-3 bar (0-43,5 psi) Max case pressure 8 bar (116 psi) 4. Charge pressure (see diagram). 5. Volumetric losses (see diagram). For more information, see Powerful Engineering (EN347-4)

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


385 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

5/28

Motor data Table 1a: Metric motor data Hägglunds CBM motor Motor type

Displacement

Specific torque

Rated speed*

Max speed

Max pressure**

Max torque2)

Max power intermittent3)

1)

cm3/rev

Nm/bar

rpm

rpm

bar

kNm

kW

CBM 2000-1200

75 838

1 200

53

53

350

394

2 186

CBM 2000-1400

88 279

1 400

44

44

350

460

2 118

CBM 2000-1600

100 782

1 600

38

38

350

525

2 090

CBM 2000-1800

113 726

1 800

33

33

350

591

2 042

CBM 2000

126 732

2 000

30

30

350

657

2 063

CBM 3000-2200

138 670

2 200

27

27

350

722

2 042

CBM 3000-2400

151 173

2 400

24

24

350

788

1 980

CBM 3000-2600

164 117

2 600

22

22

350

854

1 966

CBM 3000-2800

177 123

2 800

20

20

350

919

1 925

CBM 3000

190 066

3 000

18

18

350

985

1 856

CBM 4000-3200

201 565

3 200

16

16

350

1 051

1 793

CBM 4000-3400

214 508

3 400

15

15

350

1 116

1 774

CBM 4000-3600

227 514

3 600

14

14

350

1 182

1 755

CBM 4000-3800

240 458

3 800

13

13

350

1 248

1 738

CBM 4000

253 464

4 000

13

13

350

1 313

1 722

CBM 5000-4600

290 849

4 600

11

11

350

1 510

1 678

CBM 5000

316 798

5 000

10

10

350

1 642

1 653

CBM 6000-5600

354 246

5 600

8

8

350

1 838

1 619

CBM 6000

380 133

6 000

8

8

350

1 970

1 599

Rated speed*

Max speed

Max pressure**

Max torque2)

Max power intermittent3)

1

2

Table 1b: US motor data Hägglunds CBM motor Motor type

Displacement

Specific torque

1)

in3/rev

lbf*ft/1000 psi

rpm

rpm

psi

lbf*ft

hp

CBM 2000-1200

4 628

61 024

53

53

5 076

290 543

2 932

CBM 2000-1400

5 387

71 194

44

44

5 076

338 967

2 840

CBM 2000-1600

6 150

81 365

38

38

5 076

387 391

2 803

CBM 2000-1800

6 940

91 536

33

33

5 076

435 815

2 738

CBM 2000

7 734

101 706

30

30

5 076

484 239

2 766

CBM 3000-2200

8 462

111 877

27

27

5 076

532 663

2 738

CBM 3000-2400

9 225

122 047

24

24

5 076

581 087

2 655

CBM 3000-2600

10 015

132 218

22

22

5 076

629 511

2 637

CBM 3000-2800

10 809

142 389

20

20

5 076

677 935

2 582

CBM 3000

11 599

152 559

18

18

5 076

726 359

2 489

CBM 4000-3200

12 300

162 730

16

16

5 076

774 783

2 405

CBM 4000-3400

13 090

172 901

15

15

5 076

823 206

2 378

CBM 4000-3600

13 884

183 071

14

14

5 076

871 630

2 354

CBM 4000-3800

14 674

193 242

13

13

5 076

920 054

2 331

CBM 4000

15 467

203 412

13

13

5 076

968 478

2 309

CBM 5000-4600

17 749

233 924

11

11

5 076

1 113 750

2 251

CBM 5000

19 332

254 266

10

10

5 076

1 210 598

2 217

CBM 6000-5600

21 617

284 777

8

8

5 076

1 355 870

2 171

CBM 6000

23 197

305 119

8

8

5 076

1 452 717

2 144

*) Related to a required pressure of 12 bar for motors in braking

1)

mode.

Special considerations regarding charge pressure, cooling and choice of hydraulic system for speed above rated, 8 ports must be

**) The motors are designed according to DNV-rules. Test pressure

used for higher speed.

420 bar. Peak/transient pressure 420 bar maximum, allowed to

2)

Calculated as: Metric= Ts·(350-15)·0,98.

occur 10000 times.

3)

Valid for minimum permissible oil viscosity 15 cSt in the motor case. RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB

3

4


386 Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

6/28

Ordering codes In order to identify Hägglunds equipment exactly, the following ordering code is used. These ordering codes should be stated in full in all correspondence e.g. when ordering spare parts. Example Hägglunds CBM motor:

C

B

M

2000

01

02

03

04

05

S

A

0

N

0

A

00

00

06

07

08

09

10

11

12

13 C

01

Motor series

02

Generation

B

03

Magnum

M

04

Motor size CBM 2000

2000

CBM 3000

3000

CBM 4000

4000

CBM 5000

5000

CBM 6000

6000

05

Specific torque (Nm/bar)

06

Mounting alternatives, shaft S

Splines 07

08

Tandem kit Motor not prepared for TA kit

A

Motor prepared for TA kit

B

Displacement shift valve Motor not prepared for displacement shift

09

10

11

0

Type of seal Nitrile

N

Viton

V

Through hole kit No

0

Yes

H

Piston set Coated pistons and uncoated cam rollers

12

Modification*

13

Design*

A 00-99

00

Standard

01-99

Special index * To be filled in by DC-IA/EHD

Painting Orange

Standard

Other

Option

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


387 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

7/28

Order code example Torque arm for Hägglunds CBM:

TC

A

200

01

02

03

-

0

-

04

0

-

05

00 06

01

Torque arm

TC

02

Generation

A

03

04

Torque arm size TCA 200 for CBM 2000

200

TCA 400 for CBM 3000 and CBM 4000

400

TCA 600 for CBM 5000 and CBM 6000

600

Attachment 2

Pivoted

9

Other 05 06

1

00-99

Modification*

2

Design* 00

Standard

01-99

Special index * To be filled in by DC-IA/EHD

Order code example for tandem kit for Hägglunds CBM:

T

B M

40

H

00

00

01

02

04

05

06

07

03

01

Tandem kit

T

02

Generation

B

03

Magnum

M

04

Size

40

05

Through hole No

0

Yes

H

06

Modification*

07

Design* Standard Special index

3

00-99

00 01-99

* To be filled in by DC-IA/EHD

4

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


388 8/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Dimensions, motor with splines for torque arm mounting

A

B D

C

Fig. 3

F

Fig. 4: CBM 2000

B

B

D

C

D

F

C

F

Fig. 6: CBM 4000

Fig. 5: CBM 3000

D

B

B E

D

C F

C

Fig. 7: CBM 5000

E

F

Fig. 8: CBM 6000

Table 2: Dimensions, motor with splines for torque arm mounting Motor type

A (mm)

B (mm)

C (mm)

D (mm)

E (mm)

F (mm)

Main conn.

Drain conn.

CBM 2000

1 460

872

1 300

419

-

N360x8x30x44x9H 4 100

SAE 2”

BSP 1 1/4” and 2”

CBM 3000

1 460

990

1 300

419

-

N440x8x30x54x9H 5 000

SAE 2”

BSP 1 1/4” and 2”

CBM 4000

1 460

1 108

1 300

537

-

N440x8x30x54x9H 5 800

SAE 2”

BSP 1 1/4” and 2”

CBM 5000

1 460

1 224

1 300

535

270

N460x8x30x56x9H 6 700

SAE 2”

BSP 1 1/4” and 2”

CBM 6000

1 460

1 342

1 300

535

270

N460x8x30x56x9H 7 500

SAE 2”

BSP 1 1/4” and 2”

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08

Weight (kg)


389 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

9/28

Flange mounting

With splines for flange or torque arm mounting. The splines shall be lubricated, either oiled with hydraulic oil at assembly, or filled with transmission oil from the connected gearbox. To avoid wear in the splines, the installation must be within the specified tolerances in fig. 9. For

1

control of spline, see table 4. When splines are used for torque arm mounting, the splines shall be lubricated with oil at assembly, see fig. 10. For control of spline, see table 4.

Unidirectional drives

Bidirectional drives

Steel with yield strength Relmin = 450 N/mm2

Steel with yield strength Relmin = 700 N/mm2

øi

Table 3: Recommeded material in the shaft

Table 4 Spline

CBM 2000

CBM 3000/4000

CBM 5000/6000

Tooth data

W360

W440

W460

Tooth profile and bottom form

DIN 5480

DIN 5480

DIN 5480

Tolerance

8f

8f

8f

Guide

Flank

Flank

Flank

Pressure angle

30°

30°

30°

Module

8

8

8

Number of teeth

44

54

56

Pitch diameter

Ø352

Ø432

Ø448

Bottom diameter

Ø340,8

Tip diameter

Ø358,4

0 -1,801 h11 -0,107

Ø420,8 Ø438,4

0 -1,825 h11 -0,121

Ø440,8 Ø458,4

Measure over measuring pins

377,099

Diameter of measuring pins

Ø16

Ø16

Ø16

Addendum modification x*m

-0,4

-0,4

-1,6

-0,188

457,155

-0,212

476,907

2

Fig. 9

For production of shaft see dwg 078 2432, 078 2451 and 078 2673. Table 5

CBM 2000-4000 *

øi

Dy

Di

t

1 300 +0.125

ø 1 329

ø 1 315

4.4±0.1

0 O-ring to be used in submerged applications, or for external lubrication of the splines.

0 -1,825 h11

3

Torque arm mounting

-0,118 -0,208

Filled with oil

4

Fig. 10

For production of shaft see dwg 078 2432, 078 2451 and 078 2673.

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


390 Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

10/28

Dimensions, motor with hollow shaft, coupling adapter

B

A

D

C

F

Rotating part Fig. 11

Fig. 12: CBM 2000

B

B

D

D

C

F

C

F

Rotating part

Rotating part Fig. 13: CBM 3000

Fig. 14: CBM 4000

B D

C

B E

D

C

F

E

F

Rotating part

Rotating part

Fig. 15: CBM 5000

Fig. 16: CBM 6000

Table 6: Dimensions motor with hollow shaft, shaft coupling Motor

A (mm)

B (mm)

C (mm)

D (mm)

E (mm)

F (mm)

Weight (kg)

Main conn.

Drain conn.

CB 2000

1 460

1 227

720

773

-

360

4 850

2"

1 1/4" och 2"

CB 3000

1 460

1 434

950

863

-

460

6 600

2"

1 1/4" och 2"

CB 4000

1 460

1 552

950

981

-

460

7 450

2"

1 1/4" och 2"

CB 5000

1 460

1 719

1 180

1 030

270,2

480

9 700

2"

1 1/4" och 2"

CB 6000

1 460

1 838

1 180

1 030

270,2

480

10 500

2"

1 1/4" och 2"

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


391 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

Design of driven shaft end on heavily loaded shaft

11/28

Table 7 CBM 2000

Where the driven shaft is heavily loaded and is subject to high stresses, for example for changes in the direction of

Dim

rotation and/or load, it is recommended that the driven

A

mm

ø360

-0,018

CBM 3000 CBM 4000 ø460

-0,075

shaft should have a stress relieving groove; see figure

in

below and tables 8 and 9.

ø14,1732

-0,00068

Max. Ra 3,2 C

mm

257

ø480

-0,083 ø18,1102

-0,00292

B

-0,020

CBM 5000 CBM 6000

-0,00075

ø18,8976

-0,00323

300

-0,020 -0,083 -0,00075 -0,00323

1

320

in

10,12

11,81

12,60

mm

354

454

474

in

13,94

17,87

18,66

ÆA

ÆC

Note! The dimensions are valid for +20 °C (68 °F) Table 8: Recommeded material in the shaft

30° 6±0,5 (0,24±0,02)

Unidirectional drives

Bidirectional drives

Steel with yield strength Relmin = 300 N/mm2

Steel with yield strength Relmin = 450 N/mm2

2

R 50 (R 1,97)

B±0,5 (B±0,02)

Fig. 17

Normally loaded shaft In drives with only one direction of rotation and/or load where the stresses in the shaft are moderate, the shaft can be plain, see fig. 18 and tables 8 and 9.

Max. R a 3,2

ÆA

3

30°

6±0,5 (0,24±0,02)

4

Fig. 18

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


392 12/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | H채gglunds CBM

Accessories

Torque arm, type TCA 200 - 600 Easy to apply - H채gglunds torque arms. A shaft mounted gearless drive is achieved by utilizing the standard H채gglunds torque arm. Spline shaft for external load, or shaft for shaft coupling can be used. As a result, alignment problems, expensive flexible couplings and bed plates are eliminated.

Table 9 Dimensions Torque arms

Max, torque, Nm (lbf.ft) For alternating or pulsating torque

At static torque

TCA 200 for CBM 2000

700 000 (516 300)

840 000 (619 600)

TCA 400 for CBM 3000/CBM 4000

1 400 000 (1 032 600)

1 680 000 (1 239 100)

TCA 600 for CBM 5000/CBM 6000

2 100 000 (1 548 900)

2 520 000 (1 858 700)

Spline shaft on driven machine

Mounting kit Shaft on driven machine Shaft adapter

H채gglunds CBM motor

Torque arm

Fig. 19: Torque arm

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08

Shaft coupling


393 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

13/28

A B Thickness = T

1

E C

2

Fig. 20: Dimensions torque arm Table 10: Dimensions torque arm Torque arm

A mm (in)

B mm (in)

C mm (in)

D

E mm (in)

T mm (in)

Weight kg (lb)

TCA 200 for CBM 2000

2 875 (113,19)

2 000 (78,74)

580 (22,83)

M30

1 600 (62,99)

40 (1,57)

445 (981)

TCA 400 for CBM 3000/ CBM 4000

3 900 (153,54)

3 000 (118,11)

690 (27,17)

M30

1 600 (62,99)

50 (1,97)

875 (1 929)

TCA 600 for CBM 5000/ CBM 6000

3 900 (153,54)

3 000 (118,11)

840 (33,07)

M30

1 600 (62,99)

50 (1,97)

2 000 (4 409)

3

a£±25°

x = ±2 mm (0.079) misalignment in installation. x ≤ ±15 mm (0.59) movement when in use.

x

Note: Ideal angle = 0°

10

4

Fig 21: Mounting of pivoted attachment

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


394 14/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Double ended torque arm, DTCBM 2000-1200 - DTCBM 6000 Double ended torque arm, including double acting hydraulic cylinder and pivoted attachment. Following are included in delivery: – Screws and washers (motor-torque arm) – Hose kit + clamps – Hose flange connections

B

A

Fig. 22: Dimensions double torque arm Table 11: Dimensions double torque arm Torque Arm

Motor type

Ordering code

A mm (In)

078 2510-801 R939056847

CBM 6000-6000

DTCBM 6000

3 600 (141,73)

2 170 (4 784)

DTCBM 6000-5600

3 200 (125,98)

1 960 (4 321)

DTCBM 5000-4600

2 800 (110,23)

1 760 (3 880)

DTCBM 4000

4 200 (165,35)

1 130 (2 491)

078 2510-802 R939056848 078 2510-803 R939056849 078 2509-801 R939056144 078 2509-802 R939056145

CBM 6000-5600 CBM 5000-5000 CBM 5000-4600 CBM 4000-4000 CBM 4000-3800

078 2509-803 R939056850

CBM 3000-3000

078 2509-804 R939056851

CBM 3000-2600

078 2509-806 R939056852 078 2509-807 R939056853 078 2509-808 R939056854

Weight Kg (Ib)

CBM 4000-3600 CBM 4000-3400

DTCBM 4000-3600

CBM 4000-3200

078 2509-805 R939056146

B mm (In)

CBM 3000-2800 CBM 3000-2400 CBM 3000-2200 CBM 2000-2000 CBM 2000-1800 CBM 2000-1600 CBM 2000-1400 CBM 2000-1200

3 600 (141,73)

950 (2 094) 1 235 (48,62)

DTCBM 3000 DTCBM 3000-2600 DTCBM 3000-2200

3 200 (125,98)

850 (1 874)

2 800 (110,24)

740 (1 631)

DTCBM 2000-1800 DTCBM 2000-1600 DTCBM 2000-1200

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


395 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

15/28

Mounting set SMCB1 for speed encoder

Cross-over valve, COCB 1000

Speed encoder kit for Compact CBM 2000-6000

The valve can be used on CBM motors with adapter 041

motors where the speed encoder is enclosed and well

0523-801. The valve is bolted on the adapter which is

protected.

bolted on the motor, and the valve protects the motor and

The mounting set can be used for both spline and shaft

system from too high pressure, if the motor is suddenly

coupling motors.

stopped.

The encoder is used for detection of speed by pulse-

The relief valves have a standard pressure settings of 350

frequency or/either direction of rotation by pulse-train.

bar (5076 psi), but are fully adjustable between 50 bar

1

(725 psi) to 350 bar (5076 psi). Pressure setting is made without charge pressure. Screws and O-rings are included in delivery. The valve for charge pressure have a standard pressure setting of 15 bar (218 psi), but are fully adjustable down to 3 bar (43,5 psi). Anti-cavitation check valves are built into the block, and makes it possible to arrange for external supply of charge

2

pressure.

Fig. 23

3

Fig. 25 Q(gpm) 0

50

100

150

200

250

60 800 50

700

Δp(bar)

4

600

40

500 30

400

Δp (psi)

Fig. 24 CBM 2000 with SMCB1

300

20

m -C Am

10

200 100

0 0

100

200

300

400

500

600

700

800

900

0 1000

Q(l/min)

Fig. 25: Pressure loss COCB

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


396 16/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Coupling adapter, CBM 2000-6000 The adapter includes shrink disk and shaft adapter. Mounting kit must be ordered separately. The coupling adapter is designed for shaft, that can not be made with splines.

Shrink disk

Shaft adapter

O-ring delivered with the motor

Mounting kit (must be ordered separately)

Fig. 26 Table 13: Ordering code

Table 12: Ordering code, coupling adapter Motor type

Unidirectional drive

Bidirectional drive

Motor type

Ordering code

CBM 2000

078 2411-801 R939055538

078 2412-801 R939055544

CBM 2000

R939055413 078 2315-801

CBM 3000/4000

078 2411-802 R939056668

078 2412-802 R939056674

CBM 3000

R939055509 078 2315-802

078 2412-803 R939056676

CBM 4000

R939055497 078 2315-803

CBM 5000

R939055505 078 2315-804

CBM 6000

R939055506 078 2315-805

CBM 5000/6000

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


397 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

17/28

SWEDEN

Hägglunds tandem motors A Tandem motor consists of 3 major units, Front motor + Tandem kit TBM xx + Rear motor. On the stamping sign on

HAGGLUNDS TYPE

the Tandem kit, the max pressure and the total weight for the complete unit are declared. Note that the complete

Telephone +46 660-870 00 Telefax +46 660-871 60 http://www.hagglunds.com

A

INDIVID NO.

MAX PRESSURE

WEIGHT

B

Ordering code for a Tandem motor, contains of 3 individual

HÄGGLUNDS DRIVES AB S-890 42 Mellansel

D

kg

C

bar

Ordering codes (3 parts).

A: TBM-type, same as Ordering code B: Week of assembly (yy-ww) C: Max working pressure for the assembly D: Total weight of the assembly

1

Fig 27: Stamping for TBM-unit

CBM 2000 XXXX SB0V0A XX XX

CBP 400 XXX SA0V00F XX XX

2 TBM 40 G 3/4“ / for oiling g of splines p

3

4

Fig. 27: Example, CBM 2000 XXXX SB0V0A XX XX + TBM 40 X 00 00 + CBP 400 XXX SA0V00F XX XX Table 14 Tandem motor

Max. pressure bar

psi

Total weight

A Lenght

B Diameter

kg

lb

mm

in

6 505

14 344

1 845

72,6

7 437

16 399

1 963

77,3

8 320

18 346

2 081

81,9

CBM 5000 + TBM 40 +CBP 400

9 140

20 154

2 199

86,6

1 890 000

1 393 997

CBM 6000 + TBM 40 +CBP 400

10 005

22 061

2 317

91,2

2 240 000

1 652 145

CBM 2000 + TBM 40 +CBP 400 CBM 3000 + TBM 40 +CBP 400 CBM 4000 + TBM 40 +CBP 400

350

5 076

mm

1 460

in

Max. torque to driven shaft

57,5

Nm

lbf•ft

840 000

619 554

1 190 000

877 702

1 540 000

1 135 850

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


398 18/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Diagrams for Hägglunds CBM

Fig 28: Recommended charge pressure - Compact CBM motors 4-port connection. Valid for oil viscosity 40 cSt.

Fig 29: Recommended charge pressure -Compact CBM motors 8-port connection. Valid for oil viscosity 40 cSt.

Case 1: The motor works in braking mode. Required charge pressure at the inlet port is according to diagram above. Case 2: The motor works in driving mode only. Required back pressure at the outlet port corresponds to 30% of value given in diagram above, but may not be lower than 2 bar (29 psi).

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


399 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

19/28

Overall efficiency, oil viscosity 40 cSt, Pc = 15 bar (217 psi)

800

800

0

5

10

15

20

25

Speed (rpm)

95%

300000 200000

0

1 Torque (ft·lbf)

Torque (kNm)

Torque (ft·lbf)

Torque (kNm)

300

400000

94%

96%

97%

100000

100

0

30

kW

100000

00

0

400

200

100

500000

W)

200000

97%

200

500 W 100 k

300

300000

93%

00k

W)

400000

96%

W 100 k

400

g (5

kW

600

95%

00k

500

700

500000

10

00

g (5

600

94%

shin Flu

10

shin Flu

700

0

5

10

15

20

25

Speed (rpm)

0

30

Fig 31: CBM 2000 4-port

Fig 30: CBM 2000 8-port

2

10 Speed (rpm)

15

20

20

3

15

0

1000000

94%

95%

800000 600000

96%

400000 97%

200000

200 0

Torque (ft·lbf)

Torque (ft·lbf)

600 400

10

kW

1000 800

93%

00

Torque (kNm)

Torque (kNm)

Torque (ft·lbf)

0

W

400000 200000

0

5

Speed (rpm) Fig 34: CBM 4000 8-port

15

10

600000

W) 00k

800000

200 5

g (5

1200

100 k

Torque (kNm)

10

shin

95%

97%

0

5

Flu

kW

W) 00k

kW

400

0

1400

1000000

100

600

100000

1600

96%

800

200000

Speed (rpm)

00

g (5

1000

0

Torque (kNm)

0

94%

10

shin

1200

300000

Fig 33: CBM 3000 4-port

Flu

1400

400000 96%

200

0

Fig 32: CBM 3000 8-port

1600

kW

5

400

500000

95%

97%

100000 0

00

200

600000

W)

200000

97%

600

W

kW

300000

700000 94%

100 k

400000

800

800000

93%

00k

500000

g (5

W)

600000

10

kW 95%

100

400

1000

700000

96%

600

shin Flu

800000

00

00k

g (5

800

0

10

shin Flu

1000

1200

94%

Torque (ft·lbf)

1200

10

15

0

Speed (rpm) Fig 35: CBM 4000 4-port

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB

4


400 Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

400000

97%

200000

0

2

4

6

Speed (rpm)

8

10

0

0

8

10

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08

Torque (ft·lbf)

Torque (kNm)

Fig 38: CBM 6000 8-port

kW

4 6 Speed (rpm)

0

00

200 2

Torque (ft·lbf)

0

1400000

10

200000

)

400

0

10

1200000

94%

1000 800

1000000

95%

93%

600

400000

400

200000

200 0

800000 600000

96%

kW

400000

97%

1200 100

600

600000

0kW

1400

)

94%

kW

800

8

(50

1000000 800000

96%

100

1000

0

1600

ng

0kW

95%

1200000

shi

(50

1200

4 6 Speed (rpm)

Flu

kW

ng

1400

2

1800

00

shi

1600

0

2000

1400000

10

Flu

1800

200000

Fig 37: CBM 5000 4-port

Fig 36: CBM 5000 8-port

2000

400000

97%

200

Torque (kNm)

0

600000 96%

600 400

400 200

800

0

2

Fig 39: CBM 6000 4-port

4 6 Speed (rpm)

8

10

0

Torque (ft·lbf)

600

1000

1000000 800000

95%

kW

600000

Torque (kNm)

96%

kW

800

1200 100

1000

1200000 94%

)

800000 100

Torque (kNm)

1400

kW

1600

1000000

1400000

0kW 50

1200

95%

g(

kW

1400

1800

1200000

00

00

) kW 500

1600

2000

1400000

94%

10

10

( ng shi Flu

1800

n shi Flu

2000

Torque (ft·lbf)

20/28


401 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

Flushing of motor case

21/28

Variation in volumetric loss at different oil viscosities for Compact motors

The Hägglunds CBM motors have very high total efficiency,

When calculating volumetric losses using other viscosities

and they are now frequently used in applications with high

than 40 cSt, multiply the value given in the volumetric loss

power. To avoid high temperature in the motor case, the

diagram by the factor K. 1

losses generated in the motors must be cooled away, because high temperature gives lower viscosity and this K 1.5

gives reduction in rating life and max allowed power for the motor. For continuous duty the motor case must be flushed when the power exceed the following max power:

1.0

Max power without flushing ▶ CBM 2000 - 6000

0.5

500 kW (670 hp)

Volumetric losses - Compact CBM motors Valid for an oil viscosity of 40 cSt.

10

20

40

60

100

200

400 600

1000 n cSt

2

Fig 41

Volumetric losses (l/min)

25

CBM 6000

20

CBM 5000 CBM 4000 CBM 3000 CBM 2000

15 10 5 0

3 0

100

200 300 High Pressure (bar)

400

Fig 40: volumetric loss

4

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


402 Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

22/28

Diagrams for Hägglunds CBM Pressure loss, oil viscosity 40 cSt 20

14

200

00

M

12

20

CB

10

0

80

1 0-

150

0

M

CB

8

20

00

-16

00

20

400

M CB -1 000 M2 00 0-12 200

6

100

CB

4

CBM

2 30

40

0

0

2

CBM 3000-2400

CBM 3000-2200

CBM 3000-2800 CBM 3000-2600

CBM 3000

10

20 Speed (rpm)

30

100 50

40

18

200

12 150

10 8

100

6 4 2 30

Fig 44: CBM 3000 pressure loss 4 ports

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08

40

Pressure loss (bar)

14

20 Speed (rpm)

0

20

Pressure loss (psi)

Pressure loss (bar)

16

10

6 4

250

0

00 20 M CB 800 -1 0 0 0 M 2 -1600 CB 0 200 400 CBM 2000-1 CBM 00-1200 20 CBM

8

0

Fig 43: CBM 2000 pressure loss 8 ports

18

0

150

10

50

Fig 42: CBM 2000 pressure loss 4 ports

20

200

12

250

16

0

14

0 24

-

00

12

M

30

20

2 0-

0

10

M

30

100

6 4

0

0

150

CB

8

50

200

0

CB

50

2 0

10

20 Speed (rpm)

Fig 45: CBM 3000 pressure loss 8 ports

30

40

0

Pressure loss (psi)

20 Speed (rpm)

14

CBM 3000

10

250

16

CBM 3000-2800 CBM 3000-2600

0

Pressure loss (bar)

16

0

18

250

Pressure loss (psi)

Pressure loss (bar)

18

Pressure loss (psi)

20


403

12 150

10 8

100

6 4

CBM 4000-3200

200

12 150

10 8

100

6

30

40

0

0

0

10

20 Speed (rpm)

30

40

CBM 6000 CBM 6000-5600 CBM 5000 CBM 5000-4600

Fig 47: CBM 4000 pressure loss 8 ports

20

18

200

12 150

10 8

100

6 4

50

2

Pressure loss (bar)

14

Pressure loss (psi)

16

2

18

250

250

16 14

200

12 150

10 8

100

6 4

10

20 Speed (rpm)

30

Fig 48: CBM 5000, 6000 pressure loss 4 ports

40

0

0

3

50

2 0

0

Pressure loss (psi)

20 Speed (rpm)

CBM 5000-4600

10

1

50

CBM 6000 CBM 6000-5600 CBM 5000

0

20

Pressure loss (bar)

14

2

Fig 46: CBM 4000 pressure loss 4 ports

0

250

16

4

50

2

23/28

Pressure loss (psi)

200

Pressure loss (bar)

14

Pressure loss (psi)

Pressure loss (bar)

18

250

16

CBM 4000-3400

20

18

0

CBM 4000 CBM 4000-3800 CBM 4000-3600

20

CBM 4000-3200

CBM 4000 CBM 4000-3800 CBM 4000-3600 CBM 4000-3400

Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

0

10

20 Speed (rpm)

30

40

0

Fig 49: CBM 5000, 6000 pressure loss 8 ports

4

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


404 24/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Fire resistant fluid

Choice of hydraulic fluid

The following fluids are tested for Hägglunds motors (ISO/ The Hägglunds hydraulic motors are primarily designed to operate on conventional petroleum based hydraulic oils. The hydraulic oil can be chosen in consultation with the oil

DP 6071). Table 17 Fluid

Approved

Seals

Internal paint

HFA: Oil (3-5%) in water emulsion

No

-

-

HFB: Inverted emulsion 4045% water in oil

Yes

The oil shall have FZG (90) fail stage minimum 11 descri-

Nitrile (std motor)

Not painted*

bed in IP 334 (DIN 51354). The oil must also contain inhibi-

HFC: Water-glycol

Yes

Nitrile * (std motor)

Not painted*

HFD:S - Chlorinated hydrocarbons

Yes

Viton

Not painted*

HFD:T - Mixture of the above

Yes

Viton

Not painted*

HFD:U - Other compositions

Yes

Viton

Not painted*

supplier of your local sales office, bearing the following requirements in mind: General

tors to prevent oxidation, corrosion and foaming. The viscosity of mineral oil is highly dependent of the temperature. The final choice of oil must depend on the operating temperature that can be expected or that has been established

HFD synthetic fluids

in the system and not in the hydraulic tank. High temperatures in the system greatly reduce the service life of oil and rubber seals, as well as resulting in low viscosity, which in turn provides poor lubrication. Content of water shall be

* Must be specified in the order.

less than 0,1%. In industrial applications with high demands for service life, the content of water shall be less

Down rating of pressure data and basic rating life

than 0,05%.

Down rating of pressure, for motors used in systems with

Viscosity index = 100 is recommended. Viscosity index =

fire resistant fluids, the maximum pressure for motor given

150 can be used for operation with large temperature

on data sheet must be multiplied with following factors:

difference, however many hydraulic fluids are subject to

HFA-fluid

not fit for use

temporary and permanent reductions of the viscosity.

HFB-fluid

0.7 x maximum pressure for motor

Hägglunds recommendation is always to use the base oil

HFC-fluid

0.7 x maximum pressure for motor

viscosity when calculating the rated life and max allowed

HFD-fluid

0.9 x maximum pressure for motor

power. For heavy-duty applications we recommend syntheDown rating of basic rating life, for motors used in systems

tic oils.

with fire resistant fluids, the “expected basic rated life” must be multiplied with following factors: Recomended viscosity in motor case at operating

HFA-fluid

not fit for use

temperature: 40-150 cSt.

HFB-fluid

0.26 x expected life with mineral oil

HFC-fluid

0.24 x expected life with mineral oil

HFD-fluid

0.80 x expected life with mineral oil

Table 15: Temperature limits Normal operating temperature should be less than +50 °C (122 °F) Temp °C

Temp °F

Nitrile seals (std motor)

-35 °C to +70 °C

-31 °F to +158 °F

Viton seals

-20 °C to +100 °C

-4 °F to +212 °F

Table 16: Viscosity limits Minimum viscosity limits at operating temprature in motor case Standard motors with coated piston, uncoated cam rollers and charge pressure below 50 bar (725 psi).

15 cSt *

*) Low viscosity gives reduced service life for the motors. Maximum permitted viscosity is 10.000 cSt.

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


405 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

Filtration

Environmentally acceptable fluids

The oil in a hydraulic system must always be filtered and

Table 18

also new oil from your supplier has to be filtered when

Fluid

Seals

Internal paint

adding it to the system. The grade of filtration in a hydraulic

Vegetable */** Fluid Yes HTG

Nitrile (std motor)

-

Synthetic ** Esters HE

Nitrile (std motor)

-

system is a question of ser vice life v.s. money spent on filtration.

Approved

25/28

Yes

1

In order to obtain stated service life it is important to follow our recommendations concerning contamination level. When choosing the filter it is important to consider the amount of dirt particles that the filter can absorb and still operate satisfactory. For that reason we recommend a filter

*

Vegetable fluids give good lubrication and small change of viscosity with different temperature. Vegetable fluids must be controlled every 3 months and temperature shall be less than +45 °C (113 °F) to give good service life for the fluid.

** Environmentally acceptable fluid give the same service life for the drive, as mineral oil.

with an indicator that gives a signal when it is time to change the filter cartridge. Filtering recommendations

2

Before start-up, check that the system is thoroughly cleaned. ▶ 1. For industrial applications the contamination level should not exceed ISO 4406:1999 18/16/13 (NAS 1638, class 7). ▶ 2. When filling the tank and motor case, we recommend the use of a filter with the grade of filtration β10≥75. ▶ Explanation of “Grade of Filtration” Grade of filtration β10≥75 indicates the following: β10 means the size of particle ≥10µm that will be removed by filtration. =75 means the grade of filtration of above mentioned size

3

of particle. The grade of filtration is defined as number of particles in the oil before filtration in relation to number of particles in the oil after filtration. Ex. Grade of filtration is β10≥75. Before the filtration the oil contains N number of particles ≥10µm and after passing the filter once the oil contains

N 75 number of particles ≥10µm. This means that

N

4

N = 74·N 75 75

number of particles have been filtered (=98.6%).

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


406 26/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Versatile mounting - examples of installations

Fig 50: Torque arm mounted motor with splines.

Fig 51: Torque arm mounted motor with coupling adapter.

Fig 52: Flange mounted motor with splines and high radial load Fr on driven shaft.

Fig 53: Flange mounted motor with splines and low radial load from driven shaft.

Fig 54: Flange mounted motor with splines and through hole for cooling of the driven machine.

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08


407 Hägglunds CBM | Radial piston hydraulic motor

27/28

Declaration of Conformity Example of the Declaration of Conformity given by Hägglunds Drives AB

1

2

3

4

The Declaration of Conformity above, is available on request for deliveries from Hägglunds Drives AB. Translations into other languages are also available.

RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08, Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB


408 28/28

Radial piston hydraulic motor | Hägglunds CBM

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB 895 80 Mellansel, Sweden Tel: +46 (0) 660 870 00 Fax: +46 (0) 660 871 60 documentation.mll@boschrexroth.se www.boschrexroth.com

Bosch Rexroth Mellansel AB, RE 15300, Edition: 2012-08

The data specified above only serve to describe the product. As our products are constantly being further developed, no statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from ourinformation. The information given does not release the user from the obligation of own judgment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and aging.


409

RE 15 190/07.03 Replaces: 02.92

Radial piston hydraulic motors with a fixed displacement Types MKM, MRM Nominal sizes 11 to 250 Series 1X Maximum operating pressure 315 bar Maximum displacement 251 L/min Maximum torque 1165 Nm

Type MKM 11 AZ 1X/M2 A0

Overview of contents Contents Features Ordering details Technical data Function, section Motor types - overview, features, symbols Bearing life, shaft strength Characteristic curves Unit dimensions: MKM 11 / MRM 11 MKM 22, 32, 45, 63, 90, 110 MRM 80, 125 MRM 160, 250 Shaft for tachometer, 2nd shaft end Valve, subplate mounting Motors with holding brake Circuit, storage, assembly, drain line, flushing connection, commissioning

Page 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 to 12

Type MKM 90 AZ 1X/M1 A1

13 14 15, 17 16, 17 18 19 to 24 25, 26 27, 28

Features

Type MRM 160 AZ 1X/M1 A0

– – – –

– Very low operating noise level – Versions with: • Shaft for tachometer • Through shaft • Built-on valves • With brakes

Wide speed range Linear acting backlash compensation control Smooth rotation even at very low speeds Extremely small moment of inertia permitting high reversal frequency – Very suitable for control applications – Suitable for fire resistant fluids

© 2003 by Bosch Rexroth AG, Industrial Hydraulics, D-97813 Lohr am Main All rights reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced or stored, processed, duplicated or circulated using electronic systems, in any form or by means, without the prior written authorisation of Bosch Rexroth AG. In the event of contravention of the above provisions, the contravening party is obliged to pay compensation.

MKM, MRM

1/28

RE 15 190/07.03


410

Ordering details

1X Motor type Standard motor = MKM (NS 11, 22, 32, 45, 63, 90, 110) Motor with backlash compensation control = MRM (NS 11, 80, 125, 160, 250) Displacement – NS MKM MRM • • = 11 11 cm3 = NS 11 • – = 22 22 cm3 = NS 22 • – = 32 33 cm3 = NS 32 44 cm3 = NS 45 • – = 45 3 • – = 63 66 cm = NS 63 3 – • = 80 81 cm = NS 80 3 • – = 90 89 cm = NS 90 • – = 110 110 cm3 = NS 110 126 cm3 = NS 125 – • = 125 – • = 160 161 cm3 = NS 160 – • = 250 251 cm3 = NS 250 • = Available 1st shaft end Cylindrical, key DIN 6885 =A Splined shaft DIN 5480 =K (only motor type MRM without NS 11) Internally splined shaft DIN 5480 =H (only motor type MRM without NS 11) 2nd shaft end Without 2nd shaft end = Z Cylindrical Ø 10 mm for = M tacho connection Splined Ø 28 mm DIN 5480 = M10(only motor type MKM without NS 11) Series 10 to 19 = 1X (10 to 19, unchanged installation and connection dimensions) NBR seals, suitable for =M HLP mineral oil to DIN 51 524 part 2 FKM seals, suitable for phosphate ester (HFD) =V for HFB and HFC – pressure reduced to 70 %

* Further details in clear text e. g. gear unit tacho/valves Holding brake Without brakes

No code = LBD9A2 (see LBD11A2 technical LBD124A2 data on page 5) LBD249A2 Built-on valves, subplate mounting (only in conjunction with line connections A1) No code = None N01 = Pressure-anti-cavitation valve (pressure stage in clear text) N61 = Pressure-anti-cavitation valve Valve connection NS 6 to DIN 24 340 N101 = Pressure-anti-cavitation valve Valve connection NS 10 to DIN 24 340 Additional details No code = Standard S99 = Flushing connection (not for NS 11) T= Increased clearance for very high speeds and very high temperatures Pipe connections A0= Threaded connection, radial A1= Flange connection, radial (for NS 80, 125, 160, 250-SAE 3/4") B5= Threaded connections, axial (only NS 22, 32, 45, 63, 90, 110) Flange version 1= Face mounting - standard version (not for type MKM NS 11) 2= Flange mounting 3= Face mounting (only for NS 22, 32, 45, 63, 90, 110)

}

Ordering example: MKM 45 AZ1X/M2A0

RE 15 190/07.03

2/28

MKM, MRM


411

Technical data (for applications outside these parameters, please consult us!) General Design Type Mounting style Connection type Installation Shaft loading, bearing life Nominal size Moment of inertia J Weight

NS kg cm2 m

kg

V Specific theoretic T Specific average T Continuous T Max. T Pressure differential Continuous pressure Δp Operating pressure, max Δp Peak pressure 3) Δp Max. summated pressure in ports A + B p Leakage fluid pressure p Speed range From n Up to n

cm3 Nm/bar Nm/bar Nm Nm bar bar bar bar bar min–1 min–1

Radial piston motor, fixed displacement MKM; MRM Flange mounting; front face mounting Threaded; flange (depending on version) Optional See page 6 111) 112) 22 32 45 63 80 90 110 125 160 250 2.63 2.63 2.8 2.8 3.3 3.3 17 3.9 4.1 17 23 23 12 12 17.4 17.4 18.8 18.8 40 21.4 21.4 40 58 58

1

Hydraulic Displacement Torque

11 11 22 33 44 66 81 89 110 126 161 251 0.17 0.17 0.35 0.52 0.7 1.05 1.29 1.41 1.75 2 2.56 4 0.15 0.15 0.32 0.48 0.63 0.95 1.16 1.27 1.59 1.8 2.38 3.7 21 24 50 76.8 100 152 290 178 223 360 595 740 31.5 37.5 78 120 157 237 365 266 334 567 750 1165 140 160 160 160 160 160 250 140 140 200 250 200 210 250 250 250 250 250 315 210 210 315 315 315 250 315 315 315 315 315 400 250 250 350 400 350 250 315 315 315 315 315 400 250 250 350 400 350 1.5 bar (special seals for higher pressures on request.) 10 5 10 10 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 3000 3600 2250 1500 1800 1200 800 900 750 600 800 600 For speeds ≤ 10 min–1 please take the operating instructions into account, depending on the application minimum speeds of 0.1 min–1 are possible in closed loop applications. Power Continuous P kW 3.5 4.7 6 6 9.5 9.5 12 8.5 8.5 12 24 24 Intermittent P kW 4.3 5.8 7.5 7.5 11 11 15 10 10 15 30 30 Pcontinuous Continuous working power (with a max. return pressure of 10 bar): If continuously exceeded, then rotary group flushing should be provided. Pintermittent Power that intermittently (max. 10 % ED within an operating period of one hour) can be demanded. Pressure fluid HLP mineral oil to DIN 51 524 part 2 HFB and HFC fluids – pressures reduced to 70 %, Phosphate ester (HFD), FKM seals required Pressure fluid temperature range ϑ °C – 30 to + 90 Viscosity range ν mm2/s 20 to 150 recommended operating range 30 to 50, up to 1000 on start-up Cleanliness class to ISO code Maximum permissible degree of contamination of the pressure fluid is to ISO 4406 class 20/18/15 The cleanlines class stated for the components must be adhered too in hydraulic systems. Effective filtration prevents faults from occurring and at the same time increases the component service life. For the selection of filters see catalogue sheets RE 50 070, RE 50 076 and RE 50 081. Design

1) 3)

Tü Ts p m

Nm Nm bar kg

MKM; 2) MRM Definition to DIN 24 312 peak pressure = pressure curve which temporarily exceeds the maximum operating pressure and at which the motor continues to remain operable.

MKM, MRM

3

4

Technical data for the holding brake

Brake type Static braking moment (wet running) Dynamic braking moment (wet running) Air pressure Weight Motor type cross reference

2

Spring pressure multiple disc brake, static holding brake; dynamic operation only in the case of an emergency LBD9A2 LBD11A2 LBD124A2 LBD249A2 17 190 400 740 11 140 300 500 20 – 250 30 – 320 30 – 320 30 – 320 8 9.5 28 32 MKM 11 A2 MKM 22 A1 MRM 80 K2 MRM 160 K2 MRM 11 A2 MKM 32 A1 MRM 125 K2 MRM 250 K2 MKM 45 A1 MKM 63 A1 MKM 90 A1 MKM 110 A1 3/28

RE 15 190/07.03


412

Function, section 9

6

Section X-X

3

D

7

F

4 A/B

X

1

X

E

2

Types MKM and MRM hydraulic motors are fixed displacement external radial piston motors. Design The main components are housing (1), crankshaft (2), cover (3), cover plate (4), tapered roller bearings (5), pistons (6), control (7). Rotary group details The radial pistons (6) act on the crankshaft (2) via needle bearings (9) or via heptagonal rings with needle bearings. Crankshaft bearings: Pre-stressed, generously sized tapered roller bearings (5) in the Xarrangement. Power transmission pistons (6) – crankshaft (2): Via needle bearings (9) (or heptagon ring with needle bearings) Low friction losses, very long life, not sensitive to contamination, also suitable for maximum pressures and motor speeds, high starting torque, no stick/slip at low motor speeds, minimal leakage and high efficiency.

5

H

5

1

G

L 8 C

Operating medium return The pistons (6), which are again pushed outwards by the rotation of the crankshaft (2) eccentric, expel the fluid from the cylinder chambers (E), which are at present connected to the return flow line. Control Design: A flat distributor which moves in a linear manner. Purpose: Distribution of incoming flow to the cylinder chambers, collection of return flow. Operating principle: The control plate (7) incorprates an inner annular area (F) and forms with the annulus (8) an external annular chamber (G). By offsetting the control plate (7) radially between the motor housing (1) and locking cover (4) with the help of the eccentric which is connected firmly relative to the crankshaft (2) the inner and the outer annular areas are alternately brought into contact with the cylinders. The annular areas themselves open out into ports A or B on the outside.

Operating medium, feed and return The operating medium is supplied to and carried away from the motor by way of ports A or B. The cylinder chambers (E) are filled or emptied by way of the control and the channels (D) in the housing (1).

Leakages Leakages occurring at piston (6) and control (7) are collected in the motor casing (H) and discharged via drain port (C).

Torque generation; operating stroke The operating medium in the cylinder chambers (E), which are at present connected to the supply, are pressurised. The pistons (6) are pushed from the outside (external loading!) onto the eccentric of the crankshaft (operating stroke) and the crankshaft rotates.

Flushing With high powers and/or temperatures we recommend the use of rotary group flushing. Dependent on the type, 1 to 4 litres of flushing oil is fed into the drain connection L (4) and is then passed together with the motor leakage via the flushing port S99 to tank.

RE 15 190/07.03

4/28

MKM, MRM


413

Motor types - overview

Features

MKM Rotary group – 7, 14 or 21 radially arranged pistons – Power transmission piston - crankshaft: by means of pistons via heptagonal ring with needle cage

A/B

1

Control – Needle cage between the control plate and eccentric – A flat distributor plate that moves in a linear manner with gap seals to counter internal leakage and gap compensating sealing against external leakage. – Hydrostatic spring supported pressing of the pressure piece onto the control plate – Reduction in external leakage with minimal friction losses

L 2

MRM

B

Rotary group – 5 or 10 radially arranged pistons – Power transmission piston - crankshaft: by means of hydrostatically unloaded pistons and pentagonal ring with needle cage

A

Control – Roller bearings between the control rings and eccentric – A flat distributor plate that moves in a linear manner with backlash compensation – Hydrostatic spring supported pressing of the control rings onto the flat surfaces – Hydrostatic backlash compensation of the flat eccentric surfaces, spring supported via the pressure piece – Reliable backlash compensation even at high reversing frequencies – Only very slight leakage with minimal friction losses – The miniaturised shuttle valve ensures: that within the ring chamber. between the control lands. the higher pressure that the motor is being subjected too is applied

L

Symbols

4

With one shaft end

A

B

MKM, MRM

3

With 2 shaft ends

A

L

B

5/28

With holding brake

A

L

B

L

RE 15 190/07.03


414

Bearing life, shaft strength Ln-hyd10 is the modified nominal bearing life using mineral oil with a viscosity of n = 36 mm2/s in operating hours where 10 % of the bearings may fail. 90 % achieve a higher bearing life. The average mean bearing life Ln-hyd50 with mineral oil is approximately five times Ln-hyd10. In practice a minimum of Ln-hyd50 can be expected for hydraulic

Type

MKM / MRM11 MKM 22/32 MKM 45/63 MKM 90/110 MRM 80 MRM 125 MRM 160 MRM 250

Type

MKM / MRM11 MKM 22/32 MKM 45/63 MKM 90/110 MRM 80 MRM 125 MRM 160 MRM 250

RE 15 190/07.03

drives with mineral oil. As the operating speed is incorporated into the calculation approximatly as a proportionate figure, the table value is converted accordingly.

Speed n (min–1) 1000 500 350 250 400 400 400 300

Ln-hyd10 in operating hours at a defined Δp and speed n with no external forces on the drive shaft. 100 bar 140 bar 160 bar 180 bar >100000 88950 56995 38489 >100000 >100000 81400 54969 43679 14228 9119 6157 15719 5121 3281 2216 >100000 >100000 >100000 >100000 >100000 85030 54484 36792 >100000 38925 24941 16843 31319 10203 6537 4415

Speed n (min–1) 1000 500 350 250 400 400 400 300

Ln-hyd10 in operating hours at a defined Δp and speed n MKM 11, 22, 32, 45, 63 max. permissible radial force at the centre of the output shaft = 4500 N MKM 90, 110 max. permissible radial force at the centre of the output shaft = 3000 N MRM 80, 125, 160, 250 max. permissible radial force at the centre of the output shaft = 10 000 N 100 bar 140 bar 160 bar 180 bar 210 bar 250 bar 315 bar 4963 4485 4235 3983 3614 5838 5092 4717 4353 3839 3225 9319 5898 4713 3788 2767 1704 11423 4689 3098 2115 1281 27172 22727 20610 18623 15923 12872 9118 20998 15203 12872 10897 8514 6190 3810 25074 14939 11648 9167 6523 4289 2344 14150 6882 4977 3681 2421 1387 656

6/28

210 bar 23024 32883 3683 1325 97424 22009 10075 2641

250 bar

315 bar

18388 2059 54484 12308 5634 1477

25217 5697 2608 684

MKM, MRM


415

Characteristic curves (average value) measured at ν = 36 mm2/s; ϑoil= 50 °C; poutlet = 0 bar; pleakage oil = 0 bar MKM 11 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar → Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

1

Off-load characteristi curve 30 20 10 0

1000

2000

3000

Speed n in min–1 →

4000

2

Leakage flow 0,4 0,2

50

0

100

150

200

250

Pressure p1 in bar →

Speed n in min–1 →

MRM 11

Pressure differential p in bar →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

20 10 4

0

1000

2000

Speed n in

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Off-load characteristic curve 30

3000

min–1 →

4000

Leakage flow 0,4 0,2

0

50

100

150

200

250

Pressure p1 in bar →

Speed n in min–1 →

MKM, MRM

3

Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Flow qv in L/min

7/28

RE 15 190/07.03


416

Characteristic curves (average value) measured at ν = 36 mm2/s; ϑoil = 50 °C; poutlet = 0 bar; pleakage oil = 0 bar MKM 22 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar →

Off-load characteristic curve

Speed n in min–1 →

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

Speed n in min–1 →

80

160

240

Pressure p1 in bar →

MKM 32 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar → Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

Speed n in min–1 →

RE 15 190/07.03

8/28

20

Off-load characteristic curve

10

0

500

1000

Speed n in min–1 →

1500

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

80

160

240

Pressure p1 in bar →

MKM, MRM


417

Characteristic curves (average value) measured at ν = 36 mm2/s; ϑoil = 50 °C; poutlet = 0 bar; pleakage oil = 0 bar MKM 45 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar →

1

Off-load characteristic curve

Speed n in min–1 →

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

2

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

80

160

240

Pressure p1 in bar →

Speed n in min–1 →

MKM 63

Pressure differential p in bar →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

10 4

0

MKM, MRM

min–1 → 9/28

400

Speed n in

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Off-load characteristic curve 20

800

min–1 →

1200

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

Speed n in

3

Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Flow qv in L/min

80

160

240

Pressure p1 in bar →

RE 15 190/07.03


418

Characteristic curves (average value) measured at ν = 36 mm2/s; ϑoil= 50 °C; poutlet = 0 bar; pleakage oil = 0 bar MRM 80 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar →

Off-load characteristic curve

Speed n in min–1 →

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

100

200

300

Pressure p1 in bar →

Speed n in min–1 → MKM 90 Flow qv in L/min

Pressure differential p in bar →

10

10/28

300

600

Speed n in min–1 →

900

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

Speed n in min–1 →

RE 15 190/07.03

Off-load characteristic curve 20

0

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

80

160

240

Speed p1 in bar →

MKM, MRM


419

Characteristic curves (average value) measured at ν = 36 mm2/s; ϑoil= 50 °C; poutlet = 0 bar; pleakage oil = 0 bar MKM 110 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar →

1

Off-load characteristc curve 20

10

0

250

500

750

Speed n in min– 1 →

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

2

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

80

160

240

Pressure p1 in bar →

Speed n in min–1 → MRM 125

Pressure differential p in bar →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar → 11/28

Off-load characteristic curve 20

10

4 0

300

Speed n in

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Speed n in min–1 →

MKM, MRM

3

Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Flow qv in L/min

600

min–1 →

900

Leakage flow 3 2 1 0

100

200

300

Pressure p1 in bar →

RE 15 190/07.03


420

Characteristic curves (average value) measured at ν = 36 mm2/s; ϑoil= 50 °C; poutlet = 0 bar; pleakage oil = 0 bar MRM 160 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar →

Off-load characteristic curve

Speed n in min–1 →

Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

Speed n in min–1 →

Leakage flow 6 4 2 0

100

200

300

Pressure p1 in bar →

MRM 250 Minimum feed pressure during brake operation and closed circuit operation to the off-load characteristic curve.

Pressure differential p in bar → Leakage flow in dm3/min →

Torque T in Nm →

Inlet pressure Pinlet in bar →

Flow qv in L/min

Speed n in min–1 →

RE 15 190/07.03

12/28

Off-load characteristic curve 20

10

0

200

400

600

200

300

Speed n in min–1 → Leakage flow

6 4 2 0

100

Pressure p1 in bar →

MKM, MRM


421

Unit dimensions: MKM 11 and MRM 11 (dimensions in mm) Flange version „2“ (ISO 3019/2) Pipe connection „A0“ 45°

5

2

26

9 82 (92)

7

3

~ 190

View "X"

18,5

2

39

(~ 200)

15

1 2 3

2,6

Port A 8 Port B Direction of rotation viewed on the shaft end Right: With flow from port B to A Left: With flow from port A to B Leakage port Key A 5 x 5 x 20 DIN 6885 Counterbore for O-ring 21.89 x 2.62 Type MKM 11 Type MRM 11

4

14

G1

/2

60 ° 60°

1,5

Ø3

4 5

G 1/4

1

Ø 15,85 +0,025

27,2

135

Ø 25

1

Ø 115

“X”

135

160

Ø 133

44

Ø 125 h8

5

18

14 H13

45°

4

6 7 8

2

3

Pipe connection “A1” 26 22

60 M12 x 14 4

°

100

2

34

30

15

70

1

6 4

44

Ø2

5

MKM, MRM

13/28

G1

/4

RE 15 190/07.03


422

Unit dimensions: MKM 22, 32, 45, 63, 90 and 110 (dimensions in mm) Flange version „1“ Pipe connection „A0“

3

6 L1 55 52 50

Ø135 2,3

33

6x

60°

0 10 M8

30°

° 14 77,

5

5

Flange version “2” DIN ISO 3019/2 18

Ø 160 h8

0 20

45°

Ø

Ø 120 h8

6 140

51

43°

360 °

52

Port A Port B Direction of rotation viewed on the shaft end Right: With flow from port B to A Left: With flow from port A to B Leakage port G1/4 Flushing connection 2 x G1/4 (version „S99“) Key A 8 x 7 x 45 DIN 6885 Counterbore for O-ring 21.89 x 2.62

4 5 6 7

7 x M8, 10

Pipe connection “B5” M12 x 14

1

Ø25 Ø42 G1/4

100 18

70 34

4 44

RE 15 190/07.03

4

G3/4

70

7

2

Piston row(s) 1 1 2 2 3 3

77

Pipe connection “A1” 26 22

L1 208 208 226 226 248 248

2

36

7x

51,

1

Type MKM 22 MKM 32 MKM 45 MKM 63 MKM 90 MKM 110 1 2 3

52 61

Flange version “3”

°=

4

6

11

,4 3

17 34,5

5

175 L

G1 / Ø2 4 5

19

G1/2 Ø34

3 6°

36

77 ,14 °

72 36°

°

M8 Ø30k6

DIN 332

1,3

22

74 26

Ø80h8 Ø120h8

Ø178 8

36°

2

36

0,5 14

°

1 8°

18

14/28

MKM, MRM


423

Unit dimensions: MRM 80 and 125 (dimensions in mm) Flange version „1“ with splined shaft „K“ Pipe connection „A0“ 326 241 65 47

78 19

4

17 54

174

1

2

Flange version “2” with through holes

1 2 3 223 140h8

4

5 6 7 8

72°

200 160 72°

M12

11

9 36°

Ø 40j6

60 7,5

Ø47

G 3/8,14

5

Ø 185

140

M12 ° 36

°

Ø 125h8

126

31 56 G1

°

60

36

1

36

72°

129

1,85

50

R4

0

16

4

8

70

110

M16 Ø37,5

3

° 60

2

10

Shown offset

5

7

Port A G 1 Port B G 1 Direction of rotation viewed on the shaft end Right: With flow from port B to A Left: With flow from port A to B Leakage port G 3/8 Counterbore Ø 28 mm, offset 72° in relation to ports A and B Flushing connection G 3/8 (version „S99“) Key A 12 x 8 x 56 DIN 6885 Shaft groove for retaining ring DIN 471 Splined shaft connection DIN 5480 W40 x 2 x 18 x 7h Splined shaft connection DIN 5480 N45 x 2 x 21 x 9H 25

3

38 18

Shaft version “A”

Shaft version “H”

69 65

6

4

7

6 Ø60

Ø45H7

M10

43

M16

Ø35H7

12

DIN 332

DIN 332

40k6

9 79

MKM, MRM

3 14–1,5

15/28

RE 15 190/07.03


424

Unit dimensions: MRM 160 and 250 (dimensions in mm) Flange version „1“ with splined shaft „K“ Pipe connection „A0“ 378 283

4

80

110

2,15

60

7

M16

140

Ø 47

M12

R4

0 72°

78

16

Ø 125h8

36

Ø 185

257

Ø 50j6

41

18°

66 G1

19

54

°

70 7,5

Ø47

G 3/8,14

42°

17 47

54

3

216

9

1 1 2 3

Flange version “2” with through holes 223 140h8

4

5 6 7

72°

200 16 0

72 °

11 M1

2

18°

10

2

8 9

9

Port A G 1 Port B G 1 Direction of rotation viewed on the shaft end Right: With flow from port B to A links: With flow from port A to B Leakage port Counterbore Ø 28 mm, offset 72 ° in relation to ports A and B Key A 14 x 9 x 70 DIN 6885 Shaft groove for retaining ring DIN 471 Splined shaft connection DIN 5480 W50 x 2 x 24 x 7h Splined shaft connection DIN 5480 N45 x 2 x 21 x 9H Flushing connection G 3/8 (version „S99“)

42°

25

Shaft version “A”

6

38 18

Shaft version “H”

6

86 82

7

5 Ø60

Ø45H7

M10

53,5

M16

Ø35H7

14

DIN 332

DIN 332

50m6

8 96

RE 15 190/07.03

3 14–1,5

16/28

MKM, MRM


425

Unit dimensions MRM 80, 125, 160 a und 250 (dimensions in mm) MRM 80, MRM 125 Flange version “1” with splined shaft “K” Pipe connection “A1”

For dimensions see page 15

3

1

4

129

54

174

10

47

126 M12

M10, 18

28

30

Ø20

47.63

68

0

16

°

60

2

22.23

72°

1 11

2

1 2 3

MRM 160, MRM 250 Flange version “1” with splined shaft “K” Pipe connection “A1”

Port A SAE J 518 3/4" standard Port B SAE J 518 3/4" standard Direction of rotation viewed on the shaft end Right: With flow from port B to A Left: With flow from port A to B 4 Leakage port G 3/8 Counterbore Ø 28 mm, offset 72° in relation to ports A and B 10 Flushing connection G 3/8 (version „S99“) 11 Flange height from centre of shaft 80+0.5 mm

For dimensions see page 16

4

54

3

216 47

M12

28

4

30

Ø20

68

257

0 16

47.63

M10, 18

42°

22.23

72°

1

MKM, MRM

17/28

11

2

10

RE 15 190/07.03


426

Motor with tachometer shaft (dimensions in mm) Ordering detail “M” One size of tachometer shaft for all types, for measuring the motor speed, transmits a maximum torque of 5 Nm (for higher output torques please consult us).

22 20

Ø40h8

Ø10h6

6 x 8 deep, on one P.C.D. of Ø 63

4

Motor with through shaft (dimensions in mm) Ordering detail “M10–” (only for MKM 22 to 110) All of the radial piston motors of series MKM without the MKM 11 can be supplied with a through shaft, ordering detail M10-, for transmitting the full motor torque.

56 4 50 35

Ø 28k6

M8

Ø 40h8

19

Splined shaft DIN 5480 W 28 x 1.25 x 21 x 7h

RE 15 190/07.03

18/28

MKM, MRM


427

Valve design: pressure relief, anti-cavitation/feed, MKM...N01 (dimensions in mm) Series MKM radial piston motors with two direct operated pressure relief valves, gauge port G 1/4, anti-cavitation/feed via two 0.1 bar check valves and G 1/2 pipe connections. 100 67 33

A

160 1

B 49

MA

70 92

L1

89

36°

L

L 2 22

44,5

Counter bore Ø Depth 28 1.3+0.1 28 1.3+0.1 25 1.3–0.3 20 1 20 1 20 1 20 1 Up to 100 bar Up to 200 bar Up to 315 bar

MB B

39 237

Port Thread Depth A G 1/2 16 B G 1/2 16 L G 1/4 14 L1 G 1/4 14 L2 G 1/4 14 MA G 1/4 12 MB G 1/4 12 Pressure stage I Pressure stage II Pressure stage III

A

3

MA 53,5 89

Note: The valve cartridges are not included within the scope of supply, they must be ordered separately! Pressure stage to be stated in clear text!

Symbol (Version „MKM...N01”), function A

4

B L

MA

MB 0,1 bar

0,1 bar

0,5 bar

L2 A

MKM, MRM

Two individually adjustable DBDS 10 K1X/... valves protect the drive from overloads. Via port L1 and two 0.1 bar check valves the occurring leakage is fed back into the drive. A flow control valve can be screwed into port L1 so that the feed flow can be controlled. For the anticavitation function, the motor connection L is connected to L1 on the block and L2 is connected to tank. The leakage back pressure of 0.5 bar causes the motor leakage oil to be fed into the circuit.

L1 B

19/28

RE 15 190/07.03


428

Valve design: pressure relief, anti-cavitation/feed, valve connection NS 6, MKM...N61 (in mm) Series MKM radial piston motors with two direct operated pressure relief valves, gauge ports G 1/4, anti-cavitation/feed via two 0.1 bar check valves, G 1/2 pipe connections and valve connections NS 6 to DIN 24 340 form A6 (CETOP 3). 160

100 70

21,6 50

38

T

T

49

MA 170 142

L1 89

36°

L

70 92

P

L 22 22,5

Counter bore Ø Depth 28 2.1+0.1 23 0.5+0.1 25 1.3-0.3 20 1 20 1 Up to 100 bar Up to 200 bar Up to 315 bar

MB T

39 237

Port Thread Depth A, B G 1/2 16 P, T G 3/8 12 L G 1/4 14 L1, L2 G 1/4 14 MA, MB G 1/4 12 Pressure stage I Pressure stage II Pressure stage III

P MA

Note: The valve cartridges are not included within the scope of supply, they must be ordered separately!

30 89

Pressure stage to be stated in clear text!

Symbol (version „MKM...N61”), function A

B L

MA

MB 0,1 bar

0,1 bar

With this block design valves with a porting pattern to DIN 24 340 form A6 are bolted directly onto the motor. Two individually adjustable DBDS 10 K1X/... valves protect the drive from overloads. Via port L1 and two 0.1 bar check valves, the occurring leakage is fed back into the drive. A flow control valve can be screwed into port L1 so that the feed flow can be controlled. For the anticavitation function the motor connection L is connected to L1 on the block and L2 is connected to tank. The leakage back pressure of 0.5 bar causes the motor leakage oil to be fed into the circuit.

0,5 bar L2

L1 P T A

RE 15 190/07.03

B

20/28

MKM, MRM


429

Valve design: pressure relief, anti-cavitation/feed, valve connection NS 10, MKM...N101 (in mm) Series MKM radial piston motors with two direct operated pressure relief valves, gauge port G 1/4, anti-cavitation/feed via two 0.1 bar check valves and valve connection DIN 24 340 form A10 (CETOP 5). 50 100

25

4

17,5

P

P

1

T 160

T

49

156

197

MA

70 92

L1

89

2

36°

L

L 26

Counter bore Ø Depth 28 2.1+0.1 28 0.5 25 1.3–0.3 20 1 20 1 Up to 100 bar Up to 200 bar Up to 315 bar

MB P

39 237

Port Thread Depth A, B G 1/2 16 P, T G 1/2 14 L G 1/4 14 L1, L2 G 1/4 14 MA, MB G 1/4 12 Pressure stage I Pressure stage II Pressure stage III

3

MA

Note: The valve cartridges are not included within the scope of supply, they must be ordered separately!

53,5 89

Pressure stage to be stated in clear text!

Symbol (version „MKM...N101”), function A

B L

MA

MB 0,1 bar

0,1 bar

0,5 bar L2

With this block design, directional, proportional or servo valves with a porting pattern to DIN 24 340 form A10 are bolted directly onto the motor. Two individually adjustable DBDS 10 K1X/... valves protect the drive from overloads. Via port L1 and two 0.1 bar check valves the occurring leakage is fed back into the drive. A flow control valve can be screwed into port L1 so that the feed flow can be controlled. For anti-cavitation function the motor connection L is connected to L1 on the block and L2 is connected to tank. The leakage back pressure of 0.5 bar causes the motor leakage oil to be fed into the circuit.

L1 P T A

MKM, MRM

B

21/28

RE 15 190/07.03

4


430

Valve design: pressure relief, anti-cavitation/feed, MRM...N01 (dimensions in mm) Series MRM radial piston motors with two direct operated pressure relief valves, gauge ports G1/4, anti-cavitation/feed via two 0.1 bar check valves and G 3/4 pipe connections. 68 70

°

72

13

115

45

L1

80

MA L

L

42

Port Thread Depth A, B G 3/4 17 L G 3/8 14 L1, L2 G 3/8 14 MA, MB G 1/4 14 Pressure stage I Pressure stage II Pressure stage III

Counter bore Ø Depth 33 2.1+0.1 28 1.5 24 1 20 1 Up to 100 bar Up to 200 bar Up to 315 bar

MA MB

B

A

L2

L1 L

Note: The valve cartridges are not included within the scope of supply, they must be ordered separately! Pressure stage to be stated in clear text!

Symbol (version „MRM...N01“), function A

Two individually adjustable DBDS 10 K1X/... valves protect the drive from overloads. Via port L1 and two 0.1 bar check valves the occurring leakage is fed back into the drive. A flow control valve can be screwed into port L1 so that the feed flow can be controlled. When there is sufficient back pressure L1 can be connected with the tank line.

B L

MA

MB 0,1 bar

0,1 bar

L2

L1 A

RE 15 190/07.03

B

22/28

MKM, MRM


431

Valve design: pressure relief, anti-cavitation/feed, valve connection NS 6, MRM...N61 (in mm) Series MRM radial piston motors with two direct operated pressure relief valves, gauge port G 1/4, anti-cavitation/feed via two 0.1 bar check valves and valve connection DIN 24 340 form A6 (CETOP 3). 70

68

115 35

13

35

P

1

78

P

T

T L1

45

MA

80

°

72

L

L

2

Port Thread Depth P, T G 1/2 17 L G 3/8 14 L1, L2 G 3/8 14 MA, MB G 1/4 14 Pressure stage I Pressure stage II Pressure stage III

Counter bore Ø Depth 28 1 28 1.5 24 1 20 1 Up to 100 bar Up to 200 bar Up to 315 bar

MA MB T P

L1

3

L2 L

Note: The valve cartridges are not included within the scope of supply, they must be ordered separately! Pressure stage to be stated in clear text!

Symbol (version „MRM...N61”), function A

B L

MA

MB 0,1 bar

0,1 bar

L2

With this block design, valves with a porting pattern to DIN 24 340 form A6 are bolted directly onto the motor, due to the low entrapped volume of oil, this gives the drive good open loop or closed loop control characteristics. Two individually adjustable DBDS 10 K1X/... valves protect the drive from overloads. Via port L1 and two 0.1 bar check valves the occurring leakage is fed back into the drive. A flow control valve can be screwed into port L1 so that the feed flow can be controlled. When there is sufficient back pressure L1 can be connected with the tank line. L2 is plugged.

L1 P T A

MKM, MRM

B

23/28

RE 15 190/07.03

4


432

Valve design: pressure relief, anti-cavitation/feed, valve connection NS 10, MRM...N101 (in mm) Series MRM radial piston motors with two direct operated pressure relief valves, gauge port G 1/4, anti-cavitation/feed via two 0.1 bar check valves and valve connection DIN 24 340 form A10 (CETOP 5). 70

68

115 35

13

35

P 78

P

T

T L1

45

MA

80

°

72

L

L

Port Thread Depth P, T G 3/4 18 L G 3/8 14 L1, L2 G 3/8 14 MA, MB G 1/4 14 Pressure stage I Pressure stage II Pressure stage III

Counter bore Ø Depth 33 0.5 28 1.5 24 1 20 1 Up to 100 bar Up to 200 bar Up to 315 bar

MA MB T P

L1

L2 L

Note: The Valve cartridges are not included within the scope of supply, they must be ordered separately! Pressure stage to be stated in clear text!

Symbol (version „MRM...N101”), function A

B L

MA

MB 0,1 bar

0,1 bar

L2

With this block design, valves with a porting pattern to DIN 24 340 form A10 are bolted directly onto the motor, due to the low entrapped volume of oil, this gives the drive good open loop or closed loop control characteristics. Two individually adjustable DBDS 10 K1X/... valves protect the drive from overloads. Via port L1 and two 0.1 bar check valves the occurring leakage is fed back into the drive. A flow control valve can be screwed into port L1 so that the feed flow can be controlled. When there is sufficient back pressure L1 can be connected with the tank line. L2 is plugged.

L1 P T A

RE 15 190/07.03

B

24/28

MKM, MRM


433

Holding brake type LBD9A2 for motor types MKM 11 and MRM 11 (dimensions in mm)

1

289,5

2

100 9

2

1

58,5

30°

S1

135

S1

18

135

27,2 125h8 15,85+0,025

16

0

30

LB LB 18,5

4 1 2 3 4

2

30°

14H13

3

Control line G 1/4 to bleed the brake Breather filter (brake) M12 x 1.5 Brake drain oil connection M12 x 1.5 Key A5x5x20 DIN 6885

Holding brake type LBD11A2 for motor types MKM 22 to 110 (dimensions in mm) 11 3

61 3

45

2

1

00

Ø2

33

S1

LB 45°

175

Ø 120

Ø30k6

8

S1 15°

Ø160h8

45°

4

175

73

50

LB DIN 332 DS M8

4

3

9

Ø18

106 167

148 315

1 2 3 4

Control line G 1/4 to bleed the brake Breather filter (brake) M12 x 1.5 Brake drain oil connection M12 x 1.5 Key A8 x 7 x 45 DIN 6885

MKM, MRM

25/28

RE 15 190/07.03


434

Holding brake type LBD124A2 for motor types MRM 80 / MRM 125 (dimensions in mm)

472 79 10 65

DS-M16 DIN 332

60°

1

2

56

Ø11 Ø2 20

S1 L

00

Ø2

43

90

Ø40k6

Ø140h8

4

138

LB 5x

72

20

4 1 2 3 4

°

3

Control line G 1/4 to bleed the brake Breather filter (brake) M12 x 1.5 Brake drain oil connection M12 x 1.5 Key A12 x 8 x 56 DIN 6885

Holding brake type LBD249A2 for motor types MRM 160 / MRM 250 (dimensions in mm)

535 96 10

DS-M16 DIN 332

142

2

42°

1

18°

18°

82 2°

70

S1 93

Ø200 Ø22 0

53,5

L

Ø50k6

Ø140h8

1

Ø1

5x 7

4

LB 20

4 1 2 3 4

18°

3

Control line G 1/4 to bleed the brake Breather filter (brake) M12 x 1.5 Brake drain oil connection M12 x 1.5 Key A14 x 9 x 70 DIN 6885

RE 15 190/07.03

26/28

MKM, MRM


435

Circuit example Open circuit with brake control

7

2 3 Drive motor

Driven machine 1

4 6

5

6

1

8

9

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

Tank Pump Pressure relief valve Filter 4/3-way directional valve Pressure relief valve Hydraulic brake motor Check valve 3/2-way directional valve

Storage, assembly, commissioning Storage As delivered all of the connection holes in the motor housing are plugged with plastic plugs. The internal components are coated with hydraulic oil from the run on the test rig. The drive shaft and connection flange are protected by an anti-corrosion oil. The motor can be stored in this condition, in a dry room, for approx. 6 months. For longer storage periods the motor is to be fully filled with a water emulsifing hydraulic oil H-LPD. All ports are to be plugged or have blanking flanges, these are to be oil tight. After no later than 12 months the hydraulic oil must be replaced and the drive shaft rotated by hand approx. 10 times. Mounting, assembly – The installation orientation is optional. – Never use a hammer to drive on the couplings, pinions, etc., use screws to pull them on. Use the threaded hole in the drive shaft. – The mounting surface must be flat and rigid. – Use fixing screws with a minimum tensile strength class of 10.9, with reversal operation used location bolts. – Correctly line up the motor during assembly. – Tighten the bolts to the prescribed tightening torque.

2

The brakes have a leakage oil connection and a breather filter M12x1.5. Both of the connections can be exchanged. Fit the filter to the highest point so that oil cannot run out. When installing the holding brake apply it with pilot pressure so that the shaft can be rotated.

3

Drain oil line Lay the drain oil line so that the motor housing cannot drain, if necessary fit a check valve with maximum opening pressure of 0.2.

4 max. 0,2 bar

MKM, MRM

27/28

RE 15 190/07.03


436

Storage, assembly, commissioning

max. 0,2 bar

Flushing connection Flushing the motor with approx. 1 - 3 L/min (dependent on the type) is recommended for high temperatures and powers. Leakage and flushing fluid is passed back to the reservoir. The maximum permissible housing pressure in the leakage chamber is 1.5 bar.

Commissioning Motor Before the initial commissioning the motor has to be filled with filtered operating medium via the drain connection. Drive the motor at a low power until leakage oil escapes, then full power can be applied. For motors with a separate flushing circuit first switch on the flushing circuit then the motor. Check the housing pressure: maximum of 1.5 bar leakage pressure. Brake Fill the brake before commissioning via the breather filter, remove the filter to access the filling point (wet running). LBD9A2 LBD11A2 LBD124A2 LBD249A2 0.01 litre 0.01 litre 0.02 litre 0.04 litre Switch the holding brake more than once and check for correct function. During operation the motor and holding brake must not become warmer than the operating medium.

Bosch Rexroth AG Industrial Hydraulics

Bosch Rexroth Limited

D-97813 Lohr am Main Zum Eisengießer 1 • D-97816 Lohr am Main Telefon 0 93 52 / 18-0 Telefax 0 93 52 / 18-23 58 • Telex 6 89 418-0 eMail documentation@boschrexroth.de Internet www.boschrexroth.de

Cromwell Road, St Neots Cambs, PE19 2ES Tel: 0 14 80/22 32 56 Fax: 0 14 80/21 90 52 E-mail: info@boschrexroth.co.uk

RE 15 190/07.03

28/28

The data specified above only serves to describe the product. No statements concerning a certain condition or suitability for a certain application can be derived from our information. The details stated do not release you from the responsibility for carrying out your own assessment and verification. It must be remembered that our products are subject to a natural process of wear and ageing.

MKM, MRM


Bosch Rexroth AG Zum Eisengießer 1 97816 Lohr, Germany Phone +49(0)9352/18-0 Fax +49(0)9352/18-40 info@boschrexroth.de www.boschrexroth.com

Find your local contact person here: www.boschrexroth.com/contact

Document no.: RE 00112-02 Material no.: R999000303 Versions no.: 2013-08 Replaces: RE 00112-01_2008-11 © Bosch Rexroth AG 2013 Subject to revisions!


Issuu converts static files into: digital portfolios, online yearbooks, online catalogs, digital photo albums and more. Sign up and create your flipbook.